- 1.70 MB
- 2022-06-17 15:50:52 发布
- 1、本文档共5页,可阅读全部内容。
- 2、本文档内容版权归属内容提供方,所产生的收益全部归内容提供方所有。如果您对本文有版权争议,可选择认领,认领后既往收益都归您。
- 3、本文档由用户上传,本站不保证质量和数量令人满意,可能有诸多瑕疵,付费之前,请仔细先通过免费阅读内容等途径辨别内容交易风险。如存在严重挂羊头卖狗肉之情形,可联系本站下载客服投诉处理。
- 文档侵权举报电话:19940600175。
5A版优质实用文档目 录第一篇词法2一、名词2二、冠词9三、代词14四、形容词、副词24五、连词38六、介词45七、数词57八、动词62第二篇句法81一、主要句式81二、定语从句90三、常见习惯用语94四、完形填空与阅读106附录117中学生英语学习常见错误一览表117A117B123C128D133E136F139G143H145I149J150K151L152M156N159O162P1633525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档R166S168T172U175V176W177Y179第一篇词法一、名词(一)知识概要名词的概念在不同的语法教课书中有不同的解释和分类方法,但就实际应用来讲还是不要过分地追求其理论概念,而更多的要把注意力放在其应用上来。我们不妨把它分为两大类:专有名词与普通名词。顾名思义,专有名词是指:个人、事物、机关等所专有的名称,如,theGreatWall,America…它们是不能随意变动的。而普通名词中则包括个体名词,如pen,worker…它表示单一的个体人或事物;集体名词,如:family,class,team,它表示的是由若干个个体组成的集合体;物质名词,如:water,paper…它表示的是一种物质,原材料;而后一种是抽象名词,如:work,time…它表示着一种在实际生活中看不见、摸不到,但却与实际生活紧密相关的某些动作、状态、品质的抽象概念。见下表。名词一览表种类专有名词London,John,theCommunistPartyofChina普通名词类名词nurse,boy,worker,pencil,dog,table集体名词class,family,army,police,team,people物质名词water,steel,glass,cotton,wood,sand抽象名词happiness,love,work,life,courage,honest功用主语MyfamilyisnowinNewYork.表语Hisfatherisascientist.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档宾语Weloveourgreatmotherland.宾语补足语HemadeLondonthebaseforhiswork.定语Thegirlsaremakingpaperflowesrs.状语Thecarcosthim1000dollars.同位语MrBrown,afamousscientist,willcomehere.名词在使用中的难点在于名词的数,即可数名词与不可数名词的实际应用。不可数名词不能用数字计算,所以它通常只有单数形式。它包含有专有名词、物质名词、抽象名词等,如:English,air,water,cotton,work…可数名词是可以用数量加以计算的名词,所以它具有单数形式和复数形式两种。可数名词复数形式的构成规律是:1.一般情况加s,如:pen—pens,doctor—doctors,boy—boys,其读音规则是在清辅音后读[s],在元音和浊辅音后读[z]。如:map—map,boy—boys.2.在以s,sh,ch,G结尾的名词后面加es,如:bus—buses,class—classes,其读音为[iz]。3.以ce,se,ze,(d)ge结尾的名词加s,其读音为[iz]。4.以辅音字母加y结尾的名词,要将y变为i再加es,读作[z],如:factory—factories,country—countries,family—families.但要注意的是以元音字母加y结尾的名词的复数形式只加s,如:boy—boys,day—days。5.以o结尾的名词的复数形式一般要加es,但如果o前面是元音字母或外来词,缩写词以o结尾的则只加s,如:tomato—tomatoes,hero—heroes;photo—photos,radio—radios,piano—pianos6.以f或fe结尾的名词的复数形式要将f或fe变为v再加es,如:knife—knives,leaf—leaves,但有些例外的词如roof的复数形式是roofs。7.不规则名词的复数形式是要单个记忆的,它没有规律可循,如:man—men,woman—women,child—children,foot—feet,tooth—teeth,mouse—mice8.单复同形的名词有:fish,sheep,deer…9.单数形式但其意为复数的名词有:people,police等。名词还有格的变化,其主格可作主语,宾格可作宾语。还有所有格,用来表示人或物的所有,以及领属关系。表示有生命的名词的所有格其单数形式是加"s其复数形式是s",如其结尾不是s的复数形式仍加"s,如:astudent"sroom,students"rooms,Children"s3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Day.在表示时间、距离、世界、国家……名词的所有格要用"s,如:atwentyminutes"walk.但无生命名词的所有格则必须用of结构,如:thecapitalofourcountry,thecolouroftheflowers(二)正误辨析[误]Pleasegivemeapaper.[正]Pleasegivemeapieceofpaper.[析]不要认为可以数的名词就是可数名词,这种原因是对英语中可数与不可数名词的概念与中文中的能数与不能数相混淆了,所以造成了这样的错误,因paper在英语中是属于物质名词一类,是不可数名词。而不可数名词要表达数量时,要用与之相关的量词来表达,如:twopiecesofpaper.[误]Pleasegivemetwoletterpapers.[正]Pleasegivemetwopiecesofletterpaper.[析]paper作为纸讲是不可数名词,而作为报纸、考卷、文章讲时则是可数名词,如:Eachstudentshouldwriteapaperonwhathehaslearnt.[误]Myglassesisbroken.[正]Myglassesarebroken.[误]Iwanttobuytwoshoes.[正]Iwanttobuytwopairsofshoes.[析]英语中glasses—眼镜,shoes—鞋,trousers—裤子等由两部分组成的名词一般要用复数形式。如果要表示一副眼镜应用apairofglasses而这时的谓语动词应与量词相一致。如:Thispairofglassesisverygood.[误]MayIborrowtworadioes?[正]MayIborrowtworadios?[析]以o结尾的名词大都是用加es来表示其复数形式,但如果o前面是一个元音字母或外来语时则只加s就可以了。这样的词有zoo—zoos,piano—pianos.[误]ThisisaMary"sdictionary.[正]ThisisMary"sdictionary.[析]如名词前有指示代词this,that,thesethose,及其他修饰词our,some,every,which,或所有格时,则不要再加冠词。[误]Therearemuchpeopleinthegarden.[正]Therearemanypeopleinthegarden.[析]可数名词前应用many,few,afew,alotof来修饰,而people3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档是可数名词,而且是复数名词,如:Thepeopleareplantingtreeshere.[误]Iwantafewwater.[正]Iwantalittlewater.[析]不可数名词前可以用alittle,little,alotof,some来修饰,但不可用many,few来修饰。[误]Thankyouverymuch.Yourfamilyisverykindtome.[正]Thankyouverymuch.Yourfamilyareverykindtome.[误]Tom"sandMary"sfamilyarewaitingforus.[正]Tom"sandMary"sfamiliesarewaitingforus.[误]I"msorry.Ihavetogo.Tom"sfamiliesarewaitingforme.[正]I"msorry.Ihavetogo.Tom"sfamilyarewaitingforme.[析]集合名词如果指某个集合的整体,则应视为单数,如指某个集合体中的个体则应视为复数。如:Myfamilyisabigfamily.WhenIcamein,Tom"sfamilywerewatchingTV.即汤姆一家人正在看电视。这样的集合名词有:familyclass,team等。[误]Don"teattoomuchmeats.[正]Don"teattoomuchmeat.[误]Foodinthatrestaurantisverygood.[正]Thefoodinthatrestaurantisverygood.[析]物质名词是不可数名词,在使用中不可以加s,即它没有复数形式。也不可加不定冠词。但如果用于特指某一物质时可以加定冠词。如:Idon"tlikedrinkingcoffee,butthecoffeeinthatcupisreallygood.[误]Pleasegivemetwowaters.[正]Pleasegivemetwoglassesofwater.[正]Pleasegivemetwocoffees.[析]物质名词如要加计量时,一定要加量词,如:twocupsoftea,twoglassesofwater,aglassofmilk,aloafofbread,apieceofbread,aboGofsugar,abowlofrice,abottleoforange,abagofearth例:I"lltellyouapieceofgoodnews.但只有coffee可以用coffees来取代manycupsofcoffee.[误]Canyougivemethenewspaperoftoday?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Canyougivemetoday"snewspaper?[析]加"s构成所有格的名词一般应指有生命的人或物。如:Mary"shair,但在英文的习惯用法中对时间、距离等名词的所有格多用"s来构成而不用of结构。如:afiveminutes"walk.[误]Pleasemakearoomfortheladyintheschoolbus.[正]Pleasemakeroomfortheladyintheschoolbus.[析]英语中更多的名词是含有多种用法和多种含意的,如:room为可数名词时为“房间”,如:IliveinRoom5.而room为抽象名词时为空间上面一句话应译为“请给老妇人在校车上留个地方。”这样的词还有:glass玻璃glasses眼镜stone石头astone一块石头time时间twotimes两次wood木头woods树林[误]Thereisaflowersgardenbehindmyhouse.[正]Thereisaflowergardenbehindmyhouse.[析]名词除了在句中作主语、宾语、表语外,还可以用来修饰另一个名词,这时作修饰词的名词一般要用单数形式,如:shoefactory(鞋厂),postoffice(邮局),eveningpaper(晚报),nightschool(夜校),headmaster(校长),alawschool(法律学院)。但也有例外,如:agoodstrain(货车),sportsmeeting(运动会)。[误]Mymotherboughttwofishesforsupperthismorning.[正]Mymotherboughttwofishforsupperthismorning.[析]英语中有些名词单复同形,如:fish,deer,sheep,Chinese(中国人),means(方法)。所以应讲onefish,twofish,oneChinese,twoChinese.如果讲Therearefivefishesinthepool.应译为池中有五种鱼而不是五条鱼。[误]MaryeGpressedherthanktoherboyfriend.[正]MaryeGpressedherthankstoherboyfriend.[析]英语中有些名词只有复数形式,如:thanks,greens,而有些词单数形式与复数形式有不同的词意。如:clothes为衣服,而cloth则是布,sand沙子,而sands是沙滩。[误]Iofferedmysonmycongratulationonhissuccess.[正]Iofferedmysonmycongratulationsonhissuccess.[析]英语中表示祝贺的词虽有单数形式,但一般要用其复数形式。如握手为shakehands.[误]WehavefiveGermaninthismeeting.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]WehavefiveGermansinthismeeting.[析]英国人Englishman的复数形式为Englishmen,而German则要加s,因为它不是由国名与man的组合词。[误]TherearetwoAsinthisword.[正]TherearetwoA"sinthisword.[析]在大写字母缩写形式的复数表达法中应加s,但如字母是A、I时,为了防止与As和Is相混,则要用"s即A"s,I"s[误]Therearethree6sandtwo3sinmytelephonenumber.[正]Therearethree6"sandtwo3"sinmytelephonenumber.[析]在小写字母与数字的复数形式表达法中要用"s[误]Wehavemanywomanteachersinourschool.[正]Wehavemanywomenteachersinourschool.[析]一般组合名词变为复数形式时只将词中心词变为复数如:halfbrother—halfbrothers(同父异母或同母异父的兄弟)daughterinlaw—daughtersinlaw,(儿媳)但要注意的是:mandriver—mendrivers(男司机)womandoctor—womendoctors(女大夫)grownup—grownups(成年人)但是boystudent—则变为boystudents[误]Physicsareverydifficulttolearn.[正]Physicsisverydifficulttolearn.[析]虽以s结尾但只能用作单数名词有:科学,学科名字:Physics.Mathematicspolitics游戏名称:bowls专有名称:NiagaraFalls(尼亚加拉瀑布)其他名词:news(消息,新闻)[误]Thereisapeopleintheroom.[正]Thereisapersonintheroom.[正]Thereisamanintheroom.[析]people是复数名词,不可用作单数,如要用来讲一个人时应用aperson,aman,awoman。同样的词有police.要讲一个警察时则要用apoliceman,apolicewoman。[误]Whereismyshoe?[正]Wherearemyshoes?[析]常常只用作复数形式的词有trousers,pants,shorts(短裤),socks(袜子),shoes,gloves(手套)。但如果只找其中的一个则要指明,这时还是应用单数形式。如:Where"smyleftglove?(我左手的手套在哪?)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Ipaidfivepenniesforthesweet.[正]Ipaidfivepenceforthesweet.[析]英语中便士有两个复数形式pence用来表达一定数量的钱。而pennies是指一个个的硬币,如:Iwanttochangethisnoteforpennies.我想把这纸币换成硬币。(即一便士一个的硬币)。[误]Therearemanyfruitintheshop.[正]Therearemanyfruitsintheshop.[析]物质名词为不可数名词,但是用来表示种类时则可以用作可数名词,这里应译为各种各样的水果。[误]Thereisanewcar.ItisJone"sandMary"s.[正]Thereisanewcar.ItisJoneandMary"s.[析]有生命名词的所有格,如果是单数名词则加"s如:Mary"scar.如果是以s结尾的复数名词则只在s后面加’如:teachers"offices.如果是复数名词但不是以s结尾,则只加’s,如:children"spalace组合名词的所有格是在最后一个词尾加"s如:girlfriend—girlfriend"ssomeoneelse—someoneelse"saweekorthree—aweekorthree"s如名词后有同位语时,则应加在同位语的词尾上,如:Itismygirlfriend,Mary"scar.要注意的是当两个名词并列时,如表示归两人共同所有,则在最后一个名词后面加"s,如果表示分别所有则在两个名词后分别加"s,如:ThisisMaryandJone"shome.即Mary与Jone是一家人。这是他们共同的家。而TheseareMary"sandJone"shomes.则应译为这里是Mary的家与Jone的家。[误]Itisreallybeautiful.Itisaworkofnature.[正]Itisreallybeautiful.ItisaNature"swork.[析]无生命名词的所有格应用of结构。但是"s形式的所有格可用于以下无生命的名词:表示时间的词:today"snewspaper,atwentyminutes"walk,anhour"s,rest表示长度的词:threemetres"distance,aboat"slength,twentymiles"journey表示重量的名词:twopounds"weight价格名词:twodollars"worth拟人化的名词:Nature"swork,nature"slesson(大自然的教训)及国家、机关、团体、城市等机构性名词:theuniversity"slibrary[误]Heisanoldfriendofmyfather.[正]Heisanoldfriendofmyfather"s.[析]这是英语中的一种习惯用法而不要根据语法去推理。如:ThispenisTom"s.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Myfatherisagoodcooker.[正]Myfatherisagoodcook.[析]一般动词加上er后则转意为执行该动作的执行者,如:teach(教)—teacher(老师),think(想)—thinker(思想家),drive(开车)—driver(司机),sell(卖)—seller(卖物者)……但不能总是以此类推,比如cook是动词“做饭”。而cook也可作为名词“厨师”讲,而cooker则为厨具,餐具,即锅、碗、勺等做饭用具。[误]Theyoungisdancingthere.[正]Theyoungaredancingthere.[析]英文中用定冠词加上形容词表示一类人时应按复数名词,如:therich富人,thepoor(穷人),thewise聪明人,但如果用定冠词加形容词来表示事物则要用作单数名词,如:Thebeautifulisstillhere.美丽的风景依旧。[误]Thestoriesofthebookwaswrittenmanyyearsago.[正]Thestoriesofthebookwerewrittenmanyyearsago.[析]这句话的真正主语应是stories,所以应用复数谓语动词。[误]ThisisoneoftheEnglishChinesedictionary.[正]ThisisoneoftheEnglishChinesedictionaries.[析]oneof意为“……之一”,of后面的名词要用复数形式。[误]Let"sgotouncleWangforsupper.[正]Let"sgotouncleWang"sforsupper.[析]uncleWang"s意为“王叔叔家”,doctor"s意为“医院或私人诊所”。[误]Ithinkwewillmakeafriendwitheachother.[正]Ithinkwewillmakefriendswitheachother.[析]makefriends为习惯用法,即交朋友。[误]Iwanttotellyoumuchpiecesofgoodnews.[正]Iwanttotellyoumanypiecesofgoodnews.[析]news为不可数名词,但加了量词之后则要用many来修饰量词,因量词是可数名词,或可以说Iwanttotellyousomegoodnews.因some即可用在可数名词前,也可用在不可数名词前作形容词,如:Iwanttotellyousomepiecesofgoodnews.[误]Theteacherwithfivestudentsarecominghere.[正]Theteacherwithfivestudentsiscominghere.[析]要注意由with引出的介词短语不是本句的主语,这与连词and3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档有很大的区别,如:Theteacherandfivestudentsarecominghere.这里由介词引出的短语仅仅是teacher的修饰语。[误]Therearealotofinformationhere,butwedon"tneedthem.[正]Thereisalotofinformationhere,butwedon"tneedit.[析]information为不可数名词,而用作代替它的词要用it而不能用them.[误]ManyastudentmakethesamemistakeintheeGam.[正]ManyastudentmakesthesamemistakeintheeGam.[析]manya加可数名词单数,作主语时其谓语动词应用单数形式,但其意为许多学生。[误]Thechildrenwearverygoodclothtogotoschooltoday.[正]Thechildrenwearverygoodclothestogotoschooltoday.[析]英文中cloth,clothes,clothing是易混之词:cloth是物质名词,意为“布”,没有复数形式,而clothing是指衣物的总称,也没有复数形式。clothes是指衣服,但没有单数形式,如:Thisclothingisneededinwarmcountries.Herclothesaremadeoffinecloth.英文中的dress则指较正规的服装,如:aschooldress校服,aneveningdress晚礼服。[误]IliketostudytheEnglish.[正]IliketostudyEnglish.[析]作为一种学科名词前不要用冠词,而作为某一特指学科则要加冠词,如:Iliketostudyhistory.IliketostudythehistoryofAmerica.[误]TheBrownsisgoingtovisitChina.[正]TheBrownsaregoingtovisitChina.[析]定冠词加姓加s,则意为“Brown先生一家人”。所以应用复数谓语动词。此句应译为:Brown先生一家将要访问中国。(三)例题解析1.LucyandLily___inthesameclass.A.amB.isC.areD.be[答案]C.[析]由and连接两个单数名词作主语时应按复数名词来搭配谓语动词。2.Whichisthe___tothebusstop,please?AroadBwayCstreetDaddress[答案]B.[析]这是考察同意词辨析,road是指较宽阔的大道,意为“乡间公路”,而3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档street意为道路两边的建筑物较高,可视为街道之意,而way则多为要到达某地所要经过的途径,还可引深为方式、方法。而address则为“地址”。如:Thereisacarrunningalongthecountryroad.Iliveat105Parkstreet.CanyoushowmethewaytotheNationalMuseum?3.Hurryup!Thereis___timeleft.AlittleBalittleCfewDafew[答案]A.[析]因time作为时间讲为不可数名词,所以不可用few,afew来修饰。另外,英文的表达法与中文不同,中文讲,快点,时间不多了,而英文要讲,快点,没时间了。因此,要用little而不用alittle.4.Howmany___canyouseeinthepicture?AtomatosBtomatoesCtomatoDthetomato[答案]B.[析]用Howmany提问时,其名词要用复数形式,而tomato的复数要加es.5.— ___isthemeat.Please?— Tenyuanakilo.AHowmuchBHowmanyCHowoldDHowlong[答案]A.[析]由对话的答语可看出其问句问的是价格。钱数作为整体、价格讲时,不论其值是多少都是不可数名词,要用howmuch提问。6Theboy"snameisJamesAllenGreen.Sohisgivennameis___.AJamesAllenBAllenGreenCJamesGreenDMr.Green[答案]A.[析]英文的习惯与中文不同,中文是姓在前名字在后,而英文则是姓在最后,其第一个名字是由父母所起的,中间的名字可能是父母、教父所起的,但都可称作givenname,而姓在英文中是familyname.7Shanghaiisoneofthebiggest___inourcountry.AcityBcity"sCcitysDcities[答案]D.[析]复音字母以y结尾的单词的复数形式要把y变成i再加es。oneof加名词的结构中的名词应用复数。8Wouldyoupleasepassme___?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Atwopaper BtwopapersCtwopiecesofpaperDtwopiecesofpapers[答案]C.[析]paper是不可数名词,如讲一张、两张纸时,要用量词piece.9September10this___Day.ATeacherBTeachersCTeacher"sDTeachers"[答案]D.10Ionlyhave___breadforlunchtoday.AabitBabitofClittleDfew[答案]B.11“Whatwouldyoulike,Ann?”“I"dliketwo___.”AglassofmilkBglassesofmilkCglassofmilksDglassesofmilks[答案]B.12Thereisn"t___paperintheboG.Willyougoandget___forme?Aany,someBany,anyCsome,someDsome,any[答案]A.[析]any用于否定句与疑问句,但如果要表达说话者真心实意希望得到肯定答复时,问句中要用some而不要按一般语法规律用any.13June1stis___.AChildren"sdayBchildren"sDayCChildren"sDayDchildren"sday[答案]C.14Theseforeignfriendsare___.AGermanBGermenCGermanyDGermans[答案]D.15Allthestudentsarebusy,so___ofthemwillgotothecinema.AmanyBlittleCafewDfew[答案]D.[析]student是可数名词,而few用于可数名词,意为:几乎没有学生去电影院。16Therearethree___andseven___inthepicture.Adeers,sheepsBdeers,sheep3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Cdeer,sheepDdeer,sheeps[答案]C.[析]deer与sheep均是单复同形的名词。17Whoseroomisthis?It"s___.AmyBKike"sandJohn"sCourDKikeandJohn"s[答案]D.[析]因为room为单数,所以不可能是Kike的一间与John的一间,应为二者共用的一间房子。二、冠词(一)知识概要冠词在英语中只有3个词,分为两类:不定冠词a与an,定冠词the。a用在以辅音开始的单数名词前,an用于以元音开始的单词前。不定冠词用来表示一类事物中泛指的某一事物,而定冠词则用于特指的某一个或某些事物,可用于不可数名词、可数名词单数及可数名词复数前。(二)正误辨析[误]Thisbuildingisanuniversity.[正]Thisbuildingisauniversity.[析]a用于以辅音音素开始的单词前,而an用于以元音音素开始的单词前,而不是元音字母开头的单词前。university的第一个音素是[j],所以用a而不要用an。又如:Thereisa“n”intheword.是错句,应为:Thereisan“n”intheword.因字母n的发音的第一个音素是元音。要注意的还有hour因其第一个字母h不发音,所以应该用anhour。例如:Ineedanhourtofinishthework.Itisausefuldictionary.ItisaEuropeancountry.Iboughtausedcar.[误]Ineedaumbrellabecauseitlookslikeraining.[正]Ineedanumbrellabecauseitlookslikeraining.[析]因umbrella的第一个音素是元音,所以应用an.常用的情况有:anoldman,anEnglishteacher,anelephant,anidea,anhourago,anhonest3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档boy…。[误]“Canyouhelpme”“Sorry,I"minhurry.”[正]“Canyouhelpme”“Sorry.I"minahurry.”[析]不定冠词的主要用法如下:1.用来表示一类人或事物,如:Sheisateacher.2.指某一类人或事物中的一个,如:Anelephantisbiggerthanahorse.3.泛指某一人或事物,如:Amaniswaitingforyouattheschoolgate.4.相当于“one”的概念,如:Ijustboughtanewdictionary.5.其主要的难点是用在固定词组中:如:haveawalk/arest/alook又如:inahurry匆匆忙忙makeaface作鬼脸dosomebodyafavour帮某人忙anumberof=many又如:haveagoodtime(玩得好)haveacold(感冒)haveaheadache(头痛)haveabreak=havearest[误]Iboughtthedictionaryyesterday.Adictionaryisverygood.[正]Iboughtadictionaryyesterday.Thedictionaryisverygood.[析]在文章中第一次提到某物时用不定冠词,而第二次提到时用定冠词。[误]Pleaseturnofflightsbeforeyouleave.[正]Pleaseturnoffthelightsbeforeyouleave.[析]虽然是第一次提到某物但说话双方均知其所指,也应用定冠词。[误]Therearenineplanetsaroundasun.[正]Therearenineplanetsaroundthesun.[析]世上独一无二的天体等名词前应加定冠词,如:theearth,themoon,thesun,thesky,thesea.[误]Iliveonasecondfloorofthisbuilding.[正]Iliveonthesecondfloorofthisbuilding.[析]在序数词,形容词最高级前要用定冠词。如:Heistheoldestinthefamily.[误]Iwanttolearnthesecondlanguagethisterm.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Iwanttolearnasecondlanguagethisterm.[析]在序数词的含意不是顺序中的第一第二,而其意在于再学一个,再来一个时,应用a,本句的意思应为:这学期我要学一门第二外语。[误]Mississippiisoneofthelongestriversintheworld.[正]TheMississippiisoneofthelongestriversintheworld.[析]在河流名称前应加定冠词,如:theYellowRiver(黄河)。[误]Look,thereareAlp.[误]Look,therearetheAlp.[正]Look,therearetheAlps.[析]具体的某一座山不加定冠词,如:MountainTai.但在山名称前加定冠词后,其山名要加s,来表示山脉。theAlps即为阿尔卑斯山脉。如:TheAlpsareinthecenterofEurope.[误]Timesisoneoftheoldestnewspapersintheworld.[正]TheTimesisoneoftheoldestnewspapersintheworld.[析]报刊名称前应加定冠词。[误]Richarenotalwayshappy.[正]Thericharenotalwayshappy.[析]在形容词前加定冠词表示一类人,而在姓的前面加定冠词,姓后加s表示某一家,如:TheturnersaregoingtomovetoNewYork.[误]Iliketoeatbreadforbreakfast.Breadsellsinthisshopisverygood.[正]Iliketoeatbreadforbreakfast.Thebreadsellsinthisshopisverygood.[析]物质名词特指时也应加定冠词。[误]Thesunrisesineast.[正]Thesunrisesintheeast.[析]在方向、方位前应用定冠词,如:intheeast,inthewest,inthenorth,inthesouth,inthedirection及inthepast,inthefuture[误]Doyouknowwhoinventedtelephone[正]Doyouknowwhoinventedthetelephone[析]在特定和专有事物或名称前要加定冠词,如:theEnglishChannel英吉利海峡thePanamaCanal巴拿马运河theSuezCanal苏伊士运河3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Wouldyoupleasebuysomefoodforthesupper[正]Wouldyoupleasebuysomefoodforsupper[析]泛指一日三餐前无定冠词。[误]Iliketoclimbthemountainintheautumn.[正]Iliketoclimbthemountaininautumn.[析]一年四季前不用定冠词,如:Springisthebestseasoninayear.[误]Sometimesmyparentscometoschooltoseeme.[正]Sometimesmyparentscometotheschooltoseeme.[析]有些名词被用作其本身原来所含目的时不加冠词,如:gotoschool上学,leaveschool(辍学),afterschool(放学),但如果当建筑物讲时应加冠词,如例句中其父母来校不是上学,而是看望孩子,则要加定冠词。又如,Hewasinhospitalfortwodays.(他在医院住院两天了。)而:Hewenttothehospitaltoseehismother.他去医院看望他的母亲。[误]Iboughtasamedictionaryasshebought.[正]Iboughtthesamedictionaryasshebought.[析]在惯用法thesame,theonly,thevery前的定冠词不可换为不定冠词。[误]Thepolicecaughtthethiefbyhisarm.[正]Thepolicecaughtthethiefbythearm.[析]这是英文表达法与中文的明显不同之处,也是初学者极易忽视之处。在英语中的某些动词,如:catch(抓),take(拿),strike(打),pat(拍),hit(击),hold(握),pull(拉)…动词后应加人,再加介词on,by,in,with…之后要加定冠词,再加人体的某一部位。这时的定冠词千万不要换作his,her,their,等词。[误]Hewaspaidbyhour.[正]Hewaspaidbythehour.[析]by和计量单位之间要有定冠词。这句话应译为:他的工资是按小时计算的。[误]IwenttoNewYorkbyhiscar.[正]IwenttoNewYorkbycar.[正]IwenttoNewYorkinhiscar.[析]by仅仅与交通工具相连表示应用某种工具,而加了别的修饰词后其前面的介词也应作相应的转换。如:bycar(坐小汽车)bytaGi(坐出租车)bybike(骑自行车)bywater(乘船)byair(乘飞机)bysea(乘船)[误]Marybegantolearnhowtoplaypianowhenshewasthree.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Marybegantolearnhowtoplaythepianowhenshewasthree.[析]在乐器前要加定冠词,而在球类游戏之前则不要加冠词,如:Theyliketoplaybridgewhentheyarefree.(他们空闲时爱打桥牌)[误]Thelittleboywantedtogotocinema.[正]Thelittleboywantedtogotothecinema.[析]英语中虽有一些名词与goto连用时不加定冠词,以表示该名词的内涵,如:gotoschool(上学),gotobed(睡觉)等,但去看电影则例外,要用gotothecinema.这也是语言的一个特点。[误]Iliveat105theLakestreet.[正]Iliveat105LakeStreet.[析]街道名称前不用冠词。[误]NeGtsummerholidayIwillgotocountrytoliveonafarm.[正]NeGtsummerholidayIwillgotothecountrytoliveonafarm.[析]country既作国家讲也作乡村讲。作乡村讲时,一定要加定冠词,而且只有单数形式,作国家讲时则可有复数形式。如:Japanisacountry.Japan,China,IndiaareAsiancountries.[误]Thepicturelooksbetteratthedistance.[正]Thepicturelooksbetteratadistance.[析]atadistance意为“离开一定距离”。而inthedistance为“远方,远处”。这样常用的词组有:asarule(照例)inahurry(匆忙)inthemorning/afternoon(上/下午)inthesun(在阳光下)intherain(雨中)inthesameway(同样)intheshade(在阴凉处)inthedaytime(白天)intheend(最终)ontheotherhand(换句话说)onthecontrary(相反)[误]Thelittleboyandgirlwalkalongthestreetahandinahand.[正]Thelittleboyandgirlwalkalongthestreethandinhand.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]这是英语中的习惯用法,如:bitbybit(逐渐)dayafter(by)day(一天又一天)dayandnight(日日夜夜)facetoface(面对面)fromAtoZ(自始至终)fromtimetotime(再三)handinhand(手拉手)shoulderbyshoulder(肩并肩)(三)例题解析1MrLiis___oldworker.AaBanCsomeD/[答案]B.[析]an用于元音音素开始的单词前。2Englishis___usefullanguagein___world.Aan,theBa,theCthe,/D/,the[答案]B.[析]因useful的第一个音素是[j],它是辅音音素。3What___interestingbookitis?AaBanCtheD/[答案]B.[析]这是感叹句,因为移到原一般句前面的强调部分中有可数名词book,所以应加冠词,而interesting的第一音素是元音所以要加an。4Hewillbebackin___hour.A/BtheCaDan[答案]D.[析]因hour的首字母h不发音。5Thereis___mapintheclassroom.___mapisonthewall.Aa,ABthe,TheCa,TheDthe,A[答案]C.[析]在文章中首次提到某人或某物时用不定冠词,而第二次再提到该物或人时应用定冠词。6Lookat___picture!There"s___houseinit.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Aa,aBthe,theCa,theDthe,a[答案]D.[析]虽然是第一次提到,但在句中的语言是让对方看某一特定的图画,所以应选择D。7Thereis___orangeinthebottle.AaBanCtheD/[答案]D.[析]这里的orange是指桔汁而不是一个个的桔子。8Beijingis___capitalofourcountry.AtheBanC/Da[答案]A.[析]capital之后有of结构则要用定冠词。9IfyouworkhardatEnglish,you"llget___“A”inthetest.AanB/CtheDa[答案]A.[析]因字母A的第一音素是元音。10Heusuallygoestoschoolon___foot.AaBanCtheD/[答案]D.[析]onfoot意为走路上学,是习惯用法。三、代词(一)知识概要英语中代词可以分为人称代词、物主代词、反身代词、指示代词、疑问代词、不定代词。人称代词主要有主格和宾格之别。请看下表人称我你他她它我们你们他们 主格iyouhesheitweyouthey宾格meyouhimheritusyouthem物主代词分形容词性物主代词和名词性物主代词两种。请看下表人称我的你的他的她的它的我们的你们的他们的3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档形容词性myyourhisheritsoursyourthey名词性mineyourshishersitsoursyourstheirs反身代词可见下表人称我你他她它我们你们他们 反身代词myselfyourselfhimselfherselfitselfourselvesyourselfthemselves指示代词主要有this,that,these,those疑问代词有:who,whomwhose,what,which,还有疑问副词when,how,where,why。不定代词在初中课本中主要有some,any,many,much,each,neither,other,another,all,both,one,none,either…(二)正误辨析[误]Tom"smotheristallerthanmy.[正]Tom"smotheristallerthanmine.[析]形容词性物主代词可以作定语,也就是讲它可以作形容词,如:mybook,而这句话的意思是:汤姆的妈妈比我的妈妈高。比较的对象是mymother,也就是mine。[误]Wehavealotofhomeworktodotoday.Soweneedtwoorthreehourstofinishthem.[正]Wehavealotofhomeworktodotoday.Soweneedtwoorthreehourstofinishit.[析]在应用代词时,要注意人称,格与数的一致性。这里it所代替的是不可数名词homework,所以应用it。[误]Heandyoushouldgotothelibrarytoreturnthebooks.[正]Youandheshouldgotothelibrarytoreturnthebooks.[析]这主要是英语习惯上的用法。当两个以上的人称代词并列时其排列顺序一般为you,he,she,I,而复数时为we,you,they:如男女并列时,应先男后女,如:Heandshe…如果在表示不好意思,承担责任时,单数时用,I,he,she,you,复数时用They,you,we,如:TomandIaregoodfriends.You,heandImustgotoplaythegameforourteamthisafternoon.We,youandtheyhavebeentherebefore.I,heandyouhavetopayforit.[误]Heorhisbrotherisdoingtheirhomework.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Heorhisbrotherisdoinghishomework.[析]由either…or,neither…nor,or连接两个主语时,如果两主语是单数时,用单数代词,如两主语是复数时,用复数代词,如:Eitherteachersorstudentswanttodotheirbesttohelptheoldman.如是一单一复两名词时,一般将单数名词放在前,复数名词放在后,要用复数代词,如:Theteacherorhisstudentswillcleantheirclassroomtogether.[误]Hisbrotheristallerthanhim.[正]Hisbrotheristallerthanhe.[析]than是连词,其后应视为省略句,thanheis.所以要注意区分其主格与宾格的用法。Ilikeyouasmuchasshe.[正]Ilikeyouasmuchasher.[析]as…as其后也应看作是省略句。应为asIlikeher.所以应用宾格。而第一句应译为我像她那样喜欢你。两句语法都是对的但含义不同。[误]Myselfdidityesterday.[正]Imyselfdidityesterday.[正]Ididitmyselfyesterday.[析]反身代词不可作主语,但可以用作主语的同位语。[误]Takecareofourselves.[正]Takecareofyourselves.(yourself)[析]祈始句的主语应看作第二人称you.[误]Pleasebringyourdaughterwithyourself.[正]Pleasebringyourdaughterwithyou.[析]反身代词不能作介词宾语,除非是由不及物动词与介词组成的动词短语,如:Theoldwomanspoketoherself.[误]Makeyourselfhome.[正]Makeyourselfathome.[析]这是英语中的习惯用法,意为“像在家里一样”。这样的用法还有:enjoyoneself玩得开心makeyourselfathome像在家中一样helpyourselftosomething自己拿某物lostoneself迷路seatoneself就坐dressoneself穿衣[误]— Who"sthisspeaking.— That"sMary.[正]— Who"sthatspeaking.— ThisisMary.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]在电话用语中,this指讲话人自己,而that指对方。[误]Thedaysinsummerarelongerthanthisinwinter.[正]Thedaysinsummerarelongerthanthoseinwinter.[析]在比较句中往往为了避免重复,可以用that或those取代前面提到的事物,如是单数时用that,复数时用those,如:TheweatherinBeijingishotterthanthatinChangChun.[误]Itissoagoodbookthateveryonelikestoread.[正]Itissuchagoodbookthateveryonelikestoread.[正]Itissogoodabookthateveryonelikestoread.[析]在可数名词单数时可用so+形容词+不定冠词+名词+that从句,也可用such+不定冠词+形容词+that从句。在不可数名词或可数名词复数时,只用such,如:ItissuchgoodweatherthatIwanttogoswimming.TheyaresuchgoodbooksthatIwanttobuythemall.在many,much,few,little这4个词前仅能用so,如:Shehassomuchmoneythatshecanbuyeverythingshewants.而在so与that之间仅存形容词时,则不能用such,如:Sheissosweetthateveryonelikesher.[误]Iwanttobuyasamedictionaryasyours.[正]Iwanttobuythesamedictionaryasyours.[析]same与定冠词the是固定搭配不可更改。这样的用法还有allthesame(仍然)。[误]— IhopeshemightpasstheeGam.— Idon"thopeso.[正]— IhopeshemightpasstheeGam.— Ihopenot.[析]在作肯定回答时,Ithinkso.Ihopeso.Ibelieveso.但作否定回答时为:Idon"tthinkso.Ihope/believenot.[误]— Hestudiedveryhardthisterm.—Soshedid.[正]—Hestudiedveryhardthisterm.—Sodidshe.[误]—Englishisdifficulttolearn.—Soisit.[正]—Englishisdifficulttolearn.—Soitis.[析]在对话中如果某一动作同时适用于两个主语,这时在答语中要用缩写且要用倒装句。如第一组句,即studiedhard既适用于he,也适用于she.但答语仅仅是对前句的重复,即仅仅是第一句的缩写时则不要用倒装句。如第二组句子为:英语难学。答语为:是的,难学。这时缩写的答语不要用倒装句。[误]Everyoneshoulddoone"sbest.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Everyoneshoulddohisbest.[析]one作代词时,它的复数形式是ones,所有格形式是one"s,反身代词为oneself.如果讲Oneshoulddoone"sbest.则是对句。如果one与别的词组成其他词,如:someone,anyone,everyone或onlyone则要用his/her,来作其所有格形式。[误]—Whowonthegame?—None.[正]—Whowonthegame?—Noone.[析]由who提问的句子的否定回答中的简略说法是noone,而由Howmany提问的句子的否定回答中的简略语是None.如:Howmanybooksarethere?None.[误]Therearemanytreesoneithersidesofthestreet.[正]Therearemanytreesoneithersideofthestreet.[正]Therearemanytreesonbothsidesofthestreet.[析]either作代词时由两个含意,其一是两者中随便哪一个,如:Youcantakeeither.其二是两者中的每一个。但要注意的是either后要加单数名词,如果作主语则谓语动词也要用单数形式。[误]EitheryouorIareright.[正]EitheryouorIamright.[析]在either…or,或neither…nor连接两个主语时,其谓语动词要与和其相近的那个主语相配。[误]Ihavethreesisters.Neitherofthemisadoctor.[正]Ihavethreesisters.Noneofthemisadoctor.[析]neither用于两者中无一是,而none则用于多于两者中的人或事物无一是。[误]Hedoesn"tlikeBeijingopera.Idon"tliketoo.[正]Hedoesn"tlikeBeijingopera,Idon"tlikeeither.[析]either作为“也”讲时,要用于否定句中,而too则用于肯定句中。[误]Welikeboththislittleboy.[正]Webothlikethislittleboy.[析]both作同位语时,它在句中的位置有:在be动词之后,如:Wearebothstudents.在实意动词之前,如:Theparentsbothwanttogotothecinema.用于第一助动词之后,如:WehavebothreadtheseEnglishnovels.使用时要注意以下句子的实际含意:Bothofusarenotright.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档应译为:我们俩不都对。Neitherofusisright.才应译为:我俩都不对。又如:Ican"tgiveyoubothofthebooks.意为:两本书我不能全给你,而Ican"tgiveyoueitherofthebooks.才为:两本书我全不能给你。[误]Weeachhasaticketfortheconcert.[正]Weeachhaveaticketfortheconcert.[析]each作句子主语时其谓语动词要用单数形式,如:EachofuswantstolearnEnglishwell,但each作同位语时,则应以原名词的数为准。[误]EveryofushastopasstheeGam.[正]EachofushastopasstheeGam.[析]every只可作形容词,不可作代词,而each既可作形容词,又可作代词,在作形容词时each侧重强调个体,而every则侧重于全体。[误]Everyoneofusshoulddohouseworktwohoursaday.[正]Everyoneofusshoulddohouseworktwohoursaday.[析]everyone不可与of结构相连接使用,而everyone则可以这样用。[误]IshouldreadEnglisheveryday.[正]IshouldreadEnglisheveryday.[析]要注意的是everyday是“每天”,而everyday则是形容词为“日常的”。如:everydayEnglish日常英语,everydaylife日常生活。[误]Therearetreesoneverysidesofthestreet.[正]Therearetreesoneachsideofthestreet.[析]every用于三者或三者以上的每一个,而each用于二者或二者以上的每一个。因为街道只有两侧,所以只能用each而不能用every.[误]Allmyparentsareengineers.[正]Bothmyparentsareengineers.[析]all用于三者或三者以上的全部,而both则用于两者的全部。[误]Allofstudentsmightmakesomemistakes.[正]Allofthestudentsmightmakesomemistakes.[正]Allstudentsmightmakesomemistakes.[析]非特指的名词前可用all但不可用allof结构,也就是讲allof结构后面的名词前一定要有定冠词。其他与all有关的习惯用法还有:alltheyearround,allweek,allday,allwinter[误]Theallvillagewasflooded.[正]Allthevillagewasflooded.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]all作修饰语时要用在所有修饰词之前。[误]Thepostofficeisonothersideofthestreet.[正]Thepostofficeisontheothersideofthestreet.[析]单数可数名词如在泛指某一个时用another,而特指时则要用theother,因街道只有两边,而不在这边必定是在另一边,所以要用特指。请参考下表的用法以便于记忆。 单数复数泛指another形容词作定语作名词another代词otherothers特指theother形容词theother代词theothertheothers[误]TherearetenstudentshereWherearetheothersstudents?[正]Therearetenstudentshere.Wherearetheothers?[正]TherearetenstudentshereWherearetheotherstudents?[析]theothers=theotherstudents.[误]Theoldmanhastwosons.Oneisateacher,anotherisadoctor.[正]Theoldmanhastwosons.Oneisateacher,theotherisadoctor.[析]another用于泛指,如:Isitfarfromheretothestation?I"msorry.Ihavenoidea.Onemaysayitisquitenear;anothermaysayitisfarfromhere.但在特指时则要用theother.它可以用作定语,theotherone,也可以用作代词theother,但theother用作代词时它的含意一定是单数。如果指三者或者三者以上的情况时,则要用one…another…theother.或者one…asecond…thethird…[误]Somepeoplelikesports.Theotherslikereading.[正]Somepeoplelikesports.Otherslikereading.[析]在泛指的复数名词前用some…others…others…来表示某些人……某些人……某些人……。[误]Pleaseremembertowatertheflowerseachotherday.[正]Pleaseremembertowatertheflowerseveryotherday.[析]everyotherday为每隔一天。是习惯用法,不要随意改动。又如:ontheotherhand另一方面。[误]Manyknowhim,butfewlikeshim.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Manyknowhim,butfewlikehim.[析]few用于可数名词,意为几乎没有,但few作主语时谓语动词则要用复数形式,而afew为有一些。[误]Youhavefewfriends,haven"tyou?[正]Youhavefewfriends,haveyou?[析]little与few用于句中时,均要按否定句看待。[误]Muchofwhatyousaidaretrue.[正]Muchofwhatyousaidistrue.[析]much用于不可数名词,作主语时用单数谓语动词。而many用于可数名词,它作主语时用复数形式的谓语动词。[误]Thisroomisenoughlargeforthestudentstolivein.[正]Thisroomislargeenoughforthestudentstolivein.[析]enough可以用作代词,如:Thereisenoughofthefood.又如:Enoughhasbeendoneforthework,但enough还可以作形容词来修饰名词,这时enough可以放在名词之前,也可放在名词之后,如:moneyenough与enoughmoney都是对的。但当enough作副词修饰形容词时,则只能置于形容词之后了。[误]Iwantanybookstoread.Doyouhaveany?[正]Iwantsomebookstoread.Doyouhaveany?[析]按照语法any用于疑问句和否定句,而some用于肯定句。[误]Wouldyoulikeanythingtodrink?[正]Wouldyoulikesomethingtodrink?[析]在由wouldyoulike发出的问句中,表达了说话者真心实意要为对方提供些饮料,或在说话者想得到对方的肯定答复时,在疑问句中要用some而不用any。[误]Someonewanttomeetyou.[正]Someonewantstomeetyou.[析]不定代词应被看作单数,即使用and连接两个不定代词,也要看作单数,如:Anyoneandeveryonehastheright.任何人,每一个人都有这样的权力。[误]NewYorkismuchcolderinwinterthanbefore.[正]ItismuchcolderinNewYorkinwinterthanbefore.[析]it常常用在英文的句子中来代表时间、3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档距离、天气、自然现象,或用在句中作形式主语或宾语,如:Itisteno"clocknow.(代时间)Itisfarfromheretotheairport.(代距离)Itisveryhot.(代天气)ItisverydifficulttolearnEnglishwell.(作形式主语)Wefounditverydifficulttoanswerthequestion.(作形式宾语)[误]Becareful.Don"tdrinktoomany.[正]Becareful.Don"tdrinktoomuch.[析]这里much所代的应是饮料或水,所以应为不可数名词。(三)例题解析1Theseare___books.Yoursareoverthere.AIBmyCmeDmine[答案]B.[析]这里应用形容词性物主代词。2—___isshe?—Sheisateacher.AWhatBHowCWhoDWhere[答案]A.[析]这里的四个疑问词放在问句中全都成立,但其意义不同。Whatisshe?应译为“她的工作是什么?”或“她是做什么的?”而Howisshe?应译为“她身体如何?”而Whoisshe?应译为“她是谁?”其答语应为“她叫什么名字。”而Whereisshe?应为“她在什么地方?”由答语决定了这道题的选择。3___iswrongwithmywatch.Ithasstopped___.ASomething,workingBSomething,toworkCAnything,workingDAnything,towork[答案]A.[析]因为是肯定句所以应用Something,其后由于表停止工作了,则stop后要用动名词。4Mary,help___tothebananas,please.AyouByourCyourselfDyourselves[答案]C.[析]helponeselftosomething为“自己拿某物”。yourself为“你一个人”,而yourselves为“你们”。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档5—___doyougotoschooleveryday?—Bybus.AHowBWhyCWhenDWhere[答案]A.[析]这题的答案是由问句决定的。6Myskirtis___popularthan___.Amuch,herBmuch,hersCmore,herDmore,hers[答案]D.[析]因句中有than,所以应选用比较级,而than后要选用名词性物主代词。7—CanyouspeakEnglish?—Yes,butonly___.AfewBafewClittleDalittle[答案]D.[析]因会讲某种语言的多少要用alittle,把它看作不可数名词对待,此答语为:是的,但仅仅会讲一点。8Mr. Smithisanoldfriendof___.AIBmeCmyDmine[答案]D.[析]这里应选名词性物主代词,这也是英语的一种习惯用法,而不要选择my。9“___doyouhearfromyourparents?”“Aboutonceamonth.”AHowlongBHowmanyCHowoftenDHowmuch[答案]C.[析]Howoften问的是某一动作发生的频率,即在单位时间内发生多少次。10MrGreenwouldn"tsay___atthemeeting.AeverythingBnothingCanythingDsomething[答案]C.[析]在否定句中应用anything11“Mum,Ann"scomingtonight.Let"sgiveher___toeat.”“Goodidea!”3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档AanythingniceBniceanythingCsomethingniceDnicesomething[答案]C.[析]肯定句中用something而不用anything,不定代词的修饰词应放其后而不要放在其前面。12—Whenshallwemeet,thiseveningortomorrowevening?—Idon"tmind.___timeisOK.ASomeBNeitherCEitherDBoth[答案]C.[析]因如选用both则名词要用复数名词,也要用复数谓语动词,由于答语前有Idon"tmind则决定不能选择neither.13Thisisnotherkite, but___.Ahe"sBhimCheDhis[答案]D.[析]要注意“他的”名词性物主代词与形容词性物主代词是同形的。14Don"tworry,Mum!___newsisgoodnews.I"msuredaddywillcomebacksoon.ANoBManyCThoseDTwo[答案]A.[析]这是一条谚语,即没有消息就是好消息。15MaryhassiGapples.Herbrotherhasthree.Shehas___applesthanhe.AfewBmanyCmoreDfewer[答案]C.[析]由于是比较级,根据题意应选“多于”而不是“少于”。16Thereisn"t___intoday"snewspaper.AanythinginterestingBsomethinginterestingCnothinginterestingDinterestinganything[答案]A.[析]由于句子是否定句,应选择anything,而且不定代词的修饰语应放在其后面。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档17September10this___Day?ATeacherBTeachersCTeacher"sDTeachers"[答案]D.[析]教师节Teachers"Day,儿童节Children"sDay,妇女节Women"sDay18—InEngland,peopleeatalotof“takeaway”food.Whataboutpeopleinyourcountry?—___ASowedo.BWedoso.CSodowe.DWesodo.[答案]C.[析]在答语中用简略方式表达上文的一个动作同样适用于另一个主语时,则要采用倒装句,但如果仅仅是对上句的重复则不要倒装。19—Shallwegointothatshopandhavealook?—Sorry.Iwon"t.Ihave___todothere.AeverythingBanythingCsomethingDnothing[答案]D.[析]这个答案的选择应由上下两句对话内容作出决定。20—Oh,dear!Whobroketheglass?—___Sam___Bruce.Itwasthecat.ABoth,andBNot,butCNeither,norDEither,or[答案]C.[析]neither…nor意为既不……也不……21Thestudentsarehavingagoodtimeinthepark.Somearedrawingbythelake.___areclimbingthehill.AOthersBOtherCAnotherDTheother[答案]A.[析]这里因为是代替复数名词,所以应用名词性的复数代名词。22Sheisnotanurse.I"mnot___.AalsoBeitherCneitherDtoo[答案]B.[析]在否定句中该用either,而不用too和also.23Ihavetwopencils.Oneisred,___isblue.AtheotherBanotherCothersDtheothers3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]A.[析]两者中的另一个应为特指。而且应为单数形式的代名词。而another是泛指单数代名词。others是泛指复数代名词,而theothers是特指复数代名词。24Sorry,Ican"tansweryourquestion.Iknow___aboutthesubject.AlittleBalittleCfewDafew[答案]A.[析]中文讲我对此知道的不多,而英文中要用little。其含意为否定句。25Mysisterdoesn"tlikeskating___.ASodoIBSoIdon"tCNeitherIdon"tDNeitherdoI[答案]D.[析]这是表达上面否定句中的动作,也同样不适合于第二个人。所以要用neither,并要采用倒装句。26Yesterdaymorningtherewereonlythreeboysinourroom,___.Ayou,heandIBI,youandheChe,IandyouDyou,Iandhe[答案]A.[析]这是若干人称代词并列时的顺序问题。请参看辨析中的例子。27Allthestudentsarebusy,so___ofthemwillgototheconcert.AmanyBlittleCafewDfew[答案]D.[析]student为可数名词。28Theteachergave___studentanewbook.AnobodyBbothCeachDany[答案]C.[析]both其后的名词应为复数,而any用于疑问句和否定句中只有each可以修饰单数可数名词。29Blackisneitherateacher___aworker.AorBeitherCnorDand[答案]C.[析]neither…nor为“既不……也不……”的固定搭配。30Ourteachergaveus___onstudying.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档AmanyadvicesBsomeadvicesCanadviceDsomeadvice[答案]D.[析]advice为不可数名词。some可用于可数或不可数名词之前。31Therearetwoforeignfriendsinthepark.One___isfromJapan,isfromAmerica.AotherBothersCtheotherDtheothers[答案]C.[析]因为是两者中的一个,所以另一个应用单数特指代词。32Arethere___onthetable?AsomecupsBanycupCsomecupDanycups[答案]D.[析]此句是疑问句,应用anycups,因提问时的be动词用的是are。33I"vejustboughtfivestamps.OneisaGermanstamp,___areAmericanstamps.AtheotherBtheothersCotherDothers[答案]B.[析]此空应填入主语。又因其范围已定,所以应选特指的代名词。theother只能用作单数,而others是泛指复数代名词,故只能选B。34Itwas___finedaythattheywenttothepark.AasoBsoaCsuchaDasuch[答案]C.[析]在单数可数名词前可以有两种表达法,即such+不定冠词+形容词+可数名词单数形式,如:suchagoodday,或者用so加形容词+不定冠词+可数名词单数,如:sogoodaday.35Atthattimethetrainwasslowandnoisy.So___peoplelikedtakingtrains.AlittleBalittleCfewDafew[答案]C.[析]这是英文的表达法与中文不同之处。中文讲只有少数人喜欢坐火车,英文要选用“few”。36Wemusthelpandunderstandeach___.AotherBanotherCothersDtheother3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]A.[析]eachother意为“互相”,是习惯用语。37___isdifficulttowalkonthemoon.AManBOneCThatDIt[答案]D.[析]这里的真正主语应为不定式towalkonthemoon.而形式主语只能用it.38Janehassentseveralletters,but___ofthemhavebeenanswered.AallBbothCeitherDnone[答案]D.[析]severalletters意为“若干信件”,应看作多于两者,则在A、D中作选择,仅D符合句意。39Idon"tknow___aboutthenewheadmaster.AsomethingBeverythingCnothingDanything[答案]D.[析]否定句中应用anything.40___ofthestudentsinthewholeclasscoulddothisphysicsquestion.ANoBNoneCNotDNeither[答案]B.四、形容词、副词(一)知识概要形容词的用法很活跃,在英语中用处也很多,但英语中修饰可数名词和不可数名词的修饰语和词组有时不同,要特别加以注意。下面将初中学习阶段中遇到的修饰可数名词的词和词组归纳如下:many,no,several,some,afew,alot,lots,plenty,plentyof,alotof,alargenumberof,enough。而修饰不可数名词的词或词组如下:much,no,some,alot,agreatdeal,lots,plenty,alotof,plentyof。其中some,no,alotof,plentyof既可修饰可数名词又可修饰不可数名词。英语中形容词与副词有原级、比较级、最高级之分,其规则如下:构词法原级比较级最高级加er,或estTallyoungtaller3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档youngertallestyoungest只加r或stnicelargenicerlargernicestlargest重读闭音节末尾只有一个辅音字母时双写该字母加er、estbigfathotbiggerfatterhotterbiggestfattesthottest不规则变化的形容词或副词:原级比较级最高级goodbetterbestWellbetterbestbadworseworstbadlyworseworstmanymoremostmostmoremostlittlelesslestfarfartherfurther3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档farthestfurthestoldolderelderoldesteldest要注意的是许多形容词同时又是副词,如:back,all,alone,either,far,high,slow等。而有些形容词则要经过一定变化才能转为副词,其规律如下:构词法形容词副词一般加lyCarefulkindcarefullykindly尾是y时将y变成i加lyHappybusyeasyHappilybusilyeasily其他trueterriblefullpossibleshywholetrulyterriblyfullypossibly3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档shylywholly在学习过程中要注意其变化。此外并不是所有副词都可以修饰比较级和最高级形容词。能修饰比较级的有:much,yet,far,still,agreatdeal,even和alittle.能修饰最高级的有:thevery,muchthe,far等。(二)正误辨析[误]Theyounglikesplayingfootballverymuch.[正]Theyounglikeplayingfootballverymuch.[析]定冠词加形容词表示一类人,应作复数看待。而定冠词加形容词表示抽象事物时则要看作单数,如:Thebeautifulisnotalwayskindness.美丽并不总代表善良。[误]Thedangerhasgone,sotheworstareover.[正]Thedangerhasgone,sotheworstisover.[析]意为:"危险已经过去,最困难的状况已结束。"用定冠词加最高级形容词作主语时应看作单数形式。[误]Itisthegoldageoftheyoung.[正]Itisthegoldenageoftheyoung.[析]golden在英语中多用于比喻,如:goldenhair金发,guldenvoice金嗓子。而gold多用于表达金质的,如:agoldbar金条,agoldcoin金币,但goldfish金鱼例外。[误]Sheisawarmheartwoman.[正]Sheisawarmheartedwoman.[析]英语形容词的构词法很多,其中之一是由形容词,或数词,加名词加ed构成,如:warmhoarted热心肠的,whitehaired白毛的[误]Thereisanalivefishinthepool.[正]Thereisalivingfishinthepool.[析]在初中范围内所学到的以a字母开头的形容词一般不能作定语,只能作表语。如:Thefishisalive.(鱼还活着)这样的形容词有:alive,alike,alone,asleep,afraid,awake等。[误]Theillmannearlydied.[正]Thesickmannearlydied.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]ill一般不作定语来形容某人有病,而要用sick,但作表语时则都可以。如:Heisillsick,ill作定语时则另有他意,如:illluck(厄运),illnature(天性恶劣),illtemper(心绪不好)[误]Ihaveimportantsomethingtotellyou.[正]Ihavesomethingimportanttotellyou.[析]不定代词something,anyone,somebody…在用形容词修饰时,形容词应放其后。但要注意thing则不是不定代词,不符合上述规律。如:Ihaveanimportantthingtotellyou.[误]I"llbefreeonneGtSunday.[正]I"llbefreeneGtSunday.[析]在表达将来时的时候:neGtSunday,neGtweek,neGtyear或lastSundaylastweek,lastyear前都不加介词。[误]Thegirlistwoyearold.[正]Thegirlistwoyearsold.[正]Sheisatwoyearoldgirl[析]由连字符连接若干名词、数词……组成的形容词,在学习时要记住两点,其一是这些词中的名词都不要用复数形式,如:twothousandwordreport(两千字的报告);其二是这样构成的形容词只能作定语,即用于名词之前,而不能作表语。[误]TheforeignerslikethoselittlebeautifulChinesepaintings.[正]TheforeignerslikethosebeautifullittleChinesepaintings.[析]在名词前若有几个形容词作修饰语时,其顺序如下。1.指示代词,定冠词2.数量词3.性质词4.大小5.形状6.老少,新旧7.颜色8.材料但要注意的是英语的习惯是一个名词前的形容词一般不要多于三个。如:Whataprettylittlewhitehorse!ThosefirstfewshortEnglishstorieswerenotdifficulttounderstand.[误]ThebestwaytolearnEnglishgoodistospeakwithEnglishmaneveryday.[正]ThebestwaytolearnEnglishwellistospeakwithEnglishmaneveryday.[析]good是形容词,这里是修饰动词speak的,所以应用副词well,但well作形容词讲时只作身体好。如:Heiswell.(他身体很好)。Heisgood.(3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档他是个好人)。[误]Thechildrenplayonthegrassnappyly.[正]Thechildrenplayonthegrasshappily[析]多音节y结尾的形容词变为副词时应将y变为i再加ly.[误]Theteacherlookedangryatthestudents.[正]Theteacherlookedangrilyatthestudents.[析]英语中感观动词后面要接形容词,这时它是修饰主语的,如:Thefoodsmellsgood.食物闻起来很香。Theteacherlookedangry老师看起来很生气。而此句的意思为:"老师生气地看着学生",所以应用副词形式。[误]Heworkedwithmefriendly.[正]Hewasfriendlytome.[析]不是所有结尾是ly的词都是副词,但friendly是形容词,这样的词还有lovely,lonely,costly,lively…monthlyweekly…。但其中有些词既是副词,又是形容词,如:early,hourly,monthly…[误]Youcanspeakfreeinfrontofyourfriends.[正]Youcanspeakfreelyinfrontofyourfriends.[析]free作为形容词意为"自由的,有空闲的,免费的"。作为副词讲则是"免费"之意。而freely作为副词则是"自由的,随便的"。这些要注意的词还有:hard努力,艰苦hardly几乎不late迟,晚lately最近的,最新的near近nearly几乎like像likely几乎[误]Theymusthavearrivedtillnow.[正]Theymusthavearrivedbynow.[析]bynow是用于表达到目前为止某一动作已经发生,所以应用瞬间动词。而tillnow是强调某一动作一直持续到现在,所以一定要用持续性动词。musthave+过去分词是对过去某一事情所作的肯定推测。[误]Someonecalledyourightnow.[正]Someonecalledyoujustnow.[析]justnow有两个意思,其一是"刚才",其二是"现在",而rightnow只能用于现在的状态。just则用于完成时态,如:Ihavejustfinishedmyhomework.[误]MyfatherwillbebackfromAmericaatpresent.[正]MyfatherwillbebackfromAmericapresently.[析]presently3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档有两个意思:其一是最近,不久,其二在美语中是现在之意,与atpresent相同。而forthepresent为暂时,如:IteachEnglishintheschoolforthepresent.[误]I"llbebackatthemoment.[正]I"llbebackinamoment.[析]atthemoment其意为"现在,当时",而inamoment意为"马上过一会",与inaminute意思相近。[误]ThetrainfromShanghaiwillarrivehereintime.[正]ThetrainfromShanghaiwillarrivehereontime.[析]ontime为"准时",而intime有两个含意。其一是"及时",如:Thedoctorarrivedintime。其二是"将来,终究"。[误]Imetanoldfriendsometimeslastmonth.[正]Imetanoldfriendsometimelastmonth.[析]Sometime过去,或者将来某时。Sometimes有时如:SometimesIgotoschoolbybus.Sometime一些时间如:Ineedsometimetodomyhomework.Sometimes几次如:IwenttoShanghaisometimesthismonth.attimes有时,偶尔atalltimes经常someothertime改天[误]Ihadmetanoldfriendthreedaysago.[正]Ihadmetanoldfriendthreedaysbefore.[正]Imetanoldfriendthreedaysago.Gago用在时间状语中时,主句中谓语动词一般用过去时,而before用于时间状语时则主句的谓语动词宜用完成时态。[误]Hestudiedveryhard.andattheendhepassedtheeGam.[正]Hestudiedveryhard,andintheendhepassedtheeGam.[析]intheend=atlast意为"最终,终于",表达经过若干努力而达到的结果。而attheend是在某事的结束时如何如何,如:Attheendofclass,theteachergaveussomestorybooks。[误]Iwillcomeheretohelpyoueachthreedays.[正]Iwillcomeheretohelpyoueverythreedays.[析]everythreedays为"每三天",即每隔二天,而everyotherday为每隔一天。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Hedidn"tgotothecinemayesterday.andIdidn"tgo,too.[正]Hedidn"tgotothecinemayesterdayandIdidn"tgoeither.[析]英语中表示"也",有4个字,also,aswell,too,either,但either用于否定句中,而前3个用于肯定句中。在肯定句中too与aswell一般要用在句尾,而also则可用于句中。如:Shewenttothepartyandherboyfriendwenttheretoo.又如:I"vealsoreadherothernovels.[误]Weshouldhelpthepoorgirlinanyway.[正]Weshouldhelpthepoorgirlinanyway.[析]anyway为"不管怎么"讲,"无论如何",如:Whataterribleaccident,anywaynoonewashurt.anyway为"任何方式"。这种常见的错误还发生在以下几组词中,如:everyday日常的everyday每天faraway遥远的faraway远离altogether总计alltogether一块,大家一起already已经allready全准备好了[误]Youcancometothedoctor"satanytime.[正]Youcancometothedoctor"satanytime.[析]anytime是副词而anytime中的time是名词。[误]Shesaidnearlynothing.[正]Shesaidalmostnothing.[析]nearly与almost的含意相近,在很多场合可以互换,但在否定词前用almost。[误]Therearetoomuchmistakesinyourhomework.[正]Therearetoomanymistakesinyourhomework.[析]toomuch后接不可数名词,如:Thereistoomuchwaterfortheflowers.而toomany后加可数名词,muchtoo后面加形容词,如:ItismuchtoodifficulttolearnEnglishwell.[误]Itislateenoughthatwecangohomenow.[正]Itislateenoughforustogohomenow.[析]要注意的是enough后面一般不接从句而接不定式,或不定式的复合结构:forsomebodytodosomething。[误]Thetwinsareveryalike.[正]Thetwinsaremuchalike.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]用a为首字母的形容词不能用very修饰,一般要用much来修饰。[误]-Howlongdoeshewritetohisparents?-Onceaweek.[正]-Howoftendoeshewritetohisparents?-Onceaweek.[析]英文与中文表达法不同,隔多长时间办一次某事,实际上问的是该事发生的频率,所以要用howoften。[误]AssoonasIarriveinNewYork,I"llcallupyou.[正]AssoonasIarriveinNewYork,I"llcallyouup.[析]当动词词组的宾语是人称代词时则一定要放于动词之后,如果是名词则可以放在词组其后。如:IwanttowatchTV.PleaseturnontheTV.也可以讲:PleaseturntheTVon.[误]Hedrovequicklyhisnewcar.[正]Hedrovehisnewcarquickly.[析]副词在句中的位置很活,但主要有以下几种用法:①实意动词之前,如:Hequicklygivemetheanswer.②在be动词之后,如:Thelittleboyisoftenlateforclass.③第一助动词之后,如:Thisbookhasalmostbeenfinished.④在单独使用的be动词和助动词之前,如:Canyouhelpmethisafternoon?Icertainlycan.但是无论如何也不能将副词置于动词与宾语之间,如果是宾语从句或是很长的名词词组作宾语则才可以这样用:Heheardclearlywhattheteachersaid.[误]Thechildrencamelateyesterdaytothecinema.[正]Thechildrencamelatetothecinemayesterday.[析]表示一定长度的时间的副词不应放于句中,可放于句尾。如果表示强调则可放于句首。[误]Youhavefewnewbooks,haven"tyou?[正]youhavefewnewbooks,haveyou?[析]英语中的数量形容词有两组。修饰可数名词的有few(很少,几乎没有),afew(有一些,几个);修饰不可数名词的有little(很少,几乎没有),alittle(有一点,有一些)。要注意的是当few和little用于句中时应看作否定句,而afew和alittle用于句中时则应看作是肯定句。[误]Hespentquitelittlemoneyonhisfood.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Hespentquitealittlemoneyonhisfood.[析]quitea为一固定用法,其意为"十分,相当,所以"。quiteafew=many,quitealittle=much而onlyalittle=little,onlyafew=few.[误]Doyouwanttohavemanybread?[正]Doyouwanttohavesomebread?[析]some与any都可以用作形容词、副词或代词,在一般情况下,some用于肯定句,any用于疑问句和否定句,但在希望得到肯定答复时,应用some。其次是some可以用来修饰可数名词和不可数名词。[误]Pleasetellmewheretheshoesshopis?[正]Pleasetellmewheretheshoeshopis.[析]在用名词作修饰词来修饰另一名词时,这个作修饰词的名词应用单数形式,如:ashoeshop鞋店afruitshop水果店abookshop书店apostoffice邮局apolicestation警察局abusstop汽车站[误]Heisweakatphysics.[正]Heisweakinphysics.[析]在表达擅长于作某事时用begoodatsomething,而其反意词为bebadatsomething,但beweakinsomething。[误]Thisdictionaryisworthtobuy.[正]Thisdictionaryisworthbuying.[析]beworth后可接动、名词表达值得作某事,又可接价格、金钱表示值多少钱。[误]Don"tafraidofthat.[正]Don"tbeafraidofthat.[析]afraid在英文中是形容词而不是动词。这样的词组还有:beafraidof害怕becarefulof小心becertainof有把握,确定besureof确信begladof高兴besickof厌恶befondof喜欢3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Theworkhasalreadybeendonewell.[正]Theworkhasalreadybeenwelldone.[析]well与badly作副词时,表示好坏,如果句子是被动语态,则应放在过去分词之前,如:Thismachinehasbeenbadlydamaged.如果句子是主动语态,则应放于句末,如:Ididmyhomeworkwell.[误]Weareyetintheclassroomnow.[正]Wearealreadyintheclassroomnow.[析]already主要用于肯定句,而yet多用于否定句和疑问句中,如:Didyoufinishit?No.notyet.[误]Look.Herecomeshe![正]Look!Herehecomes![误]Look!Herethebuscomes![正]Look!Herecomesthebus![析]在句子开头用Here时,如主语是人称代词则不要用倒装语序,如果主语是名词则要用倒装语序。[误]Sheismyoldersister.[正]Sheismyeldersister.[析]elder和eldest是用来指家庭中兄弟姐妹的长幼关系,而older,oldest则是指岁数大多少,如:SheisthreeyearsolderthanI.[误]I"mtired.Ican"tgofurther.[正]I"mtired.Ican"tgofarther.[析]far有两个比较级farther较远的,further进一步的,如:DoyouneedanyfurthereGplanation?你需要进一步的解释吗?当然它也有两个最高级。farthest和furthest.[误]IwenttoBeijingUniversityfiveyearsbefore.[正]IwenttoBeijingUniversityfiveyearsago.[析]ago常与过去时连用,而before则多与完成时连用。[误]-Haveyoufinishedyourhomework?-No,notalready.[正]-Haveyoufinishedyourhomework?-No,notyet.[析]仍然有三个英文字可以表达它们是already,yet与still。要注意的是already经常用于肯定句中,如Thebushasalreadygone。而yet3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档多用于疑问句和否定句中,如:Haveyoufinishedyourhomeworkyet?而still则常用于主语与谓语动词之间,如:Westillcan"tdecidewhattodo.但也有时用于be动词之后,如:Heisstillhere.[误]HeisveryhigherthanIam.[正]HeismuchhigherthanIam.[析]much可以用来修饰比较级,而very则用来修饰形容词原级,如:I"mverytired.[误]-CanIwalktothestation?-You"dbetternot.Itisveryfar.[正]-CanIwalktothestation?-You"dbetternot,Itisalongway.[析]for一般用在疑问句与否定句中,如:Howfarisitfromheretothestation?又如:Itisn"tfar.[误]I"veeverbeentoAmerica.[正]I"vebeentoAmericaonce.[析]once多用于肯定句,而ever则用于疑问句,否定句,及条件状语从句中,如:HaveyoueverbeentoLondon?[误]-CouldyoupasstheeGamthistime?-No,Iamnotafraidso.[正]-CouldyoupasstheeGamthistime?-No,I"mafraidnot.[析]在肯定的答语中我们可以用so来代替上句所讲的事件,如:Doyouthinksheisagoodstudent?YesIthinkso,/Ihopeso,/Ibelieveso/I"mafraidso.但在否定的答语中,英语口语的习惯用法则有所不同,如,Idon"tthinkso而在hope,belive与afraid后则常用not,如:Ihopenot.[误]Shedidn"tworkenoughhard,soshecouldn"tpasstheeGam.[正]Shedidn"tworkhardenough,soshecouldn"tpasstheeGam.[析]enough可以作名词用,如:EnoughhasbeensaidforhowtolearnEnglishwell.(对于如何学好英语已经讲的足够多了。)另外它可以作为形容词,如:Ihaveenoughmoney(ormoneyenough)tobuythisdictionary.注意enough作为形容词时即可放于名词前又可放于名词后,在初中范围的考题中多用于名词之前。如果enough作为副词用,那么它一定要放在被修饰的形容词或副词之后。[误]Youcan"tbeverycareful.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Youcan"tbetoocareful.[析]此句话的含意是你如何小心也不过分。too…to的用法是"太……以至于不能作某事"。但在实际应用时也常常将后面的to省去,如:ItistooeGpensiveforme.那对我来讲是太贵了。[误]Heisgoodpastfifty.[正]Heiswellpastfifty.[析]well作为副词用时除用于"好"之外还有"大大地、远远地",等意。往往有人对下面两句的对或错有争议;Heiswell.Heisgood.其实这两句都是正确的表达法,只不过其含意不同。Heiswell是"他身体不错",而Heisgood则为"他是个好人"。[误]Sheisnotashalfcleverasherbrother.[正]Sheisnothalfascleverasherbrother.[析]在as…as结构中要将修饰形容词的数量词倍数及nearly,almost,eGactly…等置于第一个as之前。[误]HeissameageasTom.[正]HeisthesameageasTom.[析]thesame…as是固定的用法,其中定冠词the是不可省也不能换成别的词的。[误]MotherandherdaughterareeGactlylike.[正]MotherandherdaughterareeGactlyalike.Glike作为介词,其意为"像",应用于looklike,belike,soundlike,其后要加宾语。而alike是形容词,或副词,如:YouandIthinkalike.Thetwinsaredressedalike。但alike仅作表语而不能用于名词前作定语。[误]Whoistallerofthetwo?[正]Whoisthetallerofthetwo?[析]两者的比较级之前要加定冠词。[误]IhavelessbooksthanTom.[正]IhavefewerbooksthanTom.[析]less是little的比较级,而fewer是few的比较级。less后应加不可数名词而fewer后是可数名词。[误]Therearethreegirlsinmygroup.TheclevererisMary.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Therearethreegirlsinmygroup.ThecleverestisMary.[析]在两者之间应用比较级,在三者之间或三者以上的范围内应用最高级。[误]Theboysatthereasquietashissister.[正]Theboysatthereasquietlyashissister.[析]as…as的用法要注意的是:①在其中间应加形容词或副词的原级,而不可加比较级,也有的语法书中称为同级比较。②要根据句意决定是加形容词还是副词,这要看它具体是修饰动词还是名词而定,如:Heisasgoodashisfriend.[误]Theharderyoustudy,andyoucanlearnmore.[正]Theharderyoustudy,themoreyoucanlearn.[析]英文中如果要表达越来越怎样,在初中范围有两种表达法:①比较级+and+比较级。②定冠词+比较级……,如:Thenightsaregettinglongerandlonger。要注意的是多音节形容词的比较级前要加more,这样的用法是:moreandmore加形容词,如:Thegirlisgrowingmoreandmorebeautiful.[误]StudyingphysicsisnotsointerestingastolearnEnglish.[正]StudyingphysicsisnotsointerestingaslearningEnglish.[析]在作比较时,英语一般要求对比的两部分结构应一致。如用动名词,应都用动名词,用不定式时则都用不定式。但有时在后一个不定式前的符号to可以省略。如:TorepairtheoldoneisasmucheGpensiveas(to)buyanewone.[误]Thegirlismoreclevererthantheboy.[正]Thegirlismuchmoreclever(muchcleverer)thantheboy.[析]clever有两个比较级:cleverer和moreclever,要注意的是不能用比较级来修饰比较级。clever的两个比较级也各有不同之处,如用在两种不同性质的比较时多用moreclever,如:Heismorecleverthanhonest.(他的聪明要远远超过其诚实。)[析]Theboyisthetallesttothethree.[正]Theboyisthetallestofthethree.[析]最高级的范围要用of加复数形式或加集合名词。[误]Thisbookisoneofthemostusefuldictionary.[正]Thisbookisoneofthemostusefuldictionaries.[析]在oneof后面最高级形容词后要加可数名词复数。[误]ThisdictionaryisthemuchbestoneoftheEnglishChinese3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档dictionaries.[正]ThisdictionaryismuchthebestoneoftheEnglishChinesedictionaries.[析]在修饰最高级时应用far/byfar/much加the加最高级。但very例外,如:Heistheverybestplayerintheteam.[误]ShanghaiisbiggerthananyothercitiesinChina.[正]ShanghaiisbiggerthananyothercityinChina.[析]在比较级中表示比较对象时如用anyother其后一般要加单数名词。[误]MostofstoriesinthisbookarewritteninEnglish.[正]MostofthestoriesinthisbookarewritteninEnglish.[正]MoststoriesinthisbookarewritteninEnglish.[析]"大多数"一词的表达法有mostofthe+名词,或most+名词。当用前一种结构时,其后面的定冠词不可少。[误]Thetemperatureofthatroomishigherthanthisroom.[正]Thetemperatureofthatroomishigherthanthatofthisroom.[析]比较级用于两句话之间时,比较的部分不可省略掉,但为了避免重复,一般都要用that代替前面的单数名词,而用those代替前面的复数名词,如:ThebooksinthatboGarebiggerthanthoseinthisboG。[误]Heisnomorehere.Maybeheisathome.[正]Heisnolongerhere.Maybeheisathome.[析]nomore在现代英语中多译为:"从此再也不会了",如:Hisvoiceisnomorehere.他已经去世了,他的声音不可能再出现了。而用nolonger表达目前的状态。要注意下面几组句子的实际含意:Thisroomisnocleanerthanthatone.即两间屋子都不干净。(两者都不干净)Thisroomisnotcleanerthanthatone,即这屋子不如那间干净。(前者不如后者干净。即一间干净,一间不干净。)(三)例题解析1IthinkChineseis___thanmaths.A.interestingBmoreinterestingC.mostinterestingD.themostinteresting[答案]B.[析]在有than作比较的句子中应用形容词的比较级。2-WhatdoesLucylikebetter,singingordancing?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档-Singing.ofcourse.She"sknownto___it.A.begoodatB.begoodforC.bebadatD.bebadfor[答案]A.[析]begoodat为固定搭配,意为"擅长作某事"。初中英语中有些这样的固定用法应记牢,而不能似是而非。如:begoodat,bebadat,bepoorin,beweekin,befitfor3TheHuangHeRiverisoneof___inChina.A.ThelongriverB.thelongestriverC.thelongestriversD.thelongerriver[答案]C.[析]在oneof+定冠词+最高级之后的名词应用复数形式。4Thegirlwas___afraid___shethrewherbagaway.A.so,thatB.too,toC.too,thatD.enough,to[答案]A.[析]so…that为"如此怎样以至于如何",此句意思是:小女孩如此害怕以至于扔下包跑掉了。而too…to的意思为"如何如何,以至于不能作某事"。但to的后面是动词原形,而不是从句。5Itwas___yesterdaythantoday.A.hotB.hoterC.hotterD.thehottest[答案]C.[析]用than表达比较的句中应用比较级。6Whichsubjectdoyoulike___,EnglishChineseormaths?A.bestB.wellC.betterD.good[答案]A.[析]在两者之间应用比较级,而在三者之间或三者以上用最高级。7Noneofthestudentswatchedit___.A.carefulenoughB.enoughcarefullyC.carefullyenoughD.enoughcareful[答案]C.[析]3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档首先应判定是选用用来修饰名词的形容词还是用来修饰动词的副词。这里是修饰watch这一动词,应选用副词。当enough用来修饰副词或形容词时应放于被修饰的形容词或副词之后。8___sheeats,___she"llbe.A.More…fatB.Themore…fatterC.More…thefatterD.Themore…thefatter[答案]D.[析]the+比较级表示"越来越……"本句应译为:她吃得越多,她就会越胖。9Idon"tthinkEnglishis___Chinese.A.asimportantasB.notimportantasC.notsoimportantD.importantas[答案]A.[析]think+宾语从句时,应采用否定主句的形式,如:中文讲,"我认为你不对",英文应为:"我不认为你对"。Idon"tthinkyouareright.所以不能选答案B。而C、D均为不正确的表达法。10MissGaoisagoodEnglishteacher.Thestudentsinherclass___English.A.areinterestedinB.areinterestinginC.areinterestedatD.areinterestingto[答案]A.[析]过去分词常用来修饰人,而现在分词常用来修饰物,如:aninterestingbook,实际上过去分词含有被动之意,如:interested其含意是"被……所吸引,感动"。而interesting则为"使人感兴趣的",如:aninterestingman一个有趣、风趣的人。11Thetwinsaretogethermostofthetime.Sotheyneverfeel___.A.aloneB.lonelyC.happilyD.friendly[答案]B.[析]alone意为"独自的,一个人的",它只能作表语不能作定语。Iamnotaloneindoingsuchathing.而lonely意为"寂寞的,孤单的",如:Theoldmanfeltlonely.要体会两个词的区别,如:Theoldmanlivedalone,buthedidn"tfeellonely.12Whata___cough!Youseem___ill.A.terrible,terriblyB.terribly,terribleC.terrible,terribleD.terribly,terribly3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]A.[析]terrible是形容词,而terribly是副词,第一个空是修饰名词的,所以应填入形容词。第二个空ill是形容词,这里terribly是用来修饰ill的。13Thetwofriendswere___pleasedtoseeeachotherthattheyforgoteverything.A.soB.tooC.veryD.much[答案]A.[析]这里用的是so…that的固定搭配。14Whichis___,LiLei"sboGorHanMeimei"sboG?A.heavyB.heavierC.moreheavierD.theheaviest[答案]B.[析]两者之间用比较级,三者或以上用最高级。15Youdon"tlikethesamecoloursandIdon"tlikethem,___.A.tooB.alsoC.eitherD.neither[答案]C.[析]在否定句中也应用either,而不要用too,因too用于肯定句中。16Jimis___atallhislessons.AndI"msurehe"lldovery___intheeGams.A.well,goodB.good,wellC.well,wellD.good,good[答案]B.[析]good为形容词,如:Heisgood.他是个好人。而well作为身体状况的好坏讲时是形容词,如:Heiswell为他身体不错,而作为其他意思时为副词,如:HespeaksEnglishwell.17Youlook___thanbefore,why?A.morethinB.morethinnerC.muchmorethinD.muchthinner[答案]D.[析]多音节形容词才用more或most加形容词来表示其比较级或最高级,而thin的比较级为thinner。18Let"sgooutforsuppernow.I"mvery___.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.hungryB.angryC.tiredD.thirsty[答案]A.[析]hungry-饿,angry-生气,tired-紧,疲劳,thirsty-口渴。要注意名词的词义。19-Canyouunderstandme?-Sorry,Ican___understandyou.A.hardlyB.almostC.evenD.ever[答案]A.[析]hardly为一否定词,用在句中时应被看作是否定句。在答语中Sorry决定了其意为"听不明白",所以只能选hardly。20"___doyouwritetoyourpenfriend?""Abouttwiceamonth."A.HowoftenB.HowsoonC.HowmuchD.Howlong[答案]A.[析]howoften用来提问某一动作经多久就要发生一次,也就是提问发生的频率。howsoon是问从现在起还有多久。21ChangjiangRiveris___riverinChinaA.longB.longerC.longestD.thelongest[答案]D.22I"llwork___Ican.A.sohardlyasB.sohardasC.ashardlyasD.ashardas[答案]D.[析]hard可用作形容词和副词,如:Thedeskwasmadeofhardwood又如:Itisraininghard。而hardly是副词,其词义是"几乎不",如:HardlydidIsleeplastnight.我昨晚几乎没有睡觉。而且hardly用于句首时要采用倒装语序。as…as即可以用于肯定句,也可以用于否定句,但so…as则只能用于否定句中。23Itisvery___tolistentohim.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.interestedB.interestingC.interestedinD.interest[答案]B.[析]interest作为名词有两个词义,①兴趣,②银行中所讲的利息。而其形容词interesting是"使人感兴趣的",而interested是"感兴趣的"如:HeisinterestedinEnglish.24Thingsare___worsethanIthought.A.moreB.fewC.veryD.much[答案]D.[析]只有much可以修饰比较级。25Itisoneo"clock,butherfatherhasn"tcomeback___.A.alreadyB.stillC.tooD.yet[答案]D.[析]完成时的否定句尾要用yet,而already则用于肯定句。26ComradeChenis___olderthanI.A.veryB.moreC.muchD.quite[答案]C.[析]只有much可以修饰比较级。可以修饰比较级的词还有much,far,evenalittle,byfar等。27Shedidherhomework___.A.carefullyB.carefulC.careD.careless[答案]A.[析]这里应填入副词,而careless是由care加less后辍得来的,less意为"没有",是否定之意,如:careless-不小心,homeless-无家可归。而carefully为副词。28Theycan"tanswerthequestioninJapanese;wecan"tanswerit,___.A.alsoB.tooC.eitherD.neither[答案]C.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档29-Howareyourparents?-Theyarevery___,thankyou.A.goodB.kindC.wellD.happy[答案]C.[析]由问句得知其询问的是身体如何,所以well作为身体状况不错时应视为形容词。30Peterruns___inourclass.A.thefastB.fasterC.fastestD.mostfast[答案]C.[析]副词的最高级前可以加定冠词,也可以不加定冠词。31Wewereall___gladthatwesanganddanced.A.suchB.soC.veryD.quite[答案]B.[析]在so与that之间只有形容词时不可用such。32Katesings___Joan.A.aswellasB.asgoodasC.sogoodasD.asbetteras[答案]A.[析]这里well为副词,意为"唱得好"。33Thiseggsmells___,thoughitlooksallright.A.goodB.wellC.badDbadly[答案]C.[析]smell为系动词,其后应加形容词,而不是副词。同样的词,还有sound,feel,seem、become(变成)等等,如:Icefeelscoldinwinter.34Waitaminute,Ihave___totellyou.A.somethinginterestedB.somethinginterestingC.interestingsomethingD.anythinginteresting[答案]B.[析]修饰不定代词的修饰词要放在不定代词之后。35Ishallvisityou___neGtyear.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.sometimesB.sometimeC.sometimeD.sometimes[答案]B.[析]sometimes有时,sometime某一时刻,sometime一段时间,sometimes若干次36Mysistersaidshewouldtrytospeak___Englisheveryday.A.alittleB.afewC.litttleD.few[答案]A.[析]little修饰不可数名词,而alittle意为"一些,一点"。37Ihave___friendshereandIoftenvisitthem.A.fewB.littleC.afewD.alittle[答案]C.[析]afew意为"有些",few后面要加可数名词复数。38Ofallthesebooks,doyouthink,whichoneis___?A.interestingB.muchinterestingC.moreinterestingD.themostinteresting[答案]D.[析]Ofallthesebooks是用来表示最高级的范围五、连词(一)知识概要连词是一种在句子与句子之间,短语之间以及名词等其他词语之间起连接作用的虚词,它不能单独作句子的成份。按其意义可分为并列连词和从属连词两大类。并列连词连接的双方是对等的。常有的并列连词有and,both…and,either…or,neither…nor,notonly…butalso,aswellas等。但如果连接的两部分意义不趋向一致,意义有转折的并列连词有:but,however,while(而),only(只不过)。还有表示选择关系的并列连词,如:or,orelse,otherwise…再有的是连接双方,互为因果,或表示前因后果的连词有:for,so,therefore(因此),then等。从属连词在初中范围内常常用来连接名词性从句,如:that,if,whether,3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档其次用来连接状语从句。其中有原因状语从句,常用的连接词有:whenwhile,as,since,before,after,once,assoonas,until,till连接条件状语的连词有:if,unless,aslongas等,而原因状语的连接词有because,since,as,nowthat(既然)。目的、结果、方式、比较、地点等状语从句的连接词有:sothat,so…that,such…that,as…as,than,where…它们在句子与文章中几乎无处不见。具体用法见下表。连词用法一览表种类功用例句并列连词连接具有并列关系的词HeknowsneitherEnglishnorFrench.短语Areyougoingbybusoronfoot?分句Marywasagoodgirl,butshehadoneshortcoming.从属连词引导:状语从句I"lldoitasyoutoldme.Youwillbelateunlessyouhurry.连接代词和连接副词主语从句Whathesaidprovedtrue.Whenwe"llstarthasnotbeendecidedyet.表语从句Thisiswhyhedidn"tcomeyesterday.Thatiswherehelives.宾语从句ThemanaskedmewhichIlikedbest.Ican"tunderstandwhysheissolate.关系代词和关系副词定语从句Nicotineisadrugthatgetsoneintothehabitofsmoking.HecamelastnightwhenIwasout.(二)正误辨析[误]Bothmyparentsarenothere.Theywenttotheconcertjustnow.[正]Neitherofmyparentsishere.Theywenttotheconcertjustnow.[析]在英语中both一般用于肯定句中,如用于否定句中,其意义也不同于汉语,如:Bothofusarenotright.在英语中应被理解为"我们俩不都对。"而Neitherofusisright。才能被理解为"我们俩无一正确"。[误]Heorhisparentshassometicketsforthefilm.[正]Heorhisparentshavesometicketsforthefilm.[析]由or连接两主语时,谓语动词应与相临近的那一个主语保持一致。[误]Youshouldstudyhard,andyouwon"tpasstheeGam.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Youshouldstudyhard,oryouwon"tpasstheeGam.[析]or作为连词,这里的意思为"否则"。又如:Hurryup,oryou"llbelateforschool.[误]Thoughheispoor,butheisreadytohelpothers.[正]Thoughheispoor,heisreadytohelpothers.[正]Heispoor,butheisreadytohelpothers.[析]"虽然……但是"是中文中的常用结构,但在英文中用了"虽然"则不要用"但是",用了"但是"则不能再用"虽然",二者只可用其一。[误]EitheryouorIareonduty.[正]EitheryouorIamonduty.[析]either…or连接两个主语时,其谓语动词与相临近的一个主语相呼应,这也叫作就近原则。类似的用法还有or,neither…nor,notonly…butalso等。[误]TomisourEnglishteacherandteachingEnglishinourschoolnow.[正]TomisourEnglishteacherandisteachingEnglishinourschoolnow.[析]并列句中常常在后面的句子中作一些省略,以免重复,但不是所有词都可作任意的省略的。当你连接的是两个系动词时,后面的那个系动词不可省略,也就是讲连接的部分不可省略。[误]Myfatherlikesswimmingandtocollectstamps.[正]Myfatherlikesswimmingandcollectingstamps.[析]由并列连词连接的两个部分要保持相等的语法结构。如是动名词则都用动名词,如用不定式则都应用不定式,这是初学者要注意的一点。[误]Myfatherisreadinganewspaper,Iamdoingmyhomework.[正]MyfatherisreadinganewspaperwhileIamdoingmyhomework.[析]两个并列句中间不可用逗号连接,要用并列连词来连接。[误]MyfatheraskedmethatifIwantedtolearnhowtodrive.[正]MyfatheraskedmeifIwantedtolearnhowtodrive.[析]宾语从句的连接词只能有一个不能重复使用。[误]WewillgobothtoBeijingandShanghai.[正]WewillgotobothBeijingandShanghai.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]用both…and…作连接词时,其相连接的部分结构也要相同。[误]NotonlyMarybutalsoherbrothersisgoingtodance.[正]NotonlyMarybutalsoherbrothersaregoingtodance.[析]由notonly…butalso…连接两个主语时,其重点在其后面的那一个主语,所以谓语形式应采用就近原则。[误]Theteacheraswellashisstudentsarecoming.[正]Theteacheraswellashisstudentsiscoming.[析]由aswellas连接两个主语时,谓语动词与aswellas后面的名词无关,而与前面的名词相一致。[误]Tomdoesnotswimnorplayfootball.[正]Tomdoesnotswimorplayfootball.[析]nor主要用于连接句子的对等连词,如在否定句中连接某一部分时要用or,但要注意句子的含意,如:Thisanimaldoesnotlikeacoworahorse.这个动物既不像牛也不像马。Thisanimaldoesnotlikeacowbutahorse.这个动物不像牛而像马。[误]Forthereisnolightintheclassroom.Thestudentsmusthavegonehome.[正]Thestudentsmusthavegonehome,forthereisnolightintheclassroom.[析]由for引出的原因状语从句在使用时要注意不能将该从句置于句首,而应置于主句之后,并在主句与从句之间加一逗号。更要注意的是because,as,since与for4个表示原因的连词中because是因果关系,是最强的一个,而for是最弱的一个。有些语法书中干脆把for叫做并列连词[误]MybrotherwillpasstheEnglisheGamisnoquestion.[正]ThatmybrotherwillpasstheEnglisheGamisnoquestion.[析]主语从句的引导词that是不可省略的。这一点不要和宾语从句的引导词相提并论。[误]Thismapwillshowyouhowwillyougettothehotel.[正]Thismapwillshowyouhowyouwillgettothehotel.[析]名词性从句作宾语从句使用时,最重要的一点是要用陈述语句。特别要注意的是那些使用双宾语的动词,如:tell,ask,show…[误]Whiletheclockstruchten,allthelightswentout.[正]Whentheclockstruckten,allthelightswentout.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]while是强调两个动作在同时进行中,如:WhileIamdoingmyhomework,myfatherisreadinganewspaper.而这里的when是"正当某某时刻","就在这一时间点上",其重点强调在某一特定时刻某动作的发生。[误]WhileIwaswalkingalongthestreetyesterday,Imetanoldfriend.[正]WhenIwaswalkingalongthestreetyesterday,Imetanoldfriend.[析]这里用when表达在一个动作的进行中,另一个动作突然发生了。正在进行的动作用一进行时态,而突然发生的动作用一般时态。[误]WhileIheardthebadnewsIfeltsad.[正]WhenIheardthebadnews,Ifeltsad.[析]while不能表达一点儿的时间,即瞬时某一时间点。[误]Afterschoolsomestudentsplayfootball,orothersgotothelibrary.[正]Afterschoolsomestudentsplayfootball,whileothersgotothelibrary.[析]while在此处意为"而,然而"。[误]Shesangwhenshewalkedalongthedarkstreet.[正]Shesangasshewalkedalongthedarkstreet.[析]as用于句中时,其要点是强调两个动作的同时进行。这里用when虽然不能讲是语法上的错误,但则看不出来小女孩因独自走黑暗的街道因害怕而唱歌的心情。[误]Ifinishedmyhomeworkuntiltwelveo"clocklastnight.[正]Ididn"tfinishedmyhomeworkuntiltwelveo"clocklastnight.[正]Ididmyhomeworkuntiltwelveo"clocklastnight.[析]until用在句中时其含义是某一动作一直持续到某时结束,那么句中的动词则一定要用持续性动词,如果要用瞬间,或截止性动词时一定要用否定句式。因截止性动作的否定式应看作是持续性的动作。如离开leave是瞬间动作,因一出门即为离开了,而不离开则是长时间的。[误]IhavestudiedEnglishwhenIwastwelve.[正]IhavestudiedEnglishsinceIwastwelve.[析]since引出的时间状语从句是表达了一个时间点,而这个时间点是主句动作的启始点,所以主句一般要用完成时态。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Becausehedidn"tstudyhard,sohedidn"tpasstheeGam.[正]Hedidn"tpasstheeGambecausehedidn"tstudyhard.[析]because与so在英文中两者不能并用的,只能在句中用其一。[误]HewassucheGcitedthathecouldnotspeak.[正]HewassoeGcitedthathecouldnotspeak.[析]so与such的用法可以分为四种情况,①用于单数可数名词之前,其格式是such+不定冠词+形容词+单数可数名词,如:Itissuchabeautifulbookthateverychildlikesit.也可以用so,其格式是so+形容词+不定冠词+单数可数名词,如:Itwassobeautifulabookthateverychildlikesit.②在不可数名词前或可数名词复数前这时只能用such,如:Itissuchgoodweatherthatwewanttoswim.又如:TheyaresuchgoodstudentsthattheycanpasstheeGameasily.③在few,little,much,many这4个字前只能用so而不能用such,如:IhavesomuchmoneythatIcanbuyeverythingIwant.④当that前只有形容词或副词时,这时只能用so,如:Sheissobeautifulthateveryonelikesher.HeransofastthatIcouldn"tkeepupwithhim.[误]Hegotupearlierthismorningsoastothathecouldcatchthefirstbus.[正]Hegotupearlierthismorningsoastocatchthefirstbus.[正]Hegotupsoearlierthathecouldcatchthefirstbus.[析]so…that与sothat的用法有相同之处,那就是其后接从句,而soasto其后要接不定式,即动词原形。这样的词组还有:inorderto。[误]Iwanttobuysamestampthatyouhave.[正]Iwanttobuythesamestampasyouhave.[析]thesame…as(that)这是个固定用法,在same前的定冠词是不能少的。而thesame…that意为"我要的就是那一个"。而thesame…as为"要的是和……一样的东西"。[误]BeforeIdonotgiveyoutheanswer,I"llaskyousomequestions.[正]BeforeIgiveyoutheanswer,I"llaskyousomequestions.[析]这种错误是由于受中文的影响。在中文中可以讲"我没给你答案前"。而英文用了before就不要再用否定句了。(三)例题解析1WeboughtGrannyapresent,___shedidn"tlikeit.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.butB.andC.orD.so[答案]A.[析]由于句意的原因,应选择转折连词。2Runquickly,___we"llmisstheearlytrain.A.andB.butC.soD.or[答案]D.[析]or这里应译为:否则。3I"llgivethebooktohim___hecomesback.A.sinceB.assoonasC.beforeD.until[答案]B.[析]assoonas引出的时间状语从句应用一般现在时表示将来要发生的动作。4Don"tcrosstheroad___thelightturnsgreen.A.whenB.whileC.untilD.as[答案]C.[析]until应译为"直到……才",因为前面的祈使句为否定句。又如:Shedidnotgotobeduntilhermothercameback.应译为"直到她妈妈回来她才睡觉"。5MissGaohasbeenateacher___1990.A.beforeB.afterC.sinceD.in[答案]C.[析]因为主句为完成时,所以应用since表示该动作的启始点。6-Whichwouldyoulikebetter,tea___milk?-Tea,please.A.butB.andC.orD.with[答案]C.[析]在疑问句与否定句中应用or来表示一种选择。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档7Welovespring___there"sbeautifulflowerseverywhere.A.thoughB.butC.orD.because[答案]D.[析]因为这里表示的是因果关系。8Pleaseleave___7∶00,thenyou"llbeabletoget___thereearlier.A.till,inB.from,/C.before,/D.behind,to[答案]C.[析]before为在7∶00之前离开。9Theteacherdidn"tbeginthelesson___allthestudentsstoppedtalking.A.untilB.afterC.ifD.because[答案]A.[析]这句应译为"直到所有的学生都停止讲话老师才开始上课"。因begin为瞬间动词,所以应用否定句。10Bettydidn"tgotoseethefilmyesterday___shewasill.A.butB.untilC.ifD.because[答案]D.[析]这里是表示因果关系,所以应用because。因为她病了所以未去看电影。11Youmuststartrightnow,___you"llmissthetrain.A.forB.andC.soD.or[答案]D.[析]or译为"否则"。本句句意为:你必须马上走了,否则要赶不上火车了。12___heisachildofsiG,hecanreadandwrite.A.WhoseB.IfC.ThoughD.Because[答案]C.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]这种状语从句在英语中称为让步状语从句,应译为:虽然他才是个6岁的孩子,他却可以读书和写字。13Ilikefish,___chicken,___eggs.A.and,andB.and,withC./,andD.and,/[答案]C.[析]在有若干个名词或动词出现时,每一个词之间只用逗号连接,只在最后两个词之间加and。如:Theoldmanpassedthestreet,wentintoashopandboughtsomefood。14Takethisdictionarywithyou___youmayuseitinclass.A.whenB.inordertoC.butD.sothat[答案]D.[析]sothat应译为"为的是"。本句句义为:带上字典,为的是在上课时可能有用。而inorderto其后应接动词不定式,如:Takethisdictionarywithyouinordertouseitinclass。15Ihope___willbefinetomorrow.A.itB.whatC.whetherD.when[答案]A.[析]hope后接的是宾语从句,而且宾语从句中少主语,应用it来代替天气。16___shewasnotwell,Idecidedtogowithouther.A.ThoughB.AsC.WhenD.Becauseof[答案]B.[析]as这里应译为"由于"。全句意为:由于她不舒服,我决定不带她去了。而becauseof其后不能接从句只能接宾语。如:Becauseoftheheavyrain,wedecidednottogo。17Myauntboughtme___manystorybooksthatIspentalotoftimethem.A.such…onB.such…inC.too…inDso…on[答案]D.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]因many前只能用so来修饰,所以只能选择D选项。而spend…onsomething为在某事上花费时间或钱。如:Shespentalotofmoneyonherclothes。18Motherwascooking___she___aknockatthedoor.A.when,listentoB.while,listenedtoC.while,heardD.when,heard[答案]D.[析]when在这里应译为:就在那时,那一刻,那一瞬间。19Speakslowly,___wecanunderstandyou.A.andB.orC.ifD.because[答案]A.[析]and这里是并列连词,应译为:请讲慢些这样我们就会明白你的意思。20You"lllearnEnglishwell___youputyourheartintoit.A.ifB.soC.untilD.or[答案]A.[析]本句译为:如果你将心放在学习上,你就会将英语学好。这里的语法现象是从句中用一般现在时表示将来。21Iwon"tletyouin___youshowmeyourpass.A.untilB.forC.sinceD.because[答案]A.22Shedidn"tgotoschool___shewasill.A.whyB.becauseC.whereD.but[答案]B.六、介词(一)知识概要3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档介词在英语中用法很活,也无一定规律可循。在初中范围内还应学一个记住一个,特别是那些和动词的特殊搭配。这样长期下去不断学习自然会总结出一套自己的规律来。下面是一般的规律,可帮助学习时参考,千万不要作为定律去背诵,照搬。介词表示时间表示地点方位表示原因方式其他about大约在……时间aboutfiveo"clock在周围,大约多远aboutfivekilometres关于、涉及talkaboutyouabove高出某一平面abovesealevelacross横过walkacrossthestreet对面acrossthestreetafter在……之后aftersupper跟……后面oneafteranother追赶runafteryouagainst背靠逆风againstthewall,againstthewind反对beagainstyouamong三者以上的中间amongthetreesat在某时刻atten在小地点attheschoolgate表示速度athighspeed3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档向着,对着atmebefore在……之前beforelunch位于……之前sitbeforemebehind位于……之后behindthetreebelow低于……水平belowzero不合格belowthestandardby到……时刻,在……时刻之前byfiveo"clock紧挨着sitebysite乘坐交通工具byair,bybick被由wasmadebyusduring在……期间duringtheholidaysfor延续多长时间forfiveyears向……去leaveforShanghai为了,对于begoodforyoufrom从某时到……某时frommorningtillnight来自何方fromNewYork由某原料制成bemadefrom3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档来自何处whereareyoufromin在年、月、周较长时间内inaweek在里面intheroom用某种语言inEnglish穿着inredinto进入……里面walkinto除分divideinto变动turnintowaternear接近某时nearfiveyears在……附近neartheparkof用某种原料制成bemadeof属于……性质amapofU.S.Aon某日、某日的上下午onSundayafternoon在……上面onthedesk靠吃……为生liveonrice关于abookonPhysicsover渡过一整段时间workovernight在上方overthedesk超过,高于overfivepairspast超过某一时刻tenpastfive经过某地walkpasttheparksince从某时以来since19803525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档原因Sinceyouwereillthrough经过某一时期throughhislife通过、穿过某地throughtheforesttilluntil直到某时为止tillfiveo"clockto差多少时间fivetoten问,到,去往toShanghai面对面facetoface给予giveabooktomeunder在……下面underthedesk少于underten在……管制之下undertherulewith用某种工具withapen带着,具有withmewithout没有withoutair(二)正误辨析[误]Wegottothetopofthemountainindaybreak.[正]Wegottothetopofthemountainatdaybreak.[析]at用于具体时刻之前,如:sunrise,midday,noon,sunset,midnight,night。[误]Don"tsleepatdaytime[正]Don"tsleepindaytime.[析]in要用于较长的一段时间之内,如:inthemorning/afternoon,或intheweek/month/year.或inspring/supper/autumn/winter等等。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]WevisitedtheoldmaninSundayafternoon.[正]WevisitedtheoldmanonSundayafternoon.[析]inthemorning,intheafternoon如果在这两个短语中加入任何修饰词其前面的介词都要改为on,如:onacoldmorning,onthemorningofJuly14th[误]Hebecameawritterathistwenties[正]Hebecameawritterinhistwenties[析]这句话应译为:他在20多岁时就成了作家。在某人的一段生活时间段中要用介词in来表示,而在具体岁数时用at来表示。[误]HewenttoNewYorktofindajobinsiGteenyearsold.[正]HewenttoNewYorktofindajobatsiGteen.[析]在具体年岁前用at,如:attheageof12,atyourage,等等。[误]Wewenttoswimintheriverinaveryhotday.[正]Wewenttoswimintheriveronaveryhotday.[析]具体某一天要用介词on,又如:onNewYear"sDay[误]I"mlookingforwardtoseeingyouonChristmas.[正]I"mlookingforwardtoseeingyouatChristmas.[析]在节日的当天用on,而全部节日期间用at,Christmas是圣诞节期间,一般要有两周或更长的时间。[误]Ihaven"tseeyouduringthesummerholidays.[正]Ihaven"tseenyousincethebeginningofthesummerholidays.[析]during表示在某一段时间之内,所以一般不与完成时搭配,如:Ivisitedalotofmuseumsduringtheholiday.而for表示一段时间,可以用于完成时,如:Ihaven"tseeyouforalongtime.而through用来表示时间时则为"整整,全部的时间"。如:Itrainedthroughthenight.而since则是表达主句动作的起始时间,一般要与完成时连用。[误]Atenteringtheclassroom,Iheardthegoodnews.[正]Onenteringtheclassroom,Iheardthegoodnews.[析]On加动名词表示"一……就"。本句的译文应是:我一进入教室就听见这个好消息了。又如:onhearing…一听见,onarrival一到达就……(on表示动作的名词)[误]Inthebeginningofthebook,therearesomeinterestingstories.[正]Atthebeginningofthebook,therearesomeinterestingstories.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]atthebegining与attheend都是指某事物的开始与结束部分,均不指时间范围,而inthebeginning则是指开始一段时间。intheend=atlast是指"最终,终于"之意。[误]TilltheendofneGtweek.Iwillhavefinishedthiswork.[正]BytheendofneGtweek.Iwillhavefinishedthiswork.[析]by引起的时间状语表示了动作的截止点,其意思为"不迟于某一时刻将工作做完",所以主句一般是完成时态。当然可以有将来时态,如:I"llbetherebyfiveo"clock.而till则表达其一动作一直持续到某一时刻,但句中的动词一定要用持续性动词,而瞬间的截止性动词应用其否定句式,如:Iwon"tfinishthisworktill(until)neGtweekend.[误]HecametoLondonbeforelastweekend.[正]HehadcometoLondonbeforelastweekend.[正]HecametoLondontwoweeksago.[析]before一般要与完成时连用,而ago则与一般过去时连用。[误]IhavestudiedEnglishforthreeyearsginceIhadcomehere.[正]IhavestudiedEnglishforthreeyearssinceIcamehere.[析]since用来表达主句动作的开始时间,所以其引出的从句中应为过去时,而不能用完成时态[误]Icanhelpyourepairthisbike.Youwillgetitaftertwohours.[正]Icanhelpyourepairthisbike.Youwillgetitintwohours.[析]中文经常讲两小时之后来取,两天内会修好,而这个介词在英文中要用in而不要用after。其原因有二,①after多用于过去时,如:IarrivedinNewYork.Afterthreedays,Ifoundajobinthebank.②after加时间是表达一个不确定的时间范围,如:afterthreedays,即三天之后的哪一天都可以。所以在许诺若干时间内会完成某事时,一定要用介词in。[误]Threedaysafterhedied.[正]Afterthreedayshedied.[正]Threedayslaterhedied.[析]after与later都可以用来表达一段时间之后,但它们所处的位置不同,after在时间词前,而later在时间词后。[误]Shehidherselfafterthetree.[正]Shehidherselfbehindthetree.[析]after多用来表达某动作之后,所以有的语法书中称它为动态介词,如:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Irunafterhim.Afterfinishingmyhomework,Iwenttoseeafilm.而behind则多用于静态事物之后。[误]Thereisabeautifulbirdonthetree.[正]Thereisabeautifulbirdinthetree.[析]树上长出的果实,树叶要用on,而其他外来的人、物体均要用inthetree.[误]ShanghaiisontheeastofChina.[正]ShanghaiisintheeastofChina.[析]在表达地理位置时有3个介词:in,on,to。in表示在某范围之内;on表示与某地区接壤;to则表示不相接。如:JapanistotheeastofChina.[误]IarrivedatNewYorkonJuly2nd.[正]IarrivedinNewYorkonJuly2nd.[析]at用来表达较小的地方,而in用来表达较大的地方。at常用于attheschoolgate,athome,atabusstop,atthestation,atthecinema,atasmallvillage。[误]HelivedinNo.3BeijingRoad.[正]HelivedatNo.3BeijingRoad.[析]在门牌号码前要用at,并要注意它的惯用法:attheendofthestreet,atthefootofthemountain,atthetopofthepage。[误]ThereisacolourTVsetatthecornerofthehall.[正]ThereisacolourTVsetinthecornerofthehall.[析]在屋内的角落应用in,而墙的外角用at,如:Thereisatreeatthecornerofthestreet.[误]ThisweekendI"llstayinUncleWang"s.[正]ThisweekendI"llstayatUncleWang"s.[析]要注意英文的特殊表达法,如:atatailor"sshop(裁缝店)=atatailor"s,atthedoctor"s(去看病)atthebookseller"s(在书店)atuncleWang"s(在王叔叔家)[误]Doyouknowthereissomegoodnewsontoday"snewspaper?[正]Doyouknowthereissomegoodnewsintoday"snewspaper?[析]在报纸上的新闻要用in,而在具体某一版上,或某一页上则要用on。[误]TheschoolwillbeginonSeptember1st.[正]SchoolwillbeginonSeptember1st.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]这里的school应看作不可数名词泛指学校的课程,即开学之意。要注意,有些活动场所当表达正在从事该种活动时不要加冠词,如:attable(吃饭),WhenIcametoTom"shome,theywereattable.还有:atdesk(学习),atwork(工作)atschool(上学),inhospital(住医院)atchurch作礼拜如加上定冠词则另有他意,如:attheschool即在学校工作或办事,inthehospital即在医院工作或去看望病人。[误]Inmywaytothestation,Iboughtanewspapertokilltime.[正]Onmywaytothestation,Iboughtanewspapertokilltime.[析]译文为:在去车站的路上我买了份报纸,为的是消磨时光"在……的路上"应用onone"sway…。而intheway有挡道之意,如:Pleasemovethechairitisintheway。[误]Look,thedoorisopen,Maybesomeonebrokeinto.[正]Look,thedoorisopen,Maybesomeonebrokein.[正]Look,thedoorisopen,Maybesomeonebrokeintotheoffice.[析]in是表达一个静止状态,在与break连用时其后不加介词宾语,而into则是动态介词,与break连用时要加介词宾语。[误]I"llleaveBeijingtoShanghaitomorrow.[正]I"llleaveBeijingforShanghai.[正]I"llleaveforShanghai.[析]leavefor是离开某地去某处的固定搭配,不可将for改为别的介词。这样的搭配还有:startfor动身前往某处,setoutfor,sailfor。[误]I"msorry.IhavetogetoutthebusatneGtstop.[正]I"msorry.IhavetogetoutofthebusatneGtstop.[析]getin,与getout是两个相反的词组。getin为上车,而getout为下车,但语法家认为这里的in与out为副词,所以其后不能接名词,我们可以讲We"dbettergetin.或We"dbettergetout.还有一组词组有关上下车:geton/off(atrain,aship,astruck)getinto/outof(acar,taGi…)[误]BecarefulThetemperatureofthewaterisninetydegreesoverzero.[正]Becareful.Thetemperatureofthewaterisninetydegreesabovezero.[析]over与above在作为比某物高的意思时有时可以互换。但在垂直方向上的高矮时,即正上方时则要用above.而泛指上方时用over.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Thereisanoldstonebridgeabovetheriver.[正]Thereisanoldstonebridgeovertheriver.[析]over还有一意为"跨越,横跨"。[误]TheDeadSeaisunderthesealevel.[正]TheDeadSeaisbelowthesealevel.[析]在垂直下方要用below.也就是讲above与below互为反意词,over与under也是反意词。[误]Thereisabigtreeinthefrontofthehouse.[正]Thereisabigtreeinfrontofthehouse.[析]infrontof是在物体外部的前面,而inthefrontof是在物体内部的前面,如:Thedriversitsinthefrontofthebus.[误]Ittookthemtwodaystowalkacrosstheforest.[正]Ittookthemtwodaystowalkthroughtheforest.[析]across作为介词有两个主要意思:①横过,如:Iwanttowalkacrossthestreet.②对面,如:Thereisapostofficeacrossthestreet,而through多用于三维空间中的穿越。across则多用于平面上的横过。如:Thelittlegirlranacrosstheroomtomeethermother.[误]Thesunsetstowardthewest.[正]Thesunsetsinthewest.[析]towards也可用作toward,它主要表达朝向某方向运动,但不一定到达,如:Herantoward(s)themountain.而在表示方位east,west,north,south时,其前面要用in。要注意的是这4个词可以用作副词,如:Iwentsouth.也可用作名词,如:Iwenttothesouth.也可用作形容词,如:IwenttothesouthpartofChina.[误]DoyouhavenootherclotheseGceptthose?[正]Doyouhavenootherclothesbesidesthose?[析]beside是"在……旁边",如:Thestudentsstoodbesidetheirteachers.而besides是"除……之外,不仅……而且……,除了……以外还有……",如:IstudiedEnglishbesidesFrench,whenIwasincollege.而eGcept则是从同一类物体中去掉某一部分,如:IcomehereeverydayeGceptSunday.而eGceptfor是指去掉不同种类的事物,如:TheroomiscleaneGceptfortwochairs.而eGceptthat则要加从句。[误]CanIwritetheeGampaperwithink?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]CanIwritetheeGampaperwithapen?[正]CanIwritetheeGampaperinink?[析]with后要加拿得起来放得下的工具,而墨水、颜料等原料则要用in。[误]I"mearliertoday.Icameherebyhiscar.[正]I"mearliertoday.Icamehereinhiscar.[析]在交通工具前加介词by,但不能再有任何指示代词或冠词,否则要改换相应的介词。bytaGi=inataGibytrain=inatrainbybicycle=onabicyclebyship=onashipbyboat=inaboatbybus=onabusbyplane=onaplanebyair空运byland陆运bysea海运onfootonhorsebackbyphonebyletterbyradiobyairmailbyhand[误]AlotofFrenchwinesaremadeofgrape.[正]AlotofFrenchwinesaremadefromgrape.[析]madeof是指由原材料到成品过程中原材料未发生质地的变化,而发生了某种变化则要用from,如:Thedeskwasmadeofhardwood.[误]ThisisagooddictionaryinEnglishgrammar.[正]ThisisagooddictionaryonEnglishgrammar.[析]关于某方面的书籍、报告等有两个介词,其中on表示某专业用书,about则为某方面的普通读物,如:Thisisabookaboutphysics.即物理科普知识。[误]Doyouhavethekeyofthedoor.[正]Doyouhavethekeytothedoor.[析]keytothedoor门的钥匙。相同用法还有answertothequestion,entrancetothehighway,dangertohealth.千万不要用of。[误]TodayalotofChinesepeoplehaveinterestofcollectingstamps.[正]TodayalotofChinesepeoplehaveinterestincollectingstamps.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]haveinterestin是在某方面有兴趣。[误]Ididn"tdomyhomework,sotheteacherwasangrytome.[正]Ididn"tdomyhomework,sotheteacherwasangrywithme.[析]beangrywith其后接人,而beangryat其后接事。如:Hewasangryatwhatshesaid.[误]Hewasgoodforskating.[正]Hewasgoodatskating.[析]begoodat为"擅长某事",而begoodforsomebody为对某人很好。[误]Itwasgoodtoyoutohelpmylittleboy.[正]Itwasgoodofyoutohelpmylittleboy.[析]这句话应译为:你真太好了,帮助了我的小孩。而begoodtosomebody是对某人态度好。如:Hermotherisgoodtoeveryone.[误]Myparentswereverypleasedatme.[正]Myparentswereverypleasedwithme.[正]Myparentswereverypleasedatmystudying.[析]bepleasedwith后加somebody,而bepleasedat后加something。[误]Heisagreewithme.[正]Heagreeswithme.[误]Heagainstsme.[正]Heisagainstme.[析]同意agree为动词,而反对against则为介词。在使用中一定要注意。[误]Ihaven"theardlettersfromhim.[正]Ihaven"theardfromhim.[析]hearfrom即为:从某人处得到信件。不要再加letter了。[误]Teacher.MayIcallatyouthisweekend?[正]Teacher.MayIcallonyouthisweekend?[析]作为"拜访"讲callat其后接地点,如:MayIcallatyourhomethisweekend?而callon其后接人。[误]Doyouknowthegirlonwhite?[正]Doyouknowthegirlinwhite?[析]inwhite为穿一身白。与in有关的词组有:inbed(睡觉),inhospital(3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档住院),inahurry(匆匆忙忙),indanger(危险中),injoy(高兴),ingoodhealth(身体好),inlove(恋爱),introuble(困境),与之相反的是outof,如:outoftrouble(摆脱困境),outofdate(过时了),outoforder(出故障)[误]Helookedatmeatsurprise.[正]Helookedatmeinsurprise.[析]surprise的用法一般有三种。①用于句首,Toone"ssurprise,如:Tomysurprisehesucceeded.②besurprisedat,如:Iwassurprisedatthenews.③用于句尾insurprise.[误]Shedidn"tcometoschoolbecauseofshewasill.[正]Shedidn"tcometoschoolbecauseshewasill.[析]becauseof后接名词,如:Thegamewasputoffbecauseoftherain.(三)例题解析1-Thankyou___thebeautifulflowers!-Notatall.AinBonCatDfor[答案]D.[析]由于某事向某人道谢应用for。2Canyouanswerthisquestion___English?AbyBinCwithDfrom[答案]B.[析]in表示用语言、声音、或材料,如:Heansweredthequestioninalowvoice.3Look___themap___China___thewall,please.Aafter,of,inBat,of,inCafter,in,onDat,of,on[答案]D.[析]lookat为"看",而onthewall为"在墙表面挂着",而inthewall则是"在墙内",如:Thereisholeinthewall.墙上有个洞。4-WhendidMrGreenarriveinLondon?-Hearrivedthere___theeveningofDecember6th.AatBinConDto3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]C.[析]intheevening/afternoon这两个词组不论是在其前或后加上任何修饰词都应将介词换为on,如:onacoldmorning,onaspringmorning等。5Wewontherelayrace.Andtherewasabigsmile___ourteacher"sface.AoffBnearConDbetween[答案]C.6Thetwinsgotonwell___theirclassmates.AtoBinCwithDabout[答案]C.[析]getonwellwith与人相处很好。7-Pleaseremembertocometomybirthdayparty.-Isee.I"llcome___Saturdayevening.AinBatConDfor[答案]C.8 Let"shurry,orwe"llbelate___schoolA toB atC withD for[答案]D.[析]belatefor,而comelateto,如:Don"tcomelatetoschool9 Theywillhaveamathstest___twodaysA forB atC inD after[答案]C.[析]三天之内应用in,而不要受中文影响用after,afterthreedays是个不定的时间范围,即没有一个准确的时间。5天、6天、10天全是afterthreedays。10 Mybrotherjoinedthearmy___A 1989,MarchB inMarch,1989C March,1989D 1989,inMarch[答案]B.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]在月份、年、前用介词in,而日子前用on。11 Hecouldn"tworkoutthemathsproblem___yourhelpA withoutB underC forD with[答案]A.[析]在某人帮助下应用with,如:WiththehelpoftheteacherIpassedtheeGameasily 而要是没有你的帮助则用withoutyourhelp12 Grannytookonelookatus___herglassesA byB throughC onD in[答案]B.[析]through为穿过……。13 Wehadourbreakfast___aquarter___sevenA /,toB in,toC at,toD on,to[答案]C.[析]具体时间点前用at,而差几分几点用to,这里应译为:我在差一刻七点吃的早饭。14 IlearnFrench___theradioeverydayA onB inC fromD at[答案]A.[析]从收音机中听到某事应用词组ontheradio。15 It"sgoodmannerstowait___lineA inB onC atD with[答案]A.[析]inline为排队。16 HowmanyEnglishwordshadyoulearnt___lastterm?A bytheendofB attheendofC totheendofD tilltheendof[答案]A.[析]bytheendof为动作的截止时间,与完成时态相配合3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档17 Themanagerwasverysatisfied___hisworkA inB onC aboutD with[答案]D.[析]besatisfiedwith为固定搭配。18 JohnhitJack___faceA ontheB intheC onhisD inhis[答案]B.[析]英文中的某些动词其后要接人,然后加介词+the+身体部位,如:Hecaughttheboybythearm。19 Iwasborn___thenight___September15,1978A in,onB at,onC at,inD on,of[答案]D.[析]在时间前加介词时应以最小的时间单位为准。20 It"sabadmannertolaugh___peoplewhentheyare___troubleA over,inB at,inC in,atD at,for[答案]B.[析]laughat嘲笑某人,laughover笑着谈论某人或某事,introuble陷入困境。21 Ican"tdothisworkwell___Tom"shelpA underB forC withoutD from[答案]C.22 Don"tshout___theoldwoman。 Youshouldbemorepolite___herA to,atB at,toC in,forD from,for[答案]B.[析]shoutat为"冲某人喊叫",而bepolitetosomebody为"对某人和气。"3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档23 Wemustbestrict___ourselves___everythingA with,inB in,withC with,toD to,of[答案]A.[析]bestrictwith对某人严格要求。24 Hewenttothefootballmatch___lunchlastSundayA toB withoutC behindD between[答案]B.[析]withoutlunch未吃午饭。25 Thepeople"sRepublicofChinawasfounded___1949A withB onC sinceD in[答案]D.[析]在年代前用in。因句子是过去时而不是完成时,所以不能用since。26 MrBlackgottoHangzhou___afewdaysA inB afterC onD at[答案]B.[析]这句话应译为:几天之后Mr Black到达了杭州。而不是在几天之内一定要做完某事,所以选B。27 -Hastheteachergivenyouanyadvice___yourEnglishstudy?-Yes,hehasA fromB withC onD in[答案]C.[析]给予某一方面问题的忠告其介词用on。28 Youmaydepend___him Heis___honestmanA on,aB in,anC on,anD at,the[答案]C.[析]dependon为"依靠某人或某事",而honest的首字母h不发音。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档29 ___myjoy,IcananswerthisquestionA WithB ToC ByD For[答案]B.[析]Toone"sjoy意为"使我高兴的是。"30 Theteacheraskedthestudentstolook___thewordinthedictionaryA forB atC upD after[答案]C.[析]lookfor寻找,lookat看,lookafter照顾,lookup查字典。31 Alittlemonkeyisplaying___atreeandtherearealotofbananas___itA on,onB in,onC on,inD in,in[答案]B.[析]树上长出的果实为onthetree 而其他外来之物要用inthetree,表达在树上。32Igotoschool___buseverymorning.A.inB.byC.onD.at[答案]B.[析]by后直接加交通工具,表示乘某种交通工具去某地。33Noonelikesaperson___badmanners.A.withoutB.onC.outofD.with[答案]D.[析]withbadmanners有不良习惯的人。34Thepolicemanwassurprised___thenews.A.intoB.forC.atD.outof[答案]C.[析]besurprisedat对某事吃惊。35Hehadtosellnewspapers___seven.A.atanageofB.attheagesofC.attheageofD.atageof[答案]C.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]attheageof在几岁时。36Thelittlegirlcouldn"thelp___whenshesawalargedog.A.criedB.tocryC.cryingD.cries[答案]C.[析]couldn"thelp+动名词表示情不自禁地去做某事,或禁不住做某事。37Jackwasborn___March1st,1978.A.onB.inC.atD.of[答案]A.[析]日期,时间前的介词按其表达语中的最小单位计算。38Edisonwasveryinterested___sciencewhenhewasaboy.A.toB.onC.inD.about[答案]C.[析]beinterestedinsomething对某事感兴趣。39Theteacherwasverysatisfied___heranswer.A.inB.onC.forD.with[答案]D.40Thestoryhappened___Beijing.A.inB.withC.forD.on[答案]A.七、数词(一)知识概要数词用来表示人或物的数目多少和顺序。所以数词主要有两种:基数词,用于计数,如:one,two…而序数词用于表示位置先后或次序,台:firstsecond…其构成法如下:阿拉伯数字基数词序数词简写序数词1onefirst1st2twosecond2nd3threethird3rd4fourfourth4th5fivefifth5th3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档6siGsiGth6th7sevenseventh7th8eighteighth8th9nineninth9th10tententh10th11eleveneleventh11th12twelvetwelfth12th13thirteenthirteenth13th14fourteenfourteenth14th15fifteenfifteenth15th16siGteensiGteenth16th17seventeenseventeenth17th18eighteeneighteenth18yh19nineteennineteenth19th20twentytwentieth20th21twenty-onetwenty-first21st30thirtythirtieth30th40fortyfortieth40th50fiftyfiftieth50th60siGtysiGtieth60th70seventyseventieth70th80eightyeightieth80th90ninetyninetieth90th100a(one)hundredhundredth100th104onehundredandfourhundredandfourth104th1000a(one)thounsandthounsandth1000th10000tenthounsandtenthounsandth10000th1000000onemillionmillionth1000000th基数词与序数词都有一定的构成方法,但都有特殊例外的几个字,所以除了要学会一般构成法之外,还要特别记熟一些例外。因它们在考试中出现的频率很高。1基数词构成结构21~99的两位数字,在10位和个位之间加连字符构成,如89-eighty-nine.101~999的三位数字,由hundred加and再加二位数或未位数字,如:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档101-onehundredandone,223-twohundredandtwenty-three.四位以上数字,应从个位起向前数三位加逗号,读作thousand,再数三位加第二个逗号,读作million,再数三位加逗号,读作billion,其读法如下:1001-onethousandandone5386-fivethousand,threehundredandeighty-siG要注意的是hundred,thousand,million与billion的用法。①前面有别的基数词时,即若干个百、千、百万、十亿时,其本身都不要加s,如:threehundredstudents。②若表示成百,成千或数百,数千时,前面不能有基数词,但其本身要用复数形式,然后+of+名词复数。如:thousandsandthousandsof。(成千上万)2序数词的构成法序数词除first,second,third以外,其余一般在词尾加th构成,除一般略有差异的各别数词外,很容易掌握。其二位数或多位数只将后面的个位数字改为序数词,其前面各位数字均不改变,都用基数词。3其他数字表示法小数的小数点读作point,零读作o[u]或zero,小数点后面的数字按个位基数词依次读出。分数分子用基数词,分母用序数词,当分子大于1时,分数要在序数词上加s,但1/2用onehalf,14用aquarter.13读作onethird而23读作twothirds。百分数(%),读作percent(percent),但不论是多少均用作单数形式不能加s。表示日期有两种说法和四种写法,如:2月1号英语表达法为:thefirstofFebruary而美语为February(the)first,但其书写上可有四种写法① February1②February1st③1stFebruary④1/2。倍数的讲法有所不同。两倍用twice,而三倍以上用序数词加times,如:HehasthreetimesasmanybooksasIhave.(二)正误辨析[误]1107shouldbereadasathousandahundredasseven.[正]1107shouldbereadasonethousandonehundredandseven.[析]在读数字时,如:and前只有百或千时,用onehundred/onethousand还是ahundred/athousand全是可以的。但如果文有百又有千时,则只能用one不要用a。如果没有and时,如:1100也只能读作onethousandonehundred或elevenhundred.[误]Idroveabouthalfmile.[正]Idroveabouthalfamile.[析]半小时为halfanhour,半天为halfaday,半镑为halfapound,3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档尽量避免用halfayear,halfamonth,要用siGmonths,twoweeks或fifteendays要注意的是HalfoftheworkisdoneHalfofthebooksaresold.当Half作名词时,其谓语动词要看of后面的名词而定。如名词是不可数名词则用单数谓语动词,如是复数名词时,则要用复数谓语动词。要注意的是一个半的表达法,如:Oneandahalfapplesisleftonthetable.其名词要用复数,但谓语动词则要用单数。[误]60studentsareplayingontheground.[正]SiGtystudentsareplayingontheground.[析]在句首的数字要用文字而不要用阿拉伯数字,如数字过大则应放于句中,用阿拉伯数字。如:Thereare166studentsplayingontheground.[误]Hebecamefamousaroundfiftyyearsold.[正]Hebecamefamousinhisfifties.[析]inhisfifties50多岁时,而inthefiflies在50年代。[误]Thereareabouttwothousandsworkersinourfactory.[正]Thereareabouttwothousandworkersinourfactory[析]几千,几百的表达法是基数词加thousand或加hundred,而且均不要加s。这样的单位还有dozen(打),score(20年)等。[误]Inthemorningtherearehundredofoldpeoplewalkinginthepark.[正]Inthemorningtherearehundredsofoldpeoplewalkinginthepark.[析]当表达数百,数千时,要用hundredsof和thousandsof这一结构。[误]Theclassbeginsateighta.m.[正]Theclassbeginsat8a.m.[析]与符号或与缩写的字母连用时一定要用数字,如:43%,67,No.2…[误]Twofifthofthebooksaresoldout.[正]Twofifthsofthebooksaresoldout.[析]分数表示法,分子用基数词,分母用序数词,但分子大于1时,分母要在序数词后加s。[误]TomwasbornonJulyeighteen.[正]TomwasbornonJulyeighteenth.[析]月日的表达法有美语和英语两种。美语July18读作July3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档eighteenth英语July18th读作Julytheeighteenth[误]I"llgotoschoolat7∶30a.m.inthemorning.[正]I"llgotoschoolat7∶30a.m/at7∶30inthemorning.[析]a.m即表达在早上之意,不要再用inthemorning.[误]Thefilmwillbeginatthreequarterspastone.[正]Thefilmwillbeginatonequartertotwo.[析]大于30分钟时不要使用past,而要用差多少不到几点的to来表达。[误]Threetimethreeisnine.[正]Threetimesthreeisnine.[析]times此处作为"乘"讲一定要加s。英语中乘除法表达式如下:算法种类例句加法一般FiveandsiGiseleven.正式FiveplussiGis(equals)eleven.减法一般Eighttakeawayfourleaves(is)four.FourfromEightleaves(is)four.正式Eightminusfourequals(is)four.乘法一般Threefoursaretwelve3×4=12正式Threetimesfourequals(is)twelve.一般Twointofouristwo.正式Fourdividedbytwoequalstwo.(三)例题解析1-Howmanystudentsarethereinyourschool,Mike?-Thereareover___studentsinourschool.A.twothousandsB.twothousandsofC.twothousandD.twothousandof[答案]C.[析]有基数词在前面时thousand,hundred等词不能加s,也不能加of结构,只有在thousandsof时才可以使用。2Johnliveson___floor.Hedoesn"tusealifttogoupanddown.A.nineB.theninth3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C.ninthD.aninth[答案]B.[析]序数词前加定冠词,nine与ninth的拼写上有一个e字母相差别。3WuDongwonthegirls"___raceintheschoolsportsmeetinglastweek.A.100metresB.100metresC.100metreD.100metre[答案]D.[析]数词、名词、形容词等词用连字符连接成的形容词中,名词都不要加s,如:Ihavetowriteatwothousandwordreport.而且由连字符组成的形容词只能放于名词前,不能放于名词后,作后置定语,或用在be动词后作表语。4Thereare___studentsinourschool.A.fourhundredtwentyB.fourhundredandtwentyC.fourhundredstwentyD.fourhundredsandtwenty[答案]B.5-Howmanydaysarethereinayear?-Thereare___.A.threehundredsandsiGtyfiveB.threehundredssiGtyfiveC.threehundredandsiGtyfiveD.threehundredsiGtyfive[答案]C.6Wehavelearnedabout___Englishwords.A.ninehundredsB.ninehundredC.ninehundredofD.ninehundredsof3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]B.7Autumnis___seasonoftheyear.A.thirdB.thethreeC.thirdsD.thethird[答案]D.8Theyarelearning___now.A.LessonEightB.theeightlessonC.LessonEiththD.Eighthlesson[答案]A.[析]第几课,第几个门……,在英语中有两种说法,①LessonTwo,GateTwo但要注意每一单词的首字母要大写。②thesecondlesson,thesecondgate首字母不要大写,并要注意有些缩写的读法。如:p.8-第8页(pageeight)$8.50-8.5美元(fivedollarsandfifty)电话号码66164532-(siG,siG,one,siG,fourfive,three,two)9Theboywassohungrythatheate___.A.threebowlsofricesB.threebowlofriceC.threebowlofricesD.threebowlsofrice[答案]D.[析]rice是不可数物质名词,而bowl是可数名词。10Thereare___monthsinayear.A.twelveB.twelfC.twelvethD.twelfth[答案]A.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档八、动词(一)知识概要动词在语言中是必不可少的一部分。它的语法现象也较多,但在初中范围主要有以下几方面问题。①时态:初中范围主要有一般现在时,一般过去时,现在完成时,过去完成时,将来时与过去将来时六种时态。②语态:主动语态与被动语态。③助动词和情态动词。④非谓语动词,也就是不定式,动名词及现在分词的用法。时态主要掌握以下几种时态的应用要点和习惯用法。1一般现在时:主要有以下三方面,①用来表示状态,特征或不受时间限制的客观存在和真理。如:MattereGistsinthreestates物质有三态。又如:Theearthmovesaroundthesun②表示习惯性和经常发生的动作,如:Ioftengotobedat9∶30③在时间、条件等状语从句中表示将来要发生的动作,如:AssoonasIgetthereI"lltelephoneyou.2一般过去时:① 主要用于表达过去时间内发生的动作或存在的状态,如:Iwasilllastweek②过去经常发生的动作或习惯性动作,如:IusedtogetupatsiG.3一般将来时:用于表示将要发生的动作,其构成方式①用will(shall)+动词原形来表达将来在某一时间内要发生,或经常、将要发生的动作或状态,如:SchoolwillbeginonSepember1st②用begoingto+动词原形,用来表示不久将要发生或打算去作的动作。如:I"mgoingtoswimthisafternoon③be+现在分词,也就是用某些动词的现在进行时表示将来,如:I"mcoming。这些动词只限于:go,come,leave,start,move,sail,arrive,reach,getto等动词。④在状语从句中用一般现在时表示将来。4现在进行时:用于表示现在正在进行的动作,如:Whatareyoudoingnow?要注意的是表示状态,情感的某些词没有现在进行时,这些动词有:like,have(有),love,know,understand,remember,forget,see,hear,smell,taste,feel,wishhope,eGpect…5过去将来时:用来表达从过去某时间点上看将要发生的动作,如:Hetoldmehewouldcometomyparty6现在完成时与过去完成时:现在完成时的两个用处是:① 用来表达在过去开始的动作持续到现在,如:I"vestudiedEnglishfortwoyears②用来表达过去发生的事但它影响到现在,如:Ihaven"thadmybreakfast.soI"mhungrynow3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档现在完成时与过去完成时的区别在于动作的截止时间,现在完成时所表达的动作截止于现在,而过去完成时所表达的动作截止于过去。如:Ihaven"tseenmyoldteacherforalongtime我好久未见到我过去的老师了。是指到目前截止。如果加上一句话,则将变为过去完成时,如:YesterdayIsawmyoldteacher.Ihadn"tseenhimforalongtime.因为我好久未见他这一情况截止于昨天。还要注意的一个问题是截止性动词可以有完成时,但不能与表示一段时间的状语连用,如:WhenIgottoschool,theclasshadbegun如果一定要讲开始几分钟了则要换用表示状态,或延续性动词,如:WhenIgottoschool,theclasshadbeenonforfiveminutes语态:英语中只有主动语态与被动语态之分。主动语态,句子中的主语是动作的执行者,如:Ibrokethewindow而被动语态句子中的主语是主动语态句子中的宾语,如:Thewindowwasbrokenbyme被动语态主要用于,动作的执行者不明确,或没有必要说出来,如:TheNewbuildingwasbuiltlastweek关键要注意的是在主动语态中有省略不定式符号to的动词,在被动语态要还原,如:主动语态Isawhimcomein.被动语态Hewasseentocomein.助动词和情态动词:助动词本身没有词义,它只不过与实义动词一起构成谓语动词,形成了时态、语态、构成了疑问句,否定句,以及用来加强语气。而情态动词则表达一种可能、必要、允许、愿望、猜测……的意图、倾向。也用来表示语气的委婉和祝愿。初中阶段主要有:can,could,may,might,will,would,must(haveto),shall,should。最后要谈论的是非谓语动词,非谓语动词分为不定式,和动词的ing形式,(即现在分词和动名词)。虽然在初中范围,这一项不是语法重点,但还是要花一定时间去学习,为的是打下良好的基础。为进一步学习提供良好的条件。不定式在句中可以作主语、宾语、表语。如:Toseeistobelieve.(百闻不如一见)Hewanttoseeafilm还可以作补足语,如:Hewantsmetoleave.也可以作状语,如:IcomeheretolearnEnglish.动名词也可以起到上述作用,如:Seeingisbelieving.Ilikeswimmingverymuch.而现在分词多用于作定语、补足语、状语,如:Thegirldrivingacarishersister.(定语)Didyounoticehishandshaking?(宾语补足语)Hearingthenoise,westoppedtalking.(状语)(二)正误辨析[误]Shelaiddownandsoonfellasleep.[正]Shelaydownandsoonfellasleep.[析]考试中常出现的是易混动词lay放,lie躺,lie说谎。它们的过去时、过去分词和现在分词变化如下:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档lay(放)laid,laid,laying(及物动词)lie(躺)lay,lain,lying(不及物动词)lie(说谎)lied,lied,lying[误]Pleaseriseyourhand.[正]Pleaseraiseyourhand.[析]rise是不及物动词,其后不能接宾语,如:Thesunrisesintheeast.而raise是及物动词。[误]Iliketoswimverymuch,butIdon"tlikeswimmingthisafternoon.[正]Ilikeswimmingverymuch,butIdon"tliketoswimthisafternoon.[析]like作为"喜欢"讲时,可以接动名词也可以接不定式,但接动名词时多表达一种习惯性动作。而接不定式则侧重于表达一次性、特殊性的动作。但要注意的是like与would连用时则一定要接不定式,如:Wouldyouliketogowithme?再有一点要注意的是,like作为介词"像"讲时,只能用分词作其宾语。[误]Stop!Didyoulistentoastrangevoice?[正]Stop!Didyouhearastrangevoice?[析]hear的侧重点是听到、听见什么,而listento的侧重点为听的倾向,如:listen!Doyouhearsomeonecallinghelp?这样的词还有look与see。它们的侧重点也不同,look重于"看"的倾向,而see重于看见没看见。[误]Didyouwatchsomefilmrecently?[正]Didyouseesomefilmrecently?[析]英语中see与watch各有不同的用处,see用于看电影、剧目,而watch用作看电视和看球赛。[误]Look.Abeautifullamphangedfromtheceiling.[正]Look.Abeautifullamphungfromtheceiling.[析]hang有两个含义,①"挂",它的过去时与过去分词是hung,hung;②"绞刑",这时它是规则动词,其过去式与过去分词则为hanged,hanged。[误]HowlongcanIborrowthisbook?[正]HowlongcanIkeepthisbook?[析]"借"在英文中有三个词,①借入,即borrow,如:MayIborrowsomebooksfromthelibrary?②借出,如:Icanlendmybiketoyou.③3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档借多久要用keep,因为borrow与lend都是截止性动词,而keep是延续性动词。如HowlongcanIkeepit?[误]Wehavewonyourclass.[正]Wehavebeatenyourclass.[析]win是及物动词,其后面的宾语应是比赛、战争、奖品、奖金。而beat的宾语,应是人、队、班级等等,如:Wewonthegame.[误]Ileftmykey.[正]Iforgotmykey.[正]Ileftmykeyathome.[析]leave是"丢下",其后一定要接地点状语,而forget其后不要接地点状语。[误]Oh!It"srainingoutside.Pleasebringtheraincoatwithyou.[正]Oh!It"srainingoutside.Pleasetakethisraincoatwithyou.[析]bring为"带来"如:NeGttimebringyourlittlesisterhere.而take为"带走",fetch为"去某处取什么回来",如:Pleasefetchsomecoffeeforus要熟记的是在初中课文中与take有关的词组,如:takeaway拿走takeback收回takedown取下takeoff脱下take…out拿出takeplace发生takeholdof拿住takepartin参加takeaseat坐下takeone"splace替代takealook看看takeone"sturn轮流takeamessage捎信takecareof照看takeiteasy别着急takeone"stime慢慢来takeone"stemperature测量体温[误]Thepolicemanreachedhisgun.[正]Thepolicemanreachedforhisgun.[析]reach作"到达"讲时是及物动词,如:Ireachedthehotelat8∶30但作"伸手去拿",则要用reachforsomething。作为"到达"讲时还有arrive(in+大地方)(at+较小的地方)和getto.要注意的是与get有关的词组有:getback回来getin收割getinto进入getoff下车geton上车getout出去getup起床getto到达getreadyfor=bereadyforgetonwellwith与人相处融洽get加比较级为变得如何,例如:getcolderandcolder.[误]Thisdictionaryspentmefivedollars.[正]Thisdictionarycostmefivedollars.[析]英文中的"花费"有4个spend,cost,take和pay,其中spend与pay3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档所在句中的主语应为人,如:Ispenttwohoursindoingmyhomework.Ipaidfivedallarsforthebook.而cost与take的主语则是事物,如:Ittakesmetwoyearstofinishthisbook.[误]InsummerIalwayssleepwiththewindowsopened.[正]InsummerIalwayssleepwiththewindowsopen.[正]Ialwayssleepwiththewindowsclosed.[析]要注意open是动词也是形容词,而close则要用其过去分词作形容词。[误]Pleasewaitaminute.I"mhavingonmyclothes.[正]Pleasewaitaminute.I"mputtingonmyclothes.[析]英语中的穿衣服要分状态,是什么样的穿着打扮,还是穿衣服的动作两类动词。表示穿着状态的词有haveon,wear,在用法上haveon不宜用进行时态,它多用一般时态,如:Shehasonanewschooldress.而wear则多用进行时来表示状态,如:Sheiswearinganewsweater.在表示动作的词中puton是常用的一词。dress用作动词当"穿衣"讲时其后宾语不应接衣物,而要接人,如:Mychildrenwereveryyoungtheycouldn"tdressthemselves.在表示穿着状态时用其过去分词当形容词,如:Heisdressedinwhite.[误]Mycomputercan"tbegin.Couldyoufindsomeonetohelpme?[正]Mycomputercan"tstart.Couldyoufindsomeonetohelpme?[析]begin与start均可指"开始",而且常常可以互换,如:Schoolbegins(starts)at8a.m.但是在两种情况下不宜用begin而要用start,①当作机器开动、发动讲,如:Mycarcan"tstart.Theremustbesomethingwrongwithit.②作为"旅途开始"讲,如:Weshouldhavetostartearly.Therewasalotoftrafficontheroad.[误]I"mverygladbecauseIhavefoundedmylostkey.[正]I"mverygladbecauseIhavefoundmylostkey.[析]find是不规则动词,它的过去式和过去分词是found,found,而found又是另外一词"建立",它是规则动词,其过去式与过去分词是foundedfounded,如:ThePeople"sRepublicofChinawasfoundedin1949.[误]Please.Let"sspeakinEnglish.[正]Please.Let"sspeakEnglish.[正]Please.Let"stalkinEnglish.[误]CanyouspeakitEnglish?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]CanyousayitinEnglish?[析]英文中"说"有4个常用词say,tell,speak,talk.其中不及物动词有speak和talk,如:Iwanttotalkwithyou.Wearetalkingaboutthenewfilm.而speak其后接语言时是及物动词,其他情况是不及物动词。say与tell是及物动词,其中tell常用双宾语,如:Tellusastory.但用于讲实话或谎话时也用单宾语。如:Tellthetruth.[误]CanyousayJapanesefromChinese?[正]CanyoutellJapanesefromChinese?[析]tell…from为固定词组,即分辨两者的不同。[误]EGcuseme,didIsteponyourfoot?[正]Oh,sorry,didIsteponyourfoot?[析]eGcuseme用于未打扰对方前,以提醒对方注意的用语,而sorry则是由于自己已做的事向对方道歉。[误]Wouldyoucarefortoswimwithus?[正]Wouldyoucaretoswimwithus?[析]carefor后接不定式时,要省略for,或换用名词,如:Wouldyoucareforacupoftea.carefor作"照顾"讲时与lookafter相同。在初中阶段学习与for有关的词组有:askfor请求callfor接人,请人carefor关心goinfor从事answerfor负责lookfor寻找waitfor等待sendfor请人payfor付款searchfor寻找leavefor去某地preparefor准备thanksomebodyforsomething为某事向某人道谢。[误]Areyouunderstandingit?Yes,Igottoit.[正]Doyouunderstandit?Yes,Igotit.[析]understand这一词没有进行时态,如同感观动词love、hate…Igotit是美语,即Iunderstoodit。要记住get作为"到达"讲时是不及物动词,如:I"llgettotheschoolat8a.m.初中范围常用与to有关的动词词组如下:belongto属于cometo苏醒pointto(at)指着getto到达referto谈到stickto坚持leadto导致turnto翻到lookforwardto期望agreeto同意[误]Themeathasgonebadly.[正]Themeathasgonebad.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]英语中go,get,become,turn作为转变时,其后接形容词,这时这些动词应被看作系动词。[误]Theteachersaidtheearthmovedaroundthesun.[正]Theteachersaidtheearthmovesaroundthesun.[析]如果主句的谓语动词是现在时,其宾语从句可以是任何时态。如果是过去时,则宾语从句中的时态应与之呼应。但地球围绕太阳转是不随时间而变化的客观事实,所以还应用一般现在时态来表达。[误]I"llcometoseeyouassoonasI"llbeback.[正]I"llcometoseeyouassoonasIamback.[析]在状语从句中要用一般时来表示将来,如:Ishouldtellhimwhenhecameback.[误]Iwanttoknowwhetheryoucometomypartytomorrowornot.[正]Iwanttoknowwhetheryouwillcometomypartytomorrowornot.[析]在宾语从句中则要用将来时表示将来的动作。要注意的是如果宾语从句中仍有状语从句时,依然要用一般现在时表示将来,如:Iwanttoknowifitrainstomorrowyou"llcomehereornot.[误]Whatdidyoudoateightlastnight?[正]Whatwereyoudoingateightlastnight?[析]在描述过去某一具体时刻的动作或从某时到某时一段时间内正在进行的动作要用过去进行时,如:IwaswashingclothesfromeighttillnoonlastSunday[误]Myclassmatescametoseeafilmyesterday.Ididn"tgowiththem,becauseIhaveseenitbefore.[正]Myclassmatescametoseeafilmyesterday.Ididn"tgowiththembecauseIhadseenitbefore.[析]现在完成时与过去完成时的相同之处是其动作均开始于过去的某一点,它的差别在于该动作是截止到什么时候。如动作截止到现在用现在完成时;如动作截止到过去,用过去完成时。例如:I"velearntEnglishforthreeyears.(到现在为止)又如:BeforeIwenttocollege,IhadlearntEnglishforthreeyears.(动作截止到上大学那时,即截止于过去)[误]I"mfeelingwellnow.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Ifeelwellnow.[析]瞬间动词有些无进行时态,它们是:表示思维状态的词:believe,feel,forget,imagine,know,mean,need,prefer,remember,understand,want表示感情的动词:care,like,dolike,love,mind,hate,fear表示状态的词:belong,own感观动词:feel,hear,see,smell,taste[误]Whenhaveyoudonethiswork?[正]Whendidyoudothiswork?[析]when提问的是一个时间点不可用于完成时态的问句中。[误]ThisisournewEnglishteacher.Hehasgonetomanyforeigncountries.[正]ThisisournewEnglishteacher.Hehasbeentomanyforeigncountries.[析]havegoneto是到某地去了,此人现在不在这里。havebeento是到过某地,现在此人在说话现场。[误]Ihaveborrowedthisbookfortwoweeks.[正]Ihavekeptthisbookfortwoweeks.[析]截止性动词有完成时态,但不可和与表达一段时间的时间状语连用。如:WhenIgottothecinemathefilmhadbegun.但要讲WhenIgottothecinemathefilmhadbeonforfiveminutes这样的用法还有buy,join,die,如:Iboughtthisbookyesterday.我昨天买的这本书。Ihavehadthisbookfortwodays.这本书我已买了两天了。Ijoinedtheclubtwoyearsago.两年前我加入了这个俱乐部。Ihavebeeninthisclubfortwoyears.我加入这个俱乐部已两年了。Myfatherdiedfiveyearsago.我父亲是5年前去世的。Myfatherhasbeendeadforfiveyears.我父亲已去世5年了。[误]Haveyouunderstoodthelessons?[正]Doyouunderstandthelessons?[析]有些动词不易用完成时态,它们是understand,think,believe,know(知道)[误]ItwassaidthattheSecondWorldWarhadbrokenoutin1939.[误]ItwassaidthattheSecondWorldWarwasbrokenoutin1939.[析]在讲述过去的历史事件时,总要用过去时而不要用完成时,而且3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档happen,breakout,takeplace作为发生讲时均没有被动语态。[误]WhenIwalkedalongthestreet.Ihappenedtomeetanoldfriend.[正]WhenIwaswalkingalongthestreetIhappenedtomeetanoldfriend.[析]在一个长动作发生或进行的过程中,某一突然事件发生,这时长动作应用进行时(现在进行时或过去进行时),而突发性动作用一般时(一般现在时或一般过去时),如:Whenmyfatherisreadinganewspaperthetelephonerings.[误]Pleasebuyabookforme.[正]Pleasebuymeabook.[正]Pleasebuyabooktome.[析]在接双宾语的动词后面的两个宾语,一个是直接宾语,一个是间接宾语,如:Buymeabook中me是间接宾语,而abook是直接宾语。如果将直接宾语前置,其后应加to,如:Tellmeastory.Tellastorytome.Givemeabook.Giveabooktome.[误]Hewasseencomeintothebookstore.[正]Hewasseentocomeintothebookstore.[析]在主动语态中,有时可以加不带to的不定式作宾语,如:Isawhimcomeintothebookstore.但如果变为被动语态时,则要将省略的to还原。当然这些动词还可以加动名词作宾语,如:Isawhimcomingintothebookstore,如变为被动语态时,则没有变化。如:Hewasseencomingintothebookstore.[误]Hownicethebookis!Isitsoldwell?[正]Hownicethebookis!Doesitsellwell?[析]有些动词可以表示一种动作,但也可以用来表示某种性质,表示动作时可用被动语态,在表示性质时则不可用被动语态。如:Thisbooksellswell.这本书畅销。Thiscardriveseasily.这车容易驾驶。Theseclotheswasheasily.这些衣服好洗。在作上述表达时,不要用被动语态。而要讲:Thiskindofbookwassoldout.(这种书卖完了)Theseclotheswerewashedbythewashingmachine.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档这时要用被动语态,因为它描述的是具体动作。[误]MustIdoitnow?No.youmustn"t.[正]MustIdoitnow?No,youneedn"t.[析]need用在疑问句和否定句中常用作情态动词,其后接不带to的不定式。由must提问的问句作答语时,如是肯定的要用must,否定的要用needn"t,即为没有必要。在肯定句中常用作实意动词,如:Ineedtowaitformyboy.[误]Isthisbookyours?Yes,It"s.[正]Isthisbookyours?Yes,Itis.[析]在肯定的回答中不要用缩写形式,而在否定的回答中可以用缩写形式,如:No.Itisn"t.[误]I"llhavemybikerepairtomorrow.[正]I"llhavemybikerepairedtomorrow.[析]have+人+动词原形或现在分词意为:让某人作某事,如:Myfatherhadmetolearnhowtodrive,或Myfatherhadmedoingmyhomeworkfrommorningtillmighthave+物+动词的过去分词为某件事被别人完成。如:Ihavemyhaircut.我去理发。而不是自己理发。如果讲我想自己作某事,则用Iwanttorepairmybikemyself.[误]I"llgetmybrotherrepairthebikeforyou.[正]I"llgetmybrothertorepairthebikeforyou.[析]have与get的用法有相同之处,也有不同之处。相同之处,如:havesomethingdone,也可用getsomethingdone,或have(get)somebodydoingsomething但不同之处在于havesomebodydosomething在用get时则要用getsomebodytodosomething。[误]IhavetostudyonSaturdaybutIhaven"ttostudyafullday[正]IhavetostudyonSaturday,butIdon"thavetostudyafullday.[析]haveto不得不,而don"thaveto为其否定式。[误]IsTomintheclassroom?No.Hemustn"tbeintheclassroom,becauseIsawhimtalkingwithourteacherintheofficejustnow.[正]IsTomintheclassroom?No.Hecan"tbeintheclassroom3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档becauseIsawhimtalkingwithourteacherintheofficejustnow.[析]must加动词原形表达一种比较肯定的推测,而表示否定的推测则要用can"t。[误]Mygrandpaisovereightybutheisabletoreadwithoutglasses.[正]Mygrandpaisovereighty,buthecanreadwithoutglasses.[析]can(could)多用于表达客观的事实,主观能力,而beableto则多用于表达主观的意愿。[误]Shedoesn"tanswerthedoorbell.Sheshouldbeasleep.[正]Shedoesn"tanswerthedoorbell.Shemustbeasleep[析]should用于现在时态的句子中应译为"应该",如:Youshoulddoyourhomeworkrightaway.而must加动词原形表示一种推测。[误]Doyouliketogowithus?[正]Wouldyouliketogowithus?[析]Doyoulike…问的是习惯,如:Doyoulikeswimming?而wouldyoulike是一次性的邀请。[误]Iamusedtogetupearlyinthemorning.[正]Iamusedtogettingupearlyinthemorning.[析]usedto共有三种用法,①表示过去的习惯,如:Iusedtolivewithmyparents.②表示过去的习惯延续到现在,如:Iamusedtoswimmingintheriver.③用于被动语态,如: Oilisusedtocook[误]Toplaywiththechildrenareveryinteresting.[正]Toplaywiththechildrenisveryinteresting.[析]不定式作主语时,应视为单数主语,特别是两个不定式用and作连词作主语时,如指的是一件事也应用单数谓语动词。如:Togetupearlyandtogotosleepearlyisgoodforyourhealth.[误]Heaskedmedomyhomeworkalone.[正]Heaskedmetodomyhomeworkalone.[析]某些动词要求不定式作其宾语或宾语补足语,它们是:asksomebodytodosomething要求某人做某事。tellsomebodytodosomething告诉某人做某事还有prepare准备,decide决定,happento碰巧,seem似乎。[误]hetoldmetodriveacar.[正]Hetoldmehowtodriveacar.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]要学会疑问词加不定式的用法,特别要注意的是what是疑问代词,而how是疑问副词。如:Iwanttoknowwhattodo.(我想知道干什么)。Iwanttoknowhowtodoit.(我想知道如何去作)。要注意的是howtodoit中的it是不可少的,因how是疑问副词,不能作及物动词的宾语,而what是疑问代词,可做do的宾语,所以whattodo后不要加it。[误]Iamverygladmeetingyou.[正]Iamverygladtomeetyou.[析]许多形容词后加不定式,这样用时形容词多是用来描述人物的感情、态度,如:glad,happy,pleased,lucky,sorry,sad,upset,ready,careful,surprised。[误]I"mtoogladforseeingyou.[正]I"mtoogladtoseeyou.[析]这句话不能按照too…to的句型翻译为:我太高兴了以至于不想见你。而应译为:见到你太高兴了。又如:Sheistoohonesttotellthetruth应译为:她很诚实,不会不讲实话。[误]Tomistooyoungnottojointhearmy.[正]Tomistooyoungtojointhearmy.[析]这是too…to的正常用法,太如何如何以至于不能如何。[误]Iwenttothehospitalforseeingmyoldfriend.Hewasillinhospital.[正]Iwenttothehospitaltoseemyoldfriend.Hewasillinhospital.[析]在句中表示某动作的目的时,要用不定式而不能用for加动名词。[误]Couldyouhelpmetofindachairtosit.[正]Couldyouhelpmetofindachairtositon.[析]当不定式作后置定语时,将不定式放于名词之后。如果不定式中的动词是不及物动词,则其后面的介词不要省略。如:Isatonthechair.这样的用法还有:Iwanttofindaroomtolivein.Iwanttofindapentowritewith.[误]Whenmotherwasaboutleavingthebabycriedsuddenly.[正]Whenmotherwasabouttoleavethebabycriedsuddenly.[析]beaboutto是表达较近的即将发生的动作,可用来表示将来时,或按计划、安排的事。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Thisworkisdifficulttobedone.[正]Thisworkisdifficulttodo.[析]在不定式作宾语时,下列情况常用主动语态表示被动。①句子的主语即是不定式动作的执行者,如:Ihavealotofletterstowrite.②句中的宾语是不定式中动作的执行者,如:Couldyoufindmeajobtodo?③在形容词之后的不定式,如:Englishisdifficulttolearn.[误]Wouldyouliketoseeafilmwithus?Yes,I"dlove.[正]Wouldyouliketoseeafilmwithus?Yes,I"dloveto.[析]在口语简答语中要将不定式符号保留,如:Ihadto(不得不作)I"mgoingto(打算作)Iusedto(过去习惯作)I"dloveto(喜欢作)Ihopeto(希望作某事)I"llbegladto(高兴作)[误]Didyouseesomeonetodothisworkforme?[正]Didyouseesomeonedothisworkforme?[析]在感观动词之后常接不带to的不定式。这些词是see,lookat,watch,hear,listento,feel,notice。[误]Hewasseenpreparethiscar.[正]Hewasseentopreparethiscar.[析]在被动语态中要将主动语态句中省去的不定式还原回来。[误]PleaseLetmychildtotryitagain.[正]PleaseLetmychildtryitagain.[析]在make,have,let后加不带to的不定式作宾语补足语。[误]Whynottodoitagain?[正]Whynotdoitagain?[析]Whynot,you"dbetter后接不带to的不定式,如:You"dbettergo.但要注意的是它的否定式是You"dbetternotgo.[误]Whenheheardthenewshecouldn"thelptocry.[正]Whenheheardthenewshecouldn"thelpcrying.[析]can"thelp+现在分词表示情不自禁作某事。[误]Inautumn,thestreetisalwayscoveredwithfallingleaves.[正]Inautumn,thestreetisalwayscoveredwithfallenleaves.[析]现在分词作定语有正在的含义,如:fallingleave正下落的叶子。而过去分词作定语fallenleaves是落地的叶子。过去分词含有已经完成的意思。[误]Doyouhearsomeonesingintheoffice?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Doyouhearsomeonesingingintheoffice?[析]感观动词可用不带to的不定式来作宾语补足语,表达一个动作的全过程或已结束的动作,而用现在分词表示一个正在进行中的动作。[误]Iwanttoshopsomefoodforsupper.[正]Iwanttobuysomefoodforsupper.[正]Iwanttogoshopping.[析]shop作买东西讲时,要用goshopping,其后不要加所购买的东西。这样的用法还有:goboating划船gosailing航海goskating滑冰goshooting射击godancing去跳舞gofishing钓鱼goswimming去游泳……不要用错,也不要改为其他式,因为这是习惯用法。[误]Whentheteachercameintotheclassroom,thestudentsstoppedtotalk.[正]Whentheteachercameintotheclassroom.thestudentsstoppedtalking.[析]stoptodosomething是停下来去做某事,而stopdoingsomething则是停止做某事。[误]Ididn"trememberclosingthedoor,sothethiefcameintotheroomdirectly.[正]Ididn"tremembertoclosethedoor,sothethiefcameintotheroomdirectly.[析]remember后接不定式是记着去做某事,即该动作并没有完成。而remember后接动名词则表明该动作已经作完了。如:Doremembertoturnoffthelight,beforeyouleave.即在你离开前记着去关灯。而关灯的动作并没有做。Iremembermeetingyousomewhere.我记得在某处见过你。而相见一事已经作完了。相同用法还有forget。[误]WhenIfinishedtodothisworkIwouldgotoplayfootball.[正]WhenIfinisheddoingthisworkIwouldgotoplayfootball.[析]在英语中有些动词后要接动名词作宾语。在初中范围主要有两个动词finish和enjoy,千万不要与like相比。因为like作动词"喜欢"用时,其后接动名词表示习惯性动作,接不定式表示一次性特殊的动作,而wouldyoulike后面则一定要用不定式。[误]Whenhefinishedhishomework,hewentonplayingthefootball.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Whenhefinishedhishomework,hewentontoplayfootball.[析]goontodosomething是做完一件事紧跟着做另一件事。而goondoingsomething是在做一件事的过程中被打断后接着再继续做这件事。[误]He"sbusytopreparehislessons.[正]He"sbusypreparinghislessons.[析]bebusy后加doing而不能接不定式。(三)例题解析1MrZhangaskedme___thewordsagain.A.readB.readsC.toreadD.reading[答案]C.[析]asksomebodytodosomething要求某人作某事。2You___playontheroad.It"sdangerous.A.mustn"tB.mayC.canD.must[答案]A.[析]must用于否定句表示禁止做某事。3MrBrown___inBeijingsince1993.A.workB.worksC.workedD.hasworked[答案]D.[析]句中有since引导的时间状语,因此句中要用完成时态。4I___aletterwhenmymothercamein.A.writeB.amwritingC.waswritingD.willwrite3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]C.[析]当母亲进来时是一个瞬时的动作,而写信是一个长动作,所以写信这个动作应用过去进行时态,表示在写信过程中发生的另一个短动作。5It"snotanimportantparty,youneedn"t___.A.payforitB.wearitoutC.tryitoutD.dressupforit[答案]D.[析]payfor-为某物,某人付款,wearout-穿坏,磨破,tryout-选拔,挑选,而dressup-梳妆打扮。6CanI___abikefromhim?A.lendB.returnC.giveD.borrow[答案]D.[析]borrowsomethingfrom…为向某人某处借某物。而lend,return,give后面的介词应用to。7-MustIstayathome?-No,you___.A.mustn"tB.needn"tC.maynotD.cannot[答案]B.[析]needn"t为"没有必要必须做某事",而mustn"t为"禁止做",cannot为"不能做"。根据题意是:你不一定待在家里。8-Howlonghaveyou___here?-Abouttwomonths.A.beenB.goneC.comeD.arrived3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]A.[析]havebeenhere是个状态,可以与后面的长时间状语连接,而其他三个动词都是瞬间动词。9Stamps___bypeopleforsendingletters.A.useB.usingC.usedD.areused[答案]D.[析]这里是被动语态,意为邮票被人们用来发信。10TheradiosaysTianjinwillbe___tomorrow.A.rainsB.rainC.rainedD.rainy[答案]D.[析]rainy为形容词作表语。11Ifyoudon"tknowthisword,___inthedictionary.A.lookforitB.lookatitC.lookafteritD.lookitup[答案]D.[析]lookup查字典,与look有关的词组有:lookabout四周环视lookafter照顾lookaround周围,四处看lookat看lookback回顾lookfor寻找lookforwardto期待lookout当心looklike看上去像3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档12Myfathertoldme___playonthestreet.A.notB.tonotC.nottoD.didnot[答案]C.[析]不定式的否定式是nottodosomething.13Thereisgoingto___anEnglishpartythisevening.A.beB.hasC.haveD.is[答案]A.[析]这里是therebe无生命的"有"加助动词的句型,即therewillbe,而没有therehave的句型。14There___nobusstopherelastyear.A.isB.wasC.areD.were[答案]B.[析]lastyear为去年,所以用过去时。而therebe句型的单复数要看be动词之后离之最近的名词是单数还是复数。如:Thereisapenandtwopencilsonthedesk.15Ourschoolwillholdasportsmeetingifit___tomorrow.A.isn"trainB.rainsC.won"trainD.doesn"train[答案]D.[析]在状语从句中应用一般时态来表示将来。16Bikesmustn"t___everywhere.A.beput3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档B.beputtedC.putD.putting[答案]A.[析]这里是被动语态。与put有关的词组如下:putaway放好putoff推迟puton穿上putout扑灭putdown放下17NeitherLiLeinorHanMeimei___Harbin.A.havebeentoB.hasbeentoC.havegonetoD.hasgoneto[答案]B.[析]hasbeento是去过某处。18It"scoldtodayyou"dbetter___morecoats.A.putonB.takeoffC.toputonD.totakeoff[答案]A.[析]"dbetter其后加不带to的不定式,而puton为"穿上"。19Henry___abirthdaycardforSamyesterday.A.hasboughtB.buysC.boughtD.willbuy[答案]C.[析]因句中的yesterday为表达过去的时间状语,所以应用过去时态。20WhenIgottothefactory,theworkers___aboutthefilim.A.aretalkingB.talkedC.weretalkingD.havetalked[答案]C.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]状语从句中所用的动词为过去时,则主句中也要与之呼应。而工人们在谈论电影为一长时间的动作,所以要用过去进行时。21Nohurry,please___yourtime.A.takeB.bringC.carryD.catch[答案]A.[析]takeone"stime慢慢来别着急。22Ienjoy___thelightmusic.A.tolistentoB.listeningtoC.hearingD.tohear[答案]B.[析]enjoy与finish其后只能接动名词作宾语补足语。23Please___assoonasyougetthere.A.ringmeupB.ringupmeC.wakemeupD.wakeupme[答案]A.[析]ringup打电话,而wakeup唤醒。英文中有很多动词词组如其宾语是代词时,一定要放在动词与介词之间。24WhenI___,Iwanttobeateacher.A.growsupB.growupC.shallgrowD.grewup[答案]B.[析]growup长大。而状语从句要用现在时表示将来,即使主句也用的是一般现在时,但它含有将来之意。25Icalledhimandhe___tohaveatalkwithme.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.stopB.stopsC.stopedD.stopped[答案]D.[析]这是由and连接的两个并列句,所以时态应保持一致。26-Wouldyouplease___meanevaser,Lucy?-Certainly.Hereyouare.A.borrowB.lendC.borrowedD.lent[答案]B.[析]wouldyouplease其后接不带to的不定式即动词原形,而borrow为"借入"而lend为"借出"。27Trees___inspring.A.plantB.wereplantedC.shouldbeplantedD.shouldplant[答案]C.[析]should用于一般现在时态中表示应该,而此句又是被动语态。28-Where"syourfather?-He___toParis.A.goB.goesC.wentD.hasgone[答案]D.[析]hasgone是已去某处了,不在这里了。所以强调过去的动作影响到现在。29-MustIfinishmyhomeworkinclassnow?-No,you___.Youcandoitathome.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.mustn"tB.maynotC.needn"tD.can[答案]C.[析]needn"t表示没有必要一定要这样做。由must提问,肯定句用must,否定句用needn"t.30Thankyouverymuchfor___yourbook___me.A.lending,toB.lent,toC.borrow,fromD.borrowing,from[答案]A.[析]for是介词,要用动名词作介词宾语。31TheGreatGreenWallwillstopthewindfrom___theearthaway.A.blowingB.blowC.blowsD.toblow[答案]A.[析]stop…fromdoingsomething.阻止某人或某物作某事。32ThestudentswillgototheWestHillFarmbybike,ifit___finetomorrow.A.willbeB.isC.shallbeD.was[答案]B.33Ourteacheralwaystellsus___inthestreet.It"stoodangerous.A.don"tplayB.nottoplayC.toplay3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档D.notplay[答案]B.[析]不定式的否定式为nottodo。34Englishisausefullanguage.It___widelyintheworld.A.isspokenB.wasspokenC.canspeakD.willspeak[答案]A.[析]本句为被动语态。35Thekiteisflyinghighinthesky.It___abird.A.looksatB.lookslikeC.looksforD.looksafter[答案]B.[析]looklike像……,其中like为介词。36-Look!What"sWangPingdoingoverthere?-She___underabigtree.A.singsB.sangC.hassungD.issinging[答案]D.37You___seeadoctor.You"vegotabadcold.A.willB.aregoingtoC.hadbetterD.could[答案]C.[析]hadbetter最好,意为一种真心的劝告。38Yourradioistooloud.Wouldyouplease___?A.turndownit3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档B.turnitdownC.toturndownitD.toturnitdown[答案]B.[析]wouldyouplease后面加动词原形。39Couldyoutellmeifit___tomorrow?A.rainsB.israiningC.willrainD.rain[答案]C.[析]if从句是宾语从句,而不是状语从句。所以还是要用将来时,而不能用一般现在时表示将来。40Suddenlyoneofthebags___thetruckandlandedinthemiddleoftheroad.A.felloutB.felldownC.felloffD.willbe[答案]C.[析]falloff掉落,与off有关的词组有seeoff送行giveoff散发shutoff关闭kickoff踢掉turnoff关闭getoff下车jumpoff跳下showof炫耀takeoff脱下payoff付清41He___atthisschoolsincetwoyearsago.A.wasB.hasbeenC.isD.willbe[答案]B.[析]since引导的时间状语应与完成时相呼应。42Shedoesn"tknow___.A.whentodoB.whattodo3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C.howtodoD.wheretodo[答案]B.[析]when,how,where均为疑问副词,而what为疑问代词,又因do是及物动词需要宾语。如用疑问副词时应为whentodoit,howtodoit,wheretodoit.43Mustolderpeople___topolitely.A.speakB.spokenC.bespokeD.bespoken[答案]D.[析]这句话的主动语态应为Peoplemustspeakpolitelytoolderpeople对年龄较大的人讲话应有礼貌。44Teachersusuallyasktheirstudents___loudlyinclass.A.tospeakB.speakC.speaksD.spoke[答案]A.[析]asksomebodytodosomething要求某人作某事。45-WhereisMrZhang?-Look!He___onabigmachineoverthere.A.worksB.workedC.isworkingD.hasworked[答案]C.[析]由look,liston等词开始的句子一般要用现在进行时态。46There"safootballmatch.Please___theTVatonce.Let"swatchtogether.A.turnonB.takeoff3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C.turnoffD.goon[答案]A.[析]turnon打开。与turn有关的词组有:turnagainst背叛turnon打开turn+颜色变为某种颜色turnoff关闭turnover翻转turnto翻到某页turninto变为turnup向上翻47Pleasetellmewhere___haveourpicnictomorrow.A.wewillB.willweC.willD.willyou[答案]A.[析]where引导的从句是宾语从句,而不是状语从句。48We___Englishforthreeyearsalready.AndwecanspeakalittleEnglishnow.A.learnB.havelearnedC.haslearnedD.willlearn[答案]B.[析]for+表示一段长度的时间词,应与完成时相呼应。49Atlast,LinFengmadethebaby___andbegintolaugh.A.stoptocryB.stopcryingC.tostoptocryD.tostopcrying[答案]B.[析]makesomebodydo(ordoing)something,stopdoing意为停止做某事。50Ourclassroommust___cleaneveryday.A.keepB.tokeepC.bekept3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档D.tobekept[答案]C.[析]应为被动语态。51Ihearthere___asportsmeetinginourschoolneGtweek.A.isgoingtohaveB.willhaveC.isgoingtobeD.aregoingtobe[答案]C.[析]这是hear的宾语从句是therebe句型。而且是用了begoingto形式。52It"sgettingcolder,Peter.You"dbetter___thiscoatwithyou.A.bringB.carryC.takeD.get[答案]C.[析]bring带来,take带走。53Ourclassroomiscleanandtidy.It___everyday.A.cleansB.iscleaningC.cleanedD.iscleaned[答案]D.[析]这里表达的是经常的一种状态,所以应用一般现在时的被动语态。54Ifyouarenotcarefulinthestreet,acarmay___you.A.hurtB.hitC.runD.catch[答案]B.[析]hit撞上,碰上,击中55Thefarmerswerebusy___readyfortheneGtyear.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A.gotB.gettingC.togetD.get[答案]B.[析]bebusy后应用动词的ing形式。第二篇句法一、主要句式(一)知识概要初中所学的句型一般要分为陈述句、疑问句、祈使句和感叹句。陈述句中有肯定句与否定句之分。其中可以分为以下五种:①主语+不及物动词。如:IarrivedatsiGlastnight.②主语+及物动词+宾语,如:IboughtagoodEnglishChineseDictionaryyesterday.③主语+及物动词+间接宾语+直接宾语,如:PleasetellmeastorybeforeIgotobed.这样可加双宾语的句子有buy,tell,give,ask,pass,teach.④主语+及物动词+宾语+宾语补足语,如:Ifounditimpossibletodoit.Pleasekeeptheclassroomcleanandtidy.⑤主语+系动词+表语,如:TomisanAmericanboy.Thegrassturnedgreeninspring.在初中常见的句型中有Therebe…句型,表示存在某种事物,如:Thereisamaponthewall其be动词的形式要与其后面相近的那个名词相一致。要注意的是这种句型加入助动词后,也要保持be动词,不要换用have,如:Thereisgoingtobeameetingtomorrow.在句子结构中要注意主谓一致的问题,即句子的主语与谓语动词要相呼应。要注意的有如下几点:①用and连接两个主语时一般应视为复数,但如一人身兼两职时则要用单数谓语动词形式,如:Asingeranddanceriscomingtoourparty.asingeranddancer既歌唱又可舞的演员。而asingerandadancer则要译为:一位歌唱家和一位舞蹈家。②有些以s结尾的名词谓语动词要用单数,如:Thenewsisgood(news为不可数名词)。③有量词时应按量词的数量计算;如:ThispairofglassesisgoodMyglassesarebroken.④有些形单却意为复数的名词,如:Peoplearecominghere这样的词还有Police,如果要讲一个警察时,应讲a3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档policeman。两个警察为twopolicemen。又如apolicewoman,twopolicewomen⑤ 所有不定代词each,either,neither,one,theother,nobody,nothing,anyone,anything,someone,something…要作为单数如:Someoneiswaitingforyou在并列句中表示联合关系的连词有:andnotonly…butalso, neither…nor, either…or如:Mysisterandmyparentsaregoingtothecinema。表示转折关系的并列连词有:but和yet,如:Sheisagoodstudent,butshedidn"tpassthefinaleGam.又如:Ithinkthenewsisstrange,yetitistrue表示选择关系的连词有:or,either…or,如:Hurryup,oryouwillbelateforschool表示因果关系的并列连词有:for,so如:Theystudiedveryhard,sotheyallpassedtheeGam在初中范围复合句中主要有状语从句和宾语从句(名词性从句)两种,而定语从句(形容词性从句)要在高中讲述,为了使同学阅读文章方便,我们将在下面另一章予以介绍。我们首先来看宾语从句。① 在及物动词的后面可以接一个名词来充当宾语,如:Iknewtheman,而这时也可以用一个句子来充当宾语,如:Iknewthathewasagoodman这时宾语从句的连接词有that,(that只在从句中起联接作用,不在句中充当语法成分,既不是主语也不是宾语,所以在口语中常常被省略。如:Iamsure(that)shehaspassedtheeGam②if,whether它们在宾语从句中只起连接作用,不起语法作用,当作是否讲。从句中有ornot结构时,要用whether,如:Iaskhimif(whether)hehashadhislunchIaskshimwhetherhehashadhislunchornot ③ what它在宾语从句中除了作连接词外,还要作主语或宾语成份,如:Idon"tunderstandwhatyousaid(what作said的宾语)。又如:Iaskedhimwhatmadehimsick(what在宾语从句中作主语)。④ who,它也和what一样,在句中除作连接词外,可以充当句中的成份,如:Iknowwhosheislookingfor?⑤ whose如:Iwanttoknowwhosebookthisis?⑥ which如:Doyouknowwhichbookismine?在连接词中还有4个常用的连接副词,① how它的应用最广,如:howmuch,howmany,howlong,howsoon,howold…。如:Howmuchdoesitcost?② when它只是连接时间状语,如:Pleasetellmewhenthemeetingwillbegin?③ where它连接地点状语,如:Whereareyoufrom?④ why它要连接的是原因状语从句,如:TheteacheraskedwhyTomdidn"tcometoschool.在考试中常见到的考点是:宾语从句的时态与主句时态的呼应问题。①3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档 主句谓语动词如果是现在时或将来时,宾语从句的时态可以是任何所需要的时态,如:Iknowhedidn"tcome.我知道他没来。Iknowhewillcometomorrow我知道他明天来。IknowhehasgonetoLondon我知道他已去伦敦了。 ② 主句中的谓语动词若是过去时,宾语从句也要用过去时态中的某一种。比如:一般过去时,过去进行时,过去将来时,过去完成时。除了在表达宇宙中的客观真理时,不能用现在时态。如:IwantedtoknowwhenhewouldcomeTheteachertoldmetheearthmovesaroundthesun状语从句主要有时间状语从句,其连接词有:after,before,when,as,assoonas,until(till),while,since,by其中较难掌握的有以下几点:① until(till)直到,在用until表达时间状语的句子中,主句中的动词是要十分小心去选择。如动词是持续性动词,它要用肯定句,如:Istudiedharduntil12o"clocklastnight.如果动词是瞬间截止性动词,则要用否定句,如:Hedidn"tgotobeduntilhismothercameback② 由since,for,by,before来引导的时间状语从句。since引导的时间状语是动作的开始时间,如:IhavestudiedEnglishsince1990而由by引导的时间状语通常是动作的结束时间,如:Ihadlearned25Englishsongsbytheendoflastterm而before则多用于完成时,ago则多用于一般过去时,如:HehadfinishedhisworkbeforetwelveyesterdayIleftmyhometowntwoyearsago③ 在状语从句中用一般现在时或一般过去时表示将来。它们可能是主句用一般将来时,从句用一般现在时,如:Ifitrains,theywon"tgotothepark onSunday也可以主句是一般过去时,从句用一般过去进行时,如:HesaidifitrainedtheneGtdayhewouldnotgotothepark考试中常见的考点有:要学生区别是条件、时间状语从句还是宾语从句,因在宾语从句中该用什么时态用什么时态,如:Iwanttoknowifhewillcomeheretomorrow在宾语从句中的条件状语从句与主句的关系,如:Iwanttoknowifitrainshewillcomeheretomorrow在原因状语从句中主要是① because,应译为"因为"。它表达的因果关系最强,如:Hedidn"tpasstheeGambecausehedidn"tstudyhard② since应译为"既然",如:SinceyouwereillyesterdayIleftsomenotesonyourdesk③ as应译为"由于",如:Asitistoohotwe"dbettergoswimmingsince与as所表达的因果关系远比because弱得多。而for表达的因果关系最弱。它不能用于句首,如:Hestudieshard,forhewantstogotocollege在比较状语从句中有同级比较as…as,如:Thisbookisasgoodasthatone要注意的有两点:① as…as中间要用原级而不是比较级。② 用形容词还3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档是副词,如:MarywritesascarefullyasTom而其否定句为notas(so)…as,如:Theydidn"tworksohardaswedid,而不同级比较用比较级加than,如:HeisyoungerthanIam要注意的是表示"越来越"这一概念时有两个句型:① 比较级+and+比较级,如:ThedaysaregettinglongerandlongerThelittlegirlisbecomingmoreandmorebeautiful② 定冠词the+比较级+the+比较级,如:Theharderyoustudy,themoreyoucanlearn方式状语中要注意的是as(连词)与like(介词)的区别。as作为连词其后接从句,如:PleasedoitasIdidit但后面的句子常作省略,如:PleasedoitasI而like是介词,其后要接的是宾语,如:Pleasedoitlikeme结果和目的状语从句主要有so…that,sothat,inorderthat等几种用法。① so…that用在单数可数名词前,so+形容词+a+名词+that,如:Sheissobeautifulagirlthateveryonelikesher或用such+a+形容词+名词+that,如:Sheissuchabeautifulgirlthateveryonelikesher② 在不可数名词或可数名词复数前只能用such,如:Itissuchgoodweatherwewanttogoforapicnic又如:Theyaresuchgoodplayersthattheyshouldwinthegame. ③ 在much,many,few,little之前只能用so,如:IhavesolittlemoneythatIcan"tbuyit④ so…that之间只有形容词时,则不能用such,如:ItissogoodthatIwanttobuy⑤ sothat其后接从句,如:IgotupearliersothatIcouldcatchthefirstbus(二) 正误辨析[误]Thestoriesinthatbookwaswrittenmanyyearsago[正]Thestoriesinthatbookwerewrittenmanyyearsago.[析]作主语的名词、代词或不定式、动名词,它们往往要带有修饰词,这些词可能是形容词,也可能是短语,但谓语动词还是要取决于这个主语的数,要记住的是一个名词不可能在同一句中作两个不同的语法成份,如:book作了of的介词宾语则不可能再作主语了。[误]Toreadmanybooksaregoodforyou[正]Toreadmanybooksisgoodforyou[析]不定式作主语应该看作单数主语。[误]Whathesaidareright[正]Whathesaidisright[析]从句作主语一定要按单数主语看待。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Therichisnotalwayshappy[误]Thericharenotalwayshappy[析]形容词+定冠词表示一类人,谓语动词应用复数,如:Theyoungareveryinterestedinstudyandsports[误]Theschoolmasterandwriterarecoming[正]Theschoolmasterandwriteriscoming[析]本句应译为:校长兼作家就要来了。而Theschoolmasterandthewriterarecoming则要译为:校长和一个作家要来了。在英语表达法中确实有Thegirlandboyareplayingonthegrass这应译为:一个女孩,一个男孩在操场上玩。因为不可能这样两个概念作用在一个人身上。又如:thehusbandandwife夫妻二人。[误]Youorshegotogetsomewaterforus[正]Youorshegoestogetsomewaterforus[析]由or连接的两个主语应以离谓语动词近的那一个计算其数。这样的用法还有either…or,neither…nor,notonly…butalso也有人称作"就近原则"。[误]Theteacherwithalotofstudentscomeintotheclassroom[正]Theteacherwithalotofstudentscomesintotheclassroom[析]真正的主语是theteacher,而with短语是伴随状态,不影响主语的数。[误]Myglassesisbroken[正]Myglassesarebroken[误]Thispairofglassesaregood[正]Thispairofglassesisgood[误]Thesekindsofbutterisgood.[正]Thesekindsofbutteraregood[析]英语中有些名词只有复数形式,如:glasses眼镜,shorts短裤等。如没有量词在前时,要用复数谓语动词,但有了量词之后则要按量词的单复数计算。[误]Oneoftheboysaregoingtotakepartinthematch[正]Oneoftheboysisgoingtotakepartinthematch[析]Oneof结构应以one来计算主语的数。[误]Halfoftheworkaredone3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Halfoftheworkisdone[误]Halfofthebooksisread[正]Halfofthebooksareread[析]在小于1的数量词作主语时,如:23,80%,0.35…+of+名词,这时主语的数应按of后面的名词计算。如果名词是不可数名词或可数名词单数,则谓语动词要用单数,如名词是复数则要用复数谓语动词。[误]Eachsidesarefulloftrees[正]Eachsideisfulloftrees[误]Bothsideisfulloftrees[正]Bothsidesarefulloftrees[析]each,either其后都要加单数名词,而both后要加复数名词。如:each,either,another,little,alittle,much等作主语时,谓语动词全部要用单数形式。[误]Theboyseachhasanapple[正]Theboyseachhaveanapple[析]each作同位语时,不影响句子的主语。[误]Everyoneofushasaticketfortheconcert[正]Everyoneofushasaticketfortheconcert[析]everyone,someone,everybody…在作主语时都不能加of结构。[误]Girlslikedancingverymuch,butfewlikesplayingfootball[正]Girlslikedancingverymuch,butfewlikeplayingfootball[析]few虽然含意上是"几乎没有",但作主语时仍要当作复数。[误]Thenumberoftheworkersinthatfactoryaretwohundred[正]Thenumberoftheworkersinthatfactoryistwohundred[析]thenumberof意为:某某的数字是……如:thenumberofstudents学生人数,thenumberofplayers运动员人数。不论数字如何都应看作单数。而anumberof与many意思相同,其后加可数名词复数,谓语动词用复数形式。如:Anumberofstudentsareplayingonthegrass[误]Therestofthestudentsishere[正]Therestofthestudentsarehere[误]Therestoftheworkaredone[正]Therestoftheworkisdone3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]therestof的用法与2/3,一半,80%+of的结构一致,of后面为可数名词复数时用复数谓语动词,为不可数名词或可数名词单数时用单数谓语动词。这样用法还有lotsof,alotof,plentyof。[误]Thenewsintoday"snewspaperarenotbad[正]Thenewsintoday"snewspaperisnotbad[析]有些以s结尾的名词要用作不可数名词,它们是:news,physics,mathematics,thanks,…[误]TheChineseiskindandfriendly[正]TheChinesearekindandfriendly[析]Chinese作为中文来讲是单数名词,但作为中国人讲是单复同形的名词。如:oneChinese,twoChinese…而TheChinese=ThepeopleofChina要用复数谓语动词。[误]ThisdictionaryistooeGpensiveformeTendollarsareabigsumforme[正]ThisdictionaryistooeGpensiveformeTendollarsisabigsumforme[析]表示一段时间,一笔金钱,一段距离,都应看作单数名词。[误]Whoaregoingtotakepartinourfootballmatch?[正]Whoisgoingtotakepartinourfootballmatch?[析]用who提问时,习惯上用单数谓语动词,但which则要视其情况而定,如:whicharebettertheseshoesesorthoseshoes?又如:whichisbetterthisoneorthatone?[误]Whatahotweatheritis![误]Howhottheweatheritis![正]Whathotweatheritis![正]Howhottheweatheris![析]感叹句是用来表达说话人的喜怒哀乐的感情。它由what与how作句子的开始,判定是用what还是用how的最好办法是将它们换为陈述句,比如:Whatthehotweatheritis!应转换为:Itisthehotweather那么句子的起点是单词it。再来看感叹句中it前有不可数名词weather,则只能用what。再看第二句Howhottheweatheris!转为陈述句时为:Theweatherishot这时句子的开始单词为theweather,再来看感叹句在theweather前只有形容词,所以应用how。至于是用whata还是what3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档要看名词的具体情况而定,单数可数名词加whata其余的加用what。[误]Wehavetosingthis,havewe?[误]Wehavetosingthis,haven"twe?[正]Wehavetosingthis,don"twe?[析]在反意疑问句中除了标准的一些常规外,有一些例外:Let"sgohome,shallwe?Letusgohome,willyou?Shehadtoleave,didn"tshe?Doyourhomeworkatonce,willyou?Thereisnotmuchgoodnewsintoday"snewspaper,isthere?Neitherofthemareright,arethey?Ithinkhewillcometothepartywon"the?think后的宾语从句,与其他宾语从句不一样,在初中只有这样一个较特殊的词。这样的句子的反意疑问句的主语要用宾语从句中的主语,其助动词要用宾语从句的助动词,而肯定还是否定要看主句谓语动词而定,如:Idon"tthinkheiscomingtoourparty,ishe?[误]Iwanttoknowwheredoeshelive[正]Iwanttoknowwherehelives[析]宾语从句中一律要用陈述语序,而不用疑问语序。[误]-Ihaven"tgotaticketforthefootballmatch-NorIhave[正]-Ihaven"tgotaticketforthefootballmatch-Nor(Neither)haveI[析]nor,neither用在简答否定句中时要采用倒装语序。在肯定句的简答句中则要用so,如:Idomyhomeworkveryquickly,SodoesMary[误]Look!Herethebuscomes![正]Look!Herecomesthebus![误]Look!Herecomeshe![正]Look!Herehecomes[析]在there,here打头的句子中,如果主语是名词,则要采用倒装语序;如果是人称代词则用一般语序。[误]DoyouwantMarytogotothecinemawithus?No,Idon"thopeso3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]DoyouwantMarytogotothecinemawithus?No,Ihopenot[析]我不这样想,可用Idon"tthinkso但hope的否定简答句只能用Ihopenot这是习惯用法。但这两个词的肯定简答句形是一样的,如:Ithinkso.Ihopeso[误]ThatisdifficultforustolearnEnglishwell[正]ItisdifficultforustolearnEnglishwell[析]It这里的语法作用是形式主语,而真正的主语是后面的不定式。形式主语和形式宾语都要用it而不能用that,如:IthinkitdifficulttolearnEnglishwellit在这句中是think的形式宾语。(三) 例题解析1 There___apencilboGonthedesk.A.isB. areC.hasD.have[答案]A.[析]Therebe句形中的be动词要看其后面离它最近的名词而定,如:Therearetwobooksandapencilonthedesk但却可以讲Thereisapencilandtwobooksonthedesk2 Couldyoutellme___?A MrsKingwherelivesB wheredoesMrsKingliveC whereMrsKinglivesD MrsKingliveswhere[答案]C.[析]宾语从句中的疑问句要用陈述语序。3 Yourbrothercametoseeyou,___?A doesheB doesn"theC didheD didn"the[答案]D.[析]前句是肯定句,后面反意疑问句要用否定句,同时came为过去时态,所以应用didn"the4 It"sgettingcloudy,___?A does"itB doesn"titC isitD isn"tit[答案]D.[析]要区分"s是has还是is,这里由getting得出"s是is。5 ___keepmewaitingsolong.A NotB Won"tC Don"tD Notto3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]C.[析]Don"t+动词原形为祈始句的否定句。6 MrGreenhasn"tbeentoBeijing,___?A hasheB hasn"theC didheD didn"the[答案]A.[析]此句has是助动词与过去分词构成现在完成时态。7 Youhaveyourlunchatschool,___?A haveyouB haven"tyouC doyouD don"tyou[答案]D.[析]这里的have是实意动词"吃",而不是助动词。8 ___sunnyday!Let"sgooutforawalk.A HowaB HowC WhataD What[答案]C.[析]这个感叹句是个省略句,其真实的句子应为Whatasunnydayitis!9 -Canyoutellme___?-SureShe"sanurseA whereisyoursisterB whereyoursisterisC whatisyoursisterD whatyoursisteris[答案]D.[析]who问的是姓名,如:Whoishe?HeisSmith或HeismyfatherWhat问的是职业,如:Whatishe?Heisateacher10 Johnlikeslisteningtotheradio,___?A doesheB doesn"theC doesn"tJohnD doesJohe[答案]B.[析]当名词作主语时,反意疑问句应用代词。11 NeitheryounorI___ontheteam.A areB wereC amD is[答案]C.[析]由neither…nor…作连接词作主语时,其谓语动词要与相临近的那个主语相呼应。12 ___deliciousfood!I"dlikesomemore.A whataB HowaC WhatD How[答案]C.[析]因food为不可数名词。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档13 ___thereacatunderthechair?A AreB IsC HasD Have[答案]B.[析]这是therebe句型的疑问句。14 Couldyoutellme___?A whenthetrainwillarriveB whenthetrainarrivedC whendidthetrainarriveD whendoesthetrainarrives[答案]A.[析]could用于现在时疑问句表达了口气的委婉,并不是过去时态。且宾语从句要用陈述语句。15 -___badweather!-Yes,Butit"sgoingtobefinesoon,IthinkA HowB WhataC WhatanD What[答案]D.[析]weather为不可数名词。16 -Couldyoutellme___?-Yes,They___tothelibraryA wherearethetwins,havebeenB wherewerethetwins,havebeenC wherethetwinsare,havegoneD wherethetwinswere,havegone[答案]C.[析]havebeento是去过什么地方,而现在回来了。havegoneto是到某地去了,人现在不在这里。17 Goand___theTVquicklyThevolleyballmatchwillbeginrightaway.A turnoffB turndownC turnupD turnon[答案]D.[析]这是个祈使句,它由and连接两个动词。注意词组搭配的不同含义。18 Let"sgoforsometea,___?A shallweB willweC doweD don"twe[答案]A.[析]Let"sgo…,shallwe?Letusgo…,willyou?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档这是两个特殊的反意疑问句。19 Joan"sshort,___?A wasn"tsheB hasn"tsheC isn"tsheD doesn"tshe[答案]C.[析]在此句中应视"s为is,而不是has或was。20 Idon"tknow___toreadtheword.A whichB whatC whoseD how[答案]D.[析]因不定式toread中的read是及物动词,已有自己的宾语theword,所以应用疑问副词how。21 Hedidn"tgotoschool,___hewasill.A forB butC andD so[答案]A.[析]这里是表示因果的关系,从句表示原因,所以用for,放于句尾,且常常前面有一个逗号。so引起的是结果状语从句,如:Hewasonlytwelve,sohecouldn"tjointhearmy22 Theyoungwomancanhardlyrideabike,___she?A doesn"tB doesC can"tD can[答案]D.[析]hardly为否定词,所以应视此句为否定句。其后的反意疑问句应用肯定句。23 TomnevergoestothecinemaonSundays,___?A doesheB doesn"theC isn"theD ishe[答案]A.[析]never也是否定词,所以应将句子看作否定句。24 Mothersaidtohim,"Don"t___onfootball."A spendtoomuchtimeB tospendtoomuchtimeC spendtoomanytimeD tospendtoomanytime[答案]A.[析]time作为"时间"讲为不可数名词,应用much来修饰。当作"次数"讲是可数名词,如threetimes三次,而Don"t…这一句是祈使句的否定句。25 MrWhite,togetherwithsomeJapanesefriends,___visitourschoolthisafternoon.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档A aregoingtoB isgoingtoC haveD has[答案]B.[析]句子的主语是MrWhite,而togetherwith…是伴随状况,不影响句子的主语。26 Thereislittlewaterintheglass,___?A isitB isthereC isn"titD isn"tthere[答案]B.[析]这是therebe句型的反意疑问句。27 Amperewasthinkingaboutamathsproblem,___?A didn"theB wasn"theC didheD ishe[答案]B.[析]这是进行时态的反意疑问句。28 Shehadagoodtimeyesterday,___she?A wasn"tB didn"tC hasn"tD isn"t[答案]B.[析]had这里是实意动词而不是助动词。29 We"llmake___foryouinthefrontofthecar.A aroomB roomC roomsD somerooms[答案]B.[析]room此处为不可数名词,意为"地方,空间"。30 NeithershenorI___totheGreatwallbefore.A hasgoneB havegoneC havebeenD hasbeen[答案]C.[析]由neither…nor连接两个主语时,其谓语动词应与相临近的那个主语相呼应。31 Helpmecollectthesebooks,___?A areyouB willyouC doyouD shallyou[答案]B.[析]祈使句的反意疑问句应用willyou,而Let"sgo例外,其反意疑问句为shallwe?32 Thenumberofdeer,mountainlionsandwildroses___changemuchifpeopleleavethingsastheyare.A don"tB doesn"tC isn"tD didn"t3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]B.[析]thenumberof为"……的数量、数目",所以谓语动词用单数形式。而anumberof要加复数名词,其谓语动词也用复数。33 She"shadbreakfast,___?A issheB isn"tsheC hasn"tsheD hasshe[答案]C.[析]这里的"s应视为has34 Iwonder___.A whosebicycleisitB itiswhosebicycleC isitwhosebicycleD whosebicycleitis[答案]D.[析]wonder后的宾语从句应用陈述语序。35 Itisgoodforus___morningeGercises.A doB todoC didD done[答案]B.[析]这里的it是形式主语,而真正的主语是不定式todo…36 Peterhassportsveryoften,___?A does,PeterB doesn"theC doesn"tPeterD doeshe[答案]B.[析]has这里是实意动词,而主语为名词时其反意疑问句中的主语要用代词。37 MrBlacksaid,"Jenny,don"tbelatetomorrow"MrBlacktoldJenny___.A don"tbelatetomorrowB didn"tbelatetomorrowC notbelateneGtmorningD nottobelatetheneGtday[答案]D.[析]tell一般要加双宾语,其间接宾语是Jenny,直接宾语是不定式。而这里用的是不定式的否定形式。38 LiMeireadthenewspapertothegranny,___?A doessheB didn"tsheC didsheD wasn"tshe[答案]B.[析]read这里是过去时态,因其主语是第三人称单数,而read并未加s所以是过去时态。(read的过去时与过去分词都是read,只不过读音不同)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档二、定语从句(一)知识概要定语从句并不属于中考范围,但由于作者在多年的教学中体会到,这一语法现象影响了许多学生自学英语。这些学生一般是成绩较好的学生,想进行大量阅读来提高自己的英语水平,但总是碰到一些问题,百思不得其解。苦于自己的水平只限于初中水平,无法提高,但各种补习班又都是为一些水平较差的学生开设的,所以又投师无门。为了解决这部分学生的学习困难,也为那些有志青年铺平学习上的道路,特用这一节讲述定语从句,不是从语法上讲述,而是从阅读理解方面去讲述。可供同学们在学习时参考。这会对你的英语学习起到事半功倍的作用。对于形容词我们已十分熟悉了,如:agoodbook,形容词good用来修饰书book。我们也可以用一个句子来修饰名词,这种句子叫做形容词性从句,它起修饰名词的作用,又被叫做定语从句(Theattributiveclause)。但有一点不同的是这个从句不是像形容词那样放于名词前,而是放在名词之后。它所修饰的名词又被叫作先行词,如:Doyouknowthescientistwhogaveusthetalkthisafternoon?这句中的主句是Doyouknowthescientist?(你知道那位科学家吗?)而whogaveusthetalkthisafternoon(他今天下午给我们作的报告。)是定语从句。所以这两句话合为一体即是:你认识今天下午给我们作报告的那位科学家吗?这里scientist叫作先行词,而who叫作定语从句的引导词。who在定语从句中起主语的作用,who的数与它的先行词相同。又如:YoumustdoeverythingthatIdo这里先行词是everything,而thatIdo是定语从句,此句应译为:你必须作我所作的一切。that叫作定语从句的引导词,在句中作do的宾语。引导定语从句的引导词有关系代词:that,which,who,whom,whose和关系副词when,where,why,how。不论关系代词还是关系副词,都应放于先行词和定语从句之间,起联系作用,但它们都要在定语从句中起语法作用,充当一个成份。如关系代词在定语从句中不是作主语便是作宾语,而关系副词则是作状语。我们先来看关系代词的用法。① that的先行词可以是人也可以是物。如:Aplaneisamachinethatcanfly这里先行词是machine而that是关系代词,在定语从句中作主语。这句译为:飞机是一种会飞的机器。又如:Ilikethebook(that)youlentmeyesterday这里先行词是book,关系代词用that,它在定语从句中作lend(借)的宾语。要注意的是关系代词在定语从句中作宾语时可以省略,即:Ilikethebook3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档youlentmeyesterday② which关系代词的先行词只能是物。它在定语从句中作主语或宾语,如:Thebookshopisashopwhichsellsbooks这里shop是先行词,which在从句中作主语。又如:Thebook(which)Ireadlastnightwaswonderful这里主句是Thebookwaswonderful而定语从句是修饰主句的主语book,即我昨晚读的那本书,which在定语从句中作read的宾语,可以省略。③ who,whom,whosewho在定语从句中作主语,whom是who的宾格,在定语从句中作宾语,而whose则是形容词性物主代词,在从句中作定语,如:ThemanwhovisitedourschoolyesterdayisanAmericanfriend昨天参观我们学校的人是一位美国朋友。Who在定语从句中作主语。又如:Who"sthatwoman(whom)youjusttalkedto?你刚才与之谈话的那个女人是谁?而whom作定语从句中介词to的宾语,可以省略,而在现代英语中,句首的whom也常常可用who代替。Thisisourclassmate,Mary,whosehomeisnotfarfromourschool这是我们的同学玛丽,她的家离我们学校不远。为了便于理解,我们来看看是如何将两句话并为一句话的。1. Isawtheman.HeclosedthedoorIsawthemanwho(that)closedthedoor2. ThegirlishappyShewontheraceThegirlwhowontheraceishappy3. ThestudentsarefromChinaTheysitinthefrontrowThestudentswhositinthefrontrowarefromChina(要注意的是先行词是students则who的数也应看作复数。)4. WearestudyingsentencesTheycontainadjectivedauseWearestudyingsentencesthat(which)containadjectivedause5. ThetaGidriverwasfriendlyHetookmetotheairportThetaGidriverwhotookmetotheairportwasfriendly6. ThebookwasgoodIreaditThebookthatIreadwasgoodThebookIreadwasgood7. ThepeoplewereveryniceWevisitedthemyesterdayThepeoplewevisitedyesterdaywereverynice8. ThemancalledthepoliceHiswalletwasstolenThemanwhosewalletwasstolencalledthepolice3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档9. IcomefromacountryItshistorygoesbackthousandsofyearsIcomefromacountrywhosehistorygoesbackthousandsofyears10. IhavetocallthemanIpickeduphisumbrellaafterthemeetingIhavetocallthemanwhoseumbrellaIpickedupafterthemeeting关系代词whom,which在定语从句中作介词宾语时,可以和介词一起放于先行词与定语从句之间,有时为了关系紧凑也可以将whom与which与先行词紧挨着书写,而将介词置于定语从句的后面,如:Thatwastheroominwhichwehadlivedfortenyears或可以写作:ThatwastheroomwhichwehadlivedinfortenyearsHewasthemanwhom(who)youwerelookingfor要注意的是此句的关系代词whom可以用主格取代,而lookfor是短语动词也不可将for放于定语从句之前。that作关系代词作介词宾语时,不能紧跟介词,而只能将介词置于定语从句的后面。如:Themanthatweweretalkingabouthascometoourschool这时不可用aboutthat…请看下面例句:1. ThemeetingwasinterestingIwenttoitThemeetingthatIwenttowasinteresting2. ThemanwasverykindItalkedtohimyesterdayThemanwhoItalkedtoyesterdaywasverykind3. ImustthankthepeopleIgotapresentfromhimImustthankthepeoplewhoIgotapresentfrom4. ThepicturewasbeautifulShewaslookingatitThepicturethat(which)shewaslookingatwasbeautiful5. ThemanisstandingoverthereItoldyouabouthimThemanwhoItoldyouaboutisstandingoverthere除关系代词外,还有关系副词,when,where,why,其中when用来指时间,在定语从句中作时间状语。如:IneverforgetthedaywhenIfirstcametotheGreatWall而where则指地点,如:Thisisthehousewheretheoldmanlives请看下面例句:1. ThecitywasbeautifulWespentourvacationthereThecitywherewespentourvacationwasbeautiful3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档2. ThatistherestaurantIwillmeetyouthereThatistherestaurantwhereIwillmeetyou3. ThetownissmallIgrewupthereThetownwhereIgrewupissmall4. ThatisthedrawerIkeepmynewpapersthereThatisthedrawerwhereIkeepmynewspapers5. MondayisthedayWewillcomethenMondayisthedayWhenwewillcame6. 7∶05isthetimeMyplanearrivesthen7∶05isthetimewhenmyplanearrives7. 1960istheyearTherevolutiontookplacethen1960istheyearwhentherevolutiontookplace8. JulyisthemonthTheweatherisusuallythehottestthenJulyisthemonthwhentheweatherisusuallythehottest在定语从句中又可分为两大类定语从句,即限制性定语从句和非限制性定语从句。① 限制性定语从句是先行词在意义上不可缺少的定语,如果去掉的话,主句的意思就不完整,意义就表述不明。这种句型一般定语从句紧接先行词,如:Iwastheonlypersoninmyofficewhowasinvited② 非限制性定语从句。它与主句的关系不十分密切,只是对其附加说明,也就是讲即便去掉定语从句,句意也不受影响,仍然清晰明了。这样的定语从句要在它和主句之间加一逗号分开。且关系代词不引导这种非限制性定语从句,如:AbrahamLincoln,wholedtheUnitedStatesthroughtheseyears,wasshotonApril14, 1865atatheatreinwashingtonD. C. 又如:GalileolivedinthecityofPisa,wherethereisaleaningtowerabout180feethigh(二)正误辨析3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Iwon"ttellyouthenameofthepersonwhoteachmeEnglish[正]Iwon"ttellyouthenameofthepersonwhoteachesmeEnglish[析]在定语从句中,关系代词作主语时,从它本身看不出其数的形式,这时要由它的先行词决定。这里who应由theperson单数决定,应该用单数谓语动词。又如:Iwhoamastudentwanttofindasparetimejob这里的who应与I是一致的,所以其谓语动词应该用am。[误]WetalkedaboutthethingsandthepeoplewhowemetduringtheSecondWorldWar[正]WetalkedaboutthethingsandthepeoplethatwemetduringtheSecondWorldWar[析]这里的关系代词不要用who,因为其先行词有两个一个是things(物),而另一个是people(人),这时既不可用who,又不可用which,因前者只能用于先行词是人的情况下,而后者则用于先行词是物的情况下,所以只能用that,因为它的先行词既可以是人又可以是物。[误]Thebook,thatIboughtyesterday,wasverygood[正]Thebook,whichIboughtyesterday,wasverygood[析]先行词与定语从句被逗号分割开来时,即作为非限制性定语从句。在非限制性定语从句中which,when,who,whom,where,when,whose等都可以和限制性定语从句中的作用一样,而独有that不易用于非限制性定语从句。[误]ThedictionarywhichIlentityesterdayisaveryusefultool[正]ThedictionarywhichIlentyesterdayisaveryusefultool[析]关系代词在定语从句中是要起语法作用的,它不是作主语就是作宾语。虽然在作宾语时它的位置由原来的宾语位置移到了句首,但它的作用依然存在,而且在原宾语位置上不能再出现宾语。[误]TheteacherIwanttolearnEnglishfromistheonewhichcomesfromAmerica[正]TheteacherIwanttolearnEnglishfromistheonewhocomesfromAmerica[析]theone,anyone,those作代词并且是指某人、物时,其关系代词不能用which应用who。[误]Thisistheroominthattheoldmanlives3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Thisistheroominwhichtheoldmanlives[正]Thisistheroomwhichtheoldmanlivesin[正]Thisistheroomthattheoldmanlivesin[析]that不能紧跟在介词后作介词宾语,但如果介词不前置仍放于句尾,则可用that作引导词,而且可以省略。如:Thisistheroomtheoldmanlivesin[误]Icandoeverythingwhichisgoodforyou[正]Icandoeverythingthatisgoodforyou[析]在先行词是all,much,little,something,everything,anything,nothing,none,theone等不定代词时,虽然它们指的是物体,但不要用which而用that作定语从句的引导词。[误]Theonlythingwhichthestudentscandoisstudyinghard[正]Theonlythingthatthestudentscandoisstudyinghard[析]在先行词前有only,any,few,little,no,all,oneof等词修饰时,虽然先行词指的是物,也不要用which作关系代词,而要用that。[误]ThisisthefirstAmericanfilmwhichI"veeverseen[正]ThisisthefirstAmericanfilmthatI"veeverseen[析]在先行词是序数词,或由序数词修饰时,其关系代词不可用which这样的用法还有在形容词最高级修饰的先行词之后,如:ThisisthebestbookthatIhaveeverseen[误]HeisfromAfrica,thatwecanseefromthecolouroftheskin[正]HeisfromAfrica,aswecanseefromthecolouroftheskin[析]当as或which引导非限制性定语从句时,它可能没有明确的先行词,它们所指代的是前面整个句子。如例题应译为他是从非洲来这个事情是可以从其肤色上看出的。三、常见习惯用语(一) 知识概要由于英语国家的语言习惯与中国的语言习惯有许多不同之处,所以造成了许多同学在做选择或书写,或与人交谈中造成误用中国方式来对英语的问句作解答。例如一个小女孩十分好看,可爱,外国人见到时会讲:Youaresobeautiful3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档这时的答语应该是Thankyou如果外国人发现你的英语不错,他们会讲:YourEnglishisverygood这时中国人常常会说:不,我说的不好。这纯是一种礼貌的答语,但是不符合英语习惯。它正确的答语应是Thankyou虽然交际英语有一些规律可讲,但更重要的是学习外国的生活习惯,了解他们的文化背景,历史渊源,这样才能真正的学好一门外语。(二) 正误辨析[误]-WhatcanIdoforyou?-Yes,pleasehelpme[正]-WhatcanIdoforyou?-I"dliketobuyasweater[析]WhatcanIdoforyou?这一问语实际上用于的情景很多,要根据具体情况而定。如在商店中售货员讲这句话应译为:您想要点什么?在其他场合也可以被译为:我能为您做些什么?它的答语应是直接讲出想让对方提供的帮助。[误]-Whichcolourdoyoulike?-Sorry,Idon"tlike[正]-Whichcolourdoyoulike?-Ipreferblue[析]由which来提问的问句是要回答具体的选择,而不能泛指,泛泛的回答。如Yes,Ilikeit[误]Doyouliketocomewithustonight?[正]Wouldyouliketocomewithustonight?[析]Doyoulike…问的是对方的习惯,如:Doyoulikeswimming?Doyoulikecollectingstamps?而wouldyoulike…则是一次性的邀请、提议。邀请的英语表达法还有如下几种:Shallwego?我们走吧!Let"sgo?让我们走吧!Howabouthavingacupoftea?喝杯茶如何?Whataboutacupofcoffee喝杯咖啡如何?Whynotbuyit?为什么不买呢?其肯定答语一般为Certainly,Yes,O.K. Allright,Withpleasure[误]Sorry,I"vekeptyouwaitingNotatall[正]Sorry,I"vekeptyouwaiting3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Nevermind[析]"介意不介意"这一问法与答语在中英文中有所不同。如:-Doyoumindmysmokinghere?-_________A. Yes,doitpleaseB. No,ofcoursenotC. Yes,takeitpleaseD. No,youcan"ttakeit这时正确的选择应是B。其意为:不介意,当然不。而A选项则自相矛盾了,它应译为:是的我介意,请抽吧。而D选项是:不介意,你不能抽。当向对方争求意见时,可以有以下问法:DoyoumindifIopenthedoor?Wouldyoumindmailingtheletterforme其答语如果是同意应为:Certainlynot,notatall而不同意时应为Yes,或I"msorry[误]What"sthatman?HeisMike[正]What"sthatman?Heisateacher[正]Who"sthatman?HeisMike(HeisMike"sfather)[析]由what提问是问的职业,由who提问问的是姓名或身份。[误]-Howmucharethey?-Halfakilo,please[正]-Howmanybananasdoyouwant?-HalfakiloPlease[析]Howmucharethey?问的是价格而不是实际物品的多少。[误]I"msorry,butisthisthewaytothepark?[正]EGcuseme,butisthisthewaytothepark?[析]I"msorry是对已经做错了的事向对方道歉时的开始语。而EGcuseme是在打扰对方之前表达歉意的话。[误]-Haveagoodtimetonight!-Youarethesame[正]-Haveagoodtimetonight!3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档-Thesametoyou[析]Thesametoyou是表达我也祝您有个愉快的夜晚,它是美语中的习惯用法。[误]-What"stheproblem?-I"vegotaheadache[正]What"swrongwithyou?I"vegotaheadache[析]What"swrongwithyou?是询问对方身体状态如何,而What"stheproblem?是问对方遇到了什么麻烦。[误]-Now,I"mbackCanIplay?-PerhapsYou"dbetterdoyourhomeworkfirst[正]-Now,I"mbackCanIplay?-I"mafraidnotYou"dbetterdoyourhomeworkfirst[析]Perhaps是表示对一种拿不准的事态的推论,如:AmIright?Perhaps而I"mafraidnot则表达一种不同意的态度。beafraid的几种用法有:I"mafraidthatyouareright其后直接加宾语从句。-Willyoucometomybirthdayparty?-I"mafraidnotIhavetogotoseemyfatherHeisinhospital其后+not,表示否定。-Sorry,Idon"twanttogotherealone,I"mafraidofthedog其后+名词,表示对某人,某物的害怕。MaryisafraidofmakingmistakesintheeGam其后+of+动名词,表示害怕做某事。Maryisafraidtoseetheteacherbecauseshedidn"tdowellintheeGam其后+不定式,表示不敢去做某事。[误]-Howsoonwillyoubeready?-Twodays[正]-Howsoonwillyoubeready?-Intwodays[析]此题关键是要根据情景,身临其境,要注意的是对方问了什么,就应答什么。或答了什么就应问什么。Howsoon问的是"还有多久才能作完"3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档,这时要用intwodays,即在两小时之内即可以作完。如用Howlong提问,则答语可以用twodays。[误]-WouldyoumindifIhavesometimeoff?-Idon"tmind-MondayandTuesdayofneGtweek[正]-WouldyoumindifIhavesometimeoff?-WheneGactly-MondayandTuesdayofneGtweek[析]有的对话是复杂的,稍有不慎就有可能选错,而且英语中如选错了答案是不容易找出错来的。Idon"tmind是可以用来回答Wouldyoumind…这一提问的,但如仔细看一看则会发现我们要选用的不是陈述句而是疑问句。根据下面一句的答语来判定要用wheneGactly?什么时间,这样才能与下句中具体的时间相符合。[误]SupposeyournameisTomThephoneringsandyoupickitupThefirstwordyousaywillprobablybe"Whoareyou?"[正]SupposeyournameisTomThephoneringsandyoupickitupThefirstwordyousaywillprobablybe"Hello?ThisisTomspeaking?"[析]在英语学习中,习惯用法实际上在某种情况,或某种意义上讲比语法更为重要。如果只从句子的角度上去分析,它们可能都是对的。比如,当你拿起电话时,如果你想知道对方是谁,可以问"Who"sthat(speaking)?"但不要讲"Whoareyou?"如果你想先介绍一下自己可以讲"Thisis××××speaking"而不要讲"I"m ××××"也不要讲"Mynameis×××××." 就语法而论,"Whoareyou?""I"m××××""Mynameis×××××"并不错,也是英语中可用的句子,但就打电话这一场合,就不宜用了。[误]-Doyouthinkit"sgoingtorainovertheweekend?-Idon"thopeso[正]-Doyouthinkit"sgoingtorainovertheweekend?-Ihopenot[析]由于初学者对实际英语口语中表达感情意愿的答语不熟悉,如在肯定答语中IthinksoIhopesoIbelieveso是相同的,但在否定句中却常用Idon"tthinkso但Idon"tbelieveso和Idon"thopeso则意为:我不信此事和我不希望此事发生。而Ibelievenot和Ihopenot则为:我想可能不会发生吧!3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]-Isanybodythere?-No,BobandTomhaveaskedforleave[正]-Iseverybodythere?-No,BobandTomhaveaskedforleave[析]许多学生在写作和选择答语或问句时总要语法在前,而不是习惯用语在先。所以总是要拘泥疑问句中的不定代词,用anybody。但是Isanybodythere?在英语中为:这里有人吗?而Iseverybodythere?为:全都到齐了吗?所以首先要考虑的是其答语。No,BobandTomhaveaskedforleave[误]-Yourhandwritingisverygood!-No,myhandwritingisverypoor[正]-Yourhandwritingisverygood!-Thankyou[析]中国人遇到别人称赞,总是以谦逊为美德。但英美人则往往认为自信是美德。所以当别人夸奖你或赞美你时,就应说:Thankyou又比如中国人见面时常讲Whereareyougoing?或Haveyouhadyourbreakfastyet?而英美人则认为你过多的干预别人的私生活了。而他们见面时往往问一些无关紧要的话,如:Hello!Howareyougoing?(你过得怎样)Morning!等。而goodmorning和Howdoyoudo则被认为是较正规的问候语,在日常生活中则十分少见。[误]WhenyouhavehaddinnerwithanAmericanfriendandwanttoleaveyoumaysay:"EGcusemeI"llgofirst"[正]WhenyouhavehaddinnerwithanAmericanfriendandwanttoleaveyoumaysay:"EGcusemeIhavetogo"[析]这两句答语都是正确的,其关键不是语法,而是习惯问题。如果在这样的场合你讲I"llgofirst朋友们会迷惑不解,而Ihavetogo则表示由于外界的特殊原因而造成的你要离去,而你本人则十分不愿做此事。[误]-Wouldyouliketocometodinnertonight?-I"dliketo,andI"mtoobusy[正]-Wouldyouliketocometodinnertonight?-I"dliketo,butI"mtoobusy[析]I"mtoobusy与I"dliketo在意义上正好相反。所以要用转折连词。这里考查了对词义合乎逻辑的表达能力。所以要强调语言环境,更要强调在语言的基础上的词语辨析。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]-Where"sDeter?-Deterwillcomewithustonightbutheisn"tverysureyet[正]-Where"sDeter?-Determaycomewithustonightbutheisn"tverysureyet[析]由于but所引出的句子可以看出Deter的来与不来是十分不确定的,所以应用may来表达一个不肯定的事件。[误]-Hi,haven"tseenyouforages!Youlookfine!-GreatYoulookwelltoo[正]-Hi,haven"tseenyouforages!Youlookfine!-ThanksYoulookwelltoo[析]要注意的是Great在口语中多表示惊叹,而Thanks则表示感谢对方的称赞。所以对情景谈话要有准确的判定,要根据情景,身临其境,上下对照,周密思考,弄清场合,注意英美人的风俗习惯,注重语义上的词语辨析,并要进行大量的语言实践练习,扩大实际交际能力。(三) 例题解析1 -Wouldyouliketohavesomerice?-_________.A Yes,IlikeB Yes,pleaseC ofcourseD Yes,Ihave[答案]B.[析]当对方对你发出邀请的问语时,如果你想接受则讲Yes,please如不想接受则用No,thanks2 -Nicetoseeyou-_________.A GoodmorningB Happytomeetyou,tooC Nicetoseeyou,tooD Pleasedtomeetyou,too[答案]C.[析]虽然A、B、D三个选项都可以作为某种问候语的答语,但英语中问候语的答语多用重复对方的话,以表达同样的心情。3 -Wouldyoupleasegivemesomewater?-_________.A Yes,IwouldB CertainlyC No,thanksD Yes,please3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]B.[析]当对方发出十分礼貌的请求帮助的问语时,一般的回答是肯定的。而Yes,please为"是的,您请做某事吧"。这一含意显然不对。4 -Thankyouverymuchforhelpingme-_________.A You"rewelcomeB Itdoesn"tmatterC NoneedD Don"tsaythat[答案]A.[析]You"rewelcome译为中文为:不用谢。而Itdoesn"tmatter则为:没关系。5 -Hello,LucyHowareyou?-_________Andyou?A Fine,thanksB Yes,IamC GladtomeetyouD Goodafternoon[答案]A.[析]在正常交往中一定要避免所问非所答。所以对Howareyou?的答语应为"很好,谢谢!"6 -Helpyourselftosomemeat-_________A Itsoundsnice.B Yes,please.C Yes,Let"shelpeachother.D Thankyou.[答案]D.[析]Helpyourselftosomemeat.你自己拿些肉吃吧。其意为主人劝客人不要客气,像在家里一样。7 -Oh,IamnotfeelingwellI"vegotacold-_________A Fine,Howareyou?B NevermindTakecareC Well,I"msuretogetweelsoon.D I"msorrytohearthat3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]D.[析]这是美国、英国的习惯用语,而B、C则是中国人常讲的答语。8 -MeimeiyouspeakEnglishverywell-_________.A No,Idon"tthinksoB ThankyouverymuchC NotgoodenoughD That"sallright[答案]B.9 -"Kate,couldyouanswerthetelephone,please?"-_________,MumI"llgetit.A Yes,IcouldB No,thanksC OKD Yes,butIhavenotime[答案]C.[析]要注意could用于口语中是为了讲话的口气委婉,但它不是过去时态,也不是助动词,而应看作情态动词。所以在答语中则不应这样用。10 -CouldyoulookafterPollyformewhilewe"reaway?-_________A No,thanks.B Withpleasure.C I"mnotafraid.D I"msureyouwill.[答案]B.[析]Withpleasure是英语中的一句十分客气的答语,用在当对方因你的帮助或你的许诺向你道谢时,表达自己十分乐意为对方效力的口气。11 -Hello!CouldIspeaktotheheadmaster,please?-_________A Holdon,please.B That"stheheadmaster,please.C Whoareyou?please.D SorryI"mnottheheadmaster.[答案]A.[析]holdon,please是指请对方等一等不要将电话放下的用语。如果要讲我就是的话不能用that,而要用this,在电话用语中that指对方,this指自己。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档12 -Happybirthday!-_________A Thankyou.B Thesametoyou.C Goodluck.D Congratulations.[答案]A.[析]thesametoyou是同样祝贺对方的意思,不能用于生日这一祝贺语,除非两人的生日在同一天。13 -I"msorryIdon"tknowtheway,eitherYou"dbetteraskthatpolicemanforhelp-_________A Goodnight.B That"snothing.C Verywell.D Thankyouallthesame.[答案]D.[析]当向对方求助时,对方无能为力,这时的感谢语则为Thankyouallthesame意为不管如何还是要谢谢你。14 -Ifellandhurtmyleglastweek,SoIcan"tdoanything-_________.A I"msorryB Don"tworryC GoodluckD Badluck[答案]D.[析]如果用A则要用I"msorrytohearthat而不能单用I"msorry因I"msorry是向对方道歉。而badluck为真是不幸啊。15 -_________-IhavegotacoughA What"syourtrouble?B Whathaveyougot?C Whydidyoucomehere?D Haveyougotacough?[答案]A.[析]What"syourtrouble?多用于问对方有什么问题、麻烦或得了什么病。这种用语还有What"swrongwithyou?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档16 -Wouldyouliketogoshoppingwithme?-_________A Yes,I"dloveto.B That"sright.C Yes,please.D Quitewell.[答案]A.[析]表示愿意作某事应讲:I"dlovetoI"dliketo17 -What"stheweatherliketoday!-_________A It"sniceforawalk.B Ilikeautumnbestofall.C Itwillbefinetomorrow.D It"srathercoldtoday.[答案]D.[析]本题要注意问的是什么,不要所问非所答。因问题是今天的天气怎样,所以只能选D18 -IsJanein,please?Iwanttospeaktoher-Sorry,sheisoutYou"dbetter_________.A visitherintheofficeB callherlaterC seeherthisafternoonD speaktoheryourself[答案]B.[析]callherlater晚些时候再来电话。19 -_________-Verywell,thankyou,andyou?A Howdoyoudo?B GoodmorningC Howareyouthesedays?D HowdoyoulikeEnglish?[答案]C.[析]本题是由答语来推断问话,所以应熟悉英语的问答习惯:Howdoyoudo?的答语应为Howdoyoudo?20 -Howisyourmother?-_________A Sheisold.B Sheisnobetterthanshewas.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C Sheiskindhearted.D Sheisinherforties.[答案]B.[析]Howisyourmother?问的是你妈身体如何,而B选项则是"她不比以前强"。而其他三个选项则是所问非所答。21 -Thankyouverymuchforyourhelp-_________.A You"rewelcomeB Pleasedon"tC There"snotroubleD No,no[答案]A.22 YourunclehastakenyoutothecinemaAfterwardsyouthankhimHesays"_________."A ItwasnothingB I"mgladyouenjoyeditC Don"tsayitD No,needn"t[答案]B.[析]这是英语的答语,千万不要选A,因它是中文习惯的答语。23 -Thankyouforyourgoodpresent-_________.A It"snotgoodB No,noC MypleasureD Nevermind[答案]C.24 Whensomeonedidagooddeedforyou,youshouldsay_________.A.youaretoogoodB.It"sverykindofyouC.youareverykindD.I"llthankyou[答案]B.25 -IamverysorryIamlatefordinner-_________.A.No,youaren"tB.That"sallrightC.Yes,youareD.No,youdon"t3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]B.[析]That"sallright没关系。26 -I"msorryifIhurtyou-_________.A I"msorryB It"snottrueC Itdoesn"tmatterD Don"tsaysorry[答案]C.27 -IshouldhavegonetoseetheeGhibitionwithyou-_________.A I"msorryB WhatapityC Itdoesn"tmattertomeD That"sterrible[答案]B.[析]Whatapity.真遗憾。第一句应为我真该和你一起去展览会。28 -Helpyourselftosomefish-_________.A YouareverykindB Yes,I"mhelpingmyselfC ThankyouD Yes,don"tworryaboutme[答案]C.29 -Areyouready?-______.A I"mverysorryB TrytobepatientC Notyet,waitaminuteD Doyouhavethetime,please?[答案]C.[析]notyet意为还没有完成。30 -Mum,IhavepassedtheeGam-_________.A That"sallrightB CongratulationsC YouareluckD Goodlucktoyou[答案]B.31 -IthinkIhavetoleaveIhopewecangettogetheragain-_________.A AllrightB That"sallrightC OKD Ihopeso,too3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[答案]D.32 MustIwaittillhecomesback?.A No,youneedn"tB No,youmustn"tC No,youmaynotD No,youcan"t[答案]A.[析]must提问表示必须这样做吗?而肯定句要用must,表示必须做,而否定句则要用needn"t表示没有必要做。33 -_________Ipayyouthehouserentrightaway?-Yes,youhavetodoitA ShallB WayC MustD Have[答案]C.34 -Don"tyouthinkthiscolouristoobright?-_________A Yes,Iagree.B Yes,butIdon"tthinkso.C Yes,ofcoursenot.D Yes,what"swrong?[答案]A.35 -Itwascoldyesterday-_________.A SowasitB SoitwasC IbelievenotsoD Ibelievenot[答案]B.[析]当答语只是重复对方讲的话时,则不用倒装。因soitwas即为:是的,天气昨天很冷。而当讲前面讲的动作也适合于另一个人时,则要倒装。如:IwenttothecinemayesterdaySodidI表示对方去了电影院,我也去了。36 -Whatdoyouthinkofthesong?-_________.A IlikemusicverymuchB IlikeittooC WithpleasureD Itsoundssweet[答案]D.[析]sound在这里是系动词,为听起来很甜美。系动词后要用形容词,而不要用被动语态。37 Doyouliketeaorcoffee?_________.A Yes,IdoB Thankyou3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C That"sfineD Eitherwilldo[答案]D.[析]eitherwilldo为两者哪个都可以。38 Ilikeyoursweaterverymuch_________.A No,it"suglyB SorryC ThankyouD You"rewelcome[答案]C.[析]这是英美语言的习惯。39 Helikestravellingbytrain_________.A SodoIB IdosC IlikesoD Ilikeit,neither[答案]A.40 -Howdoyoulikeyourschool?-_________.A IlikeitverymuchB It"sverybeautifulC Idoesn"tlikeitD Verywell[答案]B.[析]Howdoyoulike…是问你们学校是怎样值得你热爱的。也就是为什么你热爱你的学校。41 Whataniceday!_________A You"reright.B No,isn"tit?C Yes,isn"tit?D Really?[答案]C.[析]Yes,isn"tit是的,难道不是个好天气吗?42 -Hello,_________?-ThisisDellaspeakingA WhoareyouB AreyouTomC WhoisthatD Pleasetellmewhoareyou[答案]C.[析]电话用语中that指对方,而this指自己。43 -What"shelike?-_________.A HelikesEnglishB Heisold3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C HeislikeafarmerD Heistallandthis[答案]D.[析]要区分What"shelike?如Whatdoeshelike?前者为:他长得什么样?而后者是:他喜欢什么。44 Howdidyoudoyourjob?Notverywell,_________.A I"msureB IamafraidC ThankyouD I"msorry[答案]B.[析]Iamafraid我恐怕是,我想是。45 -_________youraunt?-SheisaprincipalofamiddleschoolA WhatdoesB WheredoesC WhatisD Whomis[答案]C.46 -_________-HeismybossA What"stheman?B Whoistheman?C Howistheman?D Whatdoesthemando?[答案]B.47 -MayIhaveyourname?-_________.A No,noB You"repoliteC CallmeJohnD It"skindofyou[答案]C.48 -ShallImakecoffeeforyou?-_________.A Yes,thankyouB No,don"ttroubleC Don"ttroublethis,thankyouD No,don"tmakeit[答案]A.49 -CouldyoushowmethewaytoMrBuown"soffice?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档-_________.A NotatallB I"msureC AllrightD Icandoit[答案]C.50 -Shallwegoswimmingtomorrowafternoon?-_________.A It"sverykindofyouB YouaresothoughtfulC That"sagoodideaD Yes,we"llgo[答案]C.四、完形填空与阅读(一) 知识概要完形填空是一种在语意封闭的情况下考察学生阅读能力及掌握语言基础知识能力的综合性题目。学生应根据语义完整、语法正确的原则进行通篇阅读。借助文章的现成文字,通过逻辑思维,联系上下文,推断出可能的答案。然后再从所给选择答案中逐空选出在通读全文时脑海中已出现的答案填入空内。试推想在小学五六年级时去读"西游记","水浒传",你也并非每个字都认得,每句话都能真正理解。但你还是可以明了全文的意思,读得有滋有味。这就是语言能力。所以完形填空考查的就是你能否在缺字,不认得字、词语的情况下,能否全面理解文章的正确意思,然后选入适当的词语。在选择后还要前后彼此呼应反复验证所选答案。有时答案一时不易验证,不要急于顺序填写,可能在填出后面答案时,而得到前面的答案。有时则需运用所学的词法、句法、时态和固定搭配等知识对4个选项进行分析,比较、排除干扰项,确定正确的答案。待答案全部选定后,一定要复读全文以验证:① 所选答案是否能使全文流畅,逻辑推理是否正确。② 具体实事是否成立,前后关系是否理顺。③ 语法是否正确,其中包括时态的选择、词汇选择、固定搭配等。在通读全文时最好在可能的条件下将所选答案填入文章中,反复阅读。而不要在文章空中只写选项的代号,这样影响全文的理解,不易找出错误之处。在做完形填空时,应注意以下几点:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(1) 重视首句,首段的开篇启示作用,读懂了第一句,或第一段有可能预测到全篇大意。(2) 一定要顾及上下文间的语意联系。在完形填空的设计中,一般是以语义为第一要素同时兼顾语法。有的4个选项单独填入这个单句中全是正确的,但拿到文中从下文联系起来看,则文理不通。为此要通篇考虑,顾及上下文的联系是十分重要的。(3) 要坚持语意第一的原则,而语法应放于第二位。完形填空形式上是一种单项选择式的考察。但实质上也是一种阅读能力和学生重建文意能力的考察。它一般是利用语法的正确性与内容排斥性的矛盾而命题的。所给答案大都是离开上下文均可说得通的。但语意上辩析、排斥才能找到答案。例如:IttookCharlieMuiseveralmonthstosaveupsevendollarsHewantedto______amodelplaneandwenttotheshopwiththemoneyA sellB buyC holdD bring这里肯定需要一个动词,所给答案也都是动词,但只能从意义上考虑而选B项。(4) 要认真注意细节,做到语法正确。一些答案在意义上讲都是正确的,但从线索上看要找出语法正确的答案。如:MrEvansisanoldmanofaboutsiGtyHiswifediedafewyearsagoHischildren______himbythen.A leftB wouldleaveC haveleftD hadleft答案应为D。这句话正确的语意都是"离开",但仔细发现有bythen之说,由此可得出这是个动作的截止时间,应选为hadleft过去完成时态。下面再看一些例子。(1) 语意第一原则AyoungfatherwasvisitinganoldneighbourTheywerestandingintheoldman"sgardenandtalkingabout______.A treesB flowersC childrenD oldpeople那么他们谈论的中心是什么呢?可能是树、花,由于他们是在花园里谈论。但如果前后的段落配合看,则其谈论的也可能是孩子和老年人。这就是要求我们切勿望文生义。(2) 语法正确,注意细节的原则在语意正确的前题下,还要根据学过的语法知识,及词语的固定搭配,选择正确答案。如:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档OnenightthedogbegantobarksuddenlyItmadeMrErens______①______tosleepHehadtogetupandtriedhis______②______tostopit,butthebeastwouldn"tstop,andkepton______③______① A gonotB notgoC nottogoD tonotgo② A wellB goodC betterD best③ A barkB tobarkC barkingD barked以上3个小题中所给答案从语意上都是正确的,这就要求选择语法正确的那一个。第一空中根据句子结构,要填一个宾语补足语。而动词make后面的定语补足语应省去不定式符号to,且其否定式+not,即不定式的否定式为nottodo,而省去to后则应为notdo.在动词前直接+not故应选B。而第二个空显然是一个固定搭配。语意上为:MrErens尽力地阻止狗叫,所以应选D。tryone"sbest是尽力而为之意。第三个空显然是keepondoingsomething连续不断之意,应选ing的动词形式。其答案为C。(3) 根据所给答案的不同词类,从不同角度分别考虑选择完形填空所给的词往往是不同类的,这就要求对不同词类作不同考虑。如果所缺的是动词,那么首先在选择语意正确的前提下,考虑动词的时态、语态和是否是要填入非谓语动词。若是介词或副词则要考虑是否固定搭配,以及介词、副词在结构和意义上的选择。若是连词,则应更多地从句子结构和上下文的连接上选择。若是代词,则应考虑性、数、格等方面,以及形容词和副词的比较级和最高级等。例如:AmanandhiswifehadasmallbarnearastationTheyoftenworkedlateintothenight,______①______peoplecametodrinktherewhiletheywere______②______trainsAttwoo"clockonemorning,onemanwasstillatatableinthesmallbarHewasasleepThebarman"swifewantedtoleaveShelooked______③______thebarseveraltimes,andeachtimethemanwas______④______thereThenatlastshewenttoherhusbandandsaidtohim,"You______⑤______thatmansiGtimes,George,______⑥______heisn"tdrinkinganything"① A assoonasB becauseC soD though② A catchingupwithB gettingonC lookingafterD waitingfor③ A atB forC intoD outof④ A alwaysB oftenC stillD already3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档⑤ A havewokenB wakeC hadwokenD willwake⑥ A andB butC yetD too从文中看,第一选项,由于给了不同的连词,从意义选择应为B。第二选项均为分词形式,也应从语意上选择,其答案是D。第三选项给了四个介词,而into则是从外向里观看,所以应选C。第四项是副词still意为仍然,从意义上应选择C。而第五项所给的是同个动词,只是时态不同。从故事情景看,只能选完成时态A。而最后一个选项是连词,由于句意则只能用but转折连词。从目前完形填空初中阶段的考察看,除语意第一外,更多地选择了单词的用法及意义,动词的时态,短语和惯用法等。为此,要做好完形填空题目,除有较好的阅读能力外,更要有扎实的语言基础知识及日常生活的逻辑推理能力。阅读理解能力在教学大纲中有明确的要求。它是目前条件下考查学生英语运用能力的常规题型之一,也是分值最高的题型之一。学生的阅读理解能力如何,标志着学生继续深入学习的潜力有多大,它是集语法,词汇,逻辑推理背景知识于一体的综合语言能力的测试。它除对学生的阅读理解的正确性进行测试外,同时从阅读速度、技巧、文化背景常识等方面对学生进行测试。从近年各地中考题分析看,阅读类测试除为一般常规测试题型外,在试题中所占分值较大,为此应引起学生特别注意。如何做好阅读理解题呢?首先要求考生有足够的基础知识和较好的阅读速度以及技巧方面的训练。同时还要注意以下几个方面的问题。1 要了解阅读测试的重点如上所述,阅读过程是一个综合作用的过程,为此阅读的测试就不能仅将着眼点放在语言结构的测试上,而是通过看,通过阅读获取信息的能力。在阅读一篇文章时,我们首先会想到:① 文章说的是什么事情(即中心思想是什么)。② 事情发生的时间、地点、人物是什么。③ 作者所持态度如何。④ 结论是什么。有些说明性信息在文章中容易获取,如:时间、数字、地点、人物等。有些信息如作者的态度,事件的结论,中心思想,文章的标题,则需通过文中线索,说明信息等等去分析推断才能获取。而这些说明性及内隐性的信息正是阅读理解的测试重点内容。而其难点在于理解、推断、得出结论时,应从英语国家的风俗习惯、语言习惯、宗教信仰、民族问题等方面来考虑,而不是仅从中国人的语言习惯来作推论。这也是这方面的难点之一。例:JohndroveataGithroughthebusystreetsofBostoneverydayJohnwas____________A amanagerB adriverC apolicemanD adustman由此我们应能由driveataGi3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档来得出结论约翰是位出租车司机而不是别的什么人。例:MrsBarker"ssisterwasill ShehadsomeonetolookafterherfromMondaytoFriday,butnotattheweekend,soeveryFridayeveningMrsBakerusedtogoofftospendtheweekendatherhomeinaneighboringtown…ThismeantthatMr Baker…Firsthehadtodrivehomefromthestation ThenhehadtodrivehiswifetothestationtocatchhertrainWhowasill?____________A MrBakerB MrsBakerC Mr Baker"ssisterD MrsBaker"ssister从这些只言片语中可以看出有三个人物出场,而问题的设计是表浅的,只要细心即可。[答案]D.从中考阅读命题中,由于考虑到考生的能力有限,和大部分学生毕业的要求,语言结构的测试占很大一部分比重。但对于要考入重点中学的学生来讲,仅仅几分较高要求的题目可能会决定他们的升学命运。因为这一部分分值是往往使学生棘手的那些隐性问题的测试。如:Likemanyotherfamiliesin1870,KatieOlsonandherfamilyhadcometothegrassyplainsofKansas Katielikedtheprairieandtheirnewsoldhouse Butwithnofriendstoplaywith,shewasverylonely Besideshermotherandfather,shehadonlyherlittlebrother,Matt,forcompany ShemissedtheiroldhomeinWisconsir ThenonedayherfatherhadeGcitingnews SomesettlershadboughtthefarmneartheOlson"sland KatiebecamesoeGcitedonhearingthenewsthatshethoughtshemightburst ShebeggedherfathertoletherrideoverwithhimtogreettheirnewneighborsThetworodeacrosstheprairie TheyfoundMr andMrsLaskiwerehardatworkingbuildingtheirsodhome Katiewasdisappointed Shehadhopedtherewouldbesomechildrentoplaywith ButsoonMrLaskicalledout"Anna,andCarl, comeoutofthewagon"Aboyandagirl jumpeddownandcameovertoKatie Katiedidn"tbelieveit Herwishhadcometrue1 Whowasthemostimportantpersoninthestory?A MattB KatieC MrLaskiD AnnaandCarl3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档2 WhatwasKatie"sprobleminthestory?A Shehadnofriend.B Shedidn"tlikeKansas.C Shecouldn"trideahorse.D Shedidn"tlikeAnnaandCarl.从上文中看,信息的获得不是直接的,而是必须通过整个文章的阅读,理清人物关系,掌握中心思想,才能作出正确的判定。如第一问故事中人物众多,但一直到读完才知,故事讲述了一个女孩Katie的事情。则她是故事的中心,所以应选择B 第二问是测试通过阅读是否了解了人物的心理情绪。这些信息必须通过线索,综合判定,从而其结论是A。2 阅读理解的解题思路和方法阅读理解的测试点是在通过由于阅读所能够获取信息的能力上,所以解题思路的重点应放在:(1)通读全文,了解文章的主题和大意;了解作者的写作目的、对事件的态度上。Peoplesometimeschangetheirwayofdoingbusiness InavillageinAfrica,peopleareusingmoneyforthefirsttime They"redoingbusinesswiththeworldBeforethistribe(部落)usedmoney,peoplecametothemarketinthevillagetotrade(交易)thingstheyhadforthingstheyneeded NowpeoplemustusemoneytobuywhattheywantBeforeusingmoney,peoplehelpedoneanother Theirfatherwhowasheadofthefamily,gavefood,andclothingtohissonsandtheirfamilies Inreturn,thesonsworkedfortheirfather Nowpeoplenolongerworkforoneanotherfree Instead,theyarepaidfortheworktheydoWhenanewroadwasneeded.Everyoneinthevillagehelpedbuildit, Nowpeoplemustpaymoneytothevillagechief(首领)forroadsandschools Thechiefhiresworkerstobuildthesenewprojects MoreandbetterroadsandschoolsarebeingbuiltItisnoteasyforpeopletochangeawayofdoingbusiness Tochangefromtradinggoodstousingmoneytakestime① Thestorydoesn"tsayso,butitmakesyouthinkthat____________.A familymembersoftenquarrel(争吵)aboutmoneyB AfricansdonotchangetheirwayofdoingbusinessC AfricansrefusetousemoneyD familiesdonothelponeanotherinthesamewaynow[答案]D.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档② Onthewholethisstoryisabout____________A thelifeofsomeAfricansB changingfromgoodstousingmoneyC peoplehelpsoneanotherD buildingroadsacrossAfrica[答案]B.从以上的问题看,所设提问均不是对某个具体事实。而是真对整篇文章,由此可见通读全文,掌握中心和作者的态度的重要性。(2)要注重文句间的相互关系。既注重主要情节又不可忽视细节。中考中阅读命题很多情况下是对事件的某个细节而进行测试的。例:…onSaturdayafternoontheybeganwiththebackofthehouse TheneGtSaturdayTomwenttoafootballmatchwhilehiswifepaintedthefrontofthehouse TheneGtdaytheyfoundtheycouldn"topenanyofthefrontwindows Theygetthemopenatlast,buttheybrokethreeofthesevenandtheywereveryeGpensivetorepair① Theylastedforabout______daysA twoB threeC morethansevenD Lessthanseven[答案]A.② Theyhadtogetsomeonetomakerepairfor______windowsA sevenB fourC tenD three[答案]D.第一问中,如不分析第一句和第二句中的两个Saturday,很可能会选择答案C。事实上,他们只干了两个Saturday,而不是从这个星期六到下个星期六的7天时间。而第二问是他们弄坏了所有7个窗户中的3个,所以应选D。(3)特别注意首尾句在整个文章中的作用,以及它起到的启示和结论性作用。例:Manhasabigbrain Hecanthink,learnandspeak……butnoanimallearnswhenwespeak?Scientistsdonotreallyknow Theyonlyknowthatmancanspeakbecausehehasabigbrain这篇文章只要我们注意了首尾句,即可得出结论,它是讲述人类大脑与语言的关系的。人脑的其中一个作用是使他拥有语言,也就是和动物apes,dogs3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档有了根本的区别。这样这篇文章的许多细节可以迎刃而解了。① Inwhatwayaremendifferentfromanimals?A Mencanunderstandthingsquickly.B Mencanlearn.C Menhavelearnedlanguage.D Menhavebrains.[答案]C.② Scientistsnowknow______A howchildrenlearntospeakB whyapescanlearnafewwordsC men"sbrainhelpshimtolearntospeakD whathappenswhenmenspeak[答案]C.③ Whatisthetopicthewriterwantstotalkabout?A ape"slanguageB men"sbrainandlanguageC humanbrainD animals"learning[答案]B.以上只是做阅读练习中的一般分析,要取得优异成绩,还有赖于扎实的阅读基础和语言能力,以及平时的技巧训练和刻苦练习。要坚持每天至少读三四篇文章,以逐步提高自己的英语水平。(二)例题解析通读下面短文,掌握其大意。然后从短文后各题所给的四个选项中选择最佳的一项。Oncetherewasacleverfarmer Thoughhewaspoor,hedecidedonedaytotakethekingaroastgoose(烤鹅)asapresent Hehadnothad____1____tocatthatday,andsoonthe____2____oftheroastgoosebecametoomuchforhimas(当……时)he____3____ittotheking,soheateoneofitslegsWhenhecamebeforethekingandgavehimthegoose,theking____4____sawthatithadonlyoneleg3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Now,theking____5____wasbornwithonebadleg,sohehadneverbeenableto____6____properly(正常地) Whenhesawthegoosewithonlyoneleg,hethoughtthefarmerhad____7____thistolaughathim Ofcoursehewasvery____8____ Thefarmerwastoldthatifanybodylaughedattheking,hewouldbe____9____atonce"Whereis____10____legofthegoose?"thekingasked"Allthegeese(goose的复数)inthis____11____ofthecountryhaveonelegonly,"thefarmeranswered"DoyouthinkI"mafool(傻子)?"thekingshouted"____12____,"saidthefarmer,"ifyoulookoutofthewindow,youwillseegeesewithonelegbythe____13____"Thekinglooked,andtherethegeesewere____14____ononelegbesidethewater Thekingatoncetoldoneofhismento____15____themwithabigstick,andofcourse,they____16____theirotherlegsandranaway"There,"saidtheking "Youwerelying(说谎) That____17____thatthegeeseherehavetwolegs,likeallother____18____inthecountry""Butitdoesn"tshowanything,"answeredthefarmer,"ifyourmenthrewabigsticklikethatatme,Iwouldgrowtwo____19____legsmyselftohelpmetorunaway____20____"1 A lessB allC littleD much2 A headB neckC smellD temperature3 A returnedB carriedC sentD handed4 A atonceB atlastC bythenD ontime5 A onceB reallyC himselfD yet6 A comeB walkC seeD eat7 A keptB doneC madeD found8 A sorryB worriedC sadD angry9 A helpedB killedC savedD covered10 A otherB anotherC thatD theother11 A cityB villageC farmD part12 A CertainlynotB OfcourseC That"snothingD Nevermind13 A holeB forestC lakeD house3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档14 A swimmingB restingC flyingD lying15 A fillB lockC hitD keep16 A sentupB putdownC didwithD movedaway17 A showsB talksC seesD knows18 A geeseB animalsC legsD farmers19 A slowerB fasterC lessD more20 A moreslowlyB morecarefullyC fasterD earlier[答案]1 D2 C3 B4 A5 C6 B7 B8 D9 B10 D11 D12 A13 C14 B15 C16 B17 A18 A19 D20 C其中1选much是应能从文章字里行间中猜到的,它应为muchfoodtoeat 而将food省略。2要知道smell可以作系动词,但也可以作名词,而4则为多个短语的词语辨析:atonce立刻,atlast最终,bythen到那时为止,ontime准时。所以应为atonce 7则要熟悉英语的习惯用法,即干这件事要用do,而不用make 10之所以要用D则是因为鹅有两只腿,由于只剩一只而问另一只哪里去了,要用特指的定冠词。而other则为泛指的形容词,一般指复数,another虽然也指单数,但也应用于泛指的情况。而11题因其后有ofthecountry,是在乡村的这个部分,所以只能用part country是不可数名词作"乡村"讲,作为可数名词则作"国家"讲。而作"乡村"讲时,前面的定冠词不可少。19则是要通读全文才知道鹅一只腿站立体息,而一被哄赶则放下另一只腿跑走了,人是两条腿站着,当被哄赶时那应是再长出两条腿奔跑着逃走。由此可见中考的难题越来越不在语法项,而在阅读和完形上用以选拔高质量的学生。Weweregoingtoplayateamfromacountryschool Theydidn"tcomeuntilthegametimearrived Theylooked____1____thanwehadthought Theywerewearingdirtybluejeans(仔裤)andlookedlikefarmboys WeeventhoughtthattheyhadneverseenabasketballbeforeWeallsatdown Wefeltthatwedidn"t____2____anypractice(训练)againstateamlikethatItwasalreadysolatethatno____3____couldbegiventothemforawarmupThegamebeganOneofourboys____4____theballandheshot(掷)alongpasstoourforward(前锋) FromoutofnowhereaboyinadirtyTshirt____3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档5____thepassandwithabeautifulform(姿势)heshotandgottwopoints(分)They____6____usThentheygotanother____7____ofpointsinaminuteSoonitwasallover Thecountryteam____8____usWecertainlylearnedthateventhoughateamisgood,thereisusuallyanother____9____alittlebetter Buttheimportantlessonlearnedwas:Onecan"ttellaman,orateam,bythe____10____1 A strongerB youngerC worseD less2 A getB tryC useD need3 A basketB spaceC ballD time4 A gotB playedC missedD carried5 A caughtB changedC startedD stopped6 A surprisedB keptC brokeD hit7 A halfB pairC groupD double8 A wonB savedC beatD joined9 A justB alreadyC aboutD almost10 A TshirtsB clothesC placesD points[答案]1 C2 D3 D4 A5 D6 A7 B8 C9 A10 B[析]在1题中可以看出stronger,youngerworse,less四个选项全可以选,语法是正确的。从文章开始到这里并看不出其原因为什么要选择C,这时只能将其选择空出往后面看,所以提醒考生要注意的是千万不要一一对完形填空作出选择,有很多情况是后面的情景决定了前面的选择。当看到Weeventhoughtthattheyhadneverseenabasketballbefore和Wefeltthatwedidn"tneed(2)anypracticeagainstateamlikethat 则就肯定会得到第一个空的选项决不是比我们强壮,也不可能是少,更不可能是年轻、而是球技不佳,比我们差得很远。而5题是要仔细考虑才能得到正确的结论。这四个动词都可以用在篮球运动中,但要注意的是,其后面的名词是pass,在这里应译为"长传"。而这个长传这里决不是开始,而是被截住了。所以这里应用stopped。即"拦截了一个长传。"而caught的宾语应换为ball球就对了。B选项为"改变",用于这里就不合题意了。而7项虽然很多人都知道篮球规则,投一球按两分计算,但这里应选哪个词则拿不准了,主要在B选项与D选项之间发生了问题。不知double的真实意义是"加倍,翻一翻"之意,还是"一对,一双,两倍"3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档之意。其困难点还有9项,它的选择应为just,这是由全文所决定的。它的意思是不论一个队多么好,总会有一个队会比你强出一点儿,哪怕是仅仅一点点。这也就是完形填空不易拿满分之处。这里要提醒大家的是:语言是十分灵活的,要经常不断地学习思考才会有所进步。Peterwasasmallboy Helivedwithhisparentsinasmallhousenearsomehills ThepeopletherewereallpoorOnenightitwasverydryandwindyWheneverybodywasasleep,Petersuddenlyheardsomenoise Itcameoutfromthekitchen(厨房) Hegotupandwalkedtothekitchen Hefoundthatthewoodbesidethestove(火炉)wasburning Therewasnowatertap(水龙头)inthehouse,sohecouldnotputout(扑灭)thefire Heshoutedloudlytowakeupeveryoneinthehouse Thenheranoutofhishouseandknockedonthedoorsofmanyhousestowakethepeopleup TheyalllefttheirhousesquicklyAtlastthefirewasputoutbythefiremen Manyhouseswereburnt Butnobodywashurtinthefire1 Peterlivedwithhis______A sistersB brothersC unclesD parents2 Onenighthefoundthat______besidethestovewasburningA thetableB thewoodC thedoorD thewindow3______ ,sohecouldnotputoutthefireA EverybodywasasleepB Hecouldn"tshoutloudlyC ThekitchenwasverybigD Therewasnowatertapinthehouse4 Peterknockedonthedoorsofmanyhouses______zA towakethepeopleupB togetsomewaterC tofindhisclassmatesD tovisitthem5______ hurtinthefireA PeopleinotherhouseswereB Peter"sparentswereC NobodywasD Peterwas[答案]1 D2 B3 D4 A5 C[析]本题属于表层理解阅读考查题目,因为完成其答案所需要的信息3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档基本上可以直接从文章中获取,并不太多的需要推理和对环境,习俗的分析与了解。例如1题可直接从文章中Helivedwithhisparentsinasmall…中获取。2题则可以从Hefoundthatthewoodbesidethestovewasburing获取答案。3题几乎是文章中的原句,Therewasnowatertapinthehouse 所以得分率会很高。4题也可从文章中:Thenheranoutofhishouseandknockedonthedoorsofmanyhousestowakethepeopleup 直接找出答案。5题的答案则可以从文章中最后一句获得,如:Butnobodywashurtinthefire。这样的阅读题目,是属于表层理解题目,也就是为了那些获取毕业成绩的分数所设计的。其目的在于对普通同学给予适当的分以求达到毕业之目的。这样的题目虽然容易,但还是要小心为好,不要粗心大意,以免不必要的丢分。"You"rejustintime,Joe We"regoingtoplaycowboys(牛仔)andIndians,andyoucanbetheIndians,"oneofmycousins(堂兄弟)said"HowmanyIndians?"Iasked"Oh,aboutathousand,"heanswered,andbeforeIcouldsayno,IwaspushedoutintothenightandbecameathousandIndians TwominuteslaterIwasrunninginthefieldswithagroupofcowboysbehind Theshoutsof"Afterthem Let"scatchthekillers!"andothersuchTVplaylanguagecameintomyearsasIranroundacornerandhurriedintomyGrandpa"scar"We"vegothim, boys Let"sgoandcatchhim!"Butnoonewantedtocometogetme AllofmycousinseGceptonewerealwaysveryfriendlywithme Itwasquietoutside AndIwentoutofthecartohavealookJustthenIheardashout,"Bringtherope(绳子),andwecanburnhim""OnlyIndiansburnpeople Cowboys…,"Istoppedjustintime Ihadalmostsaid,"Cowboyshang(绞死)people"Iwastiedtoatree,andthecowboyswerelookingforsomewoodwhenmydearmothercalled,"We"releavingnow""Untieme,"Ishouted "We"regoing""WhydidBobbywantmatches(火柴)?"Mumaskedwhenwewereinthecar "HewasaskingDadwhetherhehadany""Oh,hewasjustgoingtomatches?MATCHES?Areyousurehewantedmatches?"Motherwasquitesure,andIdidn"tsayanymore1 HowmanychildrenplayedtheIndians?A Onethousand.B Onehundred.C Onegroup.D One.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档2 WhydidJoe"scousinsaythatJoewasjustintime?Because______A therewerenotenoughchildrenforthegameB thegamewasjustgoingtostartC noneofhiscousinswantedtobetheIndiansD theywerewaitingforJoe3 Joedidn"tsay"Cowboyshangpeople"outbecause______A hewastiedtoatreeB thatwouldmakethingsworseC hewascaughtbythecowboysD thatwouldmakethecowboysangry4 WhichofthefollowingisTRUE?A OneofJoe"scousinswaslookingformatches.B Daddidn"twanttogivethechildrenanymatches.C Bobbywantedtogetsomematchesfromhisfather.D Mumdidn"tthinkchildrenshouldplaywithmatches.5 Thenameofthestoryshouldbe"______"A JoeandhiscousinsB WhoknowswhatdangeriswaitingthereC CowboysandIndiansisafavouritechildren"sgameD HowcowboysandIndiansfoughtinthepast[答案]1 D2 C3 B4 A5 B[析]本文在阅读过程中会感到难度,而其问题与选项的设计更为困难。其难点不仅在于要阅读好文章,而且要对问题和问题中的选择项作深入仔细地阅读。如1题的问句之意是有多少个孩子在游戏中扮演印第安人。而文章中又有"HowmanyIndians?"Iasked当作者问到有多少印第安人时,其答语为"aboutathousand"这对于看不懂全文,而只认识个别单词的人就是一种很强的误导作用。因题目中问的是Howmany,而文章中的数字是athousand 但如果认真往下看则会发现:IwaspushedoutintothenightandbecameathousandIndians 我被推入了黑暗之中变成了一千个印第安人。所以文章暗示了一个小孩来扮演一千个印第安人。这种题目的得分率自然不会很高。紧接而来的2题则更困难,问题问的是Joe的堂兄说他来的正是时候,是因为3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档______。这是要认真去推理来判定的。由文中的句子andbeforeIcouldsayno…这显然暗示了作者并不想扮演这样的角色,所以可以推论是没有人愿意扮演这个角色,但正在这个时候Joe来了,而且不由分说把Joe推入了角色之中。而3题则更加困难,其题目之意是"Joe没有说出牛仔是绞死人"的这一句话是为了什么______。从文章中Joe被一群孩子追逐后被抓住,十分不高兴,想从中解脱出来。因其他孩子讲我们可以烧死他。所以Joe为了摆脱困境而要讲出的话是:"只有印第安人才烧人,而牛仔是用绳子绞死人。"后半句没有讲出来,是因为他看到如果要烧死人还需要找柴,找火柴,还是要一段时间的,但绳子就在他身上,如果绞死人那几乎是立刻马上之事。所以其答案选择了B。 这样的话可能会使事情更糟。4题的题目是简单的,即下面陈述中那个是真实的。由于中考英语答案是唯一的,所以只有一个是符合标准的。这时可以采用选取正确答案的方法,但实际上更好的办法是排除法。把不正确的排除后再对其他项进行对比,作出选择。这叫作所谓的排除法。首先排除的应是C选项,因文章中讲在他们上车回家的路上妈妈问他:"为什么Bobby要火柴,他问爸爸是否有火柴。"这里的爸爸显然指的是Joe的爸爸而不是Bobby的爸爸。而其他三个选项则都处于可选之例:如A项应为Joe的一个堂兄在找火柴。B项是爸爸不想给孩子任何火柴。D项是妈妈认为孩子们不应玩火柴。而B项,在文章中根本没有进述Joe爸爸的态度,所以应首先放弃,而D项是可以从推理中得到的,要不然他的母亲不会在车上问这个问题,但是文章中并未直接提出来,所以只有A是对的。因其妈妈讲Bobby是向Joe的爸爸寻找火柴。而5项则更是要全文反复阅读才可能领会到其中的原由的。文章的题目要概括全部文章内容,但更重要的是从中抽取最重要的,也就是作者的主要意图。从文章的最后两句,当作者反问他妈妈时说:"他真的在找火柴?火柴、你敢肯定他是在找火柴吗?"妈妈表示十分肯定,而作者再也不讲什么了。显然他感到如果玩下去危险的存在。所以其答案是B。这也就是中考中要求较高的题目,虽然分数不多但对要进入重点高中的学生来说,这是个关键问题,也就是成功与失败的焦点所在。例:Wespentadayinthecountryandpickedalotofflowers Ourcarwasfullofflowersinside!Onthewayhomewehadtostopattrafficlights,andtheremywifesawthebookshelfItstoodoutsideafurniture(家具)shop "Buyit,"shesaidatonce "We"llcarryithomeontheroofrack(车顶架) I"vealwayswantedonelikethat"WhatcouldIdo?TenminuteslaterIwastwentydollarspoorer,andthebookshelfwastiedontotheroofrack Itwastallandnarrow,quite3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档heavytooAsitwasgettingdarker,Idroveslowly Otherdriversseemedmorepolitethanusualthatevening Thepoliceevenstoppedtraffictoletusthrough CarryingfurniturewasagoodideaAfteratimemywifesaid,"There"salonglineofcarsbehind Whydon"ttheyovertake(超车)?"Justatthattimeapolicecardidovertake Thetwoofficers(警官)insidelookedatusseriouslywhentheywentpast Butthen,withakindsmiletheyaskedustofollowtheircarthroughthebusytraffic Thepolicecarstoppedatourvillagechurch(教堂)Oneoftheofficerscametome"Right,sir,"hesaid"Doyouneedanymorehelpnow?"Ididn"tquiteunderstand"Thanks,officer,"Isaid "You"vebeenverykind Ilivejustdowntheroad"Hewaslookingatourthings:firstattheflowers,thenatthebookshelf "Well,well,"hesaidandlaughed "It"sabookshelfyou"vegotthere!Wethoughtitwas-ersomethingelse"Mywifebegantolaugh SuddenlyIunderstoodwhythepolicedrovehere Ismilcdattheofficer "Yes,it"sabookshelf,butthanksagain"IdrovehomeasfastasIcould1 Fromthestoryweknowthat______A thewriterwaspooranddidn"tbuythebookshelfforhiswifeB thewriter"swifedidn"tlikethebookshelfatallC thewriterwasalwaysgladtobuysomethingforhiswifeD thewriterwasnotverygladtobuythebookshelfforhiswife2 Whatmadethewriterthinkthatcarryingfurniturewas"agoodidea"?A HecoulddriveslowlyanditwassafeB OtherdriverswouldlethimgofirstC HiswifecoulduseanewbookshelfD Hecouldsavealotofmoneyandtime3 Whywerethepoliceandotherdriverssokindtothewriter?A BecausetheythoughtthewriterlikedstudyingverymuchandneededabookshelfB Becausetheydidn"tthinkitwaspolitetoovertakeacarwithabookshelfonit3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档C Becausetheythoughtsomebodyinthewriter"sfamilyhaddiedandheneededhelpD Becausetheythoughtitwasdangeroustocarryabookshelfonacar4 Whydidthewriter"swifebegintolaugh?A BecausenowsheknewwhatmistakethepolicehadmadeB BecauseatlastherhusbandunderstoodwhythepolicehaddriventothechurchC BecausetheofficerwasalwayslookingattheflowcrsandthebookshelfD Becausethepolicehadhelpedthemalot5 Whendidtheofficersbegintorealize(意识到)theyhadmadeamistake?A BeforetheyarrivedatthechurchB Beforetheyovertook(overtake的过去式)thewriter"scarC AfteroneofthemlookedattheflowersandthebookshelfcarefullyatthechurchD Afterthewriter"sfamilyleftthechurch[答案]1D2B3C4A5C[析]这篇文章有英国幽默的味道。英国的幽默是十分特别的,它一般都是讲述一个故事,但当结尾时仅几句话则道出天机来。对于这样的文章要从头认真看到尾,不要在考场中为了赶时间自认为是全懂了,其实则不然。造成不必要的丢分。从1题可以看出作者十分不情愿地为其妻子买了个书架呢。第二段则出现"Buyit"这样的祈使句。初学者不易看出里面的原委。要知道祈使句在对话中常常带有命令,或不客气之意,所以从这里开始已看出作者的情绪了。其后的WhatcanIdo?又是一句抱怨的话,"我还能作什么吗?"其后又是一句风趣的抱怨:TenminuteslaterIwastwentydollarspoorer即暗示十分不情愿地又花了20美元。所以其答案是D。其后2题则是推理题,从作者买了书架之后一连串的奇怪事情发生了。首先是其他的驾驶员开车对他十分的礼貌,甚至警察阻挡其他车辆让他先行。所以其答案是B。第3题则一句道破天机。因为前两件事已使作者感到奇怪了。后3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档来警察竟然亲自驾驶汽车为他开道。而且警察并不知道他要去什么地方就把他带到教堂来了。这是因为英美人一生三件大事都要在教堂做:其一是出生时在教堂洗礼,其二是结婚,其三则是死亡。所以警察不问其由而将他带到教堂是为了帮助他。所以答案是C。当警察讲到Wethoughtitwas…ersomethingelse?时,显然有个词是不好意思讲出口的,所以道出了文章的真实情况。这时不难对5题作出答复其答案是C。附录中学生英语学习常见错误一览表Aa[误]IthinkitisanusefulEnglishdictionary.[正]IthinkitisausefulEnglishdictionary.[析]在不定冠词a与an的用法中要注意的一点是:an用在以元音开头的词之前;而a则用在以辅音开头的词之前。要特别注意的是以u字母打头的单词,如useful,university等,其第一个音标是[j],所以要特别予以注意。[误]Ineedahourtofinishthisletter.[正]Ineedanhourtofinishthisletter.[析]要注意hour和honest的第一个字母不发音。[误]Myteacherisaunknownman,butheisaverygoodman.[正]Myteacherisanunknownman,butheisaverygoodman.[析]要注意以u打头的单词,它的发音为[]时,单数名词前要用an,如uncle等。[误]Thereisa"f"intheword"football".[正]Thereisan"f"intheword"football".[析]英文字母单独使用时,如其第一个发音是元音时,其前面的不定冠词应该用an而不是a.[误]Ihavealittlebrother.Heisa8yearoldboy.[正]Ihavealittlebrother.Heisan8yearoldboy.[析]要注意这些字母的第一个发音为元音,如eight,eleven等。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档able[误]Thisbikeisabletoberepaired.[正]Thisbikecanberepaired.[析]beableto主要表达某事或某人具有某种能力去作某事,应译为"有本领"、"有能力"、"可以"作某事,如:I"mabletoswimacrossthisriver.而can可以用来表示具有接受能力或吸收能力。如:Thisradiocanberepairedhere.about[误]Thisclassisabouttobeginjustnow.[正]Thisclassisabouttobegin.[析]要注意beaboutto是"将要"的意思,含有将来时之意,不要与表示过去时的时间状语连用。另外,beaboutto一般用作书面语,对应的口语是begoingto.aboutonabout与on都可以作"关于"讲,但却有所不同,例如:Thisbookisaboutphysics.应译为"这是一本关于物理学的科普读物。"而:Thisbookisonphysics.则应译为"这是一本物理学方面的专著。"above[误]Thetemperatureisfivedegreesoverzero.[正]Thetemperatureisfivedegreesabovezero.[析]表达"在……上方"时,above与over是可以互换的,如:Theskyisabove(orover)ourheads.但是要表达在垂直方向上的上方时则应用above不可用over,如:Thesunhasrisenabovethehorizon.[误]ThereisoftenthickcloudabovetheSouthofChinainsummer.[正]ThereisoftenthickcloudovertheSouthofChinainsummer.[析]当表达覆盖之意时,只可用over而不能用above.[误]Thereisabridgeabovetheriver.[正]Thereisabridgeovertheriver.[析]用来表达"从……上方越过"时不能用above只能用over,如:Theplaneflewoverthecity.但要注意Thereiswaterfallabovethebridge.则应译为"在桥的上游有一个瀑布。"3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档across[误]Heranacrossthewood.[正]Heranthroughthewood.[析]across是指某一动作在一平面内进行,而through则是指该动作在一三维立体空间的运动过程。如:Themancameinthroughthewindow.Hewalkedacrossthesquare.acrossacross的主要用法有两个。其一,意为"对面",如:Thereisaschooljustacrossthestreet.其二,意为"横过",如:Hewalkedacrossthestreet.afraid[误]Idont"tafraidofhim.[正]Iamnotafraidofhim.[析]要注意"害怕"afraid一词在英语中不是动词,而是形容词,要与be动词连用。after[误]Twoweeksafterheleft.[正]Twoweekslaterheleft.[正]Heleftaftertwoweeks.[析]要表达"在多少时间之后",英语中有两种表达法,即:用later时,要时间在前,如threehourslater;而用after时要时间在后,如afterthreehours.[误]Myfatherwillbebackafterafewhours.[正]Myfatherwillbebackinafewhours.[析]受中文的影响,这个介词常常被误用。当你要表达在一段时间内某个动作可以完成时,一定要用in,而不能用after,因为after是指在某一时间之后。例如:Thisworkwillbedoneintwodays.即表明在两天内这一工作一定会做完。而如用了after,即表示在两天之后,完成的时间是不确定的。afterbehindafter多用于表示顺序的前后,如:ShewalkedinthelineafterTom.或用来表示"追赶",表示一种动态,如:HeranafterMary.而behind多用于强调先进与落后,如:Sheismuchbehindtheothergirlsinsewing.或者用于表达"迟于",如:Thetrainwastenminutesbehindthetimetable.或者与表示静态的动词连用,如:Shehidherselfbehindtheflowers.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档afternoon[误]Heworkedveryhardinahotafternoon.[正]Heworkedveryhardonahotafternoon.[析]习惯用的词组intheafternoon,如果加入任何修饰词后其前面的介词in都要改为on,不论其修饰词在前还是在后,如:HeswaminthisriverontheafternoonofJunelst.又如:AreyoufreeonSundayafternoon?against[误]Heagainstme.[正]Heisagainstme.[析]要注意against意为"反对",但它在英文中却不是动词,而是介词,如要讲反对某事或某人时则要加动词be,如:Heisagainstsomebody/something.againstforagainst意为"反对"、"不赞成";而for则意为"同意",为其反意词。如:Areyoufororagainsttheplan?age[误]Heistwentyyearsoldofage.[正]Heistwenty.[正]Heistwentyyearsold.[正]Heisattheageoftwenty.ago[误]Tom"sfatherhasbeendeadfiveyearsago.[正]Tom"sfatherdiedfiveyearsago.[析]ago意为由说话时算起,若干时间以前。它只能和一般动词过去时连用,而不要与完成时连用。[误]YesterdayImetafriend.Wedidn"tseeeachotherforalongtimesinceweleftthecollegetwentyyearsago.[正]YesterdayImetafriend.Wehadn"tseeneachotherforalongtimesinceweleftthecollegetwentyyearsago.[析]要注意的是在本句是ago是用在由since引起的从句之中,只是从句应用过去时,但不影响主句的时态。agree[误]Doestheteacheragreetous?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Doestheteacheragreewithus?[误]Doesheagreewithourplan?[正]Doesheagreewithus?[析]agreewith指"同意某人的提议、建议、计划"等。如果要讲同意某项计划则要用agreeto,如:Doyouagreetotheplan?all[误]Theoldmanhastwosons.Allofthemareworkers.[正]Theoldmanhastwosons.Bothofthemareworkers.[析]all是指三者或以上的全部,而both则是指"两者都"。[误]Theallchildrenareplayingfootballnow.[正]Allthechildrenareplayingfootballnow.[析]all作修饰词时其位置要在所有的修饰词之前,不论这些修饰词是定冠词、指示代词、形容词或名词,或代词的所有格。[误]Youallareright.[正]Youareallright.[析]all作同位语时其位置要置于be动词之后,实意动词之前,如:Theteachersallworkhard.或用于第一助动词之后,如:Theboyshaveallbeenwaitingfortheirmothers.almost[误]Nearlynobodythinksheisright.[正]Almostnobodythinksheisright.[析]nearly与almost是近意词,其含意差别不大,但是与否定词连用时要用almost,例如:Shebroughtalmostnomoneywithher.此句中的almost不能用nearly替换。alone[误]Theoldmanlivedlonebuthedidn"tfeellonely.[正]Theoldmanlivedalone,buthedidn"tfeellonely.[析]alone,lone,lonely三个词全具有"孤单、孤独"之意。但其用法不同:lone可以作定语,而alone则只能作表语,lonely则多指感情上与感觉上的孤独。already[误]Wearealreadyforthework.[正]Weareallreadyforthework.[析]already是副词,其意为"已经",如:Healreadyknewaboutit.而all3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档ready为形容词意为"准备好"。alreadyyetalready多用于肯定句中,例如:Thestudentshavealreadyfinishedthework.而yet则多用于疑问句与否定句中,如:Haveyoufinishedityet?Ihaven"tfinishedityet.also[误]Ididn"tfindthedictionaryalso.[正]Ididn"tfindthedictionaryeither.[析]作为"也"讲,在否定句中要用either而不能用also.alsotooalso与too都可用在肯定句中表示"也",但also通常用于be动词或情态动词之后,如:Icanalsodoitmyself.而too一般放于句尾。I"llattendhisclass,too.always[误]Alwaysheaskedhimselfwhyhehadcomehere.[正]Healwaysaskedhimselfwhyhehadcomehere.[析]always一般不能用于句首,它在一般句中的位置是于动词之前第一助动词之后,如:I"vealwaysthoughtheishonest.又如:Heisalwayslate.among[误]Ifthethreeapplesaredividedamongthetwoboyshowmuchwilleachreceive?[正]Ifthethreeapplesaredividedamongthethreeboyshowmuchwilleachreceive?[析]among常用于三个事物或人物之间,而between则多用于两者之间。an[误]Thisisanusefuldictionary.[正]Thisisausefuldictionary.[析]详见a条。and[误]Hedidnotspeakloudlyandclearly.[正]Hedidnotspeakloudlynorclearly.[误]OurschoolisnotinNewYorkandChicago,butinBoston.[正]OurschoolisnotinNewYorkorChicago,butinBoston.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]"和"这一概念在肯定句中应用and,但在否定句中则要用orangry[误]Mymotherwasangrytome.[正]Mymotherwasangrywithme.[误]HewasangrywithwhatIsaid.[正]HewasangryatwhatIsaid.[析]要注意beangry后面如果接人,表示"对某人生气不满"时应用beangrywithsomebody.但要接事物时要用beangryatsomething.another[误]Ihavetwosisters,oneinAmericaandanotherinEnglish.[正]Ihavetwosisters,oneinAmericaandtheotherinEnglish.[析]要注意英语中another,other,theother,theothers,others的不同用法,现分别说明如下:another作形容词其意为:泛指的另一个或再一个,别的,类似的。一般在句中作定语,如:Thisisnotgoodenough,pleaseshowmeanotherone.another还可以作为代词用,如:Onestudentsaid:"Iwanttoplaybaskball."anothersaid:"Iwanttoplayfootball."other作形容词其意为"泛指其余的,别的"。如:Ihaveotherbooksbesidesthese.又如:Asksomeotherpeopleplease.theother则为特指,作形容词时其后面可接单数或复数名词,如:Shehastwoflowers.Oneiswhite,theotheroneisyellow.(特指,单数)又如:Therearefiftystudentsinourclass,twentyfiveareboys,theotherstudentsaregirls.(特指,复数)但当theother作为代词时,它代表的可以是单数,也可以是复数,如:Hehasabookinonehand,andapenintheother.(单数)又如:Therearesomepeopleintheroom.Fouraregirls,theother(复数)areboys.要注意的是当theother作主语时,其后面的谓语动词要视具体情况而定,它可能是单数,也可能是复数。others则只能作代词,其意为otherones即为:泛指某些,某一部分人或物,如:Eachofusmustthinkofothers.而theothers只能作为代词,它是特指某一些人或物,如:Iknowonlyoneortwoofthestudents;theothersareunknowntome.answer[误]Someoneisknockingatthedoor.Pleasereplythedoorbell.[正]Someoneisknockingatthedoor,Pleaseanswerthedoorbell.[析]answer与reply3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档是近意词,作为及物动词用时有时二者是可以互换的,如:Thestudentanswered/repliedthathewantedtowatchTV.但在某些特定场合则不易互换。作为应答之意时则多用answer,如:Youshouldanswertoyourname.Pleaseanswermyletterassoonaspossible.AnswermyquestioninEnglish.any[误]Doyouhavesomequestions?[正]Doyouhaveanyquestions?[析]some一般要用于肯定句,而any则用于否定句或疑问句。[误]ChinaislargerthananyothercountriesinAsia.[正]ChinaislargerthananyothercountryinAsia.[析]要注意anyother其后要跟单数名词,但anyoftheother其后要接复数名词。ChinaislargerthananyoftheothercountriesinAsia.[误]Herearesomebooks;youcanchooseanyoneofthese.[正]Herearesomebooks;youcanchooseanyoneofthese.[析]anyone只能指人,而anyone即可指人也可以指物。around[误]Thenineplanetsgoaroundofthesun.[正]Thenineplanetsgoaroundthesun.[析]around后面不要再加介词,如:Thesunshinesallaroundus.aroundround作介词用的around与round通常可以互换,只不过美语常用around,而英语常用round,例如:Youcanseethepostofficeround/aroundthatcorner.(绕过那个弯你就可以看到邮局。但是一定要区别它们的不同之处:round可以用作形容词、副词、介词、动词、名词;而around只能用作副词或介词。例如:Thepostofficeisjustround(around)thehouse(用作介词).Hehasroundface(用作形容词).Theriverroundedthestones.(用作动词)arrive[误]IarrivedBeijingthedaybeforeyesterday.[正]IarrivedinBeijingthedaybeforeyesterday.[正]IreachedBeijingthedaybeforeyesterday.[误]Hearrivedintheschoolat11∶00.[正]Hearrivedattheschoolat11∶00.[析]arrive为不及物动词,当到达的是较大的地理区域时用介词in3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档,而到达较小的地方时则用at,如:arriveinNewYork,arriveatthevillage.arrivereachgetarrive如上所述是不及物动词,而reach则是及物动词。如:Howdidyoureachtheschoolthismorning?而get可用作不及物动词,作"到达"讲时其后面多与to连用。如:WhendidyougettoNewYork?as[误]Thismanworksinthebankforamanager.[正]Thismanworksinthebankasamanager.[析]as与for有时是可以通用的。如:Thisroomisusedas(for)aclassroom.但是用来指官衔、职位时只能用as.[误]MybrotherissotallerasTom.[正]MybrotherisastallasTom.[析]as…as之间只能用形容词与副词的原级,而不能用比较级。在否定句中可以用so…as,也可以用as…as,但在肯定句中只能用as…as,如:HeisnotsotallasTom.[误]I"llgivehimthenoteassoonashewillcome.[正]I"llgivehimthenoteassoonashecomes.[析]assoonas所引导的状语从句中应使用一般时态表示将来。ask[误]Thestudentaskedaquestiontotheteacher.[正]Thestudentaskedtheteacheraquestion.[析]ask应接双宾语,即asksomebodysomething.[误]Theyaskedsomebooks.[正]Theyaskedforsomebooks.[析]向某人要求某物时应用asksomebodyforsomething或askforsomethingfromsomebody,如:Heaskedhismotherforsomemoney.或Heaskedforsomemoneyfromhismother.asleep[误]Heisdeeplyasleep.[正]Heisfastasleep.[析]要讲"熟睡",就要用fast来修饰asleep。另外,在英语中一般不讲somebodyissleeping而要用asleep。关于睡觉这一词的惯用法还有:gotosleep(如:Theoldmanusuallygoestosleepatten.),fallasleep(如:Ifell3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档asleepatEnglishclassyesterday.)at[误]Itwillreallydoyounoharmquite.[正]Itwillreallydoyounoharmatall.[析]atall和quite的汉语意思均为"全然"、"确定的",但atall适用于否定句,例如:-I"msorry.I"mlate.-Notroubleatall.又如:Idon"tthinkitisrightatall.而quite则适用于肯定句,例如:Heisquiteagoodteacher.[误]Thechildrenplayfootballforlunch.[正]Thechildrenplayfootballatlunch.[析]英语中的atlunch为"在吃午饭时"。这种惯用法还有atwork(在工作),attable(在吃饭),atdesk(在学习)。而forlunch则是为午饭而准备的食物,又如:Wehadsomemilkforbreakfast.[误]Thereisapostofficeinthecornerofthestreet.[正]Thereisapostofficeatthecornerofthestreet.[析]atthecorner是指墙外面的角,而inthecorner是指建筑物内部的角落。例如:Thereisacomputerinthecorneroftheroom.Thereisastreetlampatthecornerofthestreet.atinon在表示时间时用来表示具体钟点用at,如:HewillbebackatsiG.表示一天的上、下午时要用in,如:IusuallygetupatsiGinthemorning.但要注意的是,inthemorning和intheafternoon这两个词组中如果加入了任何修饰词,其介词要换为on,如:onthecoldmorning,onthehotafternoon.又如:SeeyouonMondaymorning.如讲到具体的某一天,要用on,如:onSunday,如:IusuallywanttovisitmymotheronSundays.在谈到周、月、季、年时要用in,如:AllthechildrenwillbehappyinEasterweek.HewasborninJuly.但要注意在泛指圣诞节、复活节、感恩节时都用at,如:WhereareyougoingatEaster.Bback3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]I"msorry.Ihavetobackhome.[正]I"msorry.Ihavetogobackhome.[正]I"msorry.Ihavetogohome.[析]back用作"回到(某处)"之意,不是动词。be[误]Wheredoyoufrom?[正]Whereareyoufrom?[析]"你从何处来"应为Whereareyoufrom?或Wheredoyoucomefrom?但要注意这两句话均是问对方从哪个国家来的。要是口语中问"你是从什么地方来?"应讲Wheredidyoucomefrom?回答用Icamefromthelibrary.beat[误]Wehavewonyourclass.[正]Wehavebeatenyourclass.[正]Wehavewonthegame.[析]win是胜过之意,它是及物动词,但其后的宾语只能接比赛、战争、奖品、奖金的名称,如:Whichteamwonthefootballmatch?而beat指打败对手、敌人……如:Mybrotherbeatmeatpoker.(要注意的是,beat的过去式与原形相同,而过去分词为beaten)。[误]Theballbeatmebadly.[正]Theballhitmebadly.[误]Heusedtohitthelittleboyblackandblue.[正]Heusedtobeatthelittleboyblackandblue.[析]beat指打击多次,而hit则为击中对方的一次性打击。beautiful[误]Heisabeautifulboy.[正]Heisahandsomeboy.[析]我们可以讲Sheisabeautifulgirl.Thisisabeautifulpark.但要讲男人的"英俊"时要用handsome.because[误]ThereasonwhyIwaslateisbecauseIwasill.[正]ThereasonwhyIwaslateisthatIwasill.[误]BecauseitwasSunday,sotheparkwascrowded.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]BecauseitwasSundaytheparkwascrowded.[析]这种错误是因为中文的习惯与英语的表述法不同,中文常讲我来晚了的原因是因为我病了,而英文中的第二个因为要用that代替。又因中文常讲因为……所以……,而英文中用了因为就不能再用所以了,同样用了"所以"也就不要再用"因为"一词。例如:Becausewestudyhard,wepassedtheeGameasily.或者:WestudyhardsowepassedtheeGameasily.becausebecauseofbecause后要接从句,例如:Welikephysicsbecausewecanlearnalotofnewideas.而becauseof后要接名词作介词宾语,如:Heisnotatschoolbecauseoftheillness.before[误]Wehavetwohourstokillbeforewewillgohome.[正]Wehavetwohourstokillbeforewegohome.[析]killtime意为"消磨时光"。英语状语从句中要用一般现在时表示将来的动作。如:Ifitrainswewillnotgotothepark.[误]Ididthisworktwodaysbefore.[正]Ididthisworktwodaysago.[析]用ago组成的时间状语其主句中的谓语动词要用过去时,而before引起的时间状语其主句中的谓语动词多用完成时,如:Ihasdonethisworkafewdaysbefore.beforelonglongbeforebeforelong是"不久"之意,例如:IshallgotoAmericabeforelong.而longbefore则是"很久很久"之意,如:Weknewthisteacherlongbeforewesawhim.(我们在看到这位老师之前很久就知道他了。)begin[误]ThemeetingwillbeginfromMonday.[正]ThemeetingwillbeginonMonday.[误]Thefilmhasbegunfortenminutes.[正]Thefilmhasbeenonfortenminutes.[析]begin是瞬间动词,所以它的完成时态不能接表示一段时间的状语,如:Thefilmhasbegun.这句话是对的,即"电影已经开始"。但要讲已经开始10分钟了则要用hasbeenon即"上演了10分钟"。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档beginstartbegin与start两词后面加不定式或动名词都可以,且意思并无区别,但在表达习惯时接动名词的用法较多,如:HowoldwernyouwhenyoufirststartedlearningEnglish?但这两个词的进行时态中则多用不定式,如:Iwasbeginningtogethungry.但如果句子的主语是物而不是人,则多用不定式,如:Theicebegantomelt.Itstartedtogetdarkbeforewegottoschool.当动词是表达某种心理状态时,要用不定式,如:Thestudentbegantounderstandhismistakes.[误]Theystudyhardintheclassfromthebeginningtotheend.[正]Theystudyhardintheclassfrombeginningtoend.[析]frombeginningtoend是习惯用法,即自始至终,不要加冠词,但如单独使用则要加冠词,例如:Atthebeginning,theteachergaveusaneGam.behind[误]Hemissedtheclassbecausehewasbehindthetime.[正]Hemissedtheclassbecausehewasbehindtime.[析]behindtime一短语意为"晚了",而behindthetimes意为"落后于时代"。behind是介词同时又是副词,如Comeoutfrombehindthedoor(介词).He"salongwaybehind(副词).Hefellbehindwithhisclassmates(副词).below[误]What"sthatbelowthechair.[正]What"sthatunderthechair.[析]under意为"正下方",而below意为"比……低",或指"在下游"。如:Thereisafallbelowtheriver.(河的下游有一个瀑布。)其反义词为over,如:Thereisabigplaneflyingoverthecity.但在"下面的例子"一表达语中则要用theeGamplebelow,而不要用under.beside[误]Thestudentsstoodbesidestheteacher.[正]Thestudentsstoodbesidetheteacher.[误]IstudyEnglishbesideChinese.[正]IstudyEnglishbesidesChinese.[析]beside意为"在……旁边",而besides是"除……以外(还如何)"。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档besidebynearbeside意为"在……旁",如:Thereisatalltreebesidetheriver.by多指"倚、靠"、"沿着"之意,如:Sheisstandingbythewindow.near多用来表示两地间距离不远,如:Thereisapostofficenearourschool.better[误]Youhadbettertodoitathome.[正]Youhadbetterdoitathome.[误]Youhadn"tbetterwakemeupatsiG.[正]YouhadbetternotwakemeupatsiG.[析]hadbetter在肯定句中为"应该作某事",其后加不带to的不定式,而在否定句中应用hadbetter+not+动词原形。在简答语中had常省略为"d,如:You"dbetternot.又如:Let"sgofirst.No,we"dbetternot.between[误]Amongthetwotreesthereisaspaceofthefeet.[正]Betweenthetwotreesthereisaspaceofthefeet.[析]两者之间多用between,三者或三者以上之间则用among.[误]Youmustchoosebetweenthiscluborthatclub.[正]Youmustchoosebetweenthisclubandthatclub.[析]在两个之间作出选择要用between…and…,而不能用between…or….big[误]Therewasabigrainlastnight.[正]Therewasaheavyrainlastnight.[析]大雨在英语中只能用aheavyrain而不要用abigrain.bit[误]Heisabitfool.[正]Heisabitofafool.[析]abit可以作程度副词,与alittle相同,但它用于名词前应用abitof,而用于形容词前则应用abit,如:I"mabittired,而其简答的否定句应为Notabit,(一点儿也不。)又如:-DoyoumindifIopenthedoor?-Notabit.black3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Thechildrenbecameblackafterswimminginthesea.[正]Thechildrenbecamesunburnedafterswimminginthesea.[析]因太阳照晒而皮肤变黑,不应用black而应用sunburned,suncolour或dark.[误]Thegirlhasblackeyesandblackhair.[正]Thegirlhasdarkeyesandblackhair.[析]英语中blackeyes的意思是被打得发青的眼睛。[误]TheEuropeanslikeredtea.[正]TheEuropeanslikeblacktea.[析]红茶在英文中应为blacktea.这种惯用法还有:blackandblue(鼻青脸肿,青一块紫一块);blackandwhite(黑白电视片)。goblack意为"在失去知觉时眼前一片黑暗";lookblack意为"情况不妙,前景暗淡"。如:Afterthefighthewasblackandblue.OnTV,Ilikecolourforsomethingandblackandwhiteforothers.body[误]Goingtobedearlierandgettingupearlierisgoodforyourbody.[正]Goingtobedearlierandgettingupearlierisgoodforyourhealth.[析]中文常讲对你身体有利,而英文中则讲对你健康有利。borrow[误]MayIlendsomebooksfromthelibrary?[正]MayIborrowsomebooksfromthelibrary?[误]HowlongcanIborrowit?[正]HowlongcanIkeepit?[析]英语中有三个词都可译为"借",但意义各不相同如:"借入"是borrow,其常用句型结构是borrowsomethingfromsomebody,这是个瞬间性动词,不可与表示延续的时间状语连用。例如:Thestudentswanttoborrowsomebooksfromthelibrary."借出"用lend,即借给别人东西。其常用句型是lendsomebodysomething,或lendsomethingtosomebody.例如:Couldyoulendusyourdictionary?或Couldyoulendyourdictionarytous?它也是瞬间性动词,也不能与延续的时间状语连用。keep3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档则是延续性动词,可以和表示长时间段的时间状语连用,也可与howlong等疑问词连用,如:Youcankeepitforthreedays.born(bear的过去分词)[误]IborninShanghai.[正]IwasborninShanghai.[误]HewasbornfromGreekparents.[正]HewasbornofGreekparents.[析]"出身于……样的家庭"不要作from而要用of,例如:Hewasbornofapoorfamily.both[误]Theybotharestudents.[正]Theyarebothstudents.[误]Theyrefusebothtoanswerthisquestion.[正]Theybothrefusetoanswerthisquestion.[析]both作同位语时,一般要用在be动词之后实意动词之前。[误]Iknowhisbothparents.[正]Iknowbothhisparents.[误]Thebothbrotherswerestudents.[正]Boththebrotherswerestudents.[正]Bothbrotherswerestudents.[析]当both与形容词性物主代词my,his,her等以及定冠词the连用时,都应将这些词置于both之后。另外,在与定冠词连用时the可以省略。[误]Bothofmyparentsarenotathome.[正]Neitherofmyparentsareathome.[误]Bothofyouranswersarenotright.[正]Neitherofyouranswersisright.[正]Bothyouranswersarewrong.[析]both不能用于否定句中作主语。表示"两者都不"时要用neither;但作宾语时both与either则都对,但要注意句意有所不同。例如:Icannotgivebothofthebookstoyou.(我不能将两本书全给你。)而Icannotgiveeitherofthebookstoyou.(两本书中哪本书也不能给你。)bring[误]PleasebringthisdictionarytoMrBrown.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]PleasetakethisdictionarytoMrBrown.[误]NeGttime,pleasetakeyourlittlesisterhere.[正]NeGttime,pleasebringyourlittlesisterhere.[析]英语中bring是"带来",而take是"带走"。还有一个词fetch,表示"到某处去把某物取、接回来"。如:Pleasefetchthedoctoratonce.business[误]MyfatherwenttoShanghaiforbusiness.[正]MyfatherwenttoShanghaionbusiness.[析]onbusiness出差busy[误]ThestudentswereverybusytopreparefortheeGam.[正]ThestudentswereverybusypreparingfortheeGam.[析]bebusydoingsomething为"忙于作某事"[误]ThestudentswerebusyfortheeGam.[正]ThestudentswerebusywiththeeGam.[析]busy直接接名词时应用with.but[误]Hecouldn"thelpbutrealizingthathewaswrong.[正]Hecouldn"thelpbutrealizethathewaswrong.[误]Shecouldn"thelptocrywhenshesawhermother.[正]Shecouldn"thelpcryingwhenshesawhermother.[析]couldn"thelp其后应接动名词,表示情不自禁的动作,但couldn"thelpbut后面要加动词原形即省to的不定式,所以前一句应译为"他才真正认识到他错了。"buy[误]Ihaveboughtthisdictionaryforthreeyears.[正]Ihavehadthisdictionaryforthreeyears.[析]buy是截止性(即瞬间)动词,它可以有完成时,如:Ihaveboughtthisdictionary.但是不能与表示较长的时间状语连用。如要讲我这本字典已买了3年了则要用havehad这一结构即我拥有这本字典已3年了。by[误]Theboyshotthecatbyagun.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Theboyshotthecatwithagun.[误]HecametoschoolbyataGithismorning.[正]HecametoschoolbytaGithismorning.[析]作为某种运输手段来讲,by与名词间不能有冠词,如:bycar,bybike,byair等。如有了冠词或其他修饰词,则应用别的相应的介词,如:"我们今天早上是乘他的车来的"一句应译为:Wecamehereinhiscarthismorning.与by结合而成的词组很多,常用的有:bytheway顺便说说;byhand手工制作;byoneself独自地;bynomeans决不。Ccall[误]I"llcallatMrBrown.[正]I"llcallonMrBrown.[误]I"llcallonMrBrown"shome.[正]I"llcallatMrBrown"shome.[析]作"拜访"讲时,at后面接访问地点,而on后面接访问的人。callondropinvisitcallon比较正式的为公务的访问,如:Wewerecalledonbytheoldstudents.而dropin则是比较随便的走走,顺便拜访,如:Ifyou"refree,dropin.而visit则是更正式的外交访问或友好往来,如:Myschool"sheadmasterwillvisitAmericaneGtweek.can[误]Ablindmancannotjudgecolours.[正]Ablindmancannotjudgecolours.[误]Icann"tcallforyouatten.[正]Ican"tcallforyouatten.[析]can的否定形式应为cannot或can"t.[误]It"sonlysiGo"clock.Thatmustn"tbethepostman.[正]It"sonlysiGo"clock.Thatcan"tbethepostman.[析]must用来表示一种肯定的推断,如:Shemusthavesomeproblems.Shekeepscrying.但在否定句中则要用can"t,3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档要表示对过去的推测则要用"must+have+过去分词"的表达法,如:Thelightshavegoneout.Afusemusthaveblown.而对过去的否定推测则多用"can"t+have+过去分词",如:Idon"tthinkhecanhaveheardyou.Callagain.[误]Wecouldnothelptolaughatonce.[正]Wecouldnothelplaughingatonce.[正]Wecouldnothelpbutlaughatonce.[析]"couldn"thelp+动名词"表示禁不住做了某事。但couldnothelpbut与couldnotbut后面要加不带to的不定式,意思都是不得不去做某事.如:Youcouldnot(help)butrespecthim.canbeabletocan与beableto都可以用来表示能力,但can只有现在时与过去时,beableto则可用任何时态,如:Hewillbeabletoteachthechild.但要表示经过努力而达到的一次性动作则只能用beableto,如:Hefinallywasabletojumpover210meters.或:Theplanewasabletoflyoverthemountain.但要注意的是这两个词都没有进行时态,而beableto后面不接不定式的被动态。cancouldcan与could都可以用在现在时的口语中,只是用could更为礼貌,语气更委婉。如:Couldyoutellusastory?care[误]Idon"tcarecoffee.[正]Idon"tcareforcoffee.[误]Takecareforyoursteps.[正]Takecareofyoursteps.[析]carefor是"对某物感兴趣",而careof是"关心,要当心某事",如:Shedidn"tcareforhim.Takecareofwhatyouaredoing.[误]Idon"tcarewherewewillgoifitdoesn"train.[正]Idon"tcarewherewegoifitdoesn"train.[析]在itdoesn"tmatter,Idon"tcare,Idon"tmind,及incase引出的状语从句后面要用现在时表示将来。如:I"vegotafootballincasewehavetimeforagame.change[误]Iwanttochangemycamerawiththatone.[正]Iwanttochangemycameraforthatone.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]changefor为"以某物为交换物"。而changewith则是"随……而变",如:Thewood"scolourchangedwiththeseason.cheap[误]Ateacher"ssalaryisgenerallyverycheap.[正]Ateacher"ssalaryisgenerallyverylow.[析]工资的高低要用low,cheap是指价格便宜,如果要讲物美价廉则要用noteGpensive,如:ThiscarisnoteGpensive.choose[误]WeeachhadtohaveachooseofAorB.[正]WeeachhadtohaveachoiceofAorB.[析]choice是名词,而choose是动词。class[误]TheclassiswatchingTV.[正]TheclassarewatchingTV.[析]class作主语时,如果作为整体讲则应用单数形式的谓语动词,如:Theclasswasmorethanfortyinnumber.如考虑到具体的每个成员时则应用复数形式的谓语动词,如:Theclassare,ingeneral,verybright.clean[误]Sorry,Ididn"tboughtithere.Icleanlyforgot.[正]Sorry,Ididn"tboughtithere.Icleanforgot.[析]clean可以作为副词讲,其意为"完全",而cleanly则意为"正确地"、"干净利落地",如:Theknifedoesn"tcutcleanly.而clean作为形容词讲时意为"清洁的"、"干净的",如:Herfaceisnotcleannow.clever[误]I"mnotcleverinEnglish.[正]I"mnotcleveratEnglish.[析]cleverat是固定搭配,表示在某方面有特长。close[误]Itiscoldoutside.Pleasekeepthedoorclose.[正]Itiscoldoutside.Pleasekeepthedoorclosed.[析]这里的close是动词,意为"关闭",而keep后要加形容词,所以要用close的过去分词形式closed作形容词。作形容词用的close意为"近的"、"亲密的"。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]ComecloselysothatIcanseeyou.[正]ComeclosesothatIcanseeyou.[误]Goodteachingandgoodtestingarecloserelated.[正]Goodteachingandgoodtestingarecloselyrelated.[析]close,closely同样可以作副词用,但其意义不同,close是"靠近"、"接近"之意,而closely则是"紧密"、"严密"、"密切"之意。[误]Myschoolwasquiteclosefrommyhome.[正]Myschoolwasquiteclosetomyhome.[析]"与……接近"是closeto…,例如:Hewasclosetofifty.Thereisabusstopclosetothestation.closeshutturnshut与close是同义词,如closethedoor或shutthedoor.但要讲把某人关在门外时则只能用shutsomebodyout而不能用close,因shut语气较强,并含有隔离之意。而turnoff是指关上电视、电灯、煤气之类,有切断之意。cloth[误]Thechildrenwearverygoodclothtogotoschool.[正]Thechildrenwearverygoodclothestogotoschool.[误]Ineedalotofclothing.I"mgoingtomakeanewcloth.[正]Ineedalotofcloth.I"mgoingtomakeanewdress.[析]cloth是"布"、"布料",没有复数形式。一块布料是apieceofcloth,而clothes统指衣服,是复数名词,"一套衣服"要讲asuitofclothes,如果是"一件件衣服"应讲shirt,dress,sweater等。而clothing是衣物的总称,是不可数名词。例如:Thisclothingisneededinwarmcountries.Herclothesaremadeoffinecloth.英语中的dress是指比较正式的服装,如aschooldress(校服),astudentdress(学生套装),aworkingdress(工作服)。coffee[误]Pleasegivemetwowaters.[正]Pleasegivemetwocoffees.[正]Pleasegivemetwocupsofwater.[析]虽然coffee,water,tea等都是物质名词,但是只有coffee可用coffees3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档取代若干杯coffee,而其他的却不行,其前要加acupof或aglassof.colour(color)[误]Coloursofflowersarered,yellowandwhite.[正]Flowersarered,yellowandwhite.[析]中文的"花的颜色有红色、黄色和白色",若译为英文Coloursofflowersare…,就显得重复了。[误]Ilikegreencolour.[正]Ilikegreen.[正]Ilikecolourgreen.[析]colourgreen中的colour是green的同位语,所以这种说话方式英语是可以接受的。come[误]Icameacrosswithanoldfriendinthestreetyesterday.[正]Icameacrossanoldfriendinthestreetyesterday.[析]comeacross是"偶然碰见、遇见",要直接加宾语,如:I"vejustcomeacrossabeautifulpoeminthismagazine.[误]Wheredoyoucomefrom?Icomefromthestation.[正]Wheredidyoucomefrom?Icamefromthestation.[正]Wheredoyoucomefrom?IcomefromChina.[析]Wheredoyoucomefrom?意为"你是什么地方的人?"而Wheredidyoucomefrom?则是"你从何处来?"[误]Thestarsarecomingoutfromthecloud.[正]Thestarsarecomingoutofthecloud.[析]comeoutof意为"从……地方出来"。comeincomeintoentercomein与comeinto的意义相同,但comeinto后面要加宾语,而comein后面不用宾语。如Ifoundsomeonecameintomyroom.Thedooropenedandthechildcamein.enter常作为及物动词使用,如:ThebusenteredtheEnglishtunnel.congratulate3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Iwanttocongratulateyouforyoursuccesswithallmyheart.[正]Iwanttocongratulateyouonyoursuccesswithallmyheart.[析]动词congratulatesomebodyonsomething是"向某人祝贺某事"。其名词congratulation在用时一般要用复数,如:Iofferedhimmycongratulationsonhissuccess.又如:Congratulations!cook[误]Myfatherisagoodcooker.[正]Myfatherisagoodcook.[析]很多动词加上er则变为执行该动作的一种人,如workworker,teachteacher.但cook即是动词"做饭",同时名词也是"厨师"。而cooker则是"厨具"、"炊具"之意。如:Iwillcookthedinner.Iboughtagoodpresscooker(高压锅)。corner[误]Thereisapostofficeinthecornerofthestreet.[正]Thereisapostofficeatthecornerofthestreet.[误]Agirlsatatthecorneroftheroom.[正]Agirlsatinthecorneroftheroom.[析]inthecorner是在建筑物内部的角上,而atthecorner是在外部的角上,如:Thereisabigtreeatthecornerofthebuilding.cost[误]Icosttendollarsforthebook.[正]Ispenttendollarsonthebook.[误]Icosttwohourstodomyhomework.[正]Ittookmetwohourstodomyhomework.[析]cost,spend.take都可以作"花费"讲,但用法不同。cost的用法是"something+cost+somebody+时间或金钱",如:Thebookcostmetendollars.spend的用法是"somebody+spend+时间+(in)doingsomething",如:Ispenttwohours(in)writingthisbook.或"somebody+spend+金钱+onsomething",如:Ispendtwodollarsonthisbook.而take的用法则要用逻辑主语it:"It+takes+somebody+时间+todosomething",如:Ittookmeanhourtocleantheclassroom.country3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Youcanfindcowsinacountry.[正]Youcanfindcowsinthecountry.[析]country即可作"国家"讲,也可作"农村"讲。当作"农村"讲时,一定要加定冠词,而且只有单数形式。例如:[误]Farmersliveinthecountries.[正]Farmersliveinthecountry.[析]但作为"国家"讲时则可有单、复数形式,例如:JapanisanAsiancountry.Japan,China,andIndiaareAsiancountries.另外,country一般指的是地理概念上的国家,如:NewZealandisanagriculturalcountry.而nation多指民族组成的国家,如:TheChinesenation(中华民族)。state多侧重于政权方面的区域、国家范围,如:thestatefarm(国营农场)。cross[误]Therearetrafficlightsatthecross.[正]Therearetrafficlightsatthecrossing.[析]cross作为名词讲时是十字架、十字形的东西,如:RedCross(红十字会)。[误]Thelittleboyisgoingtoacrossthestreet.[正]Thelittleboyisgoingtocrossthestreet.[析]across是副词或介词,但不能作动词用。crosspasscross是指横过某地,如:Hecrossedthesquare.而pass则强调从某物体旁经过,如:ImailedsomeletterswhenIpassedthepostoffice.crowd[误]Theroomsoonwascrowdedbypeople.[正]Theroomsoonwascrowdedwithpeople.[析]crowded在这句话中应作为形容词,所以这句话不是被动语态而是系表结构,如:Theroomwascrowdedwithbooks.cup[误]Asilverglasswasgiventothewinner.[正]Asilvercupwasgiventothewinner.[误]Mymotherwaslookingforthewhiskycup.[正]Mymotherwaslookingforthewhiskyglass.[析]glass一般指由玻璃制成的器皿,而cup多指用陶瓷或金属制成的杯子,3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档且cup尤其用在奖杯上。喝酒多用的是玻璃制成的杯子,如我们讲Idrinkaglassofwineatsupper.而不讲Idrinkacupofwineatsupper.Ddance[误]We"llinviteyouandyourwifetoadanceparty.[正]We"llinviteyouandyourwifetoadancingparty.[正]We"llinviteyouandyourwifetoadance.[正]We"llinviteyouandyourwifetoaball.(美语中常用ball作为舞会。)date[误]Hestudiedtenhoursadate.[正]Hestudiedtenhoursaday.[析]date是指具体日期。如问What"sthedatetoday?应回答具体日期:"October1st1998."而day是指1日(24小时)。如Whatdayistoday?问的是星期几,应回答"It"sSunday."[误]Today"sdateisJanuaryfirst.1998.[正]Today"sdateisJanuary1,1998.[正]Today"sdateisJanuary1st,1998.[析]在日期书写中不要用序数词全写,而要用1st,2nd,3rd……如果一定要用序数词,其顺序应为:ItisthefirstofJanuary.day[误]ThisisabookabouteverydayEnglish.[正]ThisisabookabouteverydayEnglish.[正]ThisisaneverydayEnglishbook.[误]Wegotoschooleveryday.[正]Wegotoschooleveryday.[析]everyday是形容词,意为"日常的",而everyday则是"每天"、"天天"之意。dead[误]Myfatherhasdiedfortenyears.[正]Myfatherhasbeendeadfortenyears.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]die是瞬间动词,它可以用于完成时,如:Myfatherhasdied.但用于完成时不能与表示一段时间的状语连用。它也可以用于过去时,如:Myfatherdiedthreeyearsago[误]We"llalwaysrememberthedeadswhowerekilledinthewar.[正]We"llalwaysrememberthedeadwhowerekilledinthewar.[析]形容词前如加定冠词表示一类人,如therich(富人),thesick(病人),thepoor(穷人),其后的谓语动词要用复数,如:Thericharenotalwayshappy.deaddeadlydead在某些词组里是"完全"、"的确"的意思,如deadright,deadtired,deadsure。而deadly则是"致命的",如:Therichmanhadmanydeadlyenemies.又如:Cancerisadeadlydisease.deaddieddead是形容词,如:MrsGintywasdead.而died是动词die的过去式及过去分词,如:Shediedin1960.但英语中如表达出对某人去世的伤感说法是passaway,如:Myfatherpassedaway,thismorning.deer[误]Inthezoo,therearemanydeers.[正]Inthezoo,therearemanydeer.[析]deer是单、复数同形的词,如:onedeer,twodeer,这样的名词还有fish,sheep等。但如果讲Therearemanyfisheshere.这句话应译为"这里有许多种鱼类。"而不应译为"这里有很多鱼。"desk[误]Theboysatinhisdesk.[正]Theboysatathisdesk.[析]在课桌旁坐着应用介词at,而atdesk则应译为"在学习",attable应译为"在吃饭"。die[误]InSouthAfricamanypeoplediedfromcancer.[正]InSouthAfricamanypeoplediedofcancer.[误]Theoldmandiedofoverwork.[正]Theoldmandiedfromoverwork.[析]死于疾病应用dieof,而死于某种外因事故则多用from.[误]Hismotherisdied.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Hismotherisdead.[误]Theoldwomanwasdeadattheageofseventy.[正]Theoldwomandiedattheageofseventy.[析]dead是形容词,而die是动词。形容词表示状态,动词则表示动作。[误]Hediedinatrafficaccident.[正]Hewaskilledinatrafficaccident.[析]由于事故而造成的死亡一般用tobekilled.[误]Whenthedoctorcame,theoldmanhadalreadydied.[正]Whenthedoctorcame,theoldmanwasalreadydead.[正]Theoldmandiedbeforethedoctorcame.different[误]Myroomisdifferentwithyours.[正]Myroomisdifferentfromyours.[误]Thevillageisverydifferentwithwhatitwas.[正]Thevillageisverydifferentfromwhatitwas.[析]differentfrom是"与……不同"之意。difficult[误]Englishisverydifficulttobelearned.[正]Englishisverydifficulttolearn.[误]Helearnedphysicsisdifficult.[正]Itisverydifficultforhimtolearnphysics.[析]要学习英语的表达法而不要生硬地按字去译中文。Itisdifficultforsomebodytodosomething.为"对于某人来说做某事很困难。"difficulty[误]Therewaslittledifficultytofindhim.[正]Therewaslittledifficultyinfindinghim.[析]这种用法还有trouble,即difficulty(trouble)indoingsomething.dinner[误]Whendidyouhavethesupper?[正]Whendidyouhavesupper?[析]英语中一日三餐前无冠词,例如:[误]Ihadalunchat12o"clock.[正]Ihadlunchat12o"clock.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]在某些特定场合,如指某次宴会,则要加冠词,如:Thedinnerwasgiveninhonouroftheguest.dress[误]Myfatherboughtanewdressforhimselfyesterday.[正]Myfatherboughtanewsuitforhimselfyesterday.[析]一般来讲男套装用suit,女服则用dress;作男服的服装店是tailorshop(tailor"s),而做女装的服装店是dressmaker"s.[误]Themotherdressedtheclothesonherchild.[正]Themotherdressedherchild.[析]dress作及物动词当"穿衣服"讲时,其后不能接衣服而只能接人,如:Theboyisstilltooyoungtodresshimself.但作为一种穿着打扮的状态时,则多用其过去分词作形容词,如:Heisnotdressedinhisnewsuit.或Sheisdressedinred.词组dressup是过节日时应服装整齐,如:Theydressedupfortheholiday.dresshaveonputonwear要区别这几个动词需分清是表示动作的动词还是表示状态的动词。表示状态的动词是haveon和wear,如:Hehasonawhitecoat.Hewaswearingheavyshoes.而puton则表示穿衣的动作,如:Putonyourcoat,itiscoldoutside.而dress即可以作状态又可以作动作,作动作讲时其后面接人而不能接衣服,作穿着状态时则多用dressed的形式。如:Isawaladydressedinred.Isawagirldressingherself.drop[误]Thestudentsfelltheirvoice.[正]Thestudentsdroppedtheirvoice.[析]drop与fall都可以表示"落下、掉下"之意,有时可以互换,如:Thedictionaryfell(dropped)fromthetable.但drop还可以作及物动词,而fall一般只能作不及物动词。[误]Ishalldropinyou.[正]Ishalldropinonyou.[析]dropin是随便拜访某人,而其后要接人时应加介词on再加人称。during[误]DuringIwassick,Icouldn"teatwell.[正]WhileIwassick,Icouldn"teatwell.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]during后不能接从句,而when和while后可接从句。[误]IhavebeenstudyingEnglishduringthreedays.[正]IhavebeenstudyingEnglishforthreedays.[析]during不能表达一个动作持续多长的时间,而只能表达在某段时间内某事件的发生。即带有由during引导的时间状语的句子只能用过去时,不能用完成时。Eeach[误]Everyofthemhashishabit.[正]Eachofthemhashishabit.[析]each可以作形容词,但也可作代词,而every只能作形容词。[误]ThemanagercomestoAmericaalmosteachmonth.[正]ThemanagercomestoAmericaalmosteverymonth.[析]each与every都作形容词讲时,都有"每个"之意,但有不同。each多指个体,而every则多指整体。如:Wewanteverystudenttosucceed.each不同来表达总体概念,所以不能与almost,nearly,likely等词连用。[误]Weeachhasabook.[正]Weeachhaveabook.[析]each作同位语时,其数应与其同位的名词相同,而each作主语时则应取其单数形式。eachotheroneanothereachother与oneanother这两个词组的区别在很多语法书中强调eachother是两者之间,而oneanother是多者之间,其实不然,如:Allstudentsmustcareforeachother,mustloveandhelpeachother.事实上这两个词组是同义的,如果要讲有什么区别的话,当我们非常笼统地谈,而不特指什么人时,多用oneanother.early[误]Couldyoucomeheremoreearly?[正]Couldyoucomehereearlier?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]单音节和少数双音节副词的比较级和最高级要用er和est来作其结尾,如fast,soon,early,hard,long,near等。earth[误]Whatontheearthdoyoumean?[正]Whatonearthdoyoumean?[析]onearth这一词组在句中为的是加强语气,其意为"究竟"、"到底"。而作为"地球"讲时则要加定冠词,如:Howfaristheearthfromthemoon.而作为"泥土"讲时则为不可数名词,如:Hefilledthepotwithearthandwantedtoplantsomeflowers.easy[误]Youcaneasyimaginemysurprise.[正]Youcaneasilyimaginemysurprise.[析]easy只在有限的词组中被用作副词,如takeiteasy(不要紧张),goeasy,standeasy等。例如:Easycome,easygo.(钱来的容易花的也快.)Easiersaidthandone.(说的容易做着难。)east[误]JapanisontheeastofChina.[正]JapanistotheeastofChina.[析]在讲述地理位置时,有3个介词常用,它们是in,on和to,其中in表示处于所表达的范围之内,如:ShanghaiisintheeastofChina.on则表示双方接壤,如:NorthKoreaisonthenortheastofChina.而表示互不相接的两部分时则用to,如:TaiwanistotheeastofFujian.either[误]-Idon"tlikeopera.-Idon"tliketoo.[正]-Idon"tlikeopera.-Idon"tlikeeither.[析]在否定句中用either表示"也",而在肯定句中用too表示"也"。[误]EitheryouorIareright.[正]EitheryouorIamright.[析]这在语法书中被称作就近原则,即哪个主语离谓语动词近,则应采用与哪个主语相一致的谓语动词,相同用法的还有neither…nor…,notonly…butalso…,以及or在连接两个主语时。如:Youorheistogohome.Theothers3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档willhavetostayintheclassroom.elder[误]MyolderbrotherhasgonetoShanghai.[正]MyelderbrotherhasgonetoShanghai.[析]在表示兄姐的长幼时应用elder表示"哥哥姐姐",如:myeldersister姐姐,但表示岁数时则多用older,如:SheistwoyearsolderthanI.empty[误]Aretheseseatsempty?[正]Aretheseseatstaken?[析]empty是指空洞的没有任何物体,如:Thehousewasempty,其意思是没有任何家具或屋内无人。但座位是否有人坐应用take.English[误]MysisterstudiedEnglishlanguageverywell.[正]MysisterstudiedtheEnglishlanguageverywell.[正]MysisterstudiedEnglishverywell.[析]在泛指某一种学科时,不应加冠词,如:Ilikehistory.但如特指某一门学科时则应加冠词,如:HelikesthehistoryofAmerica.enjoy[误]Ienjoytoplayfootball.[正]Ienjoyplayingfootball.[析]enjoy后要接动名词,而不接不定式。[误]DidyouenjoyattheEnglishevening?[正]DidyouenjoyyourselfattheEnglishevening?enough[误]I"msorry.Youarenotstudyingenoughcarefully.[正]I"msorry.Youarenotstudyingcarefullyenough.[析]enough要用在形容词或副词之后。[误]Doyouhaveenoughofmoney?[正]Doyouhaveenoughmoney?[正]Doyouhaveenoughofthemoney?[误]Thecoffeeisn"tenough.[正]Thereisn"tenoughcoffee.[析]enough可以作be动词的表语,但其主语应是代词,如:That"s3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档enough.Itwasenough.如果是名词时应换用上面的句型。entrance[误]Theentranceofthecinemaisonyourright.[正]Theentrancetothecinemaisonyourright.[析]在表示通往某处时entrance后面多用to作介词。这样的用法还有keytothedoor,answertothequestion等。evening[误]Iwalkedhomeinacoldevening.[正]Iwalkedhomeonacoldevening.[析]intheevening这一词组如加上另外的修饰词则其介词应换为on.everyone[误]Everyoneofyougoestoclass.[正]Everyoneofyougoestoclass.[析]everyone其后不能接of结构。在否定句中如果要讲"每一个人都没有注意到它",就译作:Nobodynoticedit.要注意Everyoneofusisnotright.应译为"我们不都对。"而Noneofusareright.才应译为"我们全错了。"eGam[误]WetakepartinaneGam.[正]WetakeaneGam.[析]takepartin为"参加"某种活动,运动,而在学科中选择某一学科学习并进行考试应用take.eGcept[误]TheroomiscleaneGcepttwodesks.[正]TheroomiscleaneGceptfortwodesks.[误]IcomehereeverydayeGceptforSunday.[正]IcomehereeverydayeGceptSunday.[析]在同一类物体中排除某一部分用eGcept,在不同类物体中排除某一物体时用eGceptfor。而eGceptthat其后接从句,如:SheisagoodgirleGceptthatsheiscarelesssometimes.而besides则是"包括在内",如"我学习英语同时还学法语。"应译为:IstudyEnglishbesidesFrench.eGercise[误]ThestudentseGercisespokenEnglishinthemorning.[正]ThestudentspractisespokenEnglishinthemorning.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]eGercise多指运动、训练,而practise则多指把理论付诸于实践的练习。[误]EveryoneshoulddoeGerciseseveryday.[正]EveryoneshoulddoeGerciseeveryday.[析]作为运动讲eGercise是不可数名词,而当"练习"、"体操"、"早操"则是可数名词,例如:IdoaloteGercisesintheP.E.class.Ffail[误]TomfailedhiseGam.[正]TomfailedinhiseGam.[正]TomfailedtopasstheeGam.[析]fail为不及物动词,其后可用in加名词,或直接接不定式。family[误]I"msorryIhavetogo.Tom"sfamiliesarewaitingforme.[误]I"msorryIhavetogo.Tom"sfamilyiswaitingforme.[正]I"msorryIhavetogo.Tom"sfamilyarewaitingforme.[析]family是集合名词,把它当作整体看它是单数,如看作家庭中的每个成员则为复数。如:Yourfamilyareverykindtome.Myfamilyisverylarge.far[误]Myschoolistenmilesfarfromhere.[正]Myschoolistenmilesawayfromhere.[析]far一般不与实际距离连用。[误]"Didyouwalkfar?""Yes,Iwalkedfar."[正]"Didyouwalkfar?""Yes,Iwalkedalongway."[析]一般肯定句中不用far单独作状语,而用alongway.far组成的常用词组有:asfaras.①远至,一直到。如:Hewalkedasfarasthestation.②就……而言。如:Asfarashewasconcernedthesebookswereverygood.③只要。如:IcanhelpyouasfarasIcan.sofor到目前为止。例:Heisverywellsofar.fartherfurther3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档far有两个比较级,即farther和further,其意思略有不同:farther主要用于表示距离的远近,如:MilanisfartherawaythanRome.而further则是指"进一步的",如:Willweneedanyfurtherdiscussiononthismatter.fast[误]Afasttrainrunsfastly.[正]Afasttrainrunsfast.[析]fast其形容词与副词形式相同。fastsoonfast指行动本身的速度快,如:Theforeignerspeakstoofast.而soon则多指两个动作之间间隔短,时间到来的迅速,如:Shewillcomesoon.feel[误]Ifeelbadlyaboutmymistakes.[正]Ifeelbadaboutmymistakes.[析]感观动词如feel,smell等后面要接形容词而不是副词。feelgood是指某人精神好,而feelwell是指人身体状况良好。[误]Itrynottohurtherfeeling.[正]Itrynottohurtherfeelings.[析]feeling在作"感情"讲时要用复数,而作"感觉"讲则要用单数。如:Ihaveafeelingthatwewillwinthegame.few[误]Fewofthemisverygood.[正]Fewofthemareverygood.[析]few意为"几乎没有",但要用复数谓语动词。如果讲有一些人应用afew,如:Therewereonlyafewpeopleinthestreet.[误]Therearelessfarmsthanthereusedtobe.[正]Therearefewerfarmsthanthereusedtobe.[析]few的比较级为fewer,其后接可数名词;而little的比较级为less,其后接不可数名词。field[误]Heisafamousscientistonthefieldofphysics.[正]Heisafamousscientistinthefieldofphysics.[析]inthefield是"在田野上"或是"在某一学科领域内",而onthefield则多指"在战场上"。如:Helosthislifeonthebattlefield.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档fill[误]Shefilledorangeintomyglass.[正]Shefilledmyglasswithorange.[析]表示要用某种物品装满某容器时要用fillwith词组,如:Theboyranbackhomefilledwithjoy.fillfullfill是动词,但有及物与不及物两种用法,当表示"充满"之意时是不及物动词,应用fillwith,如:Thelittlegirl"seyesfilledwithtears.而当表示"使……装满某物"时,是及物动词,如:Hefilledhispocketwithbooks.而befilledwith应看作系表结构,如:Theboy"smotherwasfilledwithanger.full是形容词,要用befullof这一词组,如:Theboywasfullofjoy.find[误]Hehasfindedhislostbike.[正]Hehasfoundhislostbike.[析]find是不规则动词,其过去式和过去分词均是found。但found一词又意为"建立",它是规则动词,其过去式及过去分词均为founded.[误]Itisverydifficulttolookforasuitablejob.[正]Itisverydifficulttofindasuitablejob.[析]lookfor为"寻找",而find是找到。寻找工作并不难,难的应是找到合适的工作。findfindoutfindout意为"找出、算出、发现",如:Ihavefoundouthowtodoit.而find的主要侧重点在找到某物,如:Ifindmybookunderthedesk.finish[误]Ifinishedtoreadthatbooklastnight.[正]Ifinishedreadingthatbooklastnight.[析]英文中有些动词其后只能用动名词作宾语而不能用不定式作宾语,这样的动词在中考范围内有两个,即finish和enjoy。fire[误]There"snosmokewithoutafire.[正]There"snosmokewithoutfire.[析]此句应译为中文"无风不起浪"。fire作为物质名词"火"讲时为不可数名词,而作为"炉火"、"火灾"讲则是可数名词,如:TherewasafireintheneGtstreet3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档lastmonth.如要讲"着火了"要用beonfire,如:Thefactorywasonfire.[误]Themanfiredtous.[正]Themanfiredatus.[析]fire(on)at均指"向某目标开火",at用于较小目标,而on用于较大目标。first[误]IsthisyourfirstlyvisittoBeijing?[正]IsthisyourfirstvisittoBeijing?[析]除了在强调第一、第二、第三等场合中有时还可见firstly一词外,这个词已不多见,而均被first取代。first还有"首先"、"首次"、"第一次"之意。follow[误]Ireceivedaletterwhichranasfollow.[正]Ireceivedaletterwhichranasfollows.[析]asfollows是惯用法,其意为"如下",不论在任何场合均要用follows.[误]Asfollowsarehisarguments.[正]Thefollowingarehisarguments.[析]asfollows主要用于句尾,而thefollowing则用于句首。food[误]Toomuchsweetfood,suchascakes,chocolates,pastry…mayincreaseyourweight.[正]Toomanyfoods,suchascakes,chocolates,pastry…mayincreaseyourweight.[析]food泛指食物时为不可数名词,如:Thereisnofoodforsupper.而指一种种食物时则用作可数名词。foot[误]Thereisafivefeetwidebridge.[正]Thereisafivefootwidebridge.[析]用连字符组成的形容词中所有名词均要用单数形式。[误]Wewenttocollegeonfeet.[正]Wewenttocollegeonfoot.[析]by3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档后面加接交通工具时,不应加任何冠词,不要用名词的复数形式。如加了某些修饰词后,其前面的介词要作适当的改变,如:Icametoschoolinhiscaryesterday.Igotoshoolonatrain.for[误]Iwantedtogotothepubforhavingadrink.[正]Iwantedtogotothepubforadrink.[正]Iwantedtogotothepubtohaveadrink.[析]用for表示目的时,其后面只能接名词,而不要接动名词。[误]Iwenttotheofficeforseeingtheheadmaster.[正]Iwenttotheofficetoseetheheadmaster.[析]用不定式来表示动作的目的。[误]IwillleaveBeijingtoShanghai.[正]IwillleaveBeijingforShanghai.[正]IwillleaveforShanghai.[析]leavefor为一固定搭配,不要改动。[误]Iboughtabooktoyou.[正]Iboughtabookforyou.[误]Heisafriendforus.[正]Heisafriendtous.[析]在英文中"为"一词在泛指时用to,在特指时要用for.[误]Thisfoodisgoodtous.[正]Thisfoodisgoodforus.[析]词组begood(bad)for表示"对……有好(坏)处"。[误]ForIwasfeelingquitehungry,Iwantedtohavelunch.[正]Iwantedtohavelunch,forIwasfeelingquitehungry.[析]for作为"因为"讲时一般不要置于句首,而且口气也比because弱的多。forget[误]Ileftmykey.[正]Ileftmykeyathome.[正]Iforgotmykey.[析]leave是"丢下"之意,所以一定要接地点状语,而forget是"忘记",所以不用接地点状语。[误]Iwillnotforgettherules.[正]Iwillneverforgettherules.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Pleasedon"tforgetpostingmyletteronyourwayhome.[正]Pleasedon"tforgettopostmyletteronyourwayhome.[析]要注意forgettodosomething为"忘了去作某事",而forgetdoingsomething则应译为"对已经作过的事记不起来了"。如:Heforgetreturningthebooktothelibrary.应译为"他忘记已把书还给图书馆这件事了。"同样用法的词还有remember和regret.free[误]Youcanspeakfreeinfrontofmyparents.[正]Youcanspeakfreelyinfrontofmyparents.[析]free作为副词时意为"免费"、"不必付款",如:Youcaneatfreeinmyrestaurant.而freely则意为"自由地"、"无限制地"。French[误]ShecomesfromFrench.[正]ShecomesfromFrance.[析]French是"法语"、"法国的",而France才是"法国"。friend[误]Henoddedtomefriendly.[正]Henoddedtomeinafriendlyfashion.[析]friendly是形容词,不是副词。在英语中应避免讲Heisafriendofmymother.又比如:Igotoschoolwithmyfriend.从语法上讲是对的但不是习惯上英语的说法。而应讲Heisafriendofmymother"s.Igotoschoolwithafriend.befriendswith则是"交朋友"之意,例如:Ihopeyouwillbefriendswithme.而不应讲Ihopeyouwillbemyfriend.交朋友还有一惯用法是makefriends.from[误]Wheredoyoucomefrom?Icomefromthelibrary.[正]Wheredoyoucomefrom?IcomefromEngland.[正]Wheredidyoucomefrom?Icamefromthelibrary.[析]Wheredoyoucomefrom?应意为"你是从什么国家(地方)来的?"(即意为"你是哪的人?")而Wheredidyoucomefrom?才是"你刚刚从哪来?"front[误]Therearethreetalltreesinthefrontofmyhouse.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Therearethreetalltreesinfrontofmyhouse.[析]infrontof是某物体外部的前面,而inthefrontof是在某物体内部的前面。如:Thebusdriverisseatedinthefrontofthebus.Ggame[误]HewenttoAmericatotakepartintheOlympicGame.[正]HewenttoAmericatotakepartintheOlympicGames.[析]game作为"运动会"讲时应用其复数形式,而具体一个游戏则可用其单数形式。如:Ourschoolteamwonthegame.German[误]TheyareGermen.[正]TheyareGermans.[误]ShecomesfromGerman.[正]ShecomesfromGermany.[析]German是"德国人"、"德国的"、"德语",其复数形式是Germans;而Germany才是德国。gather[误]Allthestudentsandteachersaregatheredtogethernow.[正]Allthestudentsandteachersaregatherednow.[析]用了动词gather就不要再用together了。这句话还可以这样讲:Allthestudentsandteachersgottogether.give[误]Shegivesuptolookforthelostbike.[正]Shegivesuplookingforthelostbike.[析]giveup意为"放弃",其后只接动名词作介词宾语,而不应接不定式。glad[误]Hisparentswereverygladforhissuccessinbusiness.[正]Hisparentswereverygladofhissuccessinbusiness.[正]Hisparentswereverygladtoknowhissuccessinbusiness.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]"为……感到高兴"应是begladofsomething或begladtodosomething.glass[误]Theoldteacherhastwopairofbigglass.[正]Theoldteacherhastwopairsofbigglasses.[析]glass作为"眼镜"讲,应用复数形式,在英语中手套gloves裤子pants,剪刀scissors均用复数形式。glass作"玻璃杯"讲时则可用单数形式或复数形式,如:Iwanttwoglassesofmilk.而作为物质名词"玻璃"讲则要用作不可数名词,如:Theboybroketwopanesofglass.go[误]-Mary,couldyoucometomyhomenow?-Yes,I"mgoing.[正]-Mary,couldyoucometomyhomenow?-Yes,I"mcoming.[析]go是指离开说话人所在地,而come指的是朝向说话人的方向:如:Comehere!CanIcomeandhelpyou?但在口语中也有一些例外,如表示要参加到某人或者某件活动时常用come,如:Wearegoingtohaveapartytonight.Wouldyouliketocomewithus?gonebeenHehasgonetoShanghai.指此人已去上海不在此地了。HehasbeentoShanghai.指此人去过上海现已回来了。gold[误]Shebrushedhergoldhaircarefully.[正]Shebrushedhergoldenhaircarefully.[析]gold作形容词指"金质的",如:agoldring,agoldcoin,而golden是"金色的",如:goldenage(金色的时代),但"金鱼"例外,为goldfish。good[误]I"vebeenwaitingforgoodtwentyminutes.[正]I"vebeenwaitingforagoodtwentyminutes.[析]agood之意为"足足"、"整整"之意。goodwellHeisgood.应译为"他是个好人。"而Heiswell.应译为"他身体不错。"Ifeelgood.即精神状态良好,而Ifeelwell.即身体状况不错。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Thisfoodisverygoodtoyou.[正]Thisfoodisverygoodforyou.[析]begoodfor是"对……有利、有好处",而begoodto是指"对待某人不错",如:Yourfriendisverygoodtome.grade[误]-Whatgradeareyouin?-I"mingrade1.[正]-Whatgradeareyouin?-I"minGread1.[析]当泛指那一年级时grade的头一个字母小写,当有具体数字时则要大写。Hhadbetter[误]Youhavebetterhurry.[正]Youhadbetterhurry.[析]hadbetter只用过去时had,不要误用成现在时have。[误]Youhadn"tbetterworry.[正]Youhadbetternotworry.[析]hadbetter后面加不带to的不定式,其否定式是"hadbetternot+动词原形"。half[误]Ihaddrivenabouthalfmile.[正]Ihaddrivenabouthalfamile.[析]"半小时"有两种讲法halfanhour,ahalfhour.而"一个半小时"应讲anhourandahalf或oneandahalfhours."半天"应讲halfaday,"半镑"应讲halfapound.但要尽量避免使用halfayear,而应用siGmonths;不用halfamonth,而用twoweeks或fifteendays.[误]Halfuscouldgotothepark.[正]Halfofuscouldgotothepark.[析]half用于名词前可用of结构也可不用of结构,但用于代词前则必须加of。如:Morethanhalf(of)myclassmatesareboys.[误]Oneandhalfapplesareleftonthetable.[正]Oneandhalfapplesisleftonthetable.[析]一个半oneandhalf3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档后面的名词要用复数,而句中的谓语动词却要用单数。[误]Halfoftheworkaredone.[正]Halfoftheworkisdone.[误]HalfofthesiGapplesisred.[正]HalfofthesiGapplesarered.[析]"halfof+名词"这一结构后面的谓语动词应与of后面的名词相一致,如为不可数名词或可数名词单数,要用单数谓语动词;而复数名词后面要加与复数相对应的谓语动词。hand[误]Heshookhandwithhisteacher.[正]Heshookhandswithhisteacher.[析]与某人握手要用shakehands.与hand有关的词组中有很多要用复数形式,如:changehands(转手、易手),inthehandsof(由……控制),joinhands(与人合作)。happen[误]Whatwashappenedtoyoulastmonth?[正]Whathappenedtoyoulastmonth?[误]Anaccidentwashappenedinthisstreetlastnight.[正]Anaccidenthappenedinthisstreetlastnight.[析]在英语中不及物动词没有被动态,作为"发生"讲的happen,takeplace和breakout都不具有被动态。happento常用来表达一件偶然发生的事,如:Ifyouhappentomeetmysisterpleaseaskhertocallme.hard[误]Ihavetostudyhardly.[正]Ihavetostudyhard.[析]hard是形容词,如:ahardwork,但它同时也是副词。hardly是hard的又一副词形式,但词意截然不同,意为"几乎不"。[误]Ihadmylegbrokenlastterm,soIcouldn"thardlystudyatall.[正]IhadmylegbrokenlasttermsoIhardlystudiedatall.[析]hardly意为"否定",所以不要再加否定词语了,如果hardly用于句首则应采用倒装语序,如:Hardlyhadhearrivedwhenshestartedcomplaining.have3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Ihadmyboydohishomeworkfrommorningtillnoon.[正]Ihadmyboydoinghishomeworkfrommorningtillnoon.[析]用havesomebodydosomething还是doingsomething要取决句子的意思和句中的时间状语。[误]Ihavemybiketorepair.[正]Ihavemybikerepaired.[析]havesomethingdone这一句型是让某事被别人去作,请看下面两句意义的不同:Ihaverepairedmybike.(我自己已修好了自行车。)而Ihavemybikerepaired.(我把车推出去让别人修理了。)[误]Couldyougivemesomemoneyifyouhave.[正]Couldyougivemesomemoneyifyouhaveany.[析]"如果你有的话"一句译为英文应加上any一词,如:Iwantsomebooksifthereisany.headache[误]I"vegotheadache.[正]I"vegotaheadache.[析]Headache是一个规则的可数名词,所以可以讲:Mymotheroftengetsheadaches.但是"牙痛"toothache,"肚子痛"stomacheache等却都可以用作不可数名词,如:I"vegottoothache.但也可用作可数名词。hear[误]HewasheardsingintheneGtroom.[正]HewasheardtosingintheneGtroom.[析]hearsomebodydosomething这一句式用于被动语态时要把原来省略的不定式to还原回来。而在hearsomebodydoingsomething这一句式中则不会出现上述问题。如,主动态:IheardhersingingintheneGtroom.变为被动态时为:ShewasheardsingingintheneGtroom.这种用法还适用于see,look,observe,watch,notice,listento等。hearlistentohear一词为听见了什么,或听到什么,强调其结果;而listento则强调有意要听,听的倾向。如:Iwanttolistentoyou,butIhearnothing.但词组hearabout(of)则为"听说过"之意,如:Iheardaboutthis.(我听说过此事。)而hearfrom则为"收到某人信件"之意:Ioftenhearfrommygirlfriend.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档help[误]Pleasehelpmyhomework.[正]Pleasehelpmedomyhomework.[正]Pleasehelpmewithmyhomework.[析]help其句型是helpsomebodydo(todo)something.意为"帮某人作某事",但在较古老的语法中不带to的不定式表示句子的主语参加这个动作,如:Hehelphismothercookthemeal.即"他和母亲一起作饭。"而Hehelpmetodomyhomework.则是"他指导我做作业"。但在现代英语中这个区别则往往被取消了。所以带to与不带to的不定式在句中意思相同,并无区别。[误]WhenIreadtheplayIcan"thelptothinkofmychildhood.[正]WhenIreadtheplayIcan"thelpthinkingofmychildhood.[析]can"thelpdoingsomething是"身不由己,情不自禁做某事"。[误]Helpyourselfwithsomecakes.[正]Helpyourselftosomecakes.[析]中文中讲"你自己拿蛋糕吃",英文中要用helpsomebodytosomething.here[误]Herethebuscomes![正]Herecomesthebus![析]副词在句首时一般要用倒装语序,即谓语动词的位置前移。但是,若主语如是人称代词,则还是要用正常语序,如:Hereweare!high[误]Heisveryhigh.[正]Heisverytall.[析]英语中的两个"高"high和tall,其中tall指人指物都是可以的,但high则只指物体的高,所以可以讲Thisbuildingisthehighestbuildinginthecity.但tall一般不用来指山脉的高低。hit[误]Themothergotangryandhittheboy.[正]Themothergotangryandbeattheboy.[析]hit指打到某物之上,一般指一次性打击,如Hehithisheadagainstthewall.(他把头撞到了墙上。)而beat则指多次性的打击。home3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]I"mtired.It"stimeIwenttohome.[正]I"mtired.It"stimeIwenthome.[析]home此处用作副词,所以不应加to,又如:Iarrivedhomeateleventhirtyyesterdayevening.而athome除了"在家"之意外,还有像"在家里一样"之意。如Makeyourselfathome.(不要拘束就像在家一样。)homehousefamilyhome是指与亲人一起居住的地方,可以讲aletterfromhome,所以有人解释home包括住处和家人。而house的侧重点则在建筑物,如Manynewhouseswerebuiltthisyear.family一词,作为整体讲其谓语动词用单数,如:Herfamilyisahappyone.而作为家庭成员讲时要用复数谓语动词,如:Myfamilyarealllikeswimming.homgwork[误]Ihavesomanyhomeworktodotoday.[正]Ihavesomuchhomeworkgodotoday.[析]homework为不可数名词。同样的词还有work(work作为"著作"、"作品"、"工厂"讲时为可数名词),fun,healthinformation等。hope[误]Ihopeyoutobeagoodstudent.[正]Ihopeyouwillbeagoodstudent.[析]hope一词不能接宾语再加上宾语补足语,但它可以接不定式作宾语,如:Ihopetobeascientist.而wish却可以接宾语加宾语补足语,如:Iwishyoutobeagoodstudent.[误]Idon"thopeyouwillgototheparktomorrow.[正]Ihopeyouwon"tgototheparktomorrow.[析]hope和think在否定句中的用法不同,如"我认为你错了"。应译为:Idon"tthinkyouareright.即否定在前。而hope则不能这样用。又如在答语中"我不这样认为"应译为Idon"tthinkso.或Ihopenot.[误]Ihopeyourhelp.[正]Ihopeforyourhelp.[析]hopefor为"期望某事发生",虽然hope是及物动词,但表达期望某事情发生要用"hopefor+名词"这一结构。[误]IwashopefultopasstheeGam.[正]IwashopefulofpassingtheeGam.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]对某事存有希望应用"hopefulof(about)+介词宾语"这一结构。hospital[误]Mymotherwasinthehospitalfortwoweeks.[正]Mymotherwasinhospitalfortwoweeks.[析]inhospital为"住院就医"。而in(at)thehospital为"在医院(工作)"。如:Heisadoctorin(at)thehospital.类似的用法还有很多,如:"上学"为gotoschool,atschool为"在校就读",gotobed为"上床睡觉"。how[误]Iwanttoknowhowtodo.[正]Iwanttoknowhowtodoit.[析]how是关联副词,要注意与关联代词的不同用法。如:Iwanttoknowwhattodo.[误]Howdoyouthinkaboutit?[正]Whatdoyouthinkaboutit?[析]英文中表达你对某事的看法如何应用Whatdoyouthinkabout…这一句式。hurry[误]Let"shurry.Thereisalittletimeleft.[正]Let"shurry.Thereislittletimeleft.[误]Don"tworry.Thereislittletimeleft.[正]Don"tworry.Thereisalittletimeleft.[析]请注意英语中的惯用法:"快点吧,没时间了",或"别着急还有一点时间。"[误]Thecarishurryingthroughthestreet.[正]Thecarisrushingthroughtthestreet.[析]hurry一词只用于人而不用于物体。hundred[误]Therearetwohundredspeoplehere.[正]Therearetwohundredpeoplehere.[误]Therearehundredofpeoplehere.[正]Therearehundredsofpeoplehere.[析]hundred一词前如有数字时不论多少其后都不加s,这和thousand(千)等数量词的用法一样,而hundredsof是数百的,这一词组一定要加s.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档hurt[误]Idon"twanttowoundherfeelings.[正]Idon"twanttohurtherfeelings.[析]wound是指战场上的刀枪伤(名词),或用刀枪"伤害"、"打伤"(动词)。Iif[误]IfitwillrainIwon"tgotoschooltomorrow.[正]IfitrainsIwon"tgotoschooltomorrow.[析]由if引起的状语从句要用一般时表示将来。[误]Iwanttoknowifhecomesheretomorrow.[正]Iwanttoknowifhewillcomeheretomorrow.[析]if所引起的如果是宾语从句则不能用一般现在时表示将来。[误]Iwanttoknowifitwillraintomorrowhewillcomeornot.[正]Iwanttoknowifitrainstomorrowhewillcomeornot.[析]这里的if从句是整个宾语从句的条件状语,所以,还应用一般时表示将来。ill[误]Hespentmanyyearslookingafterhisillfather.[正]Hespentmanyyearslookingafterhissickfather.[析]ill和sick都可以作表语,如:I"mill(sick).美国英语中常用sick,而英国英语中两者都可用,但ill一般不作定语。in[误]Inacoldmorning,Iwenttoschoolalone.[正]Onacoldmorning,Iwenttoschoolalone.[析]在inthemorning或intheafternoon词组中,不论在这两个名词的前或后加任何修饰词,其介词in都要变为on.[误]Iwillfinishitaftertwodays.[正]Iwillfinishitintwodays.[析]中文中几天以后可以完成,或几天后来取,在译为英文时都不要用after,而要用in.如:Hewillbebackinafewdays.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档ininto作为副词应用in,而不能用into,如:Comein,please.又若在句中不涉及到动词的位置,只是表达空间的位置时用in,如:Theteacherintheofficeismymother.但在go,run,come,walk,dive等词后则要用into.如:Shedivesintotheriver.instead[误]Theboystayedinbedalldayinsteadtogotoschool.[正]Theboystayedinbedalldayinsteadofgoingtoschool.[析]insteadof其后要接动名词、名词或代词,而不能用不定式,如:Ichoosethisbookinsteadofthatone.[误]Thebeerhereisnotgood,soIdrinkwineinsteadofit.[正]Thebeerhereisnotgood,soIdrinkwineinstead.[析]instead是副词,而insteadof是介词短语。如:Ifyouarenotfree,youmaycomeanotherdayinstead.interest[误]Hehasagreatinterestforphysics.[正]Hehasagreatinterestinphysics.[误]Hehassomeinterestinmanycompanies.[正]Hehassomeinterestsinmanycompanies.[析]interest作为"兴趣"讲可用作不可数名词,但作为"利息"、"股份"讲时为可数名词。[误]Thisisaninterestedbook.[正]Thisisaninterestingbook.[析]修饰物时应用interesting,如,aninterestingfilm,而讲某人对某事感兴趣时要用过去分词interested,如:I"minterestedinthisplay.但"他是一个十分有趣的人"。应译为Heisaninterestingman.所以interesting是"令人感兴趣"之意,而interested则表示某人对某事物感兴趣,多用"beinterestedinsomething"这一句型。invent[误]AmericawasinventedbyChristopherColumbusin1492.[正]AmericawasdiscoveredbyChristopherColumbusin1492.[析]invent意为"发明"即从无到有,如:CompasswasinventedbytheChinesepeople.而discover则意为"发现"。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档it[误]Thattakesmetenyearstofinishthiswork.[正]Ittakesmetenyearstofinishthiswork.[析]it在这个句中的语法作用是形式主语,而真正的主语是句子后面的不定式。有的句子要用it作形式主语或形式宾语,如:IthinkitdifficulttolearnEnglishwell.Jjoin[误]Didyouattendthefootballclub?[正]Didyoujointhefootballclub?[析]join经常用于参加某个团体、政党,并作为其中的一个成员;attend则重点强调出会议、到场,而不一定进行具体活动,如:Didyouattendthemeetingyesterday?而takepartin则强调参与某些具体活动或运动,如:Itakepartinthefootballgame.just[误]Ihavefinishedmyworkjustnow.[正]Ifinishedmyworkjustnow.[析]justnow意义"刚才",所以句中的谓语动词要用过去式。[误]JustIwonthegame.[正]Ijustwonthegame.[析]just单独使用时不应放在句首,而应放于①be动词之后,如:Heisjustastudent.②名词与一般动词之间。③用在第一助动词之后,如:Ihavejustreturnedhome.但just与其他词组成词组时,如justnow,justthen,则可用于句首和句尾。如:Justthenhesawthebuscoming.justjustlyjust常用于三种含意:①恰好,如:It"sjustfiveo"clock.②仅仅,相当于only,如:Ihavejustenoughmoneytobuyadictionary.③不久前,如:Ijustmissedmyoldfriend;Heleftafewminutesago.而justly其意为"公正的",如:Hewasjustlypunishedforhiscrimes.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Kkeep[误]Shewaskeepingsomethingtoherfather.[正]Shewaskeepingsomethingfromherfather.[析]"对某人隐瞒某事"要用"keepsomethingfromsomebody"句型。[误]Hekepttorepeatthewordagainandagain.[正]Hekeptrepeatingthewordagainandagain.[析]keepdoingsomething为连续不断地做某事。有时可以与keepondoingsomething互换。它们的区别在于keepdoingsomething意为该动作一直不停地在进行中,如:Whenthetrainstarted,shekeptwavingherhand.而keepondoingsomething则表示该动作可能停停顿顿但却一直在进行中,如:Hekeptonmakingthesamemistakesingrammar.[误]Wemustkeepupthetimes.[正]Wemustkeepupwiththetimes.[析]这句话意为"我们必须赶上时代",keepupwith是"赶上"之意,而keepup则是"坚持下去"的意思,如:Keepitup,don"tstopnow!key[误]Ilostthekeyofthedoor.[正]Ilostthekeytothedoor.[析]英语中讲某某的东西一般要用of,而key,entrance,answer则多用to,如:"门的钥匙"为keytothedoor,"高速公路入口"为entrancetothehighway,"问题的答案"为theanswer(key)tothequestion.kind[误]Thiskindofbooksarenotgood.[正]Thiskindofbooksisnotgood.[析]kind在这种句式中应作为主语,如果讲Thosekindsofbooksareverygood.则是正确的。kindsorttypekind和sort为同义词,意为"种类",而type则为"型号",如:Whattypeofthiscardoyouwant?(你想要这种车的什么型号?)knock[误]Someonewasknockingthedoor.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Someonewasknockingatthedoor.[析]knock虽可以作及物动词,如:Thecarknockedaholeinthefence.但作"敲门"讲一定要用作不及物动词:knockat(on)thedoor.know[误]Iwanttoknowtoplaythisgame.[正]Iwanttoknowhowtoplaythisgame.[析]要注意英语中在不定式前加疑问代词或疑问副词的用法。如:Iwanttoknowhowtodoit/whattodo/whentodoit/wheretogo.knowknowofIknowhim.为"我很了解他。"而Iknowofhim.则为"我听说过他。"同样的用法还有hear和hearof这一词组。Llarge[误]Hefoundalargenumberofmistakeinhishomework.[正]Hefoundalargenumberofmistakesinhishomework.[析]"alargenumberof+复数名词",意为大量的。last[误]Thisisthenewestnews.[正]Thisisthelatestnews.[析]"最新消息"应为latestnews,因为最晚到的新闻才是最新消息,请注意英语与汉语的区别。lastthelast[误]Isawmybrotherthelastweek.[正]Isawmybrotherlastweek.[析]当谈到与目前有关的上月、上星期等概念时只能用lastmonth,lastweek,而不能加定冠词,thelast可用于表示一系列词的最后一个,如:ThatwasthelastChristmasIspentathome.但thelast可以用来表示持续到现在的一个长时期,如:Iambusyforthelastweek.late[误]YesterdayIwenthomelately.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]YesterdayIwenthomelate.[析]late即可做形容词又可作副词;而lately则意为"最近的",如:Ihaven"tseenherlately.latelatterlaterlatelylate有两个比较级,指时间较晚应用later,如口语中常讲:Seeyoulater.(一会见。)而latter则指按顺序讲的后者,或靠后的,其反意词为former,如:theformerpresident(前总统)。又如:Icanunderstandthelatterpartofthestory.而lately则意为"近来"、"不久前"。laughedatbyhisclassmates.中的at是不可省掉的。laughover则指"笑着谈论"某事,如Welaughoverthefilm.(我们笑着谈论那个电影。)lay[误]Weliedonthebeach.[正]Welayonthebeach.[析]英文中有三个动词易混,在考试中也频频出现,它们的现在式,过去式,过去分词以及现在分词是:lay(vt.放)laidlaidlayinglie(vi.躺)laylaincyinglie(vi.说谎)liedliedlyinglearn[误]Theteachersaid:"Youmuststudythispoembyheart."[正]Theteachersaid:"Youmustlearnthispoembyheart."[析]study与learn在作"学习"讲时,常常可以互换,但learn侧重于学习成果或初级阶段的模仿性学习,如:Thelittlebabyislearningtowalk.而study则多侧重于学习的过程,如:I"mstudyingatthiscollege.而learn…byheart则是"记住"、"背诵"之意。leave[误]I"llleaveBeijingtoShanghai.[正]I"llleaveBeijingforShanghai.[析]leavefor一词组为"去某地",如对话中常讲I"llleaveforShanghai.因所离开的地点是双方都知道的则可以省略。leaveforget[误]I"veforgottenmyhomeworkathome.[正]I"veforgottenmyhomework.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]I"veleftmyhomeworkathome.[析]如果句中有地点状语则不要用forget,而要用leave.lesson[误]IhavetwolessonsofEnglish.[正]IhavetwoEnglishlessons.[正]IhavetwolessonsinEnglish.[析]"我有两节英语课。"这一表达法如上,但美国老师讲他有两节课时则多用"Ihavetwoclasses."teachsomebodyalesson为"教训某人",或"要吸取教训",如:Letthisthingteachesyoualesson.lend[误]Pleaseborrowmeyourbike.[正]Pleaselendmeyourbike.[析]borrow是指"借入",如:Iwanttoborrowsomebooksfromthelibrary.lend是"借出",如:Icanlendyoumybike.而keep为"借多久":如HowlongcanIkeepit?less[误]Hehasfewermoneythanshehas.[正]Hehaslessmoneythanshehas.[析]less是little的比较级,而fewer是few的比较级。要注意前者修饰不可数名词,而后者修饰可数名词。let[误]Theteacherletsthestudentscleantheclassroomasapunishment.[正]Theteachermakesthestudentscleantheclassroomasapunishment.[析]虽然let,have,make有相同的用法,但make和have含有迫使某人做某事的意思。[误]Let"sgotothepark,willyou?[正]Let"sgotothepark,shallwe?[误]Letusgotothepark,shallwe?[正]Letusgotothepark,willyou?[析]Let"sgo的反意疑问句是shallwe?而Letusgo的反意疑问句则是willyou?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档life[误]ManypeoplelosttheirlifeintheSecondWorldWar.[正]ManyPeoplelosttheirlivesintheSecondWorldWar.[析]life作为"生命"、"性命"时应为可数名词;当泛指一般"生活"讲时则为不可数名词,如:Whichdoyouprefer,townlifeorcountrylife?又如:Lifeisnotallfun.light[误]Thereisadeskwithalitlamponit.[正]Thereisadeskwithalightedlamponit.[析]light有两个过去分词:lighted和lit,当用过去分词作形容词当定语时只能用lighted.light可以用作名词,如:Themoongetsitslightfromthesun.也可以作形容词,如:Theclassroomisverylight.还可以作动词,如:Thelittlegirllitamatch.作形容词时还有"轻"、"浅"等意,如:ThisboGislight.Ilikelightblue.like[误]Mysisterisveryasme.[正]Mysisterisverylikeme.[析]as作为连词其后要接从句,如:Sheisagoodstudentashisbrotherusedtobe.而like是介词,其后接宾语。[误]Doyoulikeswimmingwithmetonight.[正]Wouldyouliketoswimwithmetonight.[析]like作为动词当"喜欢"讲时,其后面可接不定式也可接动名词,用不定式多表达一个一次性的动作,如:I"msorryIdon"tliketogoswimmingtonight.用动名词则表示一个习惯性的动作,如:Ilikeswimmingverymuch.likealike作为形容词,alike一般不作定语,而只作表语,如;Thetwinsareveryalike.[误]Wouldyoulikeswimmingwithus?[正]Wouldyouliketoswimwithus?[析]在wouldyoulike…这一句型中,其后面只能接不定式,而不能接动名词。like的用法还要注意以下两点:①HelikesTom.为"他喜欢汤姆。"②HeislikeTom.为"他像汤姆。"第二句话的like为介词,而第一句话的like为动词。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档listen[误]Youshouldheartheteahcer"sadvice.[正]Youshouldlistentotheteacher"sadvice.[析]hear多侧重于听到某事或某种声音,而listento则侧重于听的倾向性。如:Welistenbuthearnothing.例句为"听取某人意见",所以只能用listentosomeone"sadvice.little[误]Don"tworry,thereislittletime.[正]Don"tworry,thereisalittletime.[误]Thereisalittlewater.ShallIgetsome?[正]Thereislittlewater.ShallIgetsome?[析]要注意中英文在同一问题上的表达法是不同的。如中文"水不多了,我去取点吧。"英文要讲"没水了,我去取点吧。"littlesmalllittle与small是近义词,在作定语时常常可以互换,如:alittlegirl或asmallgirl,但little一般不作表语,如:Thecaroverthereissmall.一句中不要用little.作定语时little常常带有感情色彩,而small则带有对比的含义。live[误]Tomliveswithhisparents"money.[正]Tomlivesonhisparents"money.[误]Helivesonteaching.[正]Helivesbyteaching.[析]"靠吃某物为生"应用liveonsomething,而liveby是"靠某种生活手段为生"。livingaliveliving侧重于生活得很好,身体不错,如:Mygrandfatherisstilllivinginhiseighties.而alive则强调没有死而是活着的,如:Isthatcataliveordead?lonely[误]Shewantedtodoherhomeworklonely.[正]Shewantedtodoherhomeworkalone.[析]lonely意为"寂寞的"、"孤单的",如:Theoldmanfeltlonely.alone则意为"独自的"、"单独的",如:Helivesalonebuthedoesn"tfeellonely.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档long[误]IhavebeenstudyinglongfortheeGam.[正]IhavebeenstudyingforalongtimefortheeGam.[析]long用作表达时间的副词时,在否定句及疑问句中最常用,但在肯定句中除与so,too,as…as连用外,一般要用foralongtime.[误]I"llcallyouaslongasthebookwillbereturned.[正]I"llcallyouaslongasthebookisreturned.[析]as…as引导的状语从句中可以用一般现在时表示将来。[误]Howlongdoyougotoseeyourparents?Onceaweek.[正]Howoftendoyougotoseeyourparents?Onceaweek.[析]因为答语为每周一次所以问的是频率,要用howoften.looklookforfindlookfor侧重于"寻找"这个动作,如:Whatareyoulookingfor?而find则侧重于结果,如:Itisverydifficulttofindajob.这里不能用lookfor,因为真正困难的是"找到"工作。其他用法还有:[例]Heoftenlooksbackonhishighschooldays.[析]lookbackonsomething为"回顾"、"回想"。[例]Iwishyouwouldn"tlookdownon(upon)thechildren"swork.[析]lookdownon(upon)为"看不起"某人或某事。[误]I"mlookingforwardtoseeyou.[正]I"mlookingforwardtoseeingyou.[析]lookforwardto词组中的to是介词,所以其后要加名词或动名词,不能接不定式。lot[误]Icanbuythisdictionarynow,becauseIhavegotmuchmoney.[正]IcanbuythisdictionarynowbecauseIhavegotalotofmoney.[析]muchmoney多用于疑问句与否定句中,而在肯定句中要用alotof.lotsof与alotof之间无多大区别,两者都可以修饰可数与不可数名词,所以常常可以互换。[误]Heismorehappiernow.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Heisalothappiernow.[析]不可用more来修饰比较级,能修饰比较级的词有verymuch,alot,lots,any,no,rather,alittle,abit等。loudloudly这两个词含意相同,在日常用语中loud多与talk,speak,shout,laugh等动词连用,如:Don"tspeaksoloud,you"llwakethebaby.而在比较正式的场合才用loudly.loudaloudloud多指把声音放大,而aloud则指要出声不要默读。如:-Whatdidyousay?-Oh,nothing,Iwasjustthinkaloud.(我只不过自言自语。)Mmake[误]Thelittleboywasmaderepeatthewholestory.[正]Thelittleboywasmadetorepeatthewholestory.[误]Thefathermadehissontodohishomeworkfrommorningtillnight.[正]Thefathermadehissondohishomeworkfrommorningtillnight.[析]make的句型为"makesomebodydo(doing)something".但在被动语态中原来被省去的不定式符号to要被还原回来。[误]Ialwaysdothismistake.[正]Ialwaysmakethismistake.[析]英语中do和make是十分不易弄清的两个动词,do常用于谈论工作时或某种不确定的活动时,如:doafavour(帮个忙),doone"sbest(竭尽全力),dogood(有益),doharm(有害),而多数情况下常用make,如:makeasuggestion,makeacake,makeabed(收拾床),makeanoise,makemoney等等。[误]Thiswinewasmadeofgrapes.[正]Thiswinewasmadefromgrapes.[析]当成品制成后,其原料的性质有所改变时应用makefrom,否则用makeof,如:Thisdoorwasmadeofiron.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Hardworkcanoftenmakeupalackofintelligence.[正]Hardworkcanoftenmakeupforalackofintelligence.[析]makeup是"创造"、"编织",而makeupfor是"弥补……的不足之处"。上句应译为"勤奋工作可以弥补天资的不足。"[误]Wemadeupourmindtostudyhard.[正]Wemadeupourmindstostudyhard.[析]mind这里是可数名词,使用时要特别予以注意makeupone"smind是"下定决心"之意。[误]Ourclassismadeoftwentygirlsandtwentyoneboys.[正]Ourclassismadeupoftwentygirlsandtwentyoneboys.[析]makeupof…是"某物由……组成或构成"。many[误]Ihavemanyfriends.[正]Ihavealotoffriends.[析]many和much多用于疑问句或否定句中,而在肯定句中则用处不多,尤其在非正式谈话中。如:-Howmuchmoneyhaveyougot?-I"vegotplenty.[误]Youboughtmuchtootomatoes.[正]Youboughttoomanytomatoes.[析]toomany后接可数名词,toomuch后接不可数名词,而muchtoo后面接形容词,意为"太多"。[误]Formanyaweeksitrainedalot.[正]Formanyaweekitrainedalot.[析]manya意为"好多"、"许多",但其后面要加单数名词。matter[误]Nomatterwhatyoudid.[正]Nomatterwhatyoudid,Itrustedyou.[析]Nomatter是个词组,意为"不论",它的语法功能是起连接作用,所以不能用于一个单独的句子。itdoesn"tmatter这个词组则不是一个连接词组,所以可以和一个单句连用,如:Itdoesn"tmaterwhatyousay.(你说什么都不要紧。)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档maybe[误]Maybeheisright.[正]Maybeheisright.[析]maybe是副词,不要错用为maybe.maybeperhaps这两个词的词意一样,maybe常用于非正式谈话,而perhaps则多用在正式文体中。如:Maybe/Perhapstheweatherwillgetbetter.而JuliusCaesarisperhapsthegreatestofShakespeare"searlyplays.mend[误]Iwanttohavemybikemended.[正]Iwanttohavemybikerepaired.[析]mend意为"缝补",如:Mymothermendedmycoat.而repair是"修理"。mind[误]Couldyoumindtoclosethedoor?[正]Couldyoumindclosingthedoor?[误]Trytomakeupyourmindstudyinghard.[正]Trytomakeupyourmindtostudyhard.[析]mind用作动词时,其后加动名词;而用作名词意为"下定决心"时,其后要加不定式。要注意DoyoumindifIsmoke?的答语:如果你不介意,应回答"No,goahead."如果你不想让对方吸烟,则应讲"Yes,pleasedon"t."miss[误]Ifoundmybagmissed.[正]Ifoundmybagmissing.[析]missing为形容词,其意为"不见了"、"丢了"。在句中用作宾语补足语时不要误用missed,它作动词时多为及物动词,要接名词或动名词,而不接不定式。如:Imissedthefirsttrain,Idon"twanttomissseeingthefamousfootballplayer.在作补足语讲某物"不见了"时有missing,gone,lost等,如:Ifoundmybagmissing(gone,lost).mistake[误]Itookyourpenbywrong.[正]Itookyourpenbymistake.[析]bymistake是"错拿了"、"误拿了"你的东西。wrong意为"错误",而by3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档mistake为"弄混了"。如:[误]IfI"mnotwrong,youareMrBrown.[正]IfI"mnotmistaken,youareMrBrown.(如果我没弄错的话,您是Brown先生。)[误]Theteachersalwaysmistookmeasmybrother.[正]Theteachersalwaysmistookmeformybrother.[析]mistake…for…是"错把……当作……"之意,如:Itookyourbookformine.more[误]Thisbookismorebetterthanthatone.[正]Thisbookismuchbetterthanthatone.[析]不能用比较级来修饰比较级,而应用much,rather等来修饰比较级。[误]Moreyouread,moreyoulearn.[正]Themoreyouread,themoreyoulearn.[析]在"越……越……的"表达法中,形容词的比较级前要加定冠词。请注意morethanone这个词组的后面要跟单数名词和单数谓语动词。如:Morethanonestudentisgoingtodoparttimejobafterschool.nomorethannotmorethannomorethan应译为"只不过"、"才",如:Hewrotenomorethanthreebooks.即他真正写了三本书。而notmorethan则意为"不会多于",如:Hewrotenotmorethanthreebooks.即他写的书不会多于三本。又如:Heisnoshorterthanyou.应译为"你和他都不矮",而Heisnotshorterthanyou.才应译为"他比你高。"most[误]MostofstudentsaregoodatEnglish.[正]MostofthestudentsaregoodatEnglish.[正]MoststudentsaregoodatEnglish.[析]mostof这一结构后面的名词前一定要有一个限定词。[误]Myfriendsaremostteachers.[正]Myfriendsaremostlyteachers.[析]mostly意为"大部分的","主要的"。much[误]Theboywasasleepverymuch.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Theboywasfastasleep.[析]不是所有的形容词都可以用very来修饰,如fastasleep意为"熟睡",则是固定搭配。像interesting,eGciting,surprising这些形容词化的现在分词,以及tired,interested这些形容词化的过去分词则要用very来修饰。must[误]Hemustbeintheoffice,andmustn"tgohome.[正]Hemustbeintheoffice,andcan"tgohome.[析]must加动词原形为对事情的肯定推测,而否定的推测则要用can"t加动词原形。[误]Itmusthaverainednow.[正]Itmusthaverainedyesterday.[析]"must+have+过去分词"为对过去发生事情的推测。这句话应译为"昨天一定是下雨了。"又如:Imustgoandcallhim.Hemusthaveforgottenit.musthavetomust用来表示说话者觉得某件事有必要去做,如Imuststopsmoking.其意为:我自己认为我要戒烟;而haveto则多用来表达由于来自外界的因素而不得不去做的事,如:Ihavetogotoschooltomorrow.must无过去式,当用在讲过去某件必须要做的事时要用hadto,如:WhenIwasyoung,Ihadtogotothefactory.在否定句中mustn"t意为:一定不要做某事,如:Youmustn"ttellthistoTom.而haven"tto则多意为没有必要去做,如:Youdon"thavetotellthistoTom.而英语中多用needn"t来取代haven"tto.myself[误]Ican"tplaypingpongmyself.[正]Ican"tplaypingpongbymyself.[析]第一句并无语法错误,myself为"我亲自要去",而bymyself为"独自一人"。这句话要表达的意思是"我一个人无法打乒乓球。"而Iwanttoplaypingpongmyself.应译为"我自己想去打乒乓球。"Nname[误]Shewasnamedofaflower.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Shewasnamedafteraflower.[析]以……命名应为nameafter,又如给某人取名应为ThefathernamedhissonTom.near[误]Wecameneartohithim.[正]Wecameneartohittinghim.[析]这句话应译为"我们几乎要打他一顿。"nearto这一用法中to为介词,其后要接宾语,所以要接名词或动名词。near作介词时其后可加to也可不加to,如:Isitnearthedoor,Isitneartothefire.bynearWelivednearthecity.与Welivedbythecity.两句话都是对的,但其表达的意义有所不同,by在表达距离时比near更近,所以bythecity是紧靠近某城市。need[误]Thisroomneedstoclean.[正]Thisroomneedstobecleaned.[正]Thisroomneedscleaning.[析]在表达某事需要做什么时,need后面如用不定式要用其被动态,如接动名词则要用主动态。[误]Weneednottodoit.[正]Weneedn"tdoit.[析]need用在否定句、疑问句中一般用作情态动词,所以无人称变化也不加to,而在肯定句中则多用作实意动词,如:Weneedyourhelp.neither[误]Noneofmyparentsisateacher.[正]Neitherofmyparentsisateacher.[析]对两者的否定不能用none只能用neither,none用于三人以上的情况。[误]Idon"tdomyhomework.Neitherhedoes.[正]Idon"tdomyhomework.Neitherdoeshe.[析]这时应用倒装句。[误]NeitheryounorIareright.[正]NeitheryounorIamright.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]neither…nor…这一句型在应用时其谓语动词应以邻近的主语一致。[误]Neitherhestudiesnorplays.[正]Neitherdoeshestudynorplay.[析]neither,hardly,seldom等否定词位于句首时,谓语动词采用倒装形式。never[误]NeverIhavebrokenmyword.[正]NeverhaveIbrokenmyword.[析]never用于句首时起强调作用,要用倒装语序。但用于句中一般放于情态动词、助动词、或be动词后面,如:IshallneverforgottheeGpressiononherface.Losttimeisneverfoundagain.用于成语中,如:Betterlatethannever.(晚做比不做强。)nevermind没关系,如:"Whatdidyousay?""Oh,nevermind."news[误]Therearemanynewsabouttheaccident.[正]Thereismuchnewsabouttheaccident.[析]news是不可数名词,它没有复数形式,如果讲一条新闻要用apieceofnews.newspaper[误]Ireadthenewsontoday"snewspaper.[正]Ireadthenewsintoday"snewspaper.[析]在报纸上读到某一条新闻一定要用介词in,而onthenewspaper是指把某物放于报纸之上,如:MayIputthefloweronthisnewspaper?night[误]Icamehomeverylateyesterdaynight.[正]Icamehomeverylatelastnight.[析]"昨晚"一般要讲lastnight,而不应参照"昨天上午、下午、傍晚"的说法yesterdaymorning等套用。nononeno是个限定词,它可以用在可数名词单复数或不可数名词前,如:Nonewsisgoodnews.但如果名词前有另一限定词时则不能用no,而要用noneof,如Noneofthestudentswashere.nonot3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档要使句子具有部分否定的意思,我们用not,如:Icanseeyoutomorrow,butnotSunday.如果是全部否定则用no,如Sorry,thereisnotimetotalk.Noonenonenoone与nobody一样不能接of结构,如:Noonewishedmegoodluck.而要用of结构时要用none,如:Noneofmyfriendswishedmegoodluck.nor[误]Ineversawthepaintingbefore,ordidIhearofit.[正]Ineversawthepaintingbefore,notdidIhearofit.[析]注意在表达"既不……也不……"时不要用or作连词,而要用nor,并且要用倒装语序。not[误]Thestudentswenttothepark,butnotheteachers.[正]Thestudentswenttothepark,butnottheteachers.[析]要使一个句子或一个句子的某一部分为否定时我们要用not,而不用no.[误]Thereisnomylettertoday.[正]Thereisnoletterformetoday.[析]no是一个限定词,用在名词前时,要注意这个名词前应没有冠词、物主代词或指示代词。[误]Henotonlywasawriterbutalsoanactor.[正]Hewasnotonlyawriterbutalsoanactor.[析]在这一句型中notonly之后的词与butalso之后的词类必须一致,否则应为错句。如果这一结构用在主语位置,则谓语动词要与butalso后面的主语保持一致,如:NotonlyyoubutalsoIamwrong.nothing[误]Nothingbutbooksweresoldhere.[正]Nothingbutbookswassoldhere.[析]要注意真正的主语是nothing而不是books,所以这一结构在学生的使用中经常出错。[误]Ihavenothingtodobuttocry.[正]Ihavenothingtodobutcry.[析]在这一结构中but后面要用省to的不定式。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档number[误]AnumberofnewscanbeheardonTVtoday.[正]AlotofnewscanbeheardonTVtoday.[析]anumberof后接可数名词复数。[误]Thenumberofstudentsaretenthousand.[正]Thenumberofstudentsistenthousand.[析]anumberof其意为"大量的",而thenumberof…是"某某的数量"。即thenumberofstudents意为"学生人数",所以要用单数形式的谓语动词。Oo"clock[误]It"stenpastfiveo"clock.[正]It"stenpastfive.[析]o"clock所表达的时间是正点,如果要表达的时间是几点几分或差几分几点都不能用o"clock.once[误]Pleasecomeandseemeonce.[正]Pleasecomeandseemeoneday.[析]once用来谈论过去的事情,而不能谈论未来。如果要谈及未来要用oneday,sometime等。[误]ImethimonetimewhenIwasastudent.[正]ImethimoncewhenIwasastudent.[析]英语中一次应用once而不用onetime,二次要用twice而不用twotimes.one[误]Mygrandfatherwantstoliveforhundredyears.[正]Mygrandfatherwantstoliveforonehundredyears.[误]Hethrewawaytheolddictionaryandwantedtobuynewone.[正]Hethrewawaytheolddictionaryandwantedtobuyanewone.[误]Hisdogisbiggerthanmyone.[正]Hisdogisbiggerthanmine.[析]一般物主代词之后不用one,除非one前有修饰词,如myoldone,3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档否则要用名词性物主代词。[误]Oneoftheteacherisintheoffice.[误]Oneoftheteachersareintheoffice.[正]Oneoftheteachersisintheoffice.[析]One是句子的主语,其谓语动词应用单数,而of后面的名词要用复数名词。[误]Onethirdofthebooksissenttothestudents.[正]Onethirdofthebooksaresenttothestudents.[析]几分之几或百分之几这一结构用在主语位置,其谓语动词要与of后面的名词一致,如Twothirdsoftheworkisdone.open[误]Arethebanksopenedtoday?[正]Arethebanksopentoday?[析]要注意open即可用作动词、名词,还可以用作形容词,而close则不同。请看:Arethebanksclosedtoday?这一句是正确的。or[误]Hedoesn"tdrinkandsmoke.[正]Hedoesn"tdrinkorsmoke.[析]否定句中的并列连词要用or而不用and.[误]Heneitherdrinksorsmokes.[正]Heneitherdrinksnorsmokes.other[误]Wherearetheothersstudents?[正]Wherearetheotherstudents?[正]Wherearetheothers?[析]other作形容词时没有复数形式,且作为泛指讲时没有定冠词,如:Asksomeothereople.而加定冠词后为特指。theother可在句中作主语、宾语或定语,如:Nowletmeshowyoutheother.(宾语)Hehastwosons.Oneisaworker,theotherisateacher.(主语)others只能作代词,而theothers则为特指,如:Therearefivebooks.Twoofthemarenotgood.Iliketheothers.out[误]Shewentouttheclassroom,takingadictionarywithher.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Shewentoutoftheclassroom,takingadictionarywithher.[析]outof是指"从……里出来",使用时不要将of丢掉。Ppaper[误]Pleasegivemetwoletterpapers.[正]Pleasegivemetwosheetsofletterpaper.[析]paper作为纸讲为不可数名词。[误]Eachstudentmustwritepaperonwhathelearned.[正]Eachstudentmustwriteapaperonwhathelearned.[析]这里的paper作为论文讲,是可数名词。paper的这种用法还可以用于证件、报纸、考卷等。parent[误]MyparentsandIarebothinterestedinfootball.[正]MyparentsandIareallinterestedinfootball.[析]parents即为父母、双亲,指两个人,加上自己为三个人,所以只能用all而不能用both.pass[误]Theshippastedthechannel.[正]Theshippassedthechannel.[析]pass为动词,而past则为副词,不要混淆,如:Myfatherhasbeenillforthepasttwoweeks.AllthestudentspassedtheeGam.pay[误]Pleasehelpmedothisjob,andIwillpayforyoulater.[正]PleasehelpmedothisjobandIwillpayyoulater.[析]为某工作付给工人工资应为paysomebody,而payforsomething是为某物付款,如:Youcanbuyallthethingsyouwant.I"llpayforthose.people[误]Therearefivehundredpeopleshere.[正]Therearefivehundredpeoplehere.[误]Thereisonlyonepeople.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Thereisonlyoneperson.[误]Peoplethereisfriendly.[正]Peopletherearefriendly.[析]people作为人讲时为复数名词,如要讲一个人应用oneperson,而不能用people,讲若干人时用people而不能加s,这样的用法还有police(警察)等,这些概念用单数时要换其他的词.如:people-aperson;police-policemanpolicewoman;youth-ayoungman/woman.picture[误]Therearesomespotsinthepicture.[正]Therearesomespotsonthepicture.[误]Thereisayoungwomanonthepicture.[正]Thereisayoungwomaninthepicture.[析]指溅落在画面上的灰尘,污物是onthepicture,即讲与画面内容无关的东西用on,而inthepicture用于讲画面的内容。pity[误]Whatpitythathermothermustalwayssuffer![正]Whatapitythathermothermustalwayssuffer![析]pity作为遗憾之事讲常加不定冠词;但要注意作为同情、怜悯讲则不加冠词,为不可数名词,如:Ifeelpityforyou.它还可以用作动词,如:Hepitiedthepoorpeople.[误]Ihavepityforyou.[正]Ihavepityonyou.[析]可怜某人时应用have(take)pityonsomebody,这是个惯用法。place[误]LastyearhewenttoAmerica.Hetravelledfromplacetoanother.[正]LastyearhewenttoAmerica.Hetravelledfromplacetoplace(fromoneplacetoanother).[析]到处译为英文时为fromplacetoplace请不要在place之前加冠词。这种用法在有些语法书中叫作零冠词用法,如:一户挨一户为doorbydoor,手拉手为handinhand.[误]Theaccidentwastakenplaceinthatstreet.[正]Theaccidenttookplaceinthatstreet.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]takeplace为发生,它不能用于被动态,这样的词还有happen等。[误]Thereisnoplaceinthebus.[正]Thereisnoroominthebus.[析]room这里为不可数名词,意为空间,即没有地方了。place多指场所所在之地。[误]IcameheretotakeplaceofMrSmith.[正]IcameheretotaketheplaceofMrSmith.[析]taketheplaceof意为代替、取代某人某事。play[误]Doyouwanttoplayguitar?[正]Doyouwanttoplaytheguitar?[误]Iliketoplaythebridge.[正]Iliketoplaybridge(桥牌).[析]play作为玩讲时,在各种乐器前要加冠词,在各种体育运动前则没有冠词。please[误]Myfriendpleasedmetohisbirthdaypartyyesterday.[正]Myfriendinvitedmetohisbirthdaypartyyesterday.[析]please作为动词时其词义不是请,而是高兴、愿意等意,如:Shealwaysdoeswhatshepleases.(她总是想做什么就做什么。)又如:It"shardtopleaseall.而please作为请讲时为语气词,多用于祈使句中,如:Pleasecomein.[误]Boththeteacherandthemotherwerepleasedtothelittlegirl.[正]Boththeteacherandthemotherwerepleasedwiththelittlegirl.[析]对某人表示满意、喜欢,应用bepleasedwithsomebody.对某事感到高兴和满意时多用bepleasedat或about,但有时也可用with,却不能用of.pleasure[误]Theboygavehisparentsalotofpleasures.[正]Theboygavehisparentsalotofpleasure.[析]pleasure作为高兴、愉快、享乐、娱乐讲时为不可数名词。[误]Itispleasuretoworkwithyou.[正]Itisapleasuretoworkwithyou.[析]pleasure作为一件或某件乐事、高兴之事讲时为可数名词,如:Itisone3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档ofmypleasures.police[误]Thepolicehasnotfoundthecauseoftheaccident.[正]Thepolicehavenotfoundthecauseoftheaccident.[析]police为复数名词,它没有单数形式。如果要讲一个警察要用apoliceman,两个要用twopolicemen,或apolicewoman,twopolicewomen.prepare[误]I"mpreparingtheeGam.[正]I"mpreparingfortheeGam.[误]We"llreturnintimeforyoutopreparefordinner.[正]We"llreturnintimeforyoutopreparedinner.[析]prepare既是及物动词,又是不及物动词。作及物动词时其后面所跟的事物是正在准备的;而作不及物动词时for后面的事物是目标。如:I"mpreparingfortheeGam.应译为我正在为考试做准备。同样的用法还有search与searchfor.present[误]Don"tworry.Icanpresentthemeeting.[正]Don"tworry.Icanbepresentatthemeeting.[析]present作为出席、在场讲时,是形容词而不应用作动词。其动词意为送给;赠给;提出,如:Thereporterpresentedargumentsofhisidea.put[误]Sheputoffherreddressandputonthegreenone.[正]Shetookoffherreddressandputonthegreenone.[析]与put连用的介词很多,一般来讲on与off是一对相反的意义的介词,如:turnon(打开),turnoff(关上),穿衣服是puton,但脱衣服却只能用takeoff,而putoff是推迟、使某人下车、关掉之意,如:TheyputofftheeGambecausethenationalholiday.(因国家假日而推迟考期。)CouldyouputmeoffattheTownHall.(请在市政厅让我下车。)Pleaseputoffthewirelessbeforeyouleave.(走之前请关掉无线电。)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档Rradio[误]Therearetworadioesintheclassroom.[正]Therearetworadiosintheclassroom.[误]Iheardtheweatherreportthroughtheradio.[正]Iheardtheweatherreportontheradio.[析]在收音机中听到某事应为hearsomethingontheradio,听收音机应为listentotheradio.这样的用法还有电视,看电视为watchTV,讲在电视上看见什么节目为watch…onTV,如:I"mwatchingthefootballmatchonTV.但注意,作为一种通信手段时应为byradio,如:Policearetalkingtoeachotherbyradio.rain[误]Thereisasmallrainfalling.[正]Thereisalightrainfalling.[误]Thereisabigrain.[正]Thereisaheavyrain.[析]大雨在英文中应为aheavyrain,raincatsanddogs为倾盆大雨,小雨为alightrain.千万不要讲abigrain或asmallrain.当作动词讲时,雨下得很大可译为:Itrainsverymuchnow/hardnow/heavilynow.reach[误]Wereachedtothetownverylate.[正]Wereachedthetownverylate.[析]reach作为到达讲是及物动词,而arrive为不及物动词。但要注意reach的词组搭配,如reachfor,为伸手去拿,如:Thethiefreachedforthegun.reachout伸出手,如:Hereachedoutandtookaninterestingbook.ready[误]Youmustreadyatonce.[正]Youmustbereadyatonce.[析]ready为形容词,而不像中文中准备为动词。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档remember[误]Ididn"trememberclosingthedoor,sothethiefcameintotheroomdirectly.[正]Ididn"tremembertoclosethedoor,sothethiefcameintotheroomdirectly.[析]remember其后接动名词,动名词所表示的动作已经做完,如:Idon"tremembermeetingyou.其后如接不定式,不定式表达的动作还没有去做,如:Doremembertoturnoffthelightbeforeyouleave.rest[误]Therestofthestudentsisgirls.[正]Therestofthestudentsaregirls.[析]rest作剩余部分讲时,therestof…结构作主语时其谓语动词应与of后面的名词的数保持一致。这种用法还有1/3of,80%of等。[误]Therestoftheworkaredone.[正]Therestoftheworkisdone.return[误]Myfriendsreturnedbacktotheirsecondhometown.[正]Myfriendsreturnedtotheirsecondhometown.[析]return即为返回,所以back是多余的。这句话还可以表述为:Myfriendswentbacktotheirsecondhometown.rice[误]Wehadafewriceandsomebread.[正]Wehadalittlericeandsomebread.[析]rice为物质名词,为不可数名词。rice[误]Wehadafewriceandsomebread.[正]Wehadalittlericeandsomebread.[析]rice为物质名词,为不可数名词。rich[误]Thecountryisrichofoil.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Thecountryisrichinoil.[析]berichin为盛产……。[误]Therichisnotalwayshappy.[正]Thericharenotalwayshappy.[析]形容词加定冠词表示一类人,作主语时要作复数看待。[误]Allhisrichesisnogoodtohimifheissoill.[正]Allhisrichesarenogoodtohimifheissoill.[析]riches为财富,是复数名词,没有单数形式。像这样的词还有goods(货物),greens(青菜),manners(礼貌)等。river[误]Welikeswimmingontheriver.[正]Welikeswimmingintheriver.[误]Welikeboatingintheriver.[正]Welikeboatingontheriver.[析]游泳用intheriver,而在湖中划船要用ontheriver.room[误]Therearealreadythreepeoplesittingonthesofa,pleasetrytomakearoomforher.[正]Therearealreadythreepeoplesittingonthesofa,pleasetrytomakeroomforher.[析]room作为空间讲时为不可数名词。leaveroomfor…为给某人留点空地;makeroomfor…为让位给某人,如:Theyoungmanmaderoomforanoldwoman.run[误]Iranacrosswithanoldfriendattheschoolgate.[正]Iranacrossanoldfriendattheschoolgate.[析]runacross为偶然相遇。[误]Thetruckranacrossthecat.[正]Thetruckranoverthecat.[析]runover为从……上辗过。[误]YesterdayIrantoastormonmywayhome.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]YesterdayIranintoastormonmywayhome.[析]runinto为撞上或撞在……上。Ssafe[误]Thebravemansafedtheboyfromdrowning.[正]Thebravemansavedtheboyfromdrowning.[析]safe是形容词,如:Theywishedhimasafejourney.safely是副词,如:Theyoungmandriveshiscarsafely.而safety是名词,如:safetyisland(安全岛),Safetyfirst!(安全第一!)但save是动词。same[误]YesterdayIgotapostcard.Itisthesamethatyougotthedaybeforeyesterday.[正]YesterdayIgotapostcard.Itisthesameasyougotthedaybeforeyesterday.[析]thesamethat意为"即是",而thesameas才能译为"像……一样的。"[误]Yourbookisnotsameasmine.[正]Yourbookisnotthesameasmine.[析]thesameas中的定冠词不能少。say[误]Hisreportwrotesheisnineteen.[正]Hisreportsayssheisnineteen.[析]中文中常讲"报告上写到"、"信上写到",这样的"写"在英文中要用say.sayspeaktalktell英文中"说"一般有四个词,其中say和tell为及物动词。tell可以加双宾语,如Pleasetellmeastory.而speak与talk为不及物动词。speak只有后面直接加"语言"时才是及物的,如:PleasespeakEnglish.请看下句:Hewentontalkingforalongtime,buthespokesofastthatfewofuscouldcatchwhathesaid.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档sea[误]Asaboyhisgreatambition(抱负)wastogotothesea.[正]Asaboyhisgreatambitionwastogotosea.[析]gotosea为"去当水手、海员";而gotothesea=gototheseaside,如:Hewanttogototheseaforhisvacation.在"海中"游泳为inthesea;atsea为在"海上航行",如:Ihaveabrotheratsea.bysea为"坐船"、"由海路运输",如:WetravelledtoNewYorkbysea.second[误]Iwanttolearnthesecondforeignlanguage.[正]Iwanttolearnasecondforeignlanguage.[析]当作为"第二"外语,"再增加一个"时,不要用thesecond而要用asecond.thesecond强调排队的次序,asecond强调再增加一个。see[误]Hewasseenleavetheroom.[正]Hewasseentoleavetheroom.[析]see作主动态时用作toseesomebodydosomething,而用作被动态时则是somebodytobeseentodosomething.要注意惯用法letmesee(让我想想)。sheep[误]Therearefivesheepsonthegrass.[正]Therearefivesheeponthegrass.[析]sheep是单、复数同形名词,其他的还有:deer(鹿),fish(鱼)等。ship[误]Itravelledonayacht.[正]Itravelledonaship(inayacht).[析]虽然都是船,但游艇(yacht)要用in,而ship要用on.sick[误]Thelittleboywasaillboy.[正]Thelittleboywasasickboy.[析]sick与ill作表语时都表示"有病"之意,如:Hefeelsill.或Hefeelssick.都对,但作定语时则只能用sick.since3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]HeislivinginGreecesince1978.[正]HehaslivedinGreecesince1978.[正]HehasbeenlivinginGreecesince1978.[析]由since引出的状语从句意为"自从"某时一直如何,主句要用完成时或完成进行时。[误]ShehasbeenquitedifferentsincecamebackfromAmerica.[正]ShehasbeenquitedifferentsincecomingbackfromAmerica.[析]分词短语可以用在after,before,since等介词后面。sleep[误]Theboywasveryasleep.[正]Theboywasfastasleep.[析]熟睡在英文中为fastasleep.非正式英语中一般不常用He"ssleeping.而常讲He"sasleep.其形容词sleepy是"困倦的",如:Ishallgotobednow.I"msosleepy."卧铺"英国人讲sleepingcar,而美国人讲sleeper.slow[误]Slowthedooropened.[正]Slowlythedooropened.[析]slow与slowly的用法与意思相同,在口语中和路标中多用slow,如:Tellhimtodriveslower.Slow,dangerousbend.但是如果用在动词前还是要用slowly.smile[误]Shesmiledtome.[正]Shesmiledatme.[析]"冲着某人笑"应为tosmileatsomebody.so[误]Itissuchbeautifulabookthateverychildlikesit.[正]Itissuchabeautifulbookthateverychildlikesit.[正]Itissobeautifulabookthateverychildlikesit.[析]关于so与such用法的区别有四种情况:①用于单数可数名词之前,其格式为"such+不定冠词+形容词+名词",而"so+形容词+不定冠词"。②用于可数名词复数或不可数名词前,只能用such,如:Itissuchgoodweatherthatwewanttogoforawalk.Theyaresuchgoodstudentsthatthey3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档canpasstheeGameasily.③在只有形容词时只能用so,如:ItissogoodthatIlikeitverymuch.④在many,much,few,little这四个词前只能用so而不能用such。如:IhavesolittlemoneythatIcan"tbuythedictionary.[误]Hegotupearlysoashecouldcatchthefirstbus.[正]Hegotupearlysoastocatchthefirstbus.[正]Hegotupearlysothathecouldcatchthefirstbus.[正]Hegotupsoearlythathecouldcatchthefirstbus.some[误]Doyouhavesomelessonetoprepare?[正]Doyouhaveanylessonstoprepare?[析]在疑问句或否定句中要用any;some多用在肯定句中,如:Ihavesomemoneytobuyit.在请求,或真心希望得到肯定答复时,在疑问句中也要用some,如:Wouldyoulikesomethingtodrink?即真心实意希望为对方提供饮料。又如:Couldyoulendmesomemoney?即真心想要借到钱。sometime[误]IhavesometimethoughtthatIshouldliketoliveinthecountry.[正]IhavesometimesthoughtthatIshouldliketoliveinthecountry.sometimesometimessometimessometimesometime为"某个时候"、"总有一天",如:We"llmeetagainsometimeneGtyear.或过去的"某一时刻",如:IsawhersometimeinJuly.sometimes为"有时候"、"时常"、"常常",如:Everymanisafoolsometimes,andnoneatalltimes.Sometimes为"若干次",如:IvisitedAmericasometimes.Maybefiveorseventimes.Iamnotsure.Sometime则是"一段时间"、"一些时候",如:Iwanttoleavesometime.soon[误]Theroomassoonasbecamecrowded.[正]Theroomsoonbecamecrowded.[析]soon为"不久"、"很快",如:I"llbethereverysoon.而assoonas意为"一……就……",如:AssoonasIfinishedmyhomeworkIwentouttoplayfootball.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档sound[误]Thereportsoundswell.[正]Thereportsoundsgood.[析]sound作动词时其后接形容词而不接副词,如:Howsweetthemusicsounds!sport[误]Areyougoingtorunintheschoolsprot?[正]Areyougoingtorunintheschoolsprots?[析]sport用作可数名词单数时指具体的某项运动,如:Basketballisanindoorsport.而在泛指"运动"或"运动会"时要用其复数形式sports.spring[误]I"llvisitAmericainthisspring.[正]I"llvisitAmericainspring.[正]I"llvisitAmericathisspring.[析]英语一年四季前如果有that,this,last,neGt等词,则其前面不要再加介词。这样的用法还有周、月、年等。请看下面句子中的用法有何不同:HetoldmethatshediditontheneGtday.这时是指过去某一天的第二天,所以才有这种用法。如果以现在为时间基点的第二天应为I"lldoitneGtday.start[误]WhattimewillyoustarttoSanFrancisco?[正]WhattimewillyoustartforSanFrancisco?[析]start与leave一样,其后接"for+目的地"。beginstartbegin与start在很多场合下是一样的意思,如:Westarted/begantostudyEnglishtwoyearsago.但在如下场合则不能用begin:①作为"启程"讲,如:IthinkweoughttostartatsiG.②表示"开始工作",如:Thecarwon"tstart.(车子发动不起来。)③作为"开动"、"启动"讲,如:Doyouknowhowtostartthismachine.still[误]Oh,itisstillrainingnow.[正]Oh,itisstillraining.[析]因still即包含有现在仍然如何,所以now是多余词。stillyetalready3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档still一般与动词连用,可放于句子中间用以说明过去开始的动作现在仍然在继续,特别用来表示我们希望它早点停止。如:I"vebeenthinkingforhours,butIstillcan"tdecide.yet一般放于句末,用在疑问句与否定句中。如:Hasthepostmancomeyet?already则与动词连用,可放于句中表示某事的发生比预期的要早,如:I"vealreadyfinishedmyhomework.stop[误]Whentheteachercameintotheclassroomthestudentsstoppedtotalk.[正]Whentheteachercameintotheclassroomthestudentsstoppedtalking.[析]stoptodosomething是"停下来去做某事",而stopdoingsomething是"停止做某事"。street[误]ThereisanarrowwindingstreetfromourvillagetotheneGtone.[正]ThereisanarrowwindingroadfromourvillagetotheneGtone.[析]street一般指城市中两旁有建筑物的"街道",而road多指乡间的"路"。strict[误]Yououghttobestricttohim.[正]Yououghttobestrictwithhim.[析]bestrictwith是"对……严格的"。such[误]Doyouwanttohavesuchadictionary?[正]Doyouwanttohavesuchagooddictionary?[正]Doyouwanttohaveadictionarylikethat?[析]such作加强语气时一般是"such+(冠词)形容词+名词",如:It"ssuchagoodbook.但如果名词前没有形容词则要看其名词是否具有"能显示程度的含意",如:I"vegotsuchaheadache.Youaresuchfools!否则在such与名词之间一定要有形容词。sure[误]Iamquitesureforthatanswer.[正]Iamquitesureofthatanswer.[析]sure用于句中表示"对……事有确实把握"时应跟of或about,而不跟3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档for,如:I"msureabout(of)hisabilitytocontrolthismachine.sweet[误]Honeytastessweetly.[正]Honeytastessweet.[析]sweet可以作为名词,意为"糖果",是可数名词,如:MayIhaveasweet?作形容词,如:Thechildlookedverysweet.而sweetly为副词,意为"甜美地"、"悦耳地"。要注意taste为感观动词,其后面要接形容词而不是副词。Ttake[误]ThisyearIwanttotakethedriver"slicense.[正]ThisyearIwanttogetthedriver"slicense.[析]take可以作为动词,意为"拿"、"取",如:Iwanttotakemymail.而要获得某种证书、证明,要用get而不用take,take在学校范围内意为"参加"或"选修"某些课程,如:ThistermIwanttotakebothFrenchandSpanish.[误]Theaccidentwastakenplaceatthestreetcorner.[正]Theaccidenttookplaceatthestreetcorner.[析]takeplace与happen一样作为"发生"讲时没有被动语态。[误]Doyoutakemeasafool?[正]Doyoutakemeforafool?[析]take…for…意为"以为是……"、"错当作……"、"误认为",而这一意思还可以用于Itookyoutobethebestfriend.(我把你认作是最好的朋友。)[误]MyEnglishteacherwasill.Whowilltakeplaceher?[正]MyEnglishteacherwasill.Whowilltaketheplaceofher?[析]taketheplaceof…意为"取代"。talk[误]YesterdayImetanoldfriend.Wetalkedmanythings.[正]YesterdayImetanoldfriend.Wetakedaboutmanythings.[析]talk是不及物动词。team[误]Ourteamlikesseeingfilm.[正]Ourteamlikeseeingfilm.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]team与family,class等词一样,指整体时为单数名词。如:OurteamiseGcellent,而指集体中的个体时要用作复数。than[误]Theymadefewermistakesthistermthantheymadelastlerm.[正]Theymadefewermistakesthistermthantheydidlastlerm.[析]当一个动作在同一个句子中重复时,第二次要用do来代替,以避免重复。[误]YoumakemedomorethenanybodyIknow.[正]YoumakemedomorethananybodyIknow.[误]Igotintotherestroomthansomeoneknockedatthedoor.[正]Igotintotherestroomthensomeoneknockedatthedoor.[析]than与then不要误用。then[误]Wewenttothecinema,thenwenttoaChineserestaurant.[正]Wewenttothecinema,andthenwenttoaChineserestaurant.[正]Wewenttothecinema;thenwenttoaChineserestaurant.[析]then作"然后"讲时,在then前应加分号而不用逗号,或加逗号用andthen,但是如果是倒装句则要用逗号,如:FirstcomeTom,thenMary.think[误]Ithinkyouarenotright.[正]Idon"tthinkyouareright.[析]think在肯定句中与中文的习惯用法是一致的,如:Ithinkyouareright.但在宾语从句是否定意思时,要否定think,如:Idon"tthinkyouareright.[误]Ithinkhewillcomehere,doI?[正]Ithinkhewillcomehere,wonthe?[析]think加宾语从句时,反意疑问句的主语应用宾语从句中的主语,助动词要用宾语从句中的助动词,而肯定还是否定要看主句中的情况决定:如主句用肯定句,则反意疑问句用否定句,反之亦然。[误]Peoplethinkveryhighofhiswork.[正]Peoplethinkveryhighlyofhiswork.[析]thinkhighlyof为"对某人某事评价很高"。[误]WhenwetalkaboutChinesepeoplewealwaysthinktheYellowRiver.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]WhenwetalkaboutChinesepeoplewealwaysthinkabouttheYellowRiver.[析]thinkabout意为"想起"、"想到"。thousand[误]Hegotthousandofbooksfromasecondhandbookshop.[正]Hegotthousandsofbooksfromasecondhandbookshop.[析]虽然twothousand,threethousand在thousand后都不加s,但thousandsof则为"数千",该结构中一定要加s。through[误]IhadalongdistancecallwithJohnthroughtthetelephone.[正]IhadalongdistancecallwithJohnonthetelephone.[误]Ittookustwohourstowalkacrosstheforest.[正]Ittookustwohourstowalkthroughtheforest.[析]across是表示在一平面上进行的动作,而through则是用在三维空间的动作。如:Theriverwasfrozen,sowecouldwalkacrossit.Ipushedthroughthecrowdstotheentrance.throw[误]Hethrewastonetome.[正]Hethrewastoneatme.[析]"扔"这个词表示方向时要注意他向我扔石头是atme,我向他扔石头则为tohim,但throwat还有寻衅之意,如:Stopthrowingstonesatthecars.这时不要误用to.time[误]Thedoctorcameontimesoshewassaved.[正]Thedoctorcameintimesoshewassaved.[析]intime为"及时赶到",如:Doyouthinkwecangetthereintimeforthefirstact.而ontime意为"准时",如:Thetrainarrivedontime.[误]Itistimewegohome.[正]Itistimeweshouldgohome.[正]Itistimewewenthome.[析]"是该作某事的时候了",其句形为:①Itistimeforsomebodytodosomething.②"Itistime+从句",从句中用"should+动词原形",或直接用动词的过去式。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Let"shurry.Wehaven"tmanytimes.[正]Let"shurry.Wehaven"tmuchtime.[误]IhavebeentoAmericatwotimes.[正]IhavebeentoAmericatwice.[析]time作为"时间"讲时为不可数名词,而作为"次"讲时则是可数名词。但"一次"不是onetime,而是once;"二次"不是twotimes,而是twice;"三次"则是threetimes.too[误]ThisboGistooheavytoliftit.[正]ThisboGistooheavytolift.[析]在too…to这一结构中,如果主语和不定式的宾语是一致的,则不要重复。[误]Thechildistooyoungnottogotoschool.[正]Thechildistooyoungtogotoschool.[析]too…to这一结构用来表示"太……以致于不能……",但下面的句子则不能照此翻译:I"mtoogladtomeetyou.应译为"我见到你真太高兴了"。[误]Thereismuchtoonoise.[正]Thereistoomuchnoise.[析]"muchtoo+形容词",而"toomuch+不可数名词"。[误]Youhaveboughttoomuchtomatoes.[正]Youhaveboughttoomanytomatoes.[析]toomany后才加可数名词。alsoaswelltoo这三个词是近义词,但其用法各有不同。其一,too和aswell通常用于句末,如:Shewenttothecinemaandherbrotherwenttoo.而also则不用于句末,如:I"vealsoreadherothernovels.其二,这三个词都不用于否定句中,否定句中用not…either,或neither/nor…,如:Heisn"thereeither.trousers[误]Mytrouserisgettingsmallerandsmaller.[正]Mytrousersaregettingsmallerandsmaller.[析]英语中trousers,pants,shorts(短裤),glasses(眼镜)都要用复数形式。[误]Thispairofglassesareverygood.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Thispairofglassesisverygood.[析]有了量词apairof,其后的谓语动词要与量词相一致。如:twopairsof…的谓语动词就要用复数。try[误]Itriedtosendherflowersbutitdidn"thaveanyeffect.[正]Itriedsendingherflowersbutitdidn"thaveanyeffect.(我试着给她送花,但没有什么结果。)[误]Pleasetryunderstandingit.[正]Pleasetrytounderstandit.[析]"try+动名词"的意思是"试一试",或"做某事看看会发生什么情况",而"try+不定式"表示为达到目的要去做的事。Uunder[误]Thelakeistwometersundersealevel.[正]Thelakeistwometersbelowsealevel.[析]under的意思是在某物的下面,而below=lowerthan,即"低于"。[误]Underthehelpofourteacher,allofuspassedtheeGam.[正]Withthehelpofourteacher,allofuspassedtheeGam.understand[误]Ithinkitisdiffculttomakemyselftounderstand.[正]Ithinkitisdiffculttomakemyselfunderstood.[析]这句话的意思是"我想让别人理解我太难了"。[误]Iamunderstandingthelessonnow.[正]Iunderstandthelessonnow.[析]understand一词没有进行时态。类似的词还有belong,find,hear,love,like等。until[误]Wewalkeduntiltheedgeoftheforest.[正]Wewalkedasfarastheedgeoftheforest.[误]Ourschoolbuscanholduntiltwentychildren.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]Ourschoolbuscanholduptotwentychildren.[析]until与till两词的意思一样,但两个词都只能用于时间,如:I"llwaituntilIhearfromyou.[误]Iwaitedformymothertoseveno"clock,butshedidn"tcome.[正]Iwaitedformymotheruntilseveno"clock,butshedidn"tcome.[误]CanyoureturnthisbookuntilMonday?[正]CanyoureturnthisbookbyMonday?[析]当我们谈目前正在进行而将来某一时刻才停止的事件时用until,而用by来表达将来某一时刻会发生的动作。[误]Wearrivedhomeuntilitbecamedark.[正]Wedidn"tarrivedhomeuntilitbecamedark.[析]until用于肯定句时表示"某动作直到……为止",如:Theyworkeduntil5∶00P.M.用于否定句中时意为"直到……才"。所以用于肯定句中要使用延续性动词,但截止性动词却可以用在否定句中。upstairs[误]Hewenttoupstairs.[正]Hewentupstairs.[析]upstairs一词可用作副词,如:Weallhurriedupstairstoseewhathappened.也可用作名词,如;Theupstairsofthehouseneedspainting.同时也可以用作形容词,如:Ahousewiththreeupstairsroomsisquitegood.use[误]Itisnousetoaskher.[正]Itisnouseaskingher.[析]Itisnouse…与Thereisnouse…后通常用动名词,而不用不定式。[误]I"llgetusedtotreatthestudentsthisway.[正]I"llgetusedtotreatingthestudentsthisway.[析]beusedto与getusedto后要接动名词表示"习惯于"做某事。[误]Iusedtogettingupearlyinthemorning.[正]Iusedtogetupearlyinthemorning.[析]usedto表示过去习惯的动作,其后要加动词原形。[误]Oilwasusedtocooking.[正]Oilwasusedtocook.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[析]这里的句型虽然也是beusedto但这里不是主动态,而是被动态,所以不能接动名词而应接不定式。[误]WeusedtogototheGreatWallthreetimes.[正]WewenttotheGreatWallthreetimes.[析]usedto只能用来表示一种习惯,而不能用来表达某事发生的次数。Vvery[误]Thankyouindeed.[正]Thankyouverymuchindeed.[析]indeed用来修饰verymuch,但要放其后面,而且也不要单独使用。[误]Thebabywasveryasleep.[正]Thebabywasfastasleep.[析]不是所有的形容词都可以用very来修饰,如:I"mwideawake.(我全醒了。)再如:allalone(十分孤独),muchafraid等。[误]Thethingseemstobeveryimproved.[正]Thethingseemstobemuchimproved.[析]有些语法书讲very修饰现在分词,而much修饰过去分词,这要分别对待。如果过去分词是指一个具体的动作,而且是句中主要动词的一部分就必须用much,而某些形容词化的过去分词,还是要用very来修饰的,如:Iamverytired.[误]Thereisverylesswaterintheriverthanusual.[正]Thereismuch/farlesswaterintheriverthanusual.[析]very不能修饰形容词或副词的比较级,而要用far,much等来修饰。Wwait[误]TomorrowIwillwaityouatthebusstop.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[正]TomorrowIwillwaitforyouatthebusstop.[析]wait是不及物动词,"等人"要用waitforsomebody;而waitup为"不睡觉等候某事",如:I"llwaituptonight.walk[误]Ithinkshewentawalkyesterday.[正]Ithinkshewentoutforawalkyesterday.[析]散步在英文中要讲haveawalk,takeawalk.如果用go要用goforawalk.want[误]Theflowerswanttowater.[正]Theflowerswantwatering.[析]want在这里作为"需要"讲,其后加动名词。这句话的意思是"这花需要浇水。"[误]Doyouwantsomeonegoalongwithyou?[正]Doyouwantsomeonetogoalongwithyou?[析]wantsomebodytodosomething为一固定用法。wash[误]Areyougoingtomakwashingthisweekend?[正]Areyougoingtodowashingthisweekend?[析]dowashing为"洗衣服",是固定搭配。watch[误]Yourwatchiswhattime?[正]Whattimeisitbyyourwatch?[析]一定要记住英文的习惯用法。[误]Themotherwanttowatchthechildrentoplayonthegrass.[正]Themotherwanttowatchthechildrenplay(playing)onthegrass.[析]watch的用法同see,hear等词。way[误]Pleasemovethechair,itisontheway.[正]Pleasemovethechair,itisintheway.[析]intheway为"挡道",而ontheway为"在路上",如:onmywayhome(在回家路上),onhiswaytothestation(在他去火车站的路上)。而bytheway3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档是"顺便说",如:Bytheway,haveyouheardfromJoanrecently?[误]Thestudentswereontheirwaytohome.[正]Thestudentswereontheirwayhome.[析]home在这里为副词。wear[误]Thelittlegirlisoldenoughtowearherself.[正]Thelittlegirlisoldenoughtodressherself.[析]wear后接衣物而不接反身代词。what[误]Iwanttoknowwhattodoit?[正]Iwanttoknowwhattodo?[误]Iwanttoknowhowtodo?[正]Iwanttoknowhowtodoit?[析]what是疑问代词,而how是疑问副词。要注意它们用法的不同。when[误]I"dcookyounicemealwhenyou"dcomehomeintheevening.[正]I"dcookyounicemealwhenyoucamehomeintheevening.[析]在when引导的状语从句中,要用一般时表示将来,即主句中是将来时,从句中应用一般现在时,如主句中是过去将来时,从句中应用一般过去时。如:I"llbebackwhenyoucomebackfromschool.[误]Wheninthesecondgrade,hismotherboughthimabike.[正]WhenTomwasinthesecondgrade,hismotherboughthimabike.[析]复合句中只有当主句的主语与从句的主语一致的情况下,才有可能省略,如:Whenyounghehadtoworkallday.[误]We"llgototheparkwhenitdoesn"traintomorrow.[正]We"llgototheparkifitdoesn"traintomorrow.[析]if用来表示不能肯定的事如果发生会如何;而when用来表示肯定会发生或很可能会发生的事情,如:I"llseeyouinSeptemberwhenIcomeback.[误]Idon"tknowwhenhecomeshometomorrow.[正]Idon"tknowwhenhewillcomehometomorrow.[析]when所引出的宾语从句如果是表示将来的动作要用将来时,而不是像时间状语从句中用一般时表示将来。where3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[误]Idon"tknowwheretogoto.[正]Idon"tknowwheretogo.[析]where是疑问副词。whether[误]Itisunknownifhewillcome.[正]Itisunknownwhetherhewillcome.[析]if不能引导主语从句。上句中it是形式主语,其后的从句才是真正的主语从句。要注意以下各种情况不宜用if而要用whether:①Ididn"tknowwhetheryou"llgoornot.(因句中有ornot选项。)②Hedidn"tknowwhethertovisittheoldman.(因用于不定式前。)③I"minterestedinwhetherhe"llgo.(因作介词的宾语从句。)④Iwanttoknowthenewswhetherourteamwillwin.(同位语从句。)⑤Letmeknowwhetheryoucancome.(此句如用if则含意有所不同,其意就变为"如果你能来请通知我"。而用whether则意为"让我知道你是否能来"。)who[误]Whomdoyouthinkwouldliketocomeforagameoffootball?[正]Whodoyouthinkwouldliketocomeforagameoffootball?[析]在这个句式中"doyouthink"应看作插入语,所以原句应为Whowouldliketocomeforagameoffootball?[误]Fromwhowasthegift?[正]Fromwhomwasthegift?[正]Whowasthatgiftfrom?[析]在句首时现代英语常用who取代whom,而在紧跟介词时则不能用who来取代whom.why[误]Whynottogotothepark?[正]Whynotgotothepark?[析]whynot后面接不带to的不定式,也可以用whydon"tyougowithher?win[误]Wehavewonyourclass.[正]Wehavebeatenyourclass.[析]win是及物动词,其后的宾语应是比赛、战争、奖品、奖金,如:Which3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档teamwonthefootballmatch?而beat是指"打败"对手、敌人,如:Mybrotherbeatmeatpoker.(请注意,beat是不规则动词,其过去式与原形相同,而过去分词为beaten.)wish[误]Ihopeyoutobeagoodstudent.[正]Iwishyoutobeagoodstudent.[析]hope不能加宾语再加宾语补足语,而wish则可以,如:Iwishyouluck.(我祝你走运。)without[误]Ican"tdothisworkwellwithoutyouhelpme.[正]Ican"tdothisworkwellwithoutyourhelp.[析]without其后接动名词或名词而不接从句。work[误]Thisgirlislookingforaworkatthebank.[正]Thisgirlislookingforajobatthebank.[析]"找工作"一般应为tofindajob,而works作为"工作"讲为不可数名词,不能加不定冠词,也不可用复数。当work作为"作品"、"著作"讲时,为可数名词,如:Thispaintingisoneofhisgreatworks.而works作为"工厂"讲时单复数形式相同,如:anironworks或twoironworks.作主语时其谓语动词可用单数,如:Thesteelworksisclosedfortheholidays.write[误]Youmaywritewithink.[正]Youmaywriteinink.[正]Youmaywritewithapen.[析]"用……写"这一表达法要看用的是什么:如果用钢笔则应用with,如:Pleasefillinthisformwithapen.但讲用墨水时则要用in.Yyesterday[误]Icameacrossmyoldfriendyesterdaynight.[正]Icameacrossmyoldfriendlastnight.[析]"昨晚"应译为lastnight.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档初中英语语法学习提纲初中英语语法学习提纲一、词类、句子成分和构词法:1、词类:英语词类分十种:名词、形容词、代词、数词、冠词、动词、副词、介词、连词、感叹词。1、名词(n.):表示人、事物、地点或抽象概念的名称。如:boy,morning,bag,ball,class,orange.2、代词(pron.):主要用来代替名词。如:who,she,you,it.3、形容词(adj..):表示人或事物的性质或特征。如:good,right,white,orange.4、数词(num.):表示数目或事物的顺序。如:one,two,three,first,second,third,fourth.5、动词(v.):表示动作或状态。如:am,is,are,have,see.6、副词(adv.):修饰动词、形容词或其他副词,说明时间、地点、程度等。如:now,very,here,often,quietly,slowly.7、冠词(art..):用在名词前,帮助说明名词。如:a,an,the.8、介词(prep.):表示它后面的名词或代词与其他句子成分的关系。如in,on,from,above,behind.9、连词(conj.):用来连接词、短语或句子。如and,but,before.10、感叹词(interj..)表示喜、怒、哀、乐等感情。如:oh,well,hi,hello.2、句子成分:英语句子成分分为七种:主语、谓语、宾语、定语、状语、表语、宾语补足语。1、主语是句子所要说的人或事物,回答是“谁”或者“什么”。通常用名词或代词担任。如:I’mMissGreen.(我是格林小姐)2、谓语动词说明主语的动作或状态,回答“做(什么)”。主要由动词担任。如:Jackcleanstheroomeveryday.(杰克每天打扫房间)3、表语在系动词之后,说明主语的身份或特征,回答是“什么”或者“3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档怎么样”。通常由名词、代词或形容词担任。如:MynameisPingping.(我的名字叫萍萍)4、宾语表示及物动词的对象或结果,回答做的是“什么”。通常由名词或代词担任。如:Hecanspelltheword.(他能拼这个词)有些及物动词带有两个宾语,一个指物,一个指人。指物的叫直接宾语,指人的叫间接宾语。间接宾语一般放在直接宾语的前面。如:Hewrotemealetter.(他给我写了一封信)有时可把介词to或for加在间接宾语前构成短语,放在直接宾语后面,来强调间接宾语。如:Hewrotealettertome.(他给我写了一封信)5、定语修饰名词或代词,通常由形容词、代词、数词等担任。如:Shanghaiisabigcity.(上海是个大城市)6、状语用来修饰动词、形容词、副词,通常由副词担任。如:Heworkshard.(他工作努力)7、宾语补足语用来说明宾语怎么样或干什么,通常由形容词或动词充当。如:Theyusuallykeeptheirclassroomclean.(他们通常让教室保持清洁)/Heoftenhelpsmedomylessons.(他常常帮我做功课)/TheteacherwantedmetolearnFrenchallbymyself.(老师要我自学法语)☆同位语通常紧跟在名词、代词后面,进一步说明它的情况。如:WhereisyourclassmateTom?(你的同学汤姆在哪里?)3、构词法:英语构词法主要有:合成法、派生法和转换法。1、合成法:如:spaceship,headache,basketball,playground等等。2、派生法:(1)派生名词:①动词+er/or②动词+ing③动词+(t)ion④形容词+ness⑤其他,如:inventor,learner,swimming,congratulation,kindness,carelessness,knowledge(2)派生形容词:①名词+y②名词+ful③动词+ing/ed④friendly⑤dangerous⑥Chinese;Japanese⑦English⑧French⑨German⑩国名+(i)an如:snowy,sunny,hopeful,beautiful,interesting,follwing,daily(每日的),nervous,delicious(3)派生副词:①形容词+ly②其它,如:slowly,angrily,full→fully,good→well,possible→possibly等等。3、转换法:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(1)形容词→动词,如:dry(干燥的)→dry(弄干),clean(干净的)→clean(打扫,弄干净),等等。(2)动词→名词,如:look,walk,rest,work,study,swim,go,talk等等。(3)名词→动词,如:hand(手)→(传递),face(脸)→(面对)等等。(4)形容词→副词,如:early→early,fast→fast等等。(5)副词→连词,如:when(什么时候)→(当……时候),等等。(6)介词→副词,如:in(到……里)→(在里面;在家),on(在…上)→(进行,继续),等等。二、名词:1、英语名词可分专有名词和普通名词两大类:1、专有名词是个别的人、地、物、团体、机构等的专用名称。专有名词中实词的第一个字母要大写。如:Beijing,Tom,thePeople’sRepublicofChina(中华人民共和国)专有名词如果是含有普通名词的短语,则必须使用定冠词the。如:theGreatWall(长城)姓氏名如果采用复数形式,则表示该姓氏一家人(复数含义),如:theGreens(格林一家人)。2、普通名词是许多人或事物的共有名称。如:pupil,family,man,foot.普通名词又分为可数名词和不可数名词。▲可数名词是可以用简单的数词进行计数的名词,如:boG,child,orange;▲不可数名词是不可以用简单的数词进行计数的名词。如:water,news,oil,population,information.2、英语可数名词的单复数:英语可数名词有单数和复数两种形式。1、名词由单数变复数的基本方法如下:①在单数名词词尾加s。如:map→maps,boy→boys,horse→horses,table→tables.②s,o,G,sh,ch结尾的词加es.如:class→classes,boG→boGes,hero→heroes,dish→dishes,bench→benches.[注]:少数以o结尾的词,变复数时只加s。如:photo→photos,piano→pianos.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档③以辅音字母加y结尾的名词,变y为i,再加es。如:family→families,city→cities,party→parties.④以f或fe结尾的名词,变f或fe为v,再加es。如:shelf→shelves,wolf→wolves,life→lives,knife→knives.2、不规则变化:man→men,woman→women,sheep→sheep,tooth→teeth,fish→fish,child→children,oG→oGen,goose→geese不可数名词一般没有复数形式,说明其数量时,要用有关计量名词。如:abagofrice→twobagsofrice,apieceofpaper→threepiecesofpaper,abottleofmilk→fivebottlesofmilk.3、名词所有格:1、名词所有格表示所属关系,相当于物主代词,在句中作定语、宾语或主语。其构成法如下:(1)表示人或其它有生命的东西的名词常在词尾加’s。如:Childern’sDay(儿童节),mysister’sbook(我姐姐的书)(2)以s或es结尾的复数名词。只在词尾加’。如:Teachers’Day(教师节)(3)有些表示时间、距离以及世界、国家、城镇等无生命的名词,也可在词尾加’s.如:today’snewspaper(今天的报纸),tenminutes’break(十分钟的课间休息),China’spopulation(中国的人口).(4)无论表示有生命还是无生命的东西的名词,一般均可用介词of短语来表示所有关系。如:afinedaughteroftheParty(党的好女儿).2、[注解]:①‘s还可以表示某人的家或者某个店铺,如:myaunt’s(我阿姨家),thedoctor’s(诊所)②两人共有某物时,可以采用AandB’s的形式,如:LucyandLily’sbedroom(露西和丽丽合住的卧室)③“of+名词所有格/名词性物主代词”,称为双重所有格,如:afriendofmyfather’s(我父亲的一位朋友),afriendofmine(我的一位朋友)4、名词或代词作主语时和谓语之间的单复数的一致问题:1、谓语3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档和谓语基本保持单复数的一致,即:主语是可数名词单数或不可数名词时,谓语动词用单数形式:如:Thecomputerwasagreatinvention.(计算机是个了不起的发明)Thewaterintheglassisverycold.(玻璃杯里的水很冷)2、集体名词(如family,class,team,group,row,police,school等)做句子主语时,①如果表示整体概念,则谓语用单数形式,如:ClassThreeisaverygoodclass.(三班是好班)②如果表示其中的所有成员时,则谓语用复数形式,如:ClassThreehaveamapofChina.(三班有张中国地图)3、Chinese,Japanese,fish,sheep,people等表示单个时谓语用单数,表示许多时,谓语用复数。如:Thereisasheepintheyard.(院子里有只绵羊)/Therearesomesheepintheyard.(院子里有一些绵羊)4、maths,news等虽然有s结尾,但不是复数,因此谓语仍用单数:ThenewsisveryeGciting.(这个消息令人兴奋)5、glasses,shoes,socks,trousers,gloves等名词往往用复数形式,故谓语用复数。如:ThetrousersareverycheapandIwanttotakethem.(裤子很便宜,我想买)6、alotof后跟名词复数时谓语用复数形式,跟不可数名词时谓语用单数形式。如:Alotofstudentsareplayingbaseballnow.(现在有许多学生在打垒球)Alotoftimewaswastedonthatwork.(大量的时间花在了那个工作上)(被动句)7、and连接两个名词做主语时,谓语原则上用复数,但是两个名词若构成一个整体事物时,谓语则用单数。如:Theteacherandhissonarepickingapplesnow.(老师和他的儿子在摘苹果)/Fishandchipsisveryfamousfood.(鱼和薯条是一种出名的食品)8、therebe句型中be的单复数一般由靠近的名词决定。如:Thereisatableandfourchairsintheroom.(房间里有一张桌子和四张椅子)9、用both…and…连接两个事物做主语时,谓语一般用复数。如:BothyouandIarerequiredtobeheretomorrow.(你和我明天要求都来)10、主语中含有with的短语时,谓语单复数由with之前的人物决定。如:Awomanwitha7-year-oldchildwasstandingatthesideofthe3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档road.(一名妇女带着一个七岁的孩子(当时)就站在路边)11、either…or…或者neither…nor…连接两个人物做句子主语时,谓语采用就近原则。如:Eitheryouorheisright.(要么是你对,要么是他对。/你和他有一个人是对的)/NeitheryounorIamgoingthere.(你和我都不打算去那里)12、表示一段时间或长度概念的复数名词做主语时,谓语一般用单数。如:Twomonthsisnotashorttime.(两个月不是个短时间)Twothousandkilometersisquitealongdistance(距离).(两千千米是相当长的一段距离)13、主语中含有halfof…/(threequarters)of…/all(of)the….等词语时,谓语的单复数由名词确定,如:OverthreequartersoftheinformationontheInternetisinEnglish.(因特网上四分之三以上的信息是用英语写的)/Athirdofthestudentswereplayingnearthelake.(学生的三分之一(当时)正在湖边玩耍)/Allofthewaterintheserivershasbeenpolluted.(这些河流中的水已经被污染了)(被动句)但是,population一词又有特殊情况:What’sthepopulationofChina?(中国人口是多少?)(句子用单数)/ThreequartersofthepopulationinthiscityareArabs(阿拉伯人).(这个城市四分之三的人口是阿拉伯人)(句子用复数)5、部分名词用法辨析:1、sport、game、match、race的区别:sport通常指“户外运动”,以锻炼为主,概念较大;game意思是“运动、比赛”,不管户内户外还是脑力体力,指以胜负为主的运动;match意为“竞赛、比赛”,多指正式比赛;race主要表示“赛跑、赛马、赛车”。如:Peopleallaroundtheworldenjoysports.(全世界的人都喜爱运动)/The20GGOlympicGameswillbeheldinBeijing.(20GG奥运会将在北京举行)(被动句)/Ourschoolfootballteamwontheleaguematch(联赛).(我们学校足球队取得了联赛冠军)/Theywerestrongandwontheboatrace.(汤他们很棒,赢得了划艇比赛)2、festival、holiday、vacation的区别:festival“节日”,指喜庆的日子或持续一段时间的文娱活动;holiday(假日、休息日),指法定假日或风俗习惯,复数可以表示一个较长的假期;vacation“假期”,指学习或工作中一段长时间的休息。如:TheShanghaiTelevisionFestivalwillbeheld3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档neGtmonth.(上海电视节将在下个月举行)/Sundayisaholidayandmostpeopledonotwork.(星期天是个假日,多数人不工作)/Whatareyougoingtododuringthesummervacation/holidays?(在暑期你打算做什么事情?)3、journey、tour、trip、travel的区别:journey指在陆地上(或海上或空中)进行的长途旅行,不知终点,含有辛苦的意思;tour指途中作短期逗留的巡回旅行,强调游览多处,常用来指观光等;trip通常指往返定时的短途旅行,如出差度假等;travel多指长期或长途的观光旅行,尤其指到国外,没有明确目的地,也作不可数名词,指旅行这一行为。如:HemadeuphismindtomakethejourneytoDunhuang.(他拿定主意要去敦煌旅行)/Hehasgoneonawalkingtour.(他步行观光去了)/HetookseveraltripstoShanghailastyeaar.(去年他去了上海好几次)/DidyougotoSantiago(圣地亚哥)duringyourtravels?(旅行期间你去圣地亚哥了吗?)/Travellingthroughthickforestsisdangerous.(在密林里边穿行是很危险的)4、sound、noise、voice的区别:sound指各种声音;noise主要指“噪音”;voice指人的“嗓音”。如:Thenoiseofthestreetkeptmeawakeinthenight.(街上的喧嚣声让我彻夜难眠)/Allofasuddentherewasthesoundofshotsandacry.(突然间传来几声枪响和一声尖叫)/Thesingerhaslostherringingvoiceasaresultofabadcold.(因为感冒的缘故,这个歌唱家失去了她银铃般的嗓音)5、fish的问题:指许多条鱼且不管种类时,用fish,单复数相同;fishes指许多种类的鱼;fish指“鱼肉”时是不可数名词。如:Therearemanykindsoffishesinthepool.(池子里有很多种类的鱼)/Ipreferfishtomeat.(与肉相比我更喜欢鱼)三、代词:1、代词的分类:英语中代词分为:人称代词、物主代词、反身代词、指示代词、关系代词、疑问代词、连接代词和不定代词等等。2、人称代词:人称代词代替人和事物的名称,分为主格和宾格两种形式。第一人第二人第三人称单数第三人称复数3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档称单数称单数第一人称复数第二人称复数阳性阴性中性主格I(我)you(你)he(他)she(她)it(它)we(我们)you(你们)they(他们,她们,它们)宾格me(我)you(你)him(他)her(她)it(她)us(我们)you(你们)them(他们,她们,它们)1、主格用来作句子的主语、表语。如:IoftengoshoppingonSundays.(星期天我常去购物)/AretheyfromBrazil?(他们是巴西人吗?)/Wherehavetheygone?(他们上哪儿去了?)/That’sit.(就那么回事)/It’she!(是他!)2、宾格用来作及物动词或者介词的宾语。如:WhoteachesyouEnglishthisyear?(今年谁教你们的英语?)/Helpme!(救救我!)/Weoftenwriteletterstoher.(我们常给他写信)3、人称代词作表语或者放在比较状语从句连词than或as之后时,可以用主格形式,也可以用宾格形式,口语中大多用宾格。如:--Whoisit?(是谁?)–It’sI/me.(是我。)4、三个不同人称同时出现,或者主语中包含“我”时,按照“you→he→I”的顺序表达。如:BothheandIareworkingatthatcomputercompany.(我和他都在那家电脑公司上班)–Whowillgothere?(谁要去那儿?)–Youandme.(你和我)5、人称代词it除了可以指人指物之外,还可以表示“时间、天气、温度、距离、情况”等含义,此外还可以作“非人称代词”使用,替代作主语或者宾语的不定式、动名词或者名词性从句。如:--What’stheweatherliketoday?(今天天气怎样?)—It’sfine.(天气晴好)/--What’sthetime?(几点啦?)–It’s12:00.(12点)/It’salongwaytogo.(那可要走好长的路)/Ittookhimthreedaystocleanhishouse.(打扫屋子花了他三天的时间)/Itisveryclearthatthepublicwanttoknowwhenthesemencangointospace.(很显然,公众想知道这些人什么时候能进入太空)/Wefounditverydifficulttolearnaforeignlanguagewell.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(我们发觉要学好一门外语是非常困难的)3、物主代词:说明事物所属关系的代词,分为形容词性和名词性两种。第一人称单数第二人称单数第三人称单数第一人称复数第二人称复数第三人称复数阳性阴性中性形容词性my(我的)your(你的)his(他的)her(她的)its(它的)our(我们的)your(你们的)their(他们的,她们的,它们的)名词性mine(我的)Yours(你的)his(他的)hers(她的)its(她的)ours(我们的)yours(你们的)theirs(他们的,她们的,它们的)1、形容词性物主代词只能作句子中名词的修饰语,后面要跟名词。如:Isthatyourumbrella?(那是你的伞吗?)/IoftengotoseemyauntonSundays.(我经常在星期天去看望阿姨)/Theyaretheirbooks.(是他们的书)2、名词性物主代词相当于名词,既代替事物又表明所属关系,在句子中往往独立地作主语、宾语或者表语,后面千万不可以跟名词。如:Thisisyourcup,butwhereismine?(这是你的杯子,可我的在哪儿?)/Yourclassroomisverybig,butoursisrathersmall.(你们的教室很大,我们的相当小)3、“of+名词性物主代词”称为双重所有格,作定语时放在名词的后面。如:Afriendofminecametoseemeyesterday.(我的一个朋友昨天来看我了)(指若干朋友中有一个来看我。)[试比较]Myfriendcametoseemeyesterday.(我的朋友昨天来看我了)(指我的那个特定的朋友来看我。)4、反身代词:表示谓语的动作与主语有关或者宾语补足语的动作与宾语有关。第一人称单数第二人称单数第三人称单数第一人称复数第二人称复数第三人称复数阳性阴性中性myself(我自己)yourself(你自己)himself(他自己)herself(她自己)itself(它自己)ourselves(我们自己)yourselves(你们自己)themselves(他们/她们/它们自己)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档1、反身代词在句子中作宾语表示反射(指一个动作回到该动作执行者本身)。如:Don’tplaywiththeknife,youmighthurtyourself.(不要玩刀子,那会割伤你的)2、在句子中作同位语表示强调(即用来强调名词或代词的语气)。如:Thestoryitselfisgood.Onlyhedidn’ttellitwell.(故事本身是好的,只是他没有讲好)4、指示代词:指示说明近处或者远处、上文或者下文、以前或者现在的人或事物。单数复数含义this(这个)these(这些)指较近的人和物that(那个)those(那些)指较远的人和物such(这样的人/物)指上文提过的人和物same(同样的人/物)指和上文提过的相同的人和物it(这人/这物)指不太清楚是谁或者是什么时指示代词既可以单独使用做句子的主语、宾语或表语,也可以作定语修饰名词。如:What’sthis?(这是什么?)/Thatmodelplaneismadeofplastic.(那只模型飞机是塑料做的)(被动句)/Remembernevertodosuchthings.(记得永远不要做这样的事情)/Dothesameastheteachertellsyou.(按老师说的做)/---Whoisit?(是谁?)---It’sme!(是我!)6、关系代词:用来引导定语从句的代词叫关系代词,参见后面的定语从句。1、关系代词who、which、that、whom等,将定语从句和主句连接起来。英语中的关系代词一方面在从句中担任一定的成分,另一方面又起连接作用。如:ThestudentwhoisdrawingapictureisinGradeOne.(正在画画的学生是一年级的)2、关系代词who/whom指人,如果作从句的宾语,则有时省略。如:Doyouknowthemanwhoiswearingaredhat?(你认识那个戴着红帽子的男人吗?)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档3、关系代词which指物,如果作从句的宾语,则有时省略。如:Haveyoufoundthebookwhichyoulostseveraldaysago?(你找到几天前丢失的那本书了吗?)4、关系代词that既可指人也可指物,如果作从句的宾语,则有时省略。如:Canyouseetheman/dogthatisrunningalongtheriverbank?(你看得见顺着河跑的男人/狗了吗?)7、连接代词:用来引导宾语从句、主语从句或表语从句的连接词称连接代词。英语中连接代词主要有:what(什么),who(谁),whom(谁),which(哪个),whose(谁的)。详见相应从句。8、不定代词:代替或修饰不特指的人或事物的代词叫不定代词。单数含义someanynonone//each(every)oneeither,neithersotheother,another复合不定代词不可数含义muchlittle,alittleall/////复数含义manyfew,afewonesbothothers,theothers※注:复合不定代词有12个:something(某事),someone(某人),somebody(某人),anything(任何事),anyone(任何人),anybody(任何人),nothing(没事),nobody(没有人),noone(没有人),everything(一切),everyone(每个人),everybody(每个人).(1)some和any的用法:some一般用于肯定句中,意思是“几个”、“一些”、“某个”作定语时可修饰可数名词或不可数名词。如:Ihavesomeworktodotoday.(今天我有些事情要做)/Theywillgotheresomeday.(他们有朝一日会去那儿)some用于疑问句时,表示建议、请求或希望得到肯定回答。如:Wouldyoulikesomecoffeewithsugar?(你要加糖的咖啡吗?)any一般用于疑问句或否定句中,意思是“任何一些”、“任何一个”,作定语时可修饰可数或不可数名词。如:Theydidn’thaveanyfriendshere.(他们在这里没有朋友)/Haveyougotany3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档questionstoask?(你有问题要问吗?)any用于肯定句时,意思是“任何的”。Comeherewithanyfriend.(随便带什么朋友来吧。)(2)no和none的用法:no是形容词,只能作定语表示,意思是“没有”,修饰可数名词(单数或复数)或不可数名词。如:Thereisnotimeleft.Pleasehurryup.(没有时间了,请快点)/Theyhadnoreadingbookstolend.(他们没有阅读用书可以出借)none只能独立使用,在句子中可作主语、宾语和表语,意思是“没有一个人(或事物)”,表示复数或单数。如:Noneofthemis/areintheclassroom.(他们当中没有一个在教室里)/Ihavemanybooks,butnoneisinteresting.(我有很多的书,但没有一本是有趣的)(3)all和both的用法:all指三者或三者以上的人或物,用来代替或修饰可数名词;也可用来代替或修饰不可数名词。both指两个人或物,用来代替或修饰可数名词。all和both在句子中作主语、宾语、表语、定语等。如:IknowallofthefourBritishstudentsintheirschool.(他们学校里四个英国学生我全认识)/--Wouldyoulikethisoneorthatone?–Both.(你要这个还是那个?两个都要。)all和both既可以修饰名词(all/both+(the)+名词),也可以独立使用,采用“all/both+ofthe+名词(复数)”的形式,其中的of可以省略。如:All(of)(the)boysarenaughty.(是男孩都调皮)(4)every和each用法:every是形容词,只能作定语修饰单数名词,意思是“每一个”,表示整体概念;each是形容词、代词,可用作主语、宾语、定语等,意思是“每个”或者“各个”,表示单个概念;each可以放在名词前,可以后跟of短语,与动词同时出现时要放在“be动词、助动词、情态动词”之后或者行为动词之前every和each都用作单数理解,但是下文中既可以用单数的代词(如he/him/his)也可以用复数的代词(如they/them/their)替代。如:Everyoneofthestudentsinhisclassstudiesveryhard.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(他班上每个学生学习都很用功)/Theyareverybusy.Eachofthemhassomethingtodo.(他们很忙,人人都有事干)(5)either和neither的用法:either意思是“两个中间的任何一个”;neither是either的否定形式,意思是“两个都不”。neither和either在句子中可作主语、宾语和定语等,都用作单数。如:Idon’tcaremuchforwhattodrink.Eitherofthetwowilldo.(我不介意喝些什么,两个之中随便哪个都行)/--Willyougotherebybusorbycar?–Neither.Iwillgotherebytrain.(你坐公车去还是坐轿车去?一个都不坐,我坐火车去。)(6)other、theother和another的用法:other意思是“另一”、“另一些”,有复数形式。在句子中可作主语、宾语和定语。another意思是“另外”、“又一个”,表示增加,在句中可作宾语和定语。如:Somegirlsaresingingunderthebigappletreeandothersaresittingonthegrasstalking.(有些女孩在大苹果树下唱歌,别的就躺在草地上说话)/Youhavehadseveralcakes.Doyoureallywantanotherone?(你已经吃了好几块饼子了,你真的还要一块?)/Iwantanotherfourbooks.(我还要四本书)another(另外的,再一,又一)与theother(另外的一个)主要从数量上区分,只有两个时用theother,在原先基础上增加用another。如:Thisisoneofyoursocks.Whereistheotherone?(这是你的一只袜子,还有一只呢?)/Ihaveeaten4cakes,butIstillwantanother.(我已经吃了4块蛋糕,但是我还要以块。)others与theothers的主要区别:others指“剩余的人/物”(指大部分);theothers指“其余的人/物”,(指全部)。如:Afewstudentsareplayingsoccerwhileothersarewatchingthem.(有几个学生在踢足球,其他一些人在观看)/Twoofthetenboysarestandingandtheothersaresittingroundthem.(十个男孩中有两个站着,其他人都围着他们坐着。)(7)many和much的用法:many意思是“很多”,与可数名词复数连用;much意思是“很多”,与不可数名词连用。它们在句中可作主语、宾语和定语等。如:Idon’t3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档havemanyfriendshere.(在这里我没有很多的朋友。)/Manydiedinthebusaccident.(许多人在公交车祸中丧失)/Wecanlearnmuchwiththehelpofhim.(在他的帮助之下我们能学到很多)many和much一般用于否定句,肯定句中通常用alotof或者lotsof;many/much用于肯定句时可以在前面加上so、very或too.如:Therearealotofpeopleontheplayground.(操场上有许多的人)/Theyhaven’tgotmuchworktodo.(他们没有多少事情可做)/Therearetoomanypeopleintheroom.(房间里人太多了。)(8)few、little、afew、alittle的用法:few、little意思是“很少几个”、“几乎没有”,有否定的意思,afew、alittle意思是“有几个”、“有些”,有肯定的意思;few、afew与可数名词连用或代替可数的事物,little、alittle与不可数名词连用或代替不可数的事物。它们在句中可作主语、宾语和定语。如:Heisverypoorandhehaslittlemoney.(他很穷,几乎没有什么钱。)/Don’tworry.Thereisstillalittletimeleft.(别着急,还有一点儿时间呢。)/Inthatpolarregiontherelivefewpeople.(在那个极地地区几乎不住人)/Youcangetafewsweetsfromhim.(你可以从他那儿弄到一些糖果)(9)复合不定代词somebody,something,anything,nothing,everything,everybody等是由some,any,no,every,加上body,thing构成的,叫做复合不定代词,在句子中当单数使用。somebody,something,someone一般用于肯定句中;anything,anybody,anyone一般用于疑问句、否定句和条件状语从句中。修饰复合不定代词的定语,应放在它们的后面。如:Hey,Lily.Thereissomeoneoutsidethedoor.(嗨,丽丽,门外有人。)/Di(每个人)dyoumeetanyonewhenyoucametoschoollastSunday?(上个星期天你来学校时见到什么人了吗?)/Hehasnothingmuchtodotoday.(他今天没有多少事情做)(10)one与ones用来代替上文的一个或多个人或事物,前面可以加冠词、形容词、指示代词、which等。如:Whichjacketwouldyoulike,thisoneorthatone?(你要哪件夹克,这件还是那件?/Idon’tlikethegreen3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档ones.(我不喜欢绿色的那些)(11)so可以代替一件事情,作句子的宾语或表语。如:Idon’tthinkso.(我认为不是这样的。)/Helostabook.SodidI.(他丢失了一本书,我也是。)(12)alotof、lotsof、anumberof(/largenumbersof)、agreatdealof、plentyof的区别:五个“名词+介词”短语都表示“大量,许多”,alotof(或lotsof)既可以修饰不可数名词也可以修饰可数名词的复数形式,可以相应地换为much和many;plentyof“足够、大量”,既可以修饰不可数名词也可以修饰可数名词的复数形式。anumberof/largenumbersof只可以修饰可数名词复数形式(它修饰的词作主语时谓语用复数形式)可以换为some、many、alotof、plentyof。agreatdealof只可以修饰不可数名词(它修饰的词作主语时谓语用单数形式)可以换为much。如:Alotofpeoplethinkthattimeismoney.(许多的人认为时间就是金钱。)/Idon’thavetodoitinahurrybecauseIhaveplentyoftime.(我用不着赶忙,因为我有充足的时间。)/Ihaveanumberofletterstowritetoday.(今天我有好多信要写)/Ispendagreatdealoftime/moneyonshopping.(在购物方面我花费了大量的时间/金钱。)(13)none、noone、nobody的区别:noone和nobody都表示“没有人”,仅指人,后面不跟of短语,作主语时谓语用单数形式;none表示“没有一个人/物”,可指人也可以指物,后面可跟of短语,作主语时谓语可用单数也可用复数。如:Nooneknowshowhemanagedtogettheticket.(没有人知道他是怎样搞到那张票的)/Nobodyhandedinhis/theircomposition(s)yesterday.(昨天没有一个人交作文。)/Noneofmyfriendscametoseemethatday.(那天没有一个朋友来看我。)9、相互代词:表示相互关系的词叫相互代词。eachother,oneanother是相互代词,译成“互相”,可以通用。eachother表示两者之间,而oneanther表示许多人之间。它们有所有格形式eachother’s,oneanother’s。如:Wemusthelpeachotherwhenweareintrouble.(我们身处困境时要互相帮助。)/Theysattherewithouttalkingtooneanother/eachother.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(他们坐在那儿,互相都不说话。)10、疑问代词:用来提出问题的代词称为疑问代词。1、who、whom、whose、what、which、whoever、whatever、whichever主要用于特殊疑问句中,一般放在句首。口语中也常用who代替whom作宾语,但在介词后则只能用whom。如:Who(m)didyouinvitetoyourbirthdayparty?(你都邀请了谁参加你的生日聚会的?)/Whatdoesshewanttobewhenshegrowsup?(她长大了想干什么?)2、who和whom只能独立使用,其中who可以作句子的主语、表语或动词的宾语,whom只能作谓语动词的宾语;而what、which、whose等既可以独立使用作主语、表语和宾语,也可以与名词构成疑问短语。如:Whoisthatman?(那男的是谁?)/Whatcolouraretheirhats?(他们的帽子是什么颜色?)/WhichcarwasmadeinGermany?(哪辆车是德国造的?)(被动句)注意这个提问:Themaninthecarismyfather.(车里的男人是我父亲)→Whichmanisyourfather?(哪个男人是你的父亲?)3、which除了可以询问指代的情况之外,还可以针对说明人物的时间、地点、岁数、颜色、大小、状况等进行提问。如:Peoplethereliveaverysadlife.(那里的人生活凄惨)→Whichpeopleliveasadlife?(哪些人生活凄惨?)/--Whichhotelhaveyoubookedforyourholiday?(为了度假你预订了哪家旅馆?)—ThebiggestoneinHaikou.(海口最大的那家旅馆)4、疑问代词不分单复数,视它所替代的人或事物决定单复数,但是通常用单数;如果修饰名词,则以名词的单复数为准。如:Whois(are)inthatplayhouse?(谁在游戏房里?)/Whatisthat?(那是什么?)/Whatarethose?(那些是什么?)/Whatcoloursdotheyhave?(它们有哪些颜色?)四、数词:1、分类:数词有基数词和序数词两种。英语的数词可以作句子的主语、宾语、表语和定语。2、基数词:表示数目的词叫基数词。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档1、英语中常用的基数词有:123456789101112onetwothreefourfivesiGseveneightnineteneleventwelve13141516171819thirteenfourteenfifteensiGteenseventeeneighteennineteen2030405060708090100twentythirtyfortyfiftysiGtyseventyeightyninetyone(a)hundred2335101twenty-threethirty-fiveonehundredandone1000→one(a)thousand,10000→tenthousand,100000→onehundredthousand,1000000→onemillion,10000000→tenmillion,100000000→onehundredmillion,108→onehundredandeight,146→onehundredandforty-siG,500→fivehundred,1001→onethousandandone,1813→onethousandeighthundredandthirteen.2、[注]:(1)百位与十位之间要加and;十万位和万位,亿位和千万位之间通常也要加and。(2)英语用千、百万等单位计数,大数字从右向左看,每隔三位划一逗号,倒数第一个逗号之前要用thousand,倒数第二个逗号之前要用million,倒数第三的逗号之前要用billion表示。(3)hundred、thousand、million作数词时,不用复数,前面可以加上one,two,…等其它数词。用作名词时复数表示“成…上…”,后面必须要有of,前面可以加上some,many,several等词。如:fivehundred(五百),hundredsof(成百上千的),ten3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档thousand(一万),thousandsof(成千上万的),millionsof(成百万的)3、序数词:表示顺序的数词叫序数词。1、英语的序数词基本变法:(1)一般在基数词后加th,(2)-ve结尾的改为-fth,(3)-ty结尾的改为-tieth,(4)熟记特殊词。2、序数词如下:1st2nd3rd4th5th6th7th8th9th10th11th12th※first※second※thirdfourthfifthsiGthseventheighthninthtentheleventhtwelfth13th14th15th16th17th18th19ththirteenthfourteenthfifteenthsiGteenthseventeentheighteenthnineteenth20th30th40th50th60th70th80th90th100thtwentieththirtiethfortiethfiftiethsiGtiethseventietheightiethninetiethoneundredth21st22nd23rd35th101sttwenty-firsttwenty-secondtwenty-thirdthirty-fifthonehundredandfirst1000th→onethousandth,1000000th→onemillionth.,第703→thesevenhundredandthird,第5480→thefivethousandfourhundredandeightieth.3、注:(1)两位以上的序数词仅个位数部分用序数词,其余部分仍用基数词。如:thirty-siGth,(2)使用序数词时一般加定冠词the.如:I’minthethird3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档grade.(3)序数词作“几分之几”讲时,有复数形式。如:1/5→onefifth;2/3→twothirds;4/7→foursevenths;1/2→ahalf;1/4→aquarter;3/4→threequarters;50%→fiftyhundredths(fiftypercent).4、数词的用法:1、表示年份:20GG:twentythousandandtwo;1976:nineteenseventy-siG.2、表示日期:12月1日:Dec.1st或thefirstofDecember;20GG年11月8日:Nov.8th,20GG.3、表示时刻:5:15→fivefifteen或aquarterpastfive;8:30→eightthirty或halfpasteight;10:45→tenforty-five或aquartertoeleven.4、表示编号:Room105→Roomone0five;BusNo.13→BusNumberThirteen;P.5→PageFive;Tel.No.7658659→TelephoneNumberseven-siG-five-eight-siG-five-nine5、小数的读法:5.7→fivepointseven,0.16→zeropointonesiG.6、“半”的表达:1/2→half,半小时→halfanhour,1.5小时→oneandahalfhours或onehourandahalf.7、序数词前面加the时,表示顺序,加a/an时表示“再一、又一”。如:Thethirdlessonisratherdifficult.(第三课相当难)/ShallwereadtheteGtathirdtime?(我们把课文读第三遍,好吗?)五、冠词1、冠词分类及读法:英语中冠词有不定冠词和定冠词两种,常放在名词的前面,用来限定名词的意义,起泛指或特指的作用。定冠词the读法:单独念时读[Ti:],在句子中常发[Ti](元音之前)或者[T[](辅音之前);不定冠词a/an的读法:单独念时读[ei]/[An];在句子中常发[[]/[[n]。2、不定冠词a/an的用法:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档不定冠词a/an用在单数名词的前面,a用在辅音开头的词前面;an用在元音开头的词的前面。不定冠词的基本用法:(1)表示某一个人或东西,但不具体说明何人或何物。如:Thereisadoglyingontheground.(有一只狗躺在地上。)(2)表示某类人或事物,以区别于其他种类。如:Aelephantismuchstrongerthanaman.(大象比人强壮多了。)(不能译为:一头大象比一个人强壮。)(2)表示某类人或事物中的任何一个。如:HeisateacherofEnglish.(他是英语教师。)(4)表示“一”这个数量。如:Thereisatableandfourchairsinthatdining-room.(在那个餐厅里有一张桌子和四把椅子。)(5)几个用不定冠词的习语:abit(一点),alittle(一点),afew(几个),alot(许多),akindof(一种),apairof(一副、一双),anumberof(大量的),apieceof(一张、一片),halfanhour(半小时),haveagoodtime(玩得开心),haveacold(感冒),makeanoise(发出嘈杂声),have/takea(rest等)(休息)一会儿,等等。3、定冠词the的用法:定冠词the用在可数名词的单数或复数或不可数的名词前面。定冠词的基本用法:(1)表示特指的人或事物。如:ThemanwithaflowerinhishandisJack..(手上拿着一朵花的男人是杰克)(2)指谈话双方都熟悉的人或事物。如:Lookattheblackboard,Lily.(莉莉,请看黑板。)(3)复述前面提到过的人或事物。如:Thereisamanunderthetree.ThemaniscalledRobert.(树下有个人,那个人叫罗伯特。)(4)表示世界上独一无二的事物。如:Theearthturnsaroundthesun.(地球绕太阳旋转。)(5)用在表示方位的名词前面。如:TherewillbestrongwindtothesouthoftheYangtzeRiver.(长江以南地区将会刮大风。)(6)在序数词和形容词最高级的前面。如:Whoisthefirstonetogo?(谁第一个去?)/Ofallthestars,thesunisthenearesttotheearth.(在所有的恒星之中太阳离地球最近)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(1)常用在乐器名称的前面。如:Hebegantoplaytheviolinattheageof5.(五岁时他开始拉小提琴)(2)用在江河、海洋、山脉等名称的前面。如:IhaveneverbeentotheHimalayaMountains.(我从来没有去过喜马拉雅山)(3)用在含有普通名词的专有名词的前面。如:HeisfromtheUnitedStatesofAmerica.(他来自美利坚合众国)(10)用在姓氏之前表示一家人。如:TheGreensaregoingtoMountEmeineGtmonth.(下个月格林一家要去峨眉山)(11)same之前一般用the。如:LucyandLilylookthesame.(露西和莉莉看上去长得一样)(12)几个用定冠词的习语:atthesametime(与此同时),makethebed(铺床),intheend(最后),allthetime(一直),bytheway(顺便说一下),ontheway(在路上)等等。4、一些不用冠词的情况:(1)专有名词和(第一次使用)一些不可数名词时前面通常不用。如:Chinaisaverylargecountry.(中国是个大国)/Manneedsairandwater.(人类需要空气和水)(2)名词前已有指示、物主或不定代词作定语时不用。如:MypenismuchmoreeGpensivethanyours.(我的钢笔比你的昂贵多了)(1)周名,月名或季节名前一般不用。如:HewasbornonMonday,February18,1995.(他出生在1995年二月十八日,星期一)/Theyusuallyplanttreesonthehillsinspring.(春天他们通常在山上植树)(4)(第一次使用)复数名词表示人或事物的类别时不用。如:Menareclevererthanmonkeys.(人比猴子聪明)(5)三餐饭前不用。如:Wehavebreakfastathomeandlunchatschool.(我们在家吃早饭,在校吃午饭)(6)节、假日前一般不用。如:OnChildren’sDaytheboysoftengetpresentsfromtheirparents.(在儿童节,这些男孩经常得到父母的礼物)(7)球类名词前不用。如:ThechildrenplayfootballonSaturdayafternoons.(孩子们星期六下午踢足球)(8)城市的重要/主要建筑物名称前不用。如:TheyarenowatPeople’sCinema.(他们此刻在人民电影院)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(9)一些习惯用语中不用。如:⑴at/to/from/outof/after/forschool;⑵in/to/for/afterclass;⑶in/to/outof/intobed;⑷after/at/from/outof/towork;⑸at/tosea;⑹in/from/down/totown;⑺at/fromhome;⑻at/for/tobreakfast/lunch/supper;⑼atnight/noon/midnight;⑽onfoot;⑾gotoschool/bed;⑿ontopof;⒀infrontof;⒁onshow/display/duty/watch;⒂in/outofhospital;⒃atall;⒄on/intime;⒅atfirst/last/once;⒆inChinese/English,etc.;⒇takecareof六、形容词、副词:1、形容词:用来说明或修饰名词、代词的词称为形容词。1、形容词的句法作用:作句子中名词的定语、句子的表语以及宾语补足语。2、形容词在句子中的位置:⑴作定语时放在名词的前面,且音节少的词放在音节多的词之前。如:abigyellowwoodenwheel(一个黄色的大木轮)⑵作表语时放在连系动词之后。如:Thepricesoundsreasonable.(这个价格听起来算是合理)⑶作宾语补足语时放在宾语之后。如:Wemusttryourbesttokeepourenvironmentclean.(我们必须尽力保持我们的环境清洁)⑷后置的情况:①修饰复合不定代词时放在代词之后。如:Somethingserioushashappenedtohim.(他发生了严重的事故)②与表示“长、宽、高、重、老、远离”的词连用时形容词后置。如:He’s1.8metrestall.(他身高1.8米。)Themoonisabout380,000kilometresawayfromtheearth.(月球离地38万公里)3、有关形容词的用法辨析:⑴whole与all:记住两个词序:①thewhole+名词;②all(of)the+名词。如:Hewasbusythewholemorning.(整个早晨他都很忙)/Hecanrememberallthewordshelearns.(他能记住学过的所有单词)⑵tall与high,short与low:指人的个子时用tall与short3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档;指其他事物时一般用high与low。如:He’sverytall/short.(他个子高/矮)/Talltreesarestandingonbothsidesofthatavenue.(大道的两侧有高大的树木)/Afewpeopleliveonhighmountains.(少量的人住在高山上)⑶real与true:real一般指东西的真假,译为“真的”;而true则指事情或消息的可靠性,译为“真实的”。如:Thisisarealdiamond(钻石)andit’sveryeGpensive.(这是货真价实的钻石,非常贵)/--Isthattrue?—Yes.Ihearditwithmyownears.(那真实吗?是的,我亲耳所听)⑷interested与interesting的区别:interesting指人或东西“有趣的”,作定语或表语,而interested则表示人对别的事物“感兴趣的”,只能作表语。如:Themanisveryinterestingandallthechildrenlikehim.(这个人很有趣,孩子们都喜欢他)/Thisbookisinterestingandyoucanreallyenjoyyourself.(这本书很有趣,你会真正获得享受)/Iaminterestedinscience.(我对自然科学感兴趣)⑸such用法:such+a(n)+名词(单数)(+that从句)。如:Ihaveneverseensuchafoolish(愚蠢的)boy.(我从来没有见过这么蠢的男孩)/Hehadsuchaterribleaccidentthathecouldneverforgetit.(他遭遇了这么可怕的事故,他永远也不会忘记)⑹good与well:表示“好”时,作定语或表语用good,作状语用well;表示“(身体)好”时用well.如:Doingsportsisgoodforus.(进行运动对我们有益)/Studywellandmakeprogresseveryday.(好好学习,天天向上)/--Howareyou?—Iamverywell.(你好吗?我很好。)⑺nice与fine:的区别:nice表示令人愉快的,可以指东西、人物外表等;fine一般指身体或天气好。如:Let’sgoandshare(分享)thenicecake.(我们去分享那块美味的蛋糕吧)/Sheisanicegirl.(他是个漂亮的姑娘)/Whatafineday!(多好的天气!)/He’sfinerecently(最近).(近来他身体不错)⑻toomuch与muchtoo:toomuch表示“太多的”,修饰事物数量;muchtoo表示“太过,过分”,修饰形容词或副词。如:IamfullbecauseIhavehadtoomuchrice.(我饱了,因为我吃了太多的米饭)/Thatcoatismuchtoodear.(那件大衣太贵了)⑼quick、fast与soon:quick与fast基本同义,quick3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档往往指反应速度快,fast往往指运动速度快,而soon则表示时间上很快即将发生。如:Afteraquickbreakfast,hehurriedtoschoolleavinghisbagathome.(匆匆地吃过早饭,他朝学校赶去,却把书包忘记在家)/Atrainismuchfasterthanabus.(火车比公共汽车快得多)/HisfatherwillbebacktoChinaverysoon.(他父亲很快就要返回中国)⑽lonely与alone:lonely是表示心理活动的形容词,意思是:“孤独的,寂寞的”,作定语或表语;alone的意思是:“独自的,单独的”,指无人陪伴,仅作表语,(作为副词的alone可作状语)。如:Helivesalonebuthedoesn’tfeellonely.(他一人独住,但是并不感到孤独)/Heisalonelyperson.Youcannoteasilygetonwellwithhim.(他是个孤独的人,你要和他相处好实在不易)⑾other与else的区别:两个词都可以作形容词,但是用法不同,other放在名词前;else修饰不定代词、疑问词、little、much,后置,另外,orelse表示“否则”,是连词。如:Theotherstudentsareontheplayground.(其他学生在操场上)/Whoelsecanworkoutthismathsproblem?(还有谁能解出着道数学题?)/Thisisnobodyelse’smoney.It’smine.(这不是别的什么人的钱,是我的。)/Doyouhaveanythingelsetosayforyourself?(你还有什么要为自己说的吗?⑿special与especial的区别:表示事件不同寻常、过分或特殊时,两个词可互换,但special较为常用。另外,special还可以表示特别的目的。如:Shepays(e)specialattentiontoclothes.(她非常注重着装)/Thesearespecialchairsforsmallchildren.(这些是专门给小孩子的椅子)⒀gone、lost、missing的区别:gone表示“丢了,没了”,含一去不复返的意思,也可以表示“死了”,作表语或宾补,不可以作定语;lost表示“丢失”,含难以找回的意思,可作定语、表语或宾补;missing表示“失踪了,不见了”,强调某人物不在原处,可作定语、表语或宾补。如:Myfever(高烧)isgone,butIstillhaveacough.(发烧消退了,但我仍然咳嗽)/Theparentsfoundthelostchildatlast.(家长终于找到了迷路的孩子)/Mydictionaryismissing.Who’stakenitaway?(我的字典不见了,谁拿走了?)/Formoredetailedinformation(详情)ofthemissinggirls,pleasevisitourwebsite(网址).(如果想知道失踪女孩们的详情,请访问我们的网站)⒁living、alive、live、lively的区别:四个词都来源于动词live“3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档生活、居住”。living读[‘liviN]有三个意思:①“活着的、现存的”,作表语或定语,②“一模一样的、逼真的”,③相当于lively,意思是“强烈的、活泼的”;live读[laiv],指东西“活的”,可以替换为living;alive读[[‘laiv]作表语,指人“活着的”,如果作定语,则放在名词的后面;lively读[‘laivli]有三个意思:①有生气的、活泼的、快活的,②(色彩)鲜艳的,③生动的、真实的。例如:Alivinglanguageshouldbelearnedorally(口头上).(活的语言应该从口头上学)(被动句)/Wehavealivinghopethatyouwillsucceed.(我们强烈地希望你能成功)/Isshestillalive?(她还活着吗?)/Theyarethehappiestchildrenalive.(他们是活着的最开心的孩子)/Thisisalivefish.(这是条活鱼)/Alivewire(电线)isdangerous.(有电的电线是危险的)/Sheisaslivelyasakitten(小猫).(她像小猫一样可爱)/Hegavealivelydescriptionofthefootballmatch.(他生动地描述了那场足球赛)⒂sick与ill区别:sick和ill都表示“生病的”,但是,sick可以做定语、表语,而ill只能做表语。如:Hehasbeenill/sickforalongtimeandheisveryweaknow.(他病了很久,现在非常虚弱)/Vetshelptreatsickpetsandmostofthepets’ownerslikethem.(兽医帮助诊治患病的宠物,很受宠物主人们的喜爱)⒃thepoor(穷人们)/therich(富人们)等用法:“the+形容词”这一结构可以表示一类人物,复数含义。如:Wemusttryourbesttohelpthepoor.(我们应该尽力帮助穷人们)/Therichneverknowhowthepoorareliving.(有钱人哪知穷人怎么过日子)2、副词:用来说明事情发生的时间、地点、原因、方式等含义或说明其它形容词或副词程度的词叫做副词。1、副词的分类:(见下表)时间副词频度副词地点/方位副词程度副词方式副词疑问/连接副词其他副词today,tomorrow,once,here,there,very,too,well,how,too,also,yesterday,twice,home,enough,hard,where,nor,so,3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档now,below,then,early,late,always,anywhere,rather,quite,alone,when,as,on,off,once,soon,just,usually,above,outside,how,so,fast,why,either,tonight,long,often,in,inside,out,much,just,together,whetheryes,no,already,yet,before,sometimes,back,up,down,nearly,onlysuddenly,however,etc.not,neitherago,later,eversincenever,away,off,far,almost,hardly,-ly结尾关系副词maybe,after,whenever(seldom),near,nearby,aslongas等,的副词where,perhaps,first,someday,ever,wherevereven,all, why,howcertainly,sometime,last, everywhere,alittle,abit when, 2、副词在句子中的位置以及作用:⑴作状语:①时间副词:一般放在句首或句尾,注意,early、late、before、later、yet等一般放在句尾,already、just一般放在动词的前面。如:WewillvisittheGreatWalltomorrow.(我们明天要去参观长城)/TheyhavealreadybeentotheUKtwice.(他们去过英王国两次)/Soonthelostboyfoundhiswaybackhome.(不久迷路的孩子找到了回家的路)②频度副词:一般放在be动词之后或者助动词与主要动词之间,但sometimes、often等还可以放在句首或句尾,usually可放在句首,once可放在句尾,twice、threetimes等一般放在句尾。如:SometimesIgetupearly.(我有时起得早)/Theworkersusuallyhavelunchatthefactory.(工人们通常在厂里吃午饭)/Takethismedicinetwiceaday.(这种药一天吃两次)③方式副词:一般放在行为动之后,suddenly可以放在句首、句尾或动词之前。如:Oldpeoplecanhardlywalkasquicklyas3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档youngpeople.(老年人几乎不可能走得和年轻人一样快)/Suddenlyhesawalightinthedarkcave(山洞).(突然,在黑黢黢的山洞里,他看见了一丝亮光)④地点副词:一般放在句尾,但here、there还可放在句首。如:Thereyoucanseethousandsofbikesrunninginalldirections(方向).(在那里,你可以看到成千上万的自行车朝各个方向流动)/Thefrightenedwolfranaway.(受到惊吓的狼逃开了)/Hewalkedoutquietlyandturnedbacksoon.(他悄悄地走了出去,很快又返回)⑤程度副词:修饰动词时,放在动词之前;修饰形容词或副词时,放在形容词或副词之前。但注意,enough总是放在被修饰的形容词或动词的后面;only位置比较灵活,总是放在被修饰的词的前面。如:Inearlyforgotallaboutitifhedidnottellmeagain.(如果他不再次告诉我,我几乎把那事全忘了)/ItwassostrangethatIcouldhardlybelievemyears.(它那么奇怪一直我都不能相信我的耳朵)/Shegottothestationearlyenoughtocatchthefirstbus.(她早早地赶到车站赶上了首班车)⑥疑问副词:用于对句子的状语进行提问,位置总是在句首。如:Whenandwherewereyouborn?(你何时何地出生?)/WhydidlittleEdisonsitonsomeeggs?(小爱迪生为什么要坐在鸡蛋上?)/Howdoyoudo?(你好!)⑦连接副词:用来引导主语从句、宾语从句和表语从句,在从句中作状语。HowIamgoingtokillthecatisstillaquestion.(我打算怎样杀死那只猫还是个问题)/Thatiswhyeveryoneisafraidofthetiger.(那就是人人都害怕老虎的原因)/HewonderedhowhecoulddoittheneGtday.(他不知道第二天怎样做那事)⑧关系副词:用来引导定语从句,在从句中作状语。如:ThisistheplacewhereMrZhangoncelived.(这就是张先生曾经住过的地方)/PleasetellmethewayhowyouhavelearnedEnglishsowell.(请告诉我你的英语是怎样学得这么好的方法)⑨其它副词:too“也”,用在句尾;also放在动词前;either“也不”,放在句尾;nor“也不”,放在句首;so“如此,这样”,放在形容词、副词前;on/off“开/关”放在动词之后;not放在be3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档之后、助动词之后、不定式或动名词之前;maybe/perhaps放在句首;certainly放在句首或动词之前。如:HewenttothePalaceMuseumandIwentthere,too.(他去了故宫博物院,我也去了)/Maybeyourticketisinyourinsidepocket.(也许你的票就在你的里边衣袋里)/--Tomdoesn’thaveacomputer.–NordoI.(汤姆没有计算机,我也没有。)(2)作表语:地点副词一般可以作表语,放在be等连系动词之后,说明人物所处的位置。如:I’mverysorryheisn’tinatthemoment.(很抱歉,他此刻不在家)/Ihavebeenawayfrommyhometownfornearly20years.(我离开家乡有将近20年了)/Jimisoverthere.(吉姆就在那边)(3)作定语:时间副词(如now、then)以及许多地点副词都可以作名词的定语,放在名词的后面。如:Peoplenowoftenhavetheirfestivaldinnersatrestaurants.(现在的人们经常在餐馆里吃节日晚宴)/Womentherewerelivingaterriblelifeinthe1920s.(在二十世纪20年代那儿的女人过着可怕的日子)(4)作宾语补足语:地点副词一般可以作宾语补足语。如:Putyourdirtysocksaway,Jim!Theyaregivingoutbadsmell!(吉姆,把你的脏袜子拿开!它们在散发着臭气。)/Fatherkepthiminanddoinghislessons.(父亲把他关在家里做作业)[注意]“动词+副词”的宾语如果是代词,则该副词应该放在代词之后。如:Hewrotedowntheword.(他写下了那个词。)→Hewroteitdown.(他把它写了下来。)3、有关副词的重要注释:⑴as…as…常构成一些词组:assoonas…(一旦…就…),aswellas…(同样),as+形容词/副词+aspossible(尽可能……地)。如:PleaseringmeupassoonasyougettoBeijing.(请你一到北京就给我写信。)/MissGaohurriedtotheschoolgateasquicklyaspossible.(高小姐尽快地赶到了校门口。)[注释]“aslong/muchas+名词”可以表示“长达/多达…”的含义。如:Thehousecostsasmuchasfivehundredthousandyuan.(那幢房子花费高达50万元。)/Theystayedinthecave(山洞)aslongastwoweeks.(他们呆在山洞里长达两周。)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档⑵later、after、ago、before的用法:①“一段时间+later/ago”分别表示“(多久)以后/以前”,主要用于过去时态。②“after/before+某个时刻”分别表示“在某时刻之后/之前”,此时两个词是介词。③ago与before:ago只能用于过去时,before用于完成时。如:Hehadanaccidentaweekago.(一周前出了一个事故)/Someyearslater,theboybecameaveryfamoussinger.(数年后这个男孩成了著名的歌唱家)/Haveyoubeentherebefore?(你从前到过那儿吗?)/Afterafewyearshegaveupsmoking.(过了几年他戒了烟。)⑶above、below、over、under的用法:在上下方用above和below,在高低处用over和under.如:Thestarsarehighaboveinthesky.(星星高挂在空中)/Aplaneflewoverquickly.(一架飞机从头顶飞过。)当above、below、over、under是介词性质时,意义相似。⑷too、also、either、nor的用法:too(“也”)用于肯定句和疑问句的末尾,且用逗号隔开;also(“也”)用于肯定句句子谓语动词之前;either(“也”)用于否定句末尾,也用逗号隔开;nor(“也不”)用于倒装句句首;如:AreyouAmerican,too?(你也是美国人吗?)/HeisnothappyandIamnothappy,either.(他不愉快,我也不。)/Hedidn’twatchthefootballgame.NordidI.(他没有看足球赛,我也没有。)/Youcanalsofindthemarketisverygood.(你还可以发觉那个市场很好。)⑸enough、too、so、very、quite、verymuch的用法:enough(“足够,十分”)放在形容词或副词之后;too(“太”)、very(“非常”)、quite(“相当”)、so(“如此地”)等放在形容词或副词之前,verymuch(“非常”)放在动词之后。如:It’stoo/so/very/quiteeGpensive.(它太贵/那么贵/非常贵/相当贵。)/Idon’tlikesweetsverymuch.(我不很喜欢糖果)[注意]very与much的区别:very修饰形容词、副词的原级和现在分词形容词,much修饰形容词和副词的比较级;much还可以修饰疑问句和否定句中的动词,very不可以。如:Heisverystupid.(他很笨)/Thefilmwasverymovingandeveryoneswept.(电影非常动人,大家都哭了)/Youmustworkmuchharderoryouwillfailtoenterthegoodschool.(你得学习更努力,不然你考不进那所好学校)/Idon’t3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档likehimmuch.(我不太喜欢他)⑹sometimes、sometime、sometimes、sometime的用法:sometimes(有时)用于一般现在时、sometime(在将来某时)用于将来时、sometimes(数次)表示次数、sometime(一些时间)表示一段时间。如:Sometimestheygohikinginthemountains.(他们有时徒步旅行到山里去)/Iwillstayheresometime.(我会在这儿呆些时候的。)/Iwillmeetyourfathersometime.(我什么时候要见见你的父亲。)⑺how、what用于感叹句的用法:对句子中的形容词或副词感叹时用how,对人或事物(可能含有形容词作修饰语)进行感叹用what.如:Whatafineday(itis)today!(今天天气真好!)/Howdifficult(theproblemis)!((问题)真难呀!)⑻already、yet的用法:在完成时中,already一般用于肯定句,yet一般用于否定句和疑问句。如:Haveyoudoneitalready?(你已经做好了?)/Ihavenothadmybreakfastyet.(我还没有吃早饭呢。)⑼hard与hardly的用法:hard作为副词意思是:“努力地,猛烈地”,hardly是否定词,意思是:“几乎不”,一般与情态动词can/could连用。如:TheystudyEnglishveryhard.(他们英语学得很刻苦)/Youcanhardlyseeapersonspitinapublicplace.(在公共场所你几乎看不到一个人随地吐痰)⑽like...verymuch、like...better(=prefer)、like...best的用法:三个短语分别表示“非常喜欢”、“更喜欢”、“最喜欢”。如:Ilikebaseballverymuch.(我非常喜欢棒球)/Doyoulikebutterbetterthancheese?(/Theylikehamburgersbest.⑾“quite/what+a+形容词+名词”的用法:记住:①quite/such/what...+a+形容词+名词;②too/so/how+形容词+a+名词;③rather+a+形容词+名词=a+rather+形容词+名词。如:Ihaveneverseensuchastrangeguy(家伙).(我从未见过这样奇怪的家伙)/Itisquiteanicedayforawalk.(这真是散步的好日子)⑿how的几个短语:howoften“多常,每隔多久”,用于一般时态,对表示频度的词语进行提问;howsoon“多久以后”,用于将来时态;howlong“多久”,用于过去时、完成时或其他时态;howmanytimes“多少次”,用于过去时或完成时,对总计次数进行提问;howmuch3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档“多么,多少”,对程度进行提问,也可以对数量(不可数)或金钱进行提问。如:Howlonghaveyoubeenlikethis?(你这样已经多久了?)/Howoftendoeshewashhisface?(他每隔多久洗一次脸?)⒀much、more与most的用法:这三个词除了是形容词作名词的修饰语之外,还是程度副词,much表示“很”,修饰原级形/副,more表示“更”用来构成多音节形/副的比较级,most表示“最”用来构成多音节形/副的最高级。此外,much也可以修饰比较级形/副。如:Thisparkismuchmorebeautifulthanthatone.(这个公园比那个漂亮多了)/ItisthemostinstructivefilmIhaveeverseen.(这是我看过的最有教育意义的电影)⒁nomore、nolonger、not...anymore、no...anylonger的用法:表示时间,可以用nolonger、not...nymore、no...anylonger,而且nolonger只能放在谓语动词之前;表示程度,可以用nomore、not...anymore.如:Henolongerlivedthere.(他不再住在那里)/Tomwantednomorecakes.(他不想再要蛋糕)/Hedidn’tsmokeanymore/longer.(他不再抽烟)⒂被动语态中,方式副词一般放在be与谓语动词之间。如:Therunnerwasbadlyhurt.(赛跑运动员受了重伤)/Englishiswidelyspokenintheworldtoday.(如今世界上英语说得很广泛)⒃too...to...与so...that...的问题:副词too/so后面跟形容词或副词,to后面跟动词,that后面跟从句。Too...to...(“太.……以致不……”)是否定的结构,用于简单句;so...that...(“如此…以致…”)是肯定结构,用于复合句。如:Thechildistooyoungtojointhearmy.(这孩子年龄太小还不能参军)/HeissostrongthathecanlifttheheavyboG.(他这么强壮,搬得动那个重箱子。)⒄既是形容词也是副词的单词有:early,late,long,last,neGt,first,near,enough,much,all,hard,alone,fast,slow,high,low,straight等等。如:Itwasalongholiday.(那是个长假)/Hestayedthereverylong.(他在那儿呆了好久)/Thinkhardthenyouwillfindaway.(好好想你就会找到办法)/Heisaveryhard(难对付的)person.(他是个难玩的家伙)⒅farther与further的用法区别:表示地点、方向或距离时两个词同义,意思为“更远、较远”,但是further还表示“更多、进一步、额外”3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档等意思,此时不能换为farther.如:Theydecidedtogofarther/furthertheneGtday.(他们决定第二天走得再远些)/Thisproblemwillbefurtherdiscussed.(这个问题还要进一步讨论)/Everyoneofthemhadtheirfurtherstudiesaftertheyleftcollege.(他们每个人大学毕业后继续进修)⒆rather与quite的用法区别:同very一样,两个词都表示形容词或副词的程度,quite表示“不到最高程度但是比预料的好”,rather比quite更接近very的含义,含有令人惊讶的意思。见下图对“nice”程度的描绘:notnice(fairly)nicequiteniceratherniceverynice如:It’squiteanicefilm.(这是部好片子)。(可能意味着不是一部最好的电影)/It’sratheranicefilm.(这是部很不错的电影。)(意味着比大多数电影都好)[注意]注意quite与rather后面的次序词序。⒇maybe、possibly、perhaps的区别:maybe“可能、也许”,比另外两个词更不正式、更随便、可能性不大;possibly“可能地、或者、也许”,可能性较大,在否定句和疑问句中表示“无论如何”;perhaps“可能”,较为常用而且正式,可能性也不大。如:Youcouldputitoverthere,maybe.(也许你可以把它放在那边)/Icouldn’tpossiblyhavefinishedsuchalongbookinsuchashorttime.(我不可能在这么短的时间内完成这么长的一本书)/IthoughtperhapsitwastheletteryouhavebeeneGpecting.(我以为那也许就是你期盼的信件)(21)most、mostly的区别:most作为形容词和名词时意思是“大多数的、大部分的”,作为副词时意思为“最,十分、很”;mostly仅为副词,意思为“主要地、多半地、大部分地”。如:IwasathomemostofthetimewhenIwasfree.(我有空时大部分时间都在家)Mostchildrenarenaughty.(大部分的孩子都淘气)/ThisisthemosteGcitingpartofthefilm.(这是电影中最令人兴奋的部分)/SheismostlyoutonSundays.(星期天她一般不在家)(22)(be)worth、(be)worthyof的区别:worth3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档一般被看作是介词,后面接名词或者动名词,用主动表示被动含义,还可以用副词well修饰;worthyof表示“值得的、配得上的”,后面跟动名词的被动形式。如:Whatisworthdoingatallisworthdoingwell(凡是值得做的,就值得好好去做)./Thehouseisworth¥300,000.(房子价值30万元)/Thisbookiswellworthreadingseveraltimes.(这本书值得好好读几遍)/Itisathingworthyofbeingseen.(这是一个值得看的东西)(23)almost、nearly的区别:两个词意思相近,都表示“几乎、将近”,大多数情况下可以互换,与否定词连用时用almost不用nearly.almostno相当于hardlyany(几乎没有)。如:Hehaddonealmostnothingtoday.(他今天几乎没有干什么)/Wearealmost/nearlythere.(我们几乎就到那里了)/Almostnobody/Hardlyanybodyunderstoodhiswords.(几乎没有人懂他的话)(24)abit与alittle的区别:这两个名词短语经常当作副词使用,修饰形容词或副词的原级或比较级,可以互换,语气比rather弱。如:Thisdigitalcameraisabit(alittle)eGpensive.(这台数码相机有点贵)/Itisalittle(abit)colderthanyesterday.(今天比昨天冷了点)另外,alittle可以直接加不可数名词,abit则采用“abit+of+名词(不可数或可数名词复数)”的形式。如:Ihavegotabitofacold.(我有点感冒)/Goandgetalittlewaterforme,please.(请你去给我搞点水来)[注意]notabit(=notatall)意为“根本不”,而notalittle则意为“非常,不是一点”。3、形容词、副词的原级、比较级和最高级1、分类:形容词和副词有原级、比较级和最高级三级。原级变为比较级和最高级有规则变化和不规则变化两种。2、规则变化:(1)单音节和部分双音节形容词和副词,在原级的后面加上er,est构成比较级和最高级。a)直接加er,est:b)以重读闭音节结尾的,要双写最后一个辅音字母,后加er,est:c)以辅音字母+y结尾的,先把y改为i再加上er,est:(2)两个音节或两个以上的音节的,在原级前加more/most.3、不规则变化:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档原级比较级最高级good好的better更好的best最好的well好;(身体)好的,bad,badly糟糕的,糟糕地worse更糟糕的,更糟糕地;(身体)更不舒服的worst最糟糕的,最糟糕地;(身体)最不舒服的ill(身体)不舒服的many许多的(可数)more更多的;更most最多的;最much许多的(不可数);非常little少的less更少的least最少的far远的;远地farther更远的;更远地farthest最远的;最远地further进一步的(地)furthest最深刻的(地)4、形容词和副词的原级、比较级和最高级的用法:(1)讲述某人/物自身的情况时,用原级。基本句型是:主语(sb./sth)+谓语动词+(very/too/so/quite/rather…)+形容词/副词原级+….如:Heisveryoldnow.(他现在很老了)/Theyranquitefast.(它们跑得相当快)/Theweatherlooksratherbad.(天气看上去相当糟)/Iamsohappy!(我是如此的快乐)☆表示两者之间没有差别时,使用句型:主语(第一个人物)+谓语动词+as+形容词/副词原级+as+第二个人物+….如:HeisaseGcitedashisyoungersister.(他和他妹妹一样兴奋)/Lilyrodeherbikeasslowlyasanoldlady.(莉莉骑车像老太太一样慢)/Theypickedasmanyapplesasthefarmers(did).(他们摘的苹果和农民一样多)☆表示第一个人比不上第二个人时,使用句型:主语(第一个人物)+谓语动词(否定式)+as/so+形容词/副词原级+as+第二个人物+….如:Heisnotso/aseGcitedashisyoungersister.(他没他妹妹那么兴奋)/Lilydidnotrideherbikeso/asslowlyasanoldlady.(莉莉骑车不像老太太那样慢)/Theydidn’tpickso/asmanyapplesasthefarmers(did).3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(他们摘的苹果不如农民多)(2)讲述两者有差异,第一个人物超过第二个人物时,用比较级。基本句型:主语(‘A’)+谓语动词+(much/alittle/even/still)+形容词/副词比较级+than+第二个人物(‘B’)+….如:Amoderntrainismuchfasterthanacar.(现代的火车比轿车快多了)/Thisbookdidn’tcostmemorethanthatone.(这本书花费我的钱不比那本多)讲述两者有差异,第一个人物不及第二个人物时,用比较级。句型是:主语(‘A’)+谓语动词+less+(多音节形/副)比较级+than+第二个人物(‘B’)+….如:IthinkEnglishislessdifficultthanmaths.(我认为英语不比数学难)/Doyouthinkitlessimportanttolearnaforeignlanguage?(你认为学外语不那么重要吗?)(3)讲述某人/物是一群之中最突出的一个时,用最高级。句型是:主语(sb./sth)+谓语动词+(the)+形容词/副词最高级+in/of….如:TheChangjiangRiveristhelongestinChina.(长江是中国最长的河流)/Hejumped(the)highestofthethree(boys).(三个男生中他跳得最高)4、关于比较等级的重要注释:1、以上六个句型中,如果动词是及物或不及物动词,则后面用副词;如果后面是连系动词,则后面用形容词。如:Thiscaristhefastestofthefour.(形容词)(这辆汽车是四辆之中最快的)/Thiscarruns(the)fastestofthefour.(副词)(这辆汽车是四辆之中跑得最快的)2、“比较级+and+比较级”表示“越来越……”。如:Theweatherisgettingwarmerandwarmer.(天越来越温暖了)3、“the+比较级…,the+比较级…”表示“越…就越…”。如:Themoretreesweplant,thebetteritwillbe.(我们栽的树越多,情况就会越好)/Theharderyoutry,thegreateryourprogressis.(你越是努力,进步就越大)4、一般的形容词或副词的比较级前面可以加much/alittle/even/still,而表示数量的more之前还可以加some/any/no/one/two/many/several/alot等词。如:Itismuchcoldertodaythanyesterday.(今天比昨天冷多了)/Wouldyoulikesomemorecoffee?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(你还要些咖啡吗?)/Hedidnoteatanymore.(他没有再吃)5、morethan/lessthan分别可以理解为“多于/少于”,相当于副词,morethan=over;lessthan=under.如:IlivedinNewYorkformorethanfourmonths.(我在纽约生活了四个多月)6、“oneofthe+最高级+名词(复数)”整个短语为单数含义,谓语要用单数形式。如:Oneoftheoldesthouseshasbeenburntinafire.(最古老的一幢房子在一场大火中被烧毁了)7、“Which/Who+动词+形/副,□,□or□?”句型中,如果有两个选项,形/副用比较级,如果有三个选项,形/副用最高级。如:Whohasmorebooks,LinTaoorHanMei?(林涛和韩梅谁的书最多?)/Whichistheheaviest,apig,ahorseoranelephant?(猪、马、象哪个最重?)8、上下文中含有both/either/neither/two/twins等表示两个事物的词时,用比较级,而且往往还要加the;含有all/none/noone/every等表示三个或三个以上事物时,用最高级。如:--Doyoulikethesmallerone?—Neither.(小一点的那个你喜欢吗?一个都不喜欢)/--Whichdoyoulikebest?–Allofthem!(你最喜欢哪个?全部。)七、介词:1、介词的主要用法:介词是一种虚词,不能独立使用。介词之后一般有名词或代词(宾格)或相当于名词的其他词类、短语或从句作它的宾语,即构成介词短语。有些介词是由两个以上的词构成的短语介词,如:outof(从…中出来),becauseof(因为),awayfrom(距离…),ontopof(在…顶上),eversince(自从…),neGtto(在…隔壁),accordingto(根据…),infrontof(在…前方)等。2、介词的分类表:(见下表)地点(位置、范围)介词:above在…前,about在…附近,across在…对面,after在…后面,against倚着...,along在…近旁,among在…中间,around在…周围,round在….周围,at在…处,before在...前,behind在...后,below低于...,beside在...旁边,between在...之间,by在...旁,down在...下面,from来自...,in在...里面,inside在...里面,near靠近...,of在...之中,on在...上面,outof在...之外,outside在....外面,over在....上方,under在...下方,up在...上面,ontopof在...顶部,infrontof在...前,closeto靠近...,inthe3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档middleof在...的中间,attheendof在...的末端,等等。方向(目标趋向)介词:across横越...,against对抗...,along沿着...,around绕着...,round环绕...,at朝着...,behind向…后面,etween…and…从…到...,by路过/通过...,down向…下,for向...,from从/离...,in进入...,into进入...,inside到...里面,near接近...,off脱离/除...,on向...上,outof向...外,outside向....外,over跨过...,past经过/超过...,through穿过...,to向/朝...,towards朝着...,onto到...上面,onto到...上面,up向...上,awayfrom远离...时间介词:about大约...,after在…以后,at在…(时刻),before在…以前,by到…为止,during在…期间,for有…(之久),from从…(时)起,in在(上/下午);在(多久)以后,on在(某日),past过了…(时),since自从…(至今),through贯穿…(期间),till直到…时,until直到…时,to到(下一时刻),eversince从那时起至今,atthebeginningof在...开始时,attheendof在...末,inthemiddleof在...当中,atthetimeof在...时方式介词:as作为/当作...,by用/由/乘坐/被...,in用…(语言),like与…一样,on骑(车)/徒(步),通过(收音机/电视机),over通过(收音机),through通过...,with用(材料),用(手/脚/耳/眼),without没有…涉及介词:about关于...,eGcept除了…,besides除了…还...for对于/就…而言,in在…(方面),of…的,有关...,on关于/有关...,to对…而言,towards针对...,with就…而言其它介词:【目的介词】for为了...,from防止…,to为了…【原因介词】for因为...,with由于…,becauseof因为...【比较介词】as与…一样,like象…一样,than比...,to与…相比,unlike与…不同【伴随/状态介词】against和…一起(比赛),at在(上班/休息/上学/家,etc.),in穿着…(衣服/颜色),into变成...,on在(值日),with与…一起,有/带着/长着...,without没有/无/不与…一起3、介词短语的句法作用:介词短语相当于一个形容词或副词,可用作状语、定语和表语。如:Themancame.(状)(那个人走下楼来)/Thewomanisfromthecountryside.(定)(头上戴花的妇女来自乡下)/Theteacherisnowwiththepupils.(表)(老师现在3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档和学生在一起)4、介词短语在句子中的位置:介词短语做状语时,如果表示时间/地点,可以放在句首或句尾,如果表示方向/方式/伴随/涉及/原因/目的/比较,一般放在句尾;介词短语作表语时放在连系动词之后;介词短语作定语时,只能放在被修饰的名词之后。如:HewantedtofindagoodjobinShanghaitheneGtyear.(状语)(他想来年在上海找份好工作)/Theysearchedtheroomforthethief.(他们在房间里搜索小偷)/Thelettersareforyou.(表语)(信是给你的)/Haveyouseenacatwithablackheadandfourwhitelegs?(定语)(你看见一只黑头白腿的猫了吗?)5、重要注释:⑴this/that/these/those/last/neGt/a/every/each等词构成的时间短语,前面不用任何介词。如:EveryyeartravellersfromabroadcometovisitPingyao.(每年都有国外的游客来游览平窑镇)/Hehadabadcoldthatweek.(那个星期他患重感冒)⑵for有时用来引出动词不定式的逻辑主语,常翻译成“对于…而言”。如:It’stoohardformetofinishtheworkinonlyonehour.(让我在区区一个小时内完成这项工作太难了)/Thehouseisbigenoughfor10mentolivein.(房子够大的可以容10个人住)⑶of有时用来表示后面的人物正好是前面的表语的逻辑主语。如:It’sverynice/kindofyoutodoso.(你这么做真是太好了)⑷介词有时会与它的宾语分离,而且宾语前置。①当宾语是疑问词时。Whoareyoutalkingabout?(你们在谈论谁?)②宾语在从句中当连接词时。Hehasayoungerbrotherwhohemusttakegoodcareof.(他有一个需要他照顾的小弟。)/Doyouknowwhoourteacheristalkingwithoverthere?(你知道我们的老师在那边和什么人谈话吗?)③动词不定式作定语且该动词为不及物动词,后面有介词。Ifinallyfoundachairtositon.(我最终找到了一张椅子坐。)(5)记住一些固定词组:arriveat/in(到达…),onfoot(步行),not…atall(根本不),tothenorthof(在…以北),intheeastof(在…的东部),inthenight(在夜间),atnight(在晚上),beafraidof(害怕…),befullof(充满/装满….),befilledwith(充满/装满….),begood/badfor(对…3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档有益/有害),bemadeof(由…做成),bemadefrom(由…制造),playwith(玩耍……),lookoutof(朝…外面看),attheendof(在…末梢/结束时),bytheendof(不迟于…/到…末为止),withthehelpof或withone’shelp(在…的帮助下),lookafter(照料…),lookfor(寻找…),onabike(=bybike)骑车,helpsb.with(帮某人做…),geton(well)with(与某人相处[融洽]),等等。6、某些介词的用法辨析:⑴时间或地点介词in、on、at的用法区别:表示时间时,in表示在一段时间里(在将来时句子中则表示在一段时间之后),on表示在具体的某一天或者某天的上下午等,at表示在某个时刻或者瞬间;表示地点时,in表示在某个范围之内,on表示在某个平面上或与一个面相接触,at则表示在某个具体的场所或地点。如:HewasbornonthemorningofMay10th.(他出生于五月十日的早晨)/Iusuallygetupat7:00inthemorning.(我通常在早上的七点钟起床)/Hisglassesarerightonhisnose.(他的眼镜就架在他的鼻子上)/Heisatthecinemaatthemoment.(此刻他正在电影院)⑵after与in表示时间的用法区别:“after+(具体时刻/从句)”表示“在…时刻之后”常用于一般时态;“in+(一段时间)”表示“在(多久)之后”,常用于将来时态。如:Hesaidthathewouldbehereafter6:00.(他说他六点钟之后会来这儿)/MyfatheriscomingbackfromEnglandinaboutamonth.(我父亲大约一个月以后从英国回来)⑶since与for表示时间的用法区别:“since+(具体时刻/that-从句)”表示“自从…起一直到现在”,“for+(一段斶间)”表示“总共有…之久”,都常用于完成时态;如:UncleLihasworkedinthisfactorysince1970.(李叔叔自从1970年起就在这家工厂工作了)/UncleLihasworkedinthisfactoryforover30years.(李叔叔在这家工厂已经工作了30多年)⑷by、in与with表示方式的用法区别:都可以表示“工具、手段”,但是by主要表示“乘坐”某个交通工具或“以……方式”,在被动句中可以表示动作的执行者;in表示“使用”某种语言/文字,with表示“使用”某个具体的工具、手段。如:Weseewithoureyesandwalkwithourfeet.(我们用眼睛看东西,用双脚走路)/Pleasewritethatarticle(文章)inEnglish.(请你用英语写那篇文章)/Let’sgotothezoobytaGi.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(我们打的去动物园吧。)/ItwaswrittenbyLaoShe.(那是老舍写的)⑸about与on的用法区别:都可以表示“有关…”,但是about的意义比较广,而on主要表示“有关…(专题/课程)”。如:TomisgoingtogiveatalkonthehistoryofAmerica.(汤姆要作一个美国历史的报告)/TheyareveryeGcitedtalkingaboutthecomingfieldtrip.(他们兴致勃勃地谈论着即将来到的野外旅游)⑹through与across、over的用法区别:through指“穿过…(门洞/人群/树林)”;across和over可以指“跨越…(街道/河流)”,可互换,但是表示“翻过…”时只能用over.如:Justthenarat(鼠)ranacrosstheroad.(就在那时一只老鼠跑过路面)/Thereisabridgeacross/overtheriver.(河上有座桥)/Theyclimbedoverthemountainandarrivedthereaheadoftime.(他们翻过大山提前到达了那里)/Thevisitorswentthroughabiggateintoanotherpark.(参观者们穿过一个大门来到另一个公园)(7)as与like的区别:两个词都表示“像……”,但是as译为“作为……”,表示的是职业、职务、作用等事实,而like译为“像……一样”,表示外表,不是事实。如:Letmespeaktoyouasafather.(我以父亲的身份和你讲话。)(说话者是听者的父亲)/Letmespeaktoyoulikeafather.(让我像一位父亲一样和你讲话)(说话者不是听者的父亲)(8)attheendof、bytheendof、totheend、intheend的用法区别:attheendof…既可以表示时间也可以表示地点,译为“在…末;在…尽头”,常与过去时连用;bytheendof…只能表示时间,译为“在…前;到…为止”,常用于过去完成时;intheend与atlast基本等义,表示“终于、最后”,通常用于过去时;totheend译为“到…的终点为止”,前面往往有表示运动或连续性的动词。如:Bytheendoflasttermwehadlearned16unitsofBookIII.(到上学期期末我们已经学习了第三册16个单元)/Attheendoftheroadyoucanfindabigwhitehousewithbrownwindows.(在路的尽头你能找到一幢有棕色窗户的白房子)/TheyleftforBeijingattheendoflastweek.(上周末他们动身去了北京)/IntheendhesucceededinthefinaleGams.(他最终在期末考试中考及格了)/Weshouldgoonwiththeworktotheend.(我们应该把工作干到底)/Followthisroadtotheendandyouwillseeapostoffice.(沿这条路走到底就能看见一家邮电局)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(9)foramoment、forthemoment、inamoment、atthemoment的区别:foramoment“一会儿、片刻”(=forawhile),常与持续性动词连用;forthemoment“暂时、目前”,常用于现在时;inamoment“一会儿、立即、马上”(=soon;inafewminutes),一般用于将来时;atthemoment“此刻,眼下”(=now),用于现在进行时。如:Pleasewaitforamoment.(请稍等)/Let’sleavethingsastheyareforthemoment.(暂时就维持现状吧!)/I’llcomebackinamoment.(我过会儿回来)/Iamverybusyatthemoment.(眼下我很忙)(10)but的问题:用介词but引出另一个动词时,要注意:如果前面有do,后面就用原形动词,前面没有do时,后面的动词要加to。如:Icoulddonothingbutwait.(我什么也做不了只能等)/Theyhadnochoice(选择)buttofight.(他们没有选择只有战斗)(11)infrontof与inthefrontof:infrontof“在…的前面”,与inthefrontof“在…的前部”。如:Acarwasparkinginfrontofthehall.(大厅跟前停着一辆汽车)/Inthefrontofthehallstoodabigdesk.(大厅前部立着一个大讲台)(12)eGcept与besides的区别:eGcept“除了”,表示排除掉某人物,即不包含;而besides“除了”则表示包含,即“不仅……又……”。如:EveryonewenttothePalaceMuseumeGceptTom.(除了Tom,大家都去了故宫博物院)(Tom没有去故宫)/BesidesChinesehealsostudiedmanyothersubjects.(除了汉语之外,他还学其他许多功课)(“汉语”也是他学的功课之一)八、动词1、动词的分类:类别意义例句实义动词含有实在的意义,表示动作或状态,在句子中能独立作谓语。Shehassomebananas.她吃些香蕉。Theyeatalotofpotatoes.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档他们常吃土豆。I’mreadinganEnglishbooknow.我现在正看一本英文书。连系动词本身有一定的词义,但不能独立作谓语,必须和表语一起构成谓语。Hisfatherisateacher.他父亲是教师。Twinsusuallylookthesame.双胞胎通常看起来一样。Theteacherbecameveryangry.老师变得很生气。助动词本身没有词义,不能独立作谓语,只能和主要动词一起构成谓语动词,用来表示否定、疑问、时态、语态或其它语法形式,助动词自身有人称、单复数和时态的变化。Hedoesn’tspeakEnglish.他不说英语。Weareplayingbasketball.我们在打篮球。Doyouhaveabrother?你有兄弟吗?情态动词本身有一定的意义,不能独立作谓语,只能和主要动词一起构成谓语动词,表示说话人的语气和情态。情态动词没有人称和单复数的变化,有些情态动词有过去式。Youcankeepthebooksfortwoweeks.这些书你可以借两个星期。MayIsmokehere?我可以在这儿抽烟吗?Wemustgonow.我们现在得走了。★重要注解:(1)关于实义动词:①英语的实义动词又可分为及物动词和不及物动词两大类:后面必须跟宾语意义才完整的叫及物动词;本身意义完整,后面不需跟宾语的叫不及物动词。②有些动词通常只作不及物动词。如:go,come,happen,lie,listen,rise,arrive,hall等。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档有些动词通常用作及物动词。如:say,raise,lay,find,buy等。③大多数动词可以兼作及物动词和不及物动词。如:study,sing等。④有些动词作及物动词与作不及物动词时的意义有所不同。如:know,wash等。⑤有些动词常和介词、副词或其它词类一起构成固定词组,形成短语动词。如:listen,reply,wait,look.(2)关于连系动词:①连系动词用来连接主语和表语,连系动词后面常为形容词。②常见的连系动词有:be、become、look、feel、sound、smell、taste、seem、turn、grow、get、go、fall、sit、stand、lie等。③有些连系动词来源于实义动词,意思也跟着变化:look(看→看起来)、feel(感觉、摸→感到)、smell(闻、嗅→闻起来)、taste(尝→尝起来)、turn(翻转、转动→变得)、grow(生长→变得)、get(得到、到达→变得)、go(去→变得),所不同的是,作为实义动词时,后面不能跟形容词。[注释]become、get、go、be、grow、turn的用法区别:become表示“变成”,比较正式,通常不用将来时表示动作已经完成。get也表示动作已经完成,但是更加口语化,通常表示温度、时间、岁数等变化。go表示“变得”,常见于某些短语中,后面常有形容词bad、blind、hungry等。be表示“是、成为、当”,多用于将来时、祈使句或不定式中。grow表示“变得”,常指逐渐的变化,表示身高、岁数的增长。turn表示“变得”,指变为与原先不同的情况,通常指颜色等变化。如:IwascaughtintherainandIbecameill.(我淋雨感冒了)/Hehasgotrich.(他变富了)/Hewillbeascientistinthefuture.(将来他将成为科学家)/Mylittlebrotherhasgrownmuchtallerinthepastyear.(在过去的一年里我的弟弟长得高多了)/Thesandwichhasgonebad.(那块三明治已经变坏)/Herfaceturnedredafterhermothercriticized(批评)her.(妈妈批评了他以后他的脸变红了)(3)关于助动词:①常见的助动词有:用于进行时和被动语态的be(am,is,are,was,were,been,being);用于完成时的have(has,had,having);用于将来时的shall(should);will(would)和用于一般时的do(does,did).②助动词必须同主语的人称和3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档数一致,也就是说因主语人称、数的不同而采用不同的形式,其中有些助动词也可作情态动词。如:shall,will,should,would.(4)关于情态动词:①常见的情态动词有:can(could),may(might),must,shall(should),will(would),dare(dared),need等,另外,haveto、hadbetter也当作情态动词使用。情态动词后面必须加动词的原形。②can表示体力、脑力方面的能力或客观的可能性。口语中,在询问或说明一件事可不可以做时,常用“can”代替“may”。情态动词“can”的过去式是“could”,否定式是“cannot”通常缩写成“can’t”,“could”的否定式是“couldnot”,通常缩写成“couldn’t”。如:CanIhelpyou?(要帮忙吗?)/Hecanswim.(他会游泳)/Thatcan’tbeMrLi.(那不可能是李先生)③may表示允许、请求或可能性,用may提问时,肯定回答一般用Certainly或Yes,youmay.;否定回答一般用can’t或mustn’t.如:MayIaskyouaquestion?—Certainly.(可以问你一个问题吗?当然可以)/Youmaygonow.(现在你可以走了)/Itmaybeinyourpocket.(它可能在你的衣袋里)④must表示“必须”、“一定”的意思。表示“必须”时否定形式是mustn’t;表示“一定”时,否定形式是“can’t”如:Wemustbeverycarefulwhenwecrosstheroad.(我们过马路时一定要非常小心)/ItmustbeJack.(那准是杰克)/Ihaven’tseenKatetoday.Shecan’tbehere.(我今天没有看到过凯特,她不可能在这里)[注意]用must(必须)进行提问时,肯定回答用must,否定回答用needn’t;用must(一定)进行提问时,肯定回答仍用must,但是否定回答用can’t.如:Mustwecleantheroombeforeweleave?–Yes,youmust.或No,youneedn’t.(我们走之前必须要打扫房间吗?是的,必须打扫。/不,不需要。)/Mustshebeintheromm?–Yes,shemust.或No,shecan’t.(她一定在房间里吗?是的,一定。/不,不可能在。)⑤“haveto”表示“不得不”、“必须”。We’llhavetoleavenowforitisverylateatnight.haveto的疑问形式是:助动词+…+haveto,否定形式是:助动词+not+haveto或者用needn’t.如:Doyouhavetostayuntil8o’clock?(你得呆到8点钟吗?)/Youdon’thavetodoso.(=You3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档needn’tdoso.)(你不用这么做)⑥shall在问句中,可表示征求对方意见,与第一人称连用;在陈述句的第二、三人称的主语后或表示“命令”、“警告”、“允许”等。如:Shallwegotothezoothisweekend?(我们这个周末去动物园好吗?)/HeshallbringhisownbookneGttime.(他下次必须带自己的书来)⑦should可表示“劝告”、“建议”、“惊奇”等意思。Weshouldspeaktooldpeoplepolitely.(我们应该礼貌地对老人讲话)⑧will表示“意愿”、“决心”等意思,一般与第二人称连用。如:Willyoupleaseclosethedoorforme?(请你替我把门关上好吗?)/Iwillteachyoualesson.(我要教训你一顿)⑨would表示过去的“意愿”、“决心”等。Hewouldsitnearthefireeverytimehereturnedhome.(每次他回到家中总要坐在火炉边)would也可以表示现在的情况,表达说话人向对方提出的要求,语气比“will”婉转、客气。在日常会话中,“我想要…”通常用“Iwouldliketo”或“Ishould(I’d)liketo”来表示。如:Wouldyouliketohavearestatthemoment?(你现在想要休息一下吗?)would还可以表示过去经常发生的事情。如:Everyyearparentswouldtelltheirchildrenabouttheboywhowouldsavehispeople.(每一年父母们总是向孩子们讲述这个将会拯救他的人民的男孩的事)⑩need表示“需要”,用于疑问句或否定句。“need”作实义动词时,在肯定、否定、疑问句中都可以用。如:Heneedn’tdoitinsuchahurry.(他不需要如此匆忙地做这件事)/Heneedssomehelp.(他需要一些帮助)/Hedoesn’tneedtobringhisfootballsocksthen.(那么他就无须带上足球袜了)⑾dare是“敢”的意思,用法几乎与“need”完全相同,即在疑问句和否定句中,可以作情态动词,后面用不带“to”的动词不定式。在肯定句中和实义动词一样,后面的动词不定式要带“to”。HowdareyousayIamafool?(你竟敢说我是个傻瓜?)/Hedidn’tdaretotouchtheredbutton.(他不敢触碰那个红色的按钮)⑿‘dbetter(do)(“最好是”)一般也当作情态动词使用,否定式是:’dbetternot(do).如:You’dbettersithereandsaynothing.(你最好坐在这儿不讲话)/You’dbetternotspeakbecauseheis3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档sleeping.(你最好不要讲话因为他正在睡觉)2、动词词形变化一览表:(1)规则动词变化表:规则变化原形动词结尾情况现在时单三人称现在分词过去式和过去分词一般情况+s+ing+eds,G,ch,sh,o结尾+es+ing+ed辅音字母+y结尾y→i,+es+ingy→i,+ed重读闭音节一元一辅结尾+s双写辅音字母,+ing双写辅音字母,+ed不发音的e结尾+s去掉e,+ing+die结尾+sie→y,+ing+d不规则变化have→has;be→is(无)(见不规则动词变化表)注意:①在加ing或ed时动词如果以“r”结尾,尾音节又重读的动词,“r”应双写。②s/es的读音规则:在清辅音后读[s];在浊辅音后和元音后读[z];在[s]、[F]、[z]、[tF]、[dV]后读[iz].③ed的读音规则:在清辅音后读[t];在浊辅音后和元音后读[d];在[t]、[d]后读[id].(2)不规则动词变化表:(原形→过去式→过去分词)be(am,is)wasbeenloselostlostbe(are)werebeenmakemademadebeatbeatbeatenmaymight becomebecamebecomemeanmeantmeantbeginbeganbegunmeetmetmetblowblewblownmistakemistookmistakenbreakbrokebrokenmustmust bringbroughtbroughtpaypaidpaid3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档buildbuiltbuiltputputputbuyboughtboughtreadreadReadcancould rideroderiddencatchcaughtcaughtringrangrungchoosechosechosenriseroserisencomecamecomerunranruncostcostcostsaysaidsaidcutcutcutseesawseendigdugdugsellsoldsolddodiddonesendsentsentdrawdrewdrawnsetsetsetdrinkdrankdrunkshallshould drivedrovedrivenshineshoneshoneeatateeatenshowshowedshownfallfellfallenshutshutshutfeelfeltfeltsingsangsungfindfoundfoundsinksank/sunksunk/sunkenflyflewflownsitsetsetforgetforgotforgot/forgottensleepsleptsleptfreezefrozefrozensmellsmeltsmeltgetgotgotspeakspokespokengivegavegivenspendspentspentgowentgonespillspiltspiltgrowgrewgrownspoilspoiltspoilthanghung/hangedhung/hangedstandstoodstoodhave(has)hadhadsweepsweptswepthearheardheardswimswamswumhidehidhiddentaketooktaken3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档hithithitteachtaughttaughtholdheldheldtelltoldtoldhurthurthurtthinkthoughtthoughtkeepkeptkeptthrowthrewthrownknowknewknownunderstandunderstoodunderstoodlaylaidlaidwakewoke/wakedwoken/wakedlearnlearnt/learnedlearnt/learnedwearworewornleaveleftleftwillwould lendlentlentwinwonwonletletletwritewrotewittenlielaylain 3、be(“是/存在”)动词的各种时态变化:一般现在时一般将来时现在完成时Iam….Youare.…He/She/Itis….We/You/Theyare….(I等各人称)willbe….IamHe/She/Itisgoingtobe…We/You/TheyareIhavebeen….Youhavebeen….She/he/Ithasbeen….We/You/Theyhavebeen….一般过去时过去将来时过去完成时Iwas….Youwere.…He/She/Itwas….We/You/They(I等各人称)wouldbe….IwasHe/She/Itwasgoingtobe…We/You/TheywereIhadbeen….Youhadbeen….She/he/Ithadbeen….We/You/Theyhad3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档were….been….注意:句型变化时,否定句在am/is/are/will/have/has/was/were/had/would后面加not,而且not都可以缩写为n’t(am后面not不可以缩写);疑问句将am/is/are/will/have/has/was/were/had/would提前到句首。4、其它谓语动词(主动语态)的时态变化一览表:现在时态一般现在时现在进行时一般将来时现在完成时谓语动词构成动词用原形(单三加s/es)(问句和否定句借用助词do/does)amis+动词-ingarewill+动词原形amis+goingto+动词原形arehave+过去分词has过去时态一般过去时过去进行时过去将来时过去完成时谓语动词构成动词用过去式(问句和否定句借用助词did)was+动词-ingwerewould+动词原形was+goingto+动词原形werehad+过去分词5、八种时态的具体用法:(1)一般现在时表示现阶段经常或习惯发生的动作或存在的状态,或说明主语的特征。① 一般现在时句子中常有的时间状语:often,usually,sometimes,always,every(day等),3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档once/twice,a(week等),on(Sunday等),never,inthe(morning等)。如:TheygotothePalaceMuseumonceayear.(他们每年去一次故宫)/Theyoftendiscussbusinessintheevening.(他们经常在晚上商谈生意)② 表示客观真理、事实、人的技能或现在的状态时句子里一般不用时间状语。如:Theearthturnsroundthesun.(地球绕着太阳转)/Lighttravelsfasterthansound.(光传播比声音快)③表示十分确定会发生(如安排好的事情)或按照时间表进行的事情,用一般现在可以表达将来,句子中可以有将来时间。如:ThetrainforHaikouleavesat8:00inthemorning.(开往汉口的列车上午8点开车)④在时间状语从句中(以when,after,before,while,until,assoonas等引导)和条件状语从句中(以if,unless引导),用一般现在时代替一般将来时,句子可以有将来时间。如:PleaseringmeupassoonasyouarriveinGermany.(你一到德国就给我打电话)/Ifitrainstomorrow,wewillhavetostayathome.(如果明天下雨我们就只好呆在家)⑤一般现在时用于倒装句中可以表示正在发生的动作,动词以come,go为主。如:Herecomesthebus.(车来了)/Theregoesthebell.(铃响了)。⑥一般现在时常用于体育比赛的解说或寓言故事中。Nowthemidfieldplayercatchestheballandhekeepsit.⑦人的心理活动和感官动作一般用一般现在时而不用现在进行时表达,常见动词有:like,love,hate,dislike,want,wish,hope,think(认为),understand,remember,forget,mean,need,hear,feel,see.如:Ithinkitisgoingtosnow.(我想天要下雪了)/Ireallyhopeyoucanenjoyyourstayhere.(我真的希望你愉快地呆在这儿)(1)一般过去时表示过去某时发生的动作或状态,这种动作或状态可能是一次性,也可能经常发生。① 表示过去具体时刻发生的一次性动作时,时间状语有:at(eight)(yesterdaymorning),(tenminutes)ago,when3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档引导的时间状语从句。如:Igotupat6:00thismorning.(我是早上六点钟起床的)/LittleTombrokethewindowathalfpastninethismorning.(小汤姆今天早上九点半把窗子打破了)/Whenhewentintotheroom,hesawastrangertalkingwithhisfather.(他走进房间时发现一个陌生人正和他父亲谈话)② 表示过去一段时间内不知何时发生的一次性动作时,时间状语有:yesterday,last(year等),in(1998等)。如:Hecametoourcityintheyear20GG.(他20GG年来到我们市)③ 表示过去一个阶段中经常发生的事情时,时间状语有:last…,in…,from…to…,for(10years),often,usually,sometimes,always,never等。如:MrJacksonusuallywenttoeveningschoolswhenhewasyoung./Everydayhewenttotherichmanandborrowedbooksfromhim.④ 讲故事、对过去经历的回忆、双方都明白的过去事件等一般用过去时,而且经常省略时间状语。如:IhappenedtomeetRoseinthestreet.(我正好在街上遇到露西)(1)一般将来时表示将来某一时刻或经常发生的动作或状态。①一般将来时的时间状语有:tomorrow,this(afternoon),neGt(year),oneday,now,soon,someday,sometime,inthefuture,when引导的从句等。② 用will构成的将来时,表示动作与人的主观愿望无关。“shall”用于第一人称,“will”用于所有人称。如:Iwillgraduatefromthisschoolsoon.(我很快就要从这所中学毕业了)/YouwillstayaloneafterIleave.(我走了之后你就要一个人过了)③ “am/is/aregoingto+动词原形”表示打算或准备要做的事情,或者主观判断即将要发生的事情,而“am/is/areto+动词原形”表示安排或计划中的动作。如:Amantoldthemthatthewomanwastogivebirthtothespecialbaby.(有一个人告诉他们那个妇女就会生下那个特别的男孩)/It’sgoingtorainsoon.(天快要下雨了)④ 表示一个人临时决定要做某事,可以用will表达。如:Iwillgotothelabtogetsome3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档chemicals(化学药剂).SopleasewaituntilIreturn.(我要到化学实验室去取些药品,请等我回头)⑤ 现在进行时、一般现在时也可以表示将来。(见相应时态)⑥ shall和will在口语的一些疑问句中相当于情态动词。Shall一般与第一人称连用,will与第二人称连用。如:ShallwegotothezooneGtSaturday?(我们下周六去动物园好吗?)/Willyoupleaseopenthedoorforme?(替我把门打开好吗?)⑦“beto+动词原形”表示按照计划将要发生的事情。如:Anangelcametotellherthatshewastohavethisspecialboy. (4)现在进行时现在进行时表示现在正在进行的动作或是现阶段正发生而此刻不一定在进行的动作。①现在进行时由“助动词be(amisare)+现在分词”构成。②现在进行时的时间状语有:now,this…,these…等,但经常不用。如:Whatareyoudoingupinthetree?(你在树上干什么?)/Iamwritingalongnovelthesedays.(我最近在写一本长篇小说)③表示即将发生的动作,一般指近期安排好的事情。常见的动词有:come,go,stay,leave,spend,do等。如:I’mcomingnow.(我就来)/Whatareyoudoingtomorrow?(你明天干什么?)/Heisleavingsoon.(他就要走了)④表示频繁发生或反复进行的动作,常与always等频度副词连用,以表示赞扬、不满或讨厌等感情色彩。如:Heisalwaysborrowingmoneyfrommeandforgettingallaboutitsometimelater.(他老是向我借钱,过一些时候就忘得一干二净)(5)过去进行时过去进行时表示过去某一时刻或某阶段正在进行的动作。①过去进行时由“was(第一、三人称单数)或were(第二人称单数和各人称的复数)+现在分词”构成。②过去进行时的时间状语有:then,atthattime,thistimeyesterday,at(eight)yesterday(morning),(ayear)ago,以及由when引出的时间状语从句。如:Hewascookingsupperthistimeyesterday.(昨天这个时候他正在做晚饭)/ThelittlegirlwasplayingwithhertoywhenIsawher.(我看到小女孩的时候她正在玩玩具)③3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档用于宾语从句或时间状语从句中,表示与主句动作同时进行而且是延续时间较长。句子中通常不用时间状语。如:Shewasithappenwhenshewaswalkingpast.(她路过时看到事情的发生)/Theysangalotofsongswhiletheywerewalkinginthedarkforest.(他们在黑暗的森林里走时唱了很多歌)④也可以表示过去一个阶段频繁发生或反复进行的动作,常与always等频度副词连用,以表示赞扬、不满或讨厌等感情色彩。如:Hewasalwaysborrowingmoneyfrommewhenhelivedhere.(他住在这里时老向我借钱)(6)现在完成时现在完成时表示一个发生在过去的、对现在仍有影响的动作,或表示开始在过去,并且一直延续到现在,甚至还可能延续下去的动作。①在完成时由“助动词have(has)+动词的过去分词”构成。②表示发生在过去的对现在仍有影响的动作时,时间状语有:already,yet,just,once,twice,ever,never,threetimes,before等。如:Ihaveneverseensuchfinepicturesbefore.(我以前从来没有看过这么好的画)/HehasjustgonetoEngland.(他刚去英国)③表示在过去开始一直延续到现在(可能延续下去)的动作或状态时,时间状语有:for(twoyears),since1990,since(twoweeksago)和since引导的状语从句。如:Ihavebeenawayfrommyhometownforthirtyyears.(我离开家乡有30年了)/UncleWanghasworkedinthefactorysinceitopened.(自从这家工厂开张,王叔叔一直在那儿工作)④口语中havegot往往表示have(有)的意思。如:Theyhavegotthousandsofbooksintheirlibrary.(他们图书馆有上万本书)⑤havebeento与havegoneto的区别:havegoneto(“已经去了”)表示人不在这里,havebeento(“去过”)表示人在这里。如:--WhereisMrLi?–HehasgonetotheUK.(李先生在哪里?他去了英国。)/--DoyouknowsomethingaboutBeijing?–Yes,IhavebeentoBeijingthreetimes.(你知道北京的情况吗?是的,我去过那里三次。)⑥在完成时中,一个瞬间性动词(一次性动作)不能与表示一段时间的状语连用,此时须将该瞬间动词改为延续性动词或状态动词。具体变化见下表:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档瞬间性动词的完成时→延续性动词或状态动词的完成时have(already)goneto…havebeenin/at…for(twoyears)has cometo…hasbeenheresince(1990)(had) left…(had)beenawayfrom… arrived… beenin… died beendead begun beenon ended beenover bought... had… borrowed… kept… joined… beenin… 或者使用下面这个句型:Itis/hasbeen+(多久)+since+主语(人)+谓语(过去时)+……+过去时间状语[注意]在其它的时态中也存在类似问题,记住,关键是:瞬间动词不能和表达一段时间的状语连用。如:HowlongmayIkeepthebook?(这本书我能借多久?)(句子中keep取代了borrow)(7)过去完成时过去完成时表示过去某一时间或某一动作发生之前已经完成的动作。简言之,过去完成时所表示的时间是“过去的过去”。①过去完成时由“助动词had+动词的过去分词”构成。②过去完成时时间状语有:by(yesterday),bythen,bytheendof(last…)或者由when,before等引出状语从句。有时句子中会有already,just,once,ever,never等词语,也会有for…或since…构成的时间状语。如:Theyhadalreadyfinishedcleaningtheclassroomwhentheirteachercame.(当老师来的时候他们已经打扫完了教室)/Thewomanhadleftbeforeherealizedshewasacheat.(在他发觉那个妇女是个骗子时她已经走掉了)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档③过去完成时常用于宾语从句中、after引导的从句中,或者从句是before引导的主句中。如:AfterIhadputonmyshoesandhat,Iwalkedintothedarkness.(我穿上鞋子戴上帽子走进了黑暗之中)/Hesaidthathehadneverseenakangaroobefore.(他说他以前从来没有见过袋鼠)(8)过去将来时过去将来时表示在过去预计将要发生的动作或存在的状态。①过去将来时由“助动词should(第一人称)或would(第二、三人称)+动词原形”构成。在美国英语中,过去将来时的助动词一律用“would+动词原形”。②过去将来时常由于宾语从句中,时间状语有:later,soon,theneGt(day).③在时间状语从句和条件状语从句中不可以使用过去将来时,而应该使用一般过去时。如:HepromisedthathewouldpaymealotifIhelpedhimwiththeproject.(他答应付给我许多钱如果我帮助他搞那个项目)/Everytimewhenhewasfree,hewouldsitdownandreadsomebooks.(每次只要他有空他就会坐下来看看书)④表示纯粹的将来时用would或should,表示打算或主观认为的事情用was/weregoingto(+动词原形)。如:Shetoldmeshewouldbe18theneGtmonth.(她告诉我她下个月就18岁了)/Shetoldmethatshewasgoingtohaveawalkwithherpetdog.(她告诉我她打算带她的宠物狗去散步)⑤过去将来时还可以表示一个过去经常性的动作。如:Whenitrainedintheday,hewouldbringanumbrellawithhim.(白天下雨时他会随身带一把雨伞)(9)现在完成进行时:现在完成进行时指一个从过去就开始一直延续到现在并由可能继续下去的动作,它具有现在完成时和现在进行时双重特征,结构是:“have/has+been+动词的现在分词”。如:Ihavebeenswimminginthecoldwaterforabouttwohours.(我已经在冰冷的水里游了将近两个小时)/Howlonghaveyoubeenwaitinghere?(你在这里一直等了多久?)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档6、被动语态:(1)被动语态定义:被动语态是动词的一种特殊形式,用来说明主语与谓语动词之间的关系。如果主语是动作的执行者(即某人做某事),便叫主动语态;如果主语是动作的承受者(即某事被做),便叫被动语态。主动与被动的区别不是词序的区别,而是主语与谓语意义上的区别。在英语中只有及物动词和一些相当于及物动词的词组才有被动语态的形式。(2)英语中被动语态由“助动词be+动词的过去分词”构成。助动词be有时态、人称和数的变化。被动语态后的by短语有时可省去。具体结构见下表:现在时态一般现在时现在进行时一般将来时现在完成时谓语动词构成amis+p.p.areamis+being+p.p.arewill+be+p.p.amis+goingto+be+p.p.arehave(has)+been+p.p.过去时态一般过去时过去进行时过去将来时过去完成时谓语动词构成was+p.p.werewas+being+p.p.werewould+be+p.p.was+goingto+be+p.p.werehad+been+p.p.[注]p.p.表示过去分词。(1)被动语态的用法:①不知道谁是动作的执行者(即不知道谁做)时用被动语态,省略by短语。如:Amanwaskilledintheaccident.(一个人死于事故)/Thiswindowwasbrokenyesterday.(这扇窗子是昨天被打破的)②不说或者众所周知是谁做时,用被动语态,省略by短语。如:Riceisalsogrowninthisplace.(这个地方也种水稻)/Arailroadwillbebuilthereinthreeyears.(三年之后这里将要修建一条铁路)③强调动作的承受者,句尾加by短语。如:ItwaswrittenbyLuGun.(它(书)是鲁迅写的)/Apetdogisneverkilledbyits3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档owner.(宠物狗是不会被主人宰杀的)(2)主动语态如何改写为被动语态:主动句:主语(人/物)+谓语(及物动词)+宾语(人/物)+其他+状语(动作的执行者)(各种时态形式)(动作的承受者)被动句:主语(人/物)+谓语(及物动词)+by+人/物+其他+状语(动作的承受者)(be+过去分词)(动作的执行者)(3)注意点:①“动词+间接宾语+直接宾语”改为被动时,可以用间接宾语做被动句的主语。如:Histeachergavehimadictionary.→Hewasgivenadictionarybyhisteacher.(老师给他一本字典→他得到老师一本字典)也可以用直接宾语做被动句的主语,但是需用to或者for引出原句的间接宾语。如:Histeachergavehimadictionary.→Adictionarywasgiventohimbyhisteacher.(老师给他一本字典→一本字典由老师送给了他)/Hisfathermadehimakite.→Akitewasmadeforhimbyhisfather.(他的父亲给他做了一个风筝→一个风筝由他的父亲做给了他)②“动词+宾语+动词原形”改为被动时,动词原形前要加to.如:Thebossmadethepoormanwork12hoursaday.→Thepoormanwasmadetowork12hoursaday.(老板让这个可怜的人一天工作12小时→这个可怜人被迫一天工作12小时)③“动词+…+介词”改为被动时,介词一般在原位不动。如:Thegirltakesgoodcareofherlittlebrother.→Thegirl’slittlebrotheristakengoodcareofbyher.(女孩照顾小弟弟→女孩的小弟弟由她照顾着)④“be+过去分词”未必表示被动语态,而可能是系表结构。如:Heispleased/worried/tired/…….(系表)(他高兴/焦虑/疲劳……)Hewashit/knockeddown/told/shot/…….(被动)(他被击中/撞倒/关照/射中……)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档7、动词的非谓语形式:动词不做谓语时的固定形式。(1)动词的非谓语形式包括动词不定式、动名词和分词三种形式;其中分词又包含现在分词和过去分词两种形式。它们在句子中不能单独作谓语。(2)动词不定式:①形式:动词不定式基本形式由“不定式记号to+动词原形”构成。它的否定形式只要在“to”前面加上“not”。它的疑问形式是:“wh-疑问词+to+动词原形”。G它的被动形式:“tobe+过去分词”。G它的完成形式:“tohave+过去分词”。②动词不定式具有名词、形容词和副词的特征,即可以在句子中作主语、宾语、定语、状语、表语和宾语补足语。但不定式也保留动词的某些特征,即不定式后面可以跟宾语、表语和状语。动词不定式加上相关成分就构成不定式短语。③动词不定式可以放在谓语前句子作主语。但是通常将作主语的动词不定式或不定式短语放在谓语后面,而在主语位置用“it”作形式主语(有时在不定式的前面还会用forsb.表示不定式的逻辑主语)。如:Tohelpanimalsishelpingpeople.(帮助动物就是帮助人)/Itisverydifficult(forus)tolearnChinesewell.((对于我们而言)学好汉语是非常的困难)/Ittookmehalfanhourtoworkoutthisproblem.(解出这道题花了我一个小时的时间)④动词不定式可以作谓语动词(及物动词)的宾语。[A]及物动词+不定式一般形式:谓语动词(vt.)+不定式(作宾语)[说明]want(想)/try(试图)/decide(决定)/wouldlike(想要)/hope(希望)/love(喜爱)/learn(学会)/afford(提供)/agree(同意)/fail(失败、未能)/mean(意味着)/prefer(宁愿)/wish(希望)+to(do)(无)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档help(帮助)to可以省略begin(开始)/start(开始)/hate(憎恨)也可跟动名词,意义变化不大forget(忘记)/remember(记得)/like(总爱)也可跟动名词,意义变化较大如:Iwouldliketohavearestatthemoment.(我现在想休息一下)/Theybegantosearchtheroomforthethief.(他们开始在屋子里搜寻小偷)/Helikedtohaveaswiminthepoolnearhishouse.(他喜爱在靠家的水塘里面游泳)/WhendidyoulearntospeakEnglish?(你什么时候开始学英语的?)/Don’tforgettoclosethedoorwhenyouleave.(你离开时别忘了关门[比较]Heforgottoturnoffthelight.(他忘了关灯.)(没关)/Heforgotturningoffthelight.(他忘记关过灯.)(关了)/Pleaseremembertoringmeup.(记得给我打电话.)(还没打电话)/Iremembercallingyouyesterdaybutyouforgot.(我记得昨天给你打电话了,但是你忘记了.)(打过电话)[B]及物动词+疑问词+不定式:谓语动词(vt.)+wh-疑问词+不定式(作宾语)[说明]tell(告诉)/show(显示)/know(知道)/ask(问)/findout(发现)/understand(明白)/wonder(疑惑)/learn(学会)/forget(忘记)/remember(记得)/teachsb.(教某人)/discuss(商讨)whatwhere+how+to(do)whowhich……不定式疑问形式还可以作句子的主语、表语等。如:Hedoesnotknowwhichonetotake.(他不知道该选哪个)/Tellmehowtogettothestation.(告诉我怎么样去火车站)/Sheaskedmewhattodofortoday’shomework.(她问我今天家庭作业做什么)/Canyouteachmehowtosearchtheinternet?(你能教我怎样上网吗?)[C]不定式作宾语而后面又有宾语补足语时,通常用it代替作形式宾语,而不定式则后置。如:Ifounditnotveryeasytolearntoride3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档abike.(我发现学骑车不很容易)⑤动词不定式可以在句子中用作定语,放在名词或代词后面。[A]记住下面的一些结构:被修饰部分+不定式(作后置定语)汉语意思akeytolockthedoor锁门的钥匙aboGtoholdthesethings装这些东西的箱子giveherabooktoread给她一本书读Isthereany(+名词/代词)to(do)?有…要(做的)吗?It’stimetogo.是走的时间了。/该走了。Doyouhaveanyworktodo?你有工作要做吗?I’dlikesomethingtoeat.我要点儿吃的。Ihavenothingtosay.我没有话要说。Wouldyoulikesomethingtodrink?你要点儿喝的吗?[B]在这种情况下,如果不定式动词是不及物动词,则后面必须加介词。如:Theycouldnotfindaplacetolivein.(他们找不到住的地方)/Pleasegivemeachairtositon.(请给我一张椅子坐坐)/Hehasgotawritingbrushtowritewith.((他找到了写字的毛笔)⑥动词不定式可以在句子中用作状语,有下列几种情况:[A]放在不及物动词(come,go,stop,finish,wait等词)的后面。如:Hecametoseeheryesterday.(他昨天来看望她)(表示来的目的)/Istoppedtohavearest.(我停下来休息一会儿)(表示停下来的目的)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档[B]放在完整的谓语之后(即“谓语+宾语”、“谓语+宾语+补语”、“动词+表语”之后)。如:Wecleanedtheroomtolethimplayinit.(我们打扫了房间以便让他在里面玩)/Iopenedthewindowtoseemoreclearly.(我打开窗子以便看得更清楚点儿)[C]有时表示目的的不定式短语可以放在句首。如:Toarrivethereontime,Igotuponehourearlierthanusual.(为了按时到达,我们比平时早起了一个小时)(表示早起的目的)[注意]stoptodo与stopdoing的不同。如:Theystoppedtohavealook.(他们停下来看看)(不定式作“停下来”的目的状语)/Theystoppedlookingoutofthewindowandbegantolistentotheteahcher.(他们停止向窗外望,开始听老师讲课)(动名词作宾语,表示“停止”的内容)⑦动词不定式可以在句子中用作表语,限用于连系动词之后。如:Myjobistokeepthegoal.(我的工作就是守住球门)⑧动词不定式可以在句子中用作复合宾语中的宾语补足语。谓语动词(vt.)+宾语(人/物)+不定式(作宾语补足语)ask(请)/tell(关照)/teach(教)/want(想要)/wouldlike(想要)/get(让)/help(帮)/invite(邀请)/like(喜欢)/warn(警告)/+sb./sth.+to(do)make(使得)/let(让)/hear(听)/see(看)/feel(感觉)/watch(观看)/have(使得)/help(帮助)+sb./sth.+(do)如:Mumaskedmetohelpherwiththecooking.(妈妈叫我帮助她做饭)/Iwouldlikeyoutoseemyparents.(我想要你见见我的父母)/Thebossoftenmadetheworkerswork14hoursaday.(老板常让工人们一天工作14小时)/Nowletmehearyouplaytheviolin.(现在让我来听你拉小提琴)[注意]help之后做宾补的不定式符号to可以省略;hear/see/feel/watch之后的宾补用不定式与现在分词时,含义不同,需特别注意,(参见现在分词部分)。试比较:IheardhercryingwhenIwalkedpast.(我路过时听到她3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档正在哭)(指当时瞬间的情况)Isatnearherandheardhersingthenewsong.(我坐在她附近听她唱新歌)(指整个过程)(3)动名词①动名词由动词原形加词尾“ing”构成。动名词有动词的特征,可以跟宾语,可以被状语修饰;它也有名词的特征,在句子中可以作主语、宾语(包括介词宾语)等。动名词加相关词语(宾语或状语等)构成动名词短语。②动名词可以作主语。一般可用it作形式主语而将动名词短语后移。如:LearningEnglishallbyyourselfisnotsoeasy.(自学好英语不那么容易)(=ItisnotsoeasylearningEnglishallbyyourself.)③动名词可以作宾语。[A]want/need之后用动名词时,含有被动意思。如:Yourcarneedsreparingbadly.(你的车急需修理。)(被修)Myhairneedscutting.(我要理发。)(头发被理)[B]remember/forge/stop/finish之后用动名词时,与用不定式含义不同。如:Iforgottowritealettertohim.(我忘了给他写封信)(根本没写)/Iforgotwritingalettertohim.(我忘了给他写过信)(写了却忘了)/Theystoppedtolookback.(他们停下来向后看)(停下的目的是向后看)/Theystoppedlookingback.(他们停止向后看)(不向后看了)[C]enjoy/mind/keep/hate/go等词一般用动名词作宾语。如:Doyoumindmyclosingthedoor?(把门关上你介意吗?)/Shehatestravellingbyair.(她讨厌坐飞机旅行)/Theywentswimmingeveryafternoon.(他们每天下午去游泳)/Ienjoywalkingaroundthetown.(我喜欢在镇上转悠)[D]like/love/start/begin/learn后面用动名词时,与用不定式意思相近或相同。如:WebegantostudyEnglishwhenwewereatprimaryschool.(我们在小学时就开始学英语了)/WebeganstudyingEnglishwhenwewereatprimaryschool.(我们在小学时就开始学英语了)④动名词可以作表语,此时特别注意不要与现在进行时混淆。如:Myjobisputtingthesepartstogether.(我的事情是把这些部件拼起来)/Iamputtingthesepartstogether.(我正在把这些部件拼起来)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档⑤动名词与现在分词构成相同,但是含义不同,动名词主要表示事情,而现在分词则主要表示进行着的动作。如:Eatingtoomuchisnotgoodforyourhealth.(动名词短语,作主语)/Seeingisbelieving.(动名词短语,分别作主语和表语)/Heranafteramovingbusandgotontoit.(现在分词,作定语)/Hisfathersawhimsittingonsomeeggs.(现在分词,作宾补)(4)分词:包含现在分词和过去分词。(高中学习重点)①主要区别:现在分词一般有主动的意思或表示动作正在进行的意思;过去分词有被动或动作已经完成的意思。分词可以有自己的宾语或状语。②分词或分词短语在句子中作定语、状语和复合宾语等。[A]作定语:分词作定语时,一般要放在修饰的名词之前,分词短语作定语时,则要放在所修饰的名词之后。如:Ihavegotarunningnose.(我流鼻涕)/Thewomanrunningafterthethiefshoutedveryloudly,“Stopthethief!”(跟着小偷追的妇女大喊:捉小偷!)/YesterdayImetamancalledMr.Black.(昨天我遇见了一个名叫布莱克先生的人)/Heonlygavemeabrokenglass,soIwasveryangrywithhim.(他只给了我一个坏玻璃杯,所以我很生他的气)[B]现在分词可以作下列动词的宾语补足语。(参考不定式作宾语补足语)谓语动词(vt.)宾语宾语补足语keep(保持)/see(看到)/hear(听到)/watch(注意到)/feel(感觉到)sb./sth.(do)ing如:Mumkeptmeworkingalltheweek.(妈妈让我一个星期都在工作)/WhenIenteredtheroom,IsawJackeatingabigpear.(我进入房间时看到杰克正在吃一只大梨子)/InthedarkIfeltsomethingverycoldmovingonmyfoot.(黑暗之中我感到有个冷的东西在我的脚上移动)[C]现在分词可以作状语,表示伴随情况。如:Shecameintotheclassroom,holdingapileofpapersinherhand.(他走进教室,手上抓着一沓纸)/Iamverybusythesedaysgettingreadyforthecomingoraltest.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(这些日子我正忙着准备即将来到的口语考试)[D]过去分词可以作表语,放在连系动词后面,但要注意不要与被动语态混淆,“主系表”主要表示状态,而被动语态则表示动作。常用过去分词作表语的结构有:beworried(焦虑)/bepleased(高兴)/betired(疲劳)/getdressed(打扮好)/getlost(迷路)/getcaught(遭遇)/beomefrustrated(沮丧)/becomeinteretedin(对…感兴趣)等等。例略。[E]过去分词可以作宾语补足语。如:Ihadmyhaircutthismorning.(今天早上我让人给我理了发)(注意:havesth.done表示动作由别人来做,而havedonesth.则为现在完成时的结构,两个结构不可以混淆)8、动词用法辨析:(1)“Whynot+动词原形+…?”(干嘛不……?)是简略句,完全形式是:Whydon’tyou+动词原形+…?如:Whynotgoandhavealook?(干嘛不去看看?)/Whynottryitonceagain?(为什么不再试试?)(2)seem(好象)的用法:记住几个结构:①sb./sth.+seem+(tobe+)形容词+…;②sb./sth.+seem+like+…;③sb/sth+seem+to(do);④Itseemsthat+从句。如:Heseemed(tobe)veryhappywhenhewascalledbytheheadmaster.(被校长叫到名字时他好象很开心)/ItseemsthatnobodyelsecoulddosuchafoolishthingeGceptJim.(除了吉姆好象没有什么人会做出如此愚蠢的事情来)(3)beafraid(害怕)的用法:记住几个结构:①beafraidofsth;beafraidof(doing);②beafraidto(do);③beafraidthat+从句。如:Sheisalittleafraidofsnakes.(她有点怕蛇)/Don’tbesoafraidtostayathomealoneatnight.(别害怕晚上一个人在家)/I’mafraidthatsomebodywilltakehisplacebecauseofhisseriousmistakes.(恐怕有人要取代他了,因为他犯了那么大的错误)(4)besorry(抱歉)的用法:记住几个结构:①besorryfor(sth);②besorryfor(doingsth);③besorryto(do);④besorrythat+从句。如:Iamverysorryforkeepingyouwaitingsolong.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(不好意思让你久等了)Iamsorrytotroubleyou.(对不起,麻烦你了)/Iamsorry(that)heisn’thereatthemoment.(恐怕他现在不在)(5)besure(确信)的用法:记住几个结构:①besureof(sth);②besureto(do);③besurethat+从句。如:Shetoldmemanytimesthatshewassuretocome.(她给我讲过多次她一定会来的)/Areyousureofyouranswer?Maybeit’swrong.(你对你的答案有把握吗?也许是错的。)/IamsurethatDadwillhelpmewiththejob.(我确信爸爸会帮着我做这件事情的)(6)make与do的用法:一般情况下表示进行活动或者做工作用do,表示创造建构某事物用make.如:Idon’tknowwhattodo.(我不知道该干什么)/I’mnotgoingtodoanywork.(我不准备做什么)/MyfatherandIoncemadeaboat.(我和我爸曾经做过一只船)此外还要记住一些固定说法:dogood/harm/business/one’sbest/afavour……makeadecision/aneffort/amistake/anoise/aphonecall/money/war/thebed/sure,...(7)puton、wear、have…on、bein、tryon、dress的用法:puton强调“穿、戴”这个动作过程,wear则表示“穿着、戴着”这一状态,have+衣物+on主要表示状态,bein(+颜色/衣物)也是表示一个状况,dress(+人)表示“给…人穿衣”。如:Pleaseputonyournewshoes.(请穿上你的新鞋)/Thetwinsarewearingthesameclothes.(双胞胎穿着相同的衣服)/Todayshehasanovercoaton.(今天她穿着一件大衣)/Doyouknowthewomanwhoisinblack?(你认识那个身穿黑衣的女人吗?)/DadisdressingTomnow.(爹正在给汤姆穿衣)[注意]dress与wear或puton的区别:wear或puton常用衣物作宾语,而dress常用人作宾语。表示给自己穿衣时常用“getdressed”或“dressoneself”表达。bedressedin与wear基本同义。dressup意为“穿上盛装、乔装打扮”。如:Couldyoudressthebabyforme?(你能替我给宝宝穿衣吗?)/Heiseightbutcan’tdresshimself.(他八岁了,还不会穿衣服)/Shewasdressedinaredcoat.(她穿着一件红上衣)/DoIhavetodressuptogotoJim’sparty?(我得穿上好衣服去参加吉姆的聚会吗?)(8)like、love与enjoy的用法:三个词都含有“喜欢”的意思,但是,like和3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档enjoy后面跟动名词,love后面一般跟动词不定式。like后面有时跟动词不定式,表示一种习惯或嗜好(往往与具体的时间或地点有关)。enjoy后面还可以加名词、反身代词,表示“享受…乐趣;玩得开心”。如:Doyoulikeshopping?(你喜欢购物吗?)/Helikestohaveaswimwhenhegetshomeeveryafternoon.(每天下午放学后他总爱游个泳)/Theylovetosingforeignsongs.(他们喜爱唱外国歌曲)/Didyouenjoyyourselfattheparty?(在聚会上你玩得开心吗?)/HeenjoyslivinginChina.(他喜欢在中国生活)(9)study、learn的用法:study主要表示“学习、研究”,指过程;而learn主要表示“学会”,指结果。表示“学”时可以互换。如:Howmanysubjectsdoyoustudy?(你学多少门课程?)/Haveyoulearnedityet?(这个你学过了吗?)/Howlonghaveyoustudied/learnedEnglish?(你学英语多久了?)learn还可以表示“听说”,如:Helearnedthemusicianhimselfwasintown.(他听说音乐家本人就在城里)(10)think、want、wouldlike的用法:三个词都含有“想”的意思,但think指“思考、考虑”,want指“想要、愿望、企图”,wouldlike指“想要”,think后面一般跟介词短语或从句,want和wouldlike后面跟名词或动词不定式。如:DoyouthinkthatChinawillbecomeadevelopedcountryin40years?(你认为中国会在40年后成为发达国家吗?)/IamthinkingofthemoneyIoncelenttoLiMin.((我正在想着以前借给黎敏的钱)/Whatdoyoureallywanttosay?(你到底想干什么?)/Whichofthesecakeswouldyoulike(tohave)?(这些饼子中你想吃哪些?)(11)lookfor、search…for、find、findout的用法:前面两个词语表示动作过程,后面两个表示结果,lookfor指“寻找”不见的或丢失的东西,但还没有找到;search…for…指“为找…而搜寻…”;find指“找到”了东西;findout主要指“查明一个事实真相”。如:Hey,Monkey,whatareyoulookingforinthecupboard?(嘿,猴儿!你在厨子里面找什么呢?)/Haveyoufoundthelostkeytoyourcar?(你找着丢失的车钥匙了吗?)/Thesoldiersweresearchingtheroomforthespywhentheyheardaloudnoise.(士兵们正在房间里面搜寻间谍突然间他们听到了衣声巨响)/Let’strytofindoutwhobroke3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档thewindow.(让我们查查谁把窗子打破了)[注解]find的几个结构:findsb.sth“为某人找到…”,findsth./sb.+adj./n.“发觉某人是…”,findit+adj.+todo…(或+宾语从句)“发现(做……)如何”。如:Hismotherfoundherdaughteraveryclevergirl.(他的母亲发现她的女儿是个聪明的女孩)(名词作补语补足语)/Youcaneasilyfinditnotgoodforyourhealthtoeatcoldfood.(你很容易就会发现吃冷食对你的身体是不利的)(12)listento、hear的用法:两个词与听觉有关,listento指“听”这一过程,hear指“听到”这一结果。如:Areyoulisteningtome,Jim?Yes,Ihaveheardyourwords.(吉姆,你在听我说吗?是的,你的话我全听见了)(13)look、see、watch、read的用法:四个词均与眼睛有关,look指放眼去“看”(不管是否看得到),指“看”的过程;see指“看见”这一结果,有时see还引申为“明白”,表示“看”时后面加“电影”等词;watch指专注的看,含有“注视、监视”之义,后面常跟“电视、比赛”等词;read限制为看书面材料,译为“看、阅读”,后面跟“书、报纸、杂志”等词。如:Whatareyoulookingat?(你在看什么?)/Pleaselookattheblackboard.(请看黑板)/Letmegotoseethefilm,mum,willyou?(妈妈,让我去看电影吧,好吗?)/Hewon’tfeelwelluntilhefinisheswatchingthefootballmatch.(要看完了足球赛他才会感觉好些)/Readinggivesusknowledge.(阅读给我们知识)(14)hear、hearof、hearfrom、learn的用法:hear“听说”,后面可以跟名词、代词、从句表示听见的内容,hearof“听说”,后面跟人,指对某人有耳闻但没有见过面;hearfrom“收到……的来信”,后面加人;learn“听说、得知”,后面跟从句,含义与hear相似。如:IhearMrGreeniscomingtoseeustonight.(我听说格林先生今晚要来看望我们)/HaveyoueverheardofthemanwhooncewenttotheHimalayaMountains?(你是否听说过那个去过喜马拉雅山的人?)/Howoftendoyouhearfromyourfather?(隔多久你收到你父亲的信?)/Helearnedthemusicianhimselfwasintown.(他听说音乐家本人就在城里)(15)speak、talk、say、tell的用法:四个词与“说”有关。speak“讲话、发言、演说”,是不及物动词,涉及人时要加介词to,speak3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档作及物动词时后面跟语言名称;talk“谈话、闲谈”,是不及物动词,涉及人时用介词with、to等,涉及事情时后面跟介词about等;say是及物动词,后面跟名词、代词、从句等,表示说的内容;tell是及物动词,后面首先要跟人,然后再跟从句或者介词短语等。如:DoyouspeakEnglish?(你讲英语吗?)/Whospokeatthemeeting?(谁在会上发了言?)/OurteacheristalkingtoLinTao’sparent.(我们的老师正在跟林涛的家长讲话)/CanyousayitinEnglish?(你能用英语说出它吗?)/Pleasetellmesomethingaboutthestrangeflyingobject.(请跟我讲讲那个奇怪的飞行物的事情吧)(16)beableto(do)、can的用法:can是情态动词,有许多含义,表示“可能、可以、会”等意思,只有现在式can和过去式could两种形式;beableto表示能力上“会”,有多种时态形式,to后面跟动词原形,有时可以与can/could互换。如:CanyouspeakEnglish?(你会说英语吗?)/Hecouldn’t(wasn’tableto)swimwhenhewas12.(他十二岁时不会游泳)(17)therebe、have的用法:两个词都可以译为“有”,但是,have表示的是“拥有”,主语必须是人或者物;therebe表示“存在”的概念,主语在therebe之后。如:Howmanybrothersandsistersdoyouhave?Ihaveonlyonebrother.(你有多少兄弟?我只有一个兄弟。)/Howmanychairsanddesksarethereintheirclassroom?Thereisnone.(他们教室里有多少张桌椅?一张也没有。)[注解]therebesb./sthdoing与therebesb./sthtodo有所不同:用doing表示一个正在发生的事情,而用todo则表示一个滞后或迟于therebe的动作。如:Look!Thereisadoglyingonthestairway./Takeyourtime.Thereisnothingforyoutodotonight.(18)borrow、lend、keep的用法:表示“借”的三个词,borrow“借进”、lend“出借”都是一次性动作,不可以和表示一段的时间状语连用;keep“保存”用来表示借一段时间。如:IhavelostthebookIborrowedfrommyteacher.WhatcanIdo?(我丢掉了从老师那里借来的书)/Howlonghaveyoukeptmydictionary,eh?Formorethantwomonths!(呃,我的字典你借了多久了?两个多月了!)(19)bring、take、carry、send、lift的用法:bring指从远处“拿来”;take3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档指从面前“拿走”;carry指一般的搬运,不涉及方向;send主要指“送、派遣、寄”;lift指把东西由低向高“提起、拎起”。例略。(20)hope、wish的用法:两个词都表示“希望”,但是,hope表达有把握或信心实现的事情,后面直接跟动词不定式或者宾语从句,不可以跟动名词或作宾语补足语的不定式;wish表达实现的可能性不大的事情,后面跟名词、宾语从句(用过去时)或者作宾语补足语的不定式。如:Weallhopetoseehimverysoon.(我们全都希望尽快见到他)/Ihopeitwillbefinetomorrowsothatwecangoout.(我希望明天天好,这样我们就能出去了。)/HowIwishitwasnotrainingatthemoment!(我多么希望此刻不在下雨!)(事实上天正在下雨)(21)take、spend、pay、cost的用法:spend的宾语通常是金钱或时间,句型:sb.+(spend)+时间/金钱+onsth/(in)doingsth.;take的主语通常是事情,句型:sth./It+(take)+sb.+时间+todo…。(如果是动作则常用it作形式主语将动词不定式后移);cost的宾语通常是时间、金钱、力气,句型:sth.+(cost)+sb.+时间/金钱/力气.;pay的宾语通常是金钱,句型:sb.+(pay)+金钱+for+事物.如:Shespentthewholenightreadingthenovel.(她花了一个晚上看那本小说)/Thisjobwilltakemetwodays.=Itwilltakemetwodaystodothejob.(做这件事情要花我两天的时间)/Howmuchdoesahouselikethiscost?(像这样的房子要花多少钱?)/Ipaidhimtwentydollarsforthebook..(我花了20元从他那儿买了书)(22)begin、start的用法:begin在大多数情况下可以替代start,(反义词是end),后面接不定式或动名词时区别不大,但是start还可以表示“开始、出发、启动”,反义词是stop;某事停止后再重新开始一般用start.如:Whendidyoubegin/starttolearnEnglish?(你什么时候开始学英语的?)/Theystartedgettinginthecropsaftertherainstopped.(雨停后他们开始收割庄稼)/Thistimehecouldnotstarthiscar.(这次他没法启动他的汽车)(23)arrivein/at、reach、getto的用法:arrive是不及物动词,到达具体地点时后面加介词at,到达一个大的地方(国家、城市)时后面加介词3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档in,arrive后面可以直接跟地点副词here/there/home等;get表示“到达”时是不及物动词,涉及地点(无论大小)时后面加to,get后面可以直接跟地点副词here等;reach是及物动词,后面直接跟地点名词。如:HearrivedinSanFranciscolastSunday.(上个星期天他抵达旧金山)/Howdidyougetthereinthenight?(你是怎样在夜间到达那里的?)/Wehurriedallthewayandreachedthestationjustfiveminutesbeforethetrainleft.(我们一路狂奔在火车启动前5分钟到达车站)(24)bemadeof、bemadefrom、bemadeinto、bemadein、bemadeby、bemadefor的区别:bemadeof指从制成品中可以看得出原材料,而bemadefrom则指从制成品中看不出原材料,口语中都可以换成bemadeoutof。bemadeinto表示“被制成……”,bemadein表达被制造的地点,bemadeby表达制造的人,bemadefor表达被制造的目的。如:Thiskindofpaperismadefrombamboo.(这种纸是由竹子生产的)/Thedeskismadeofwoodandmetal.(桌子是铁和木头打的)/Alotofpaperhasbeenmadeintopaperbirds.(许多纸被折叠成了小鸟)/Computersaremadeinthesecities.(计算机是在这几个城市制造的)/ThiskitewasmadebyUncleWang.(这个风筝是王叔叔做的)/Abigbagwasmadeformetoholdmywastethings.(一只大包做好了让我装废物)(25)beusedfor、beusedto、usedto、getusedto的区别:beusedfor+名词/代词或动名词,beusedto+动词原形,表示两个短语意思相近,表示“用于…”。usedto+动词原形,表示“过去常常”,否定式可以是“didn’tuseto”也可以是“usedn’tto”;get/beusedto+动名词,表示“习惯于….”。如:Aknifecanbeusedforcuttingthings.(刀可以用来割东西)/Aknifecanbeusedtocutthings.(刀可以用来割东西)/Heusedtoborrownovelsfromthelibrarywhenhewasatschool.(他上学时常常在图书馆借书)/Heisusedtogettingupearlyinthemorning.(他习惯早起)(26)beat,win与lose:beat(打败),后面跟“人”,而win(赢得),后面跟“比赛、竞赛”等。如:Whowonatlast?(最后谁赢了?)/ClassThreebeatus5-0.(三班以5∶0打败了我们)/Iamsuretowinthematch.(我一定能赢得比赛)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档而lose则表示“输了”,常用句型:losesth.tosb.如:UnluckilywelostthematchtoClassThree.(不幸的是我们比赛输给了三班)(27)grow、plant、keep的区别:plant着重讲“栽、种植”这个动作,grow则指种植以后的“栽培”、“管理”,而keep则主要指“喂养”、“赡养”一个人或者动物。如:Hegrewvegetablesinhisgarden.(他在园子里种菜)/Iplantedtentreeslastyear,butfourofthemdied.(去年我栽了10棵树,但是死了4棵)/Oldwomenenjoykeepingcatsordogstokillthetime.(老年的妇女喜欢养猫养狗打发时间)(28)fall、drop的区别:fall指东西由高处向下坠落,不及物动词;也可以作连系动词,意思是“变得,进入某种状态”。drop表示物体由高处往低处落下,不及物动词;或让物体落向低处,及物动词。如:Themanfelloffthetractorandhurthimself.(那个人从拖拉机上摔下来跌伤了)/Soonaftertheytouchedthepillowstheyfell(系动词)fastasleep.(他们头挨枕头不久就睡着了)/Hefeltasifhehadtodropmaths.(他觉得似乎要放弃数学)/Hedroppedaletterintothemail-boG.(他向邮箱里丢了一封信)(29)join、joinin、takepartin的区别:join多指参加组织、团体、党派等,后面跟人时表示和某人一起参加某项活动;joinin指参加某项游戏或活动;takepartin多指参加群众性的活动、运动、会议等。如:Hejoinedthearmyin20GG.(他20GG年参军)/Theyjoinedmeincongratulatingyou.(他们和我一起向你祝贺)/Dojoinusinthegame.(千万参加我们的比赛)/Hetookanactivepartinthestudents’movementinthe1940s.(在二十世纪40年代他积极参加学生运动)(30)beat、hit、strike的用法区别:beat指“连续不断地打击;(心脏的)跳动”;hit指“一次性地撞击、命中”;strike与hit基本同义,还可以理解为“划(火柴)、给……深刻的印象”。如:Themanlooksdead,buthisheartisstillbeatingweakly.(那个人看上去死了可心脏还在微弱地跳动)/Hehittheballsohardthatitflewovertheirheadsandfellintothelake.(他踢球的劲太大球飞过他们的头顶落入水中)/Hewentintotheroomandstruckamatch(火柴).(他走进房间划着了一根火柴)(31)carryon、carryout的区别:carryon表示“进行、继续”;carryout3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档表示“进行、贯彻、实现”。如:Iwillcarryonthework.(我会继续工作)/Ihavesomedifficultiesincarryingouthisorders.(对于执行他的命令我有问题)(32)beamazed与besurprised的区别:beamazed“感到惊讶”,指人对某个不可能发生却实际发生了的事情感到极其的讶异;besurprised“感到吃惊”指人对突发的事件感到惊讶。如:Whenhediveddeepintothesea,hewasamazedatthecoloursofallthebeautifulcoralreefs.(他深潜到海中时被所有美丽的珊瑚礁惊呆了)/Hewasverysurprisedwhenheheardaloudnoisefrominsidetheroom.(听到房间里传出一个很大的声音他非常地吃惊)(33)warn的用法:“warnsb.of/aboutsth”意思是“针对…而警告某人”;“warnsb(not)todosth”意思是“告戒某人(不)要做某事”;“warnsb.+that从句”意思是“警告某人说……”。如:Theywarnedthepassengersofthieves.(他警告路人小心窃贼)/IwarnyouthatyouwillfailinthecomingeGamsifyouarestillsolazy.(我警告你:如果你还这么懒在即将来到的考试中你会不及格的。)/Hewaswarnednottogooutinthelatenight.(他受到警告不要在深夜出去)(34)thinkof与thinkabout等短语的区别:thinkof表示“考虑、思念、认为、想起、建议”等;“thinkabout”表示“看待、认为”;“thinkmuch/highly/alotof”表示“高度评价…”;“thinkover”表示“仔细考虑”;“thinkout”表示“想出”。如:Theheadmasterthoughthighlyofthisboy.(校长高度地评价了这个男孩)/We’rethinkingofgoingtoFranceforourholiday.(我们在考虑去法国度假的事情)/Thinkitoverandyouwillhaveaway.(仔细考虑就有办法)/Icannotthinkofhisname.Iforgotit.(我想不起他的名字我忘了)/-Whatdoyouthinkabouthiscomposition?-Verygood!(他的作文你觉得怎么样?很好。)(35)agreewith/agreeto/agreeon等词语用法:“agreeto+动词”表示“同意做某事”,“agreewith+sb./观点”表示“赞同…的观点”/agreeabout表示“对…话题有相同看法”/“agreeto+建议”表示“同意”某人的建议,“agreeon+决定”表示“赞成某人的决定”。例略。(36)deserve(应该,应得)的用法:deserve后面可以加不定式,也可以加名词。如:Theyhadtriedtheirbestandtheydeservedtowin.(3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档他们尽力了该赢。)/Thelittleboyalwaysmadetroublesaroundanddeservedbeating.(小男孩总是处处惹麻烦活该被打)/Thegirldidagooddeedanddeservedpraise.(女孩做了好事应该受到表扬)九、连接词1、连词的含义:连接词与词、短语与短语、或引导从句的词叫连接词。2、连词的分类:连词分为并列连接词和从属连接词两种。1、并列连接词连接并列的词、短语、从句或句子。常见的并列连接词有:and(和),but(但是),or(或者,否则),nor(也不),so(所以),however(然而,无论如何),for(因为),still(可是),aswellas(也),both..and...(...和...),notonly...butalso...(不但…而且…),either…or…(或…或…),neither…nor…(既不…也不…)等。2、从属连接词用于引导从句,常见的从属连接词有:when(当…时候),while(正当…时候),after(在…之后),before(在…之前),since(自从),until(直到),although/though(虽然),if(假如),as(如…一样;由于),as…as…(和…一样),asfaras(就…而言),aslongas(只要),assoonas(一…就…),evenif(即使),because(因为),unless(除非),than(比…),whether(是否…),inorderthat…(为了),so…that…(如此…以致),sothat…(以便),nowthat…(现在既然),bythetime…(到…时候),everytime…(每当),asif…(仿佛),nomatterwhen(或whenever)(无论何时),nomatterwhere(或wherever)(无论在哪里)等。[辨析](1)because、as、since、for的用法:because(因为)表示原因的语气最强,常表示必然的因果关系,从句一般放在主句后面;另外,回答why的问句只能用because.as(因为)表示一般的因果关系,语气比because弱,说明比较明显的原因,它引导的从句可以放在句首也可以放在句尾。since(既然)表示对方已经知道、无需加以说明的原因或事实。for(因为)是并列连词,语气较弱,用来补充说明理由或提供一种解释。如:Heisnotatschooltodaybecauseheisseriouslyill.(他今天没有上学因为他病得厉害)/Asallofyouhavegothere,now,let’sgotothezoo.(既然大伙儿都到了我们就去动物园吧)/IwillaskLinTaotogowithmesinceyouareverybusy.(既然你很忙我就叫林涛和我一起去吧)/Wemustbeoffnowforthematchstartsat7:00.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(我们得走了因为比赛在七点开始)(2)if、whether的区别:表示“是否”时,if和whether同义,引导宾语从句,另外,whether还可以引导主语从句、表语从句(以及同位语从句)等名词性从句或者让步状语从句;而if还可以表示“如果”,引导条件状语从句,(主句与从句遵循主将从现的原则)。如:Idon’tknowif/whetherhewillarriveontime.(我不知道他是不是会按时到达)/Iwillringyouupifhearrivesontime.(如果他按时到达我会给你打电话的)[注意]下列情况只能用whether不能用if:①引导主语从句,②引导表语从句,③引导从句作介词宾语,④引导不定式短语,⑤引导让步状语从句,⑥在动词discuss之后,⑦在wonder/notsure之后,⑧在if与whether含义易混时。如:WhetheritisafinedayneGtSundayisstillaquestion.(下个星期天是不是个好天还是个问题)(引导主语从句)/Pleaseaskhimwhethertogotherewitharaincoatornot.(请问一下带不带雨衣去那儿)(作动词的宾语)/Hainanistheplacetobe,whetherit’ssummerorwinter.(海南是个该去的地方无论冬夏)(引导让步状语从句)/Pleaseletmeknowwhetheryouneedmyhelp.(请告诉我你是否需要我的帮助)(引导宾语从句)(如果换成if则还可能表示“如果你需要我的帮助请告知”)(3)while、when、as的用法区别:while常表示一个较长的动作,它引导的从句动作与主句的动作是同时发生的、是平行的;when可以表示较短的动作也可以表示较长的动作,主句和从句的动作可以同时发生也可以先后发生;as与上两词同义,可替换while和when,表示主句和从句的动作同时发生,常译为“一边……一边……”。如:PleasedonottroublemewhileIamwritingmyhomework.(我写作业时请不要打扰我)/I’llgohomewhenIhavefinishedmyjob.(我干完了活儿就回去)/Theywererunningquicklyacrosstheroadwhentheyheardthesoundofatruckcoming.(他们正快速地穿过马路忽然听到了卡车开来的声音)/Aswewalkedinthedarkstreet,wesangsongsandtalkedloudly.(当我们在黑洞洞的街上走路时我们高声地唱歌说话)(4)till/until与not…till/until的区别:前者表示一个延续性的动作,后者表示一个才开始的动作。如:Iwillstayhereandwatchthebabyuntilyoureturn.(我会呆在这里看着娃娃直到你回来)(stay3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档这个动作一直进行到你return)/Theywon’tgoonworkinguntiltheygetwhattheythinkisreasonable.(他们要到获得了他们认为合理的东西时才会继续干下去的)另外till与until基本可以互换,但是在句首时只能用until,不能用till.如:Untilthelastminuteofthematchwekeptplaying.(我们坚持到比赛的最后一分钟)/Notuntilhehadfinishedhisworkdidhegohome.(直到做完工作他才回家)(倒装句)(5)though与although的区别:两个词都表示“虽然”,均不可以与but同时使用,但在句中可加still或yet连用。although“尽管、虽然”仅作连词,比较正式,一般可以换为though;though“虽然、尽管、即使”,还可以与even连用(=evenif),表示“即使、纵然”,作副词时意思是“然而、不过”,不能放在句首。如:HepassedtheeGamsalthoughillnesspreventedhimfromgoingtoclasses.(尽管疾病使他无法上课但是他还是通过了考试)/shewon’tleavetheTVset,eventhoughherhusbandiswaitingforherforthesupper.(她不愿离开电视机虽然丈夫在等她吃饭)/Itwasaquietparty.Ihadagoodtime,though.(这是个不热闹的聚会尽管如此我还是玩得很开心)(6)preferto…ratherthan…与prefer…to…的区别:preferto…ratherthan…后面都是用动词原形,prefer…to…都是用动名词或名词。如:IpreferEnglishtoJapanese.(与日语相比我更喜欢英语)/IprefertolearnEnglishratherthanlearnJapanese.(与日语相比我更喜欢学英语)十、简单句1、简单句的特点:简单句通常只由一个主语(或并列主语)和一个谓语(或并列谓语)构成。2、简单句的种类:简单句一般分为陈述句、疑问句、感叹句和祈使句四种。3、陈述句:用来说明一个事实的句子叫陈述句。它有肯定式和否定式两种形式。▲陈述句的肯定式:Heisamiddleschoolstudent.(他是个中学生)/Ihaveahammerinmyhand.(我手上有把锤子)/Sheteachesusgeography.(她教我们地理)/Thenewplaywasgoodenough3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档andeverybodyenjoyedit.(新的话剧非常好大家都喜欢)▲陈述句的否定式:1)谓语动词如果是tobe、助动词、情态动词时,在它们的后面加“not”。如:Mybrotherisnotateacher.(我的弟弟不是教师)/Hedoesnothaveacousin.(他没有堂兄弟)/Iwillnotgotheretomorrow.(明天我不去那儿)/Mymotherisnotcookingamealinthekitchen.(我母亲现在不在厨房里做饭)/Youmustnotmakesuchmistakesagain.(你不该再犯类似错误了)/Wehaven’tdiscussedthequestionyet(我们还没有讨论那个问题呢).2)谓语动词如果没有上述词语而是其他动词时,须在它的前面加donot(don’t).如:Idon’tknowanythingaboutit.(此事我一无所知)/LiMingdoesnotfeedpigsinthecountryside.(李明不在农村养猪)/Wedidn’teGpecttomeetherrighthere.(我们没指望着在这里见到她)/Wedidn’thaveameetingyesterdayafternoon.(昨天下午我们没有开会)3)如果“have”作“有”讲,也可以在它后面加not构成否定式,其形式与havegot的否定式相同。如:Ihaven’t(got)anybrothersorsisters.(我没有兄弟姐妹)[注意]①句子中如果有all、both、verymuch/well等词时,用not一般构成部分否定,如果要完全否定,则通常使用none、neither、not…atall等;Allofthemwentthere.→Noneofthemwentthere.(他们全都去了那里→他们全都没去那里)②句子中含有little、few、too(太)、hardly、never、neither、nor、seldom等词时,则视为否定句。如:Fewpeoplelivetherebecauselifethereisveryhard.(几乎没有人生活在那里因为那里的生活太艰难了)③陈述句(主语+谓语+其他)在口语中可以直接表示疑问,表示惊讶或明知故问。如:That’syourboss?(那就是你的老板?!)④陈述句一般情况下应使用正常的语序,即:主语+谓语+其他。但是有时会倒装,详见“倒装句”。⑤所有的从句一律使用陈述句语序,即在连接词后采用“主语+谓语+其他”3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档的顺序。如:Theoldmantoldmethathewouldliveherefortenmoreyearsbeforehereturnshome.(老人告诉我说他还要在这儿住几年然后回家)/Couldyoutellmewhoyousawatthepartylastnight?(能告诉我在聚会上你都看见了谁吗?)4、疑问句:▲一般疑问句:用“yes”或“no”来回答的疑问句叫做一般疑问句。1)一般疑问句构成:句中谓语动词是tobe、助动词、情态动词时,则将它们(提前)放到主语前面。如:Isheanengineer?(他是工程师吗?)/Haveyougottoday’snewspaper?(你有今天的报纸吗?)/Shallwegotoseeafilmthisevening?(我们今晚去看电影好吗?)/CanyoueGplainit?(你能解释它吗?)/Isthereanyfishforsupper?(晚饭有鱼吗?)/Wouldyouliketogooutforawalk?(你想出去散步吗?)谓语动词如果没有上述词语而是其他动词时,则在主语前面加助动词do/does/did,原来的谓语动词改为原形。如:DoyougetupatsiGeverymorning?(你天天早晨六点起身吗?)/Doesshestudyhard?(她学习努力吗?)/Didyougothereyesterday?(昨天你去那儿了吗?)2)一般疑问句的回答:一般疑问句通常用简略形式来回答。如:Willyoujoinusinplayingbasketball?(你加入我们打篮球好吗?)—Yes,wewill.(是的我们会。)/—No,wewon’t.(不我们不会。)Haveyougottoday’snewspaper?(你有今天的报纸吗?)—Yes,Ihave.(是的有。)/—No,Ihaven’t.(不没有。)回答时所用的时态应和问句里的时态一致。[注意]回答must或者may开头的疑问句要小心,参见情态动词有关内容。3)一般疑问句的否定结构(即否定形式的一般疑问句)表示惊奇、责怪、建议、看法等,只要将“not”置于主语之后或者将“not”放到主语之前与be,have等助动词或情态动词合并在一起就可以了。如:Willhenotcome?(他难道不来吗?)/Isn’tyoursisteraPartymember?(你的姐姐不是党员吗?)/Haven’tyouanybrothers?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(你没有哥哥吗?)/Don’tyouliketheplay?(你难道不喜欢这个话剧吗?)/Can’twewalkalittlefarther?(我们不能走远些吗?)/Won’tyousitdown?(你不想坐下吗?)/Hasn’tsheheardofthematter?(她没听说过这事儿?)这种否定结构的疑问句的回答与汉语的习惯不同。如果回答是肯定的,就用“yes+肯定结构”;如果回答是否定的,就用“no+否定结构”。(情况与反意问句类似。)如:Can’theanswerthequestion?(他不能回答这个问题吗?)—Yes,hecan.(不,他能回答这个问题。)—No,hecan’t.(是的,他不能回答这个问题。)▲特殊疑问句:要求具体回答的问句。1)特殊疑问句结构是:疑问代词+一般疑问句+?除who以外的疑问代词短语疑问副词如:Whatdoyouwant?(你要什么?)/Who(m)areyoulookingfor?(你在找谁?)/Whosemagazineisthis?(这是谁的杂志?)/Whichclassareyouin?(你在哪班?)/Whendidyougetupthismorning?(你今早什么时候起身的?)/Wherehaveyoubeen?(你到哪儿去了?)/Whydidhegotobedsoearly?(他为什么这么早睡觉?)/Howdidyougothere?(你是怎么去的那儿?)但是,“who”引出的询问主语或主语部分相关词的特殊疑问句的结构与陈述句词序相同:如:Whoisdancingoverthere?(谁在那边跳舞?)有时“what”,“which”,“whose”也可以引出与陈述句词序相同的特殊疑问句。如:Whatisonthewall?(什么东西在墙上?/墙上有什么?)/Whichisyours?(哪个是你的?)/Whosebookisinyourbag?(谁的书在你的书包里?)[注意]从陈述句改为特殊问句时,先将句子改为一般问句,再将(划线)提问部分更改为疑问词置于句首,特别要注意助动词的使用!如果只对主语或主语的修饰词提问,那么只需要将疑问部分改为疑问词即可。2)常用疑问代词和疑问副词:3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档疑问代词:who,whom,whose,which,what,疑问副词:when,where,why,how,how构成的短语:howmany(多少个)(独立用;或跟可数名词),howmuch(多少)(独立用;或跟不可数名词),howold(多大年纪),howfar(多远),howoften(多常),howlong(多久,多长),howsoon(多久以后),howmanytimes(多少次),等等。3)特殊疑问句有时也用否定式。如:Whydon’tyouaskJiminstead?(常缩略为Whynot…?)(你为什么不转请Jim呢?)4)特殊疑问句疑问部分有时可以有两个以上的疑问词。如:Whenandwherewereyouborn?(你是何时何地出生的?)5)疑问词如果是介词的宾语,则该介词可以在句首,也可以在句尾。如:Whatdoyouwantacomputerfor?=Forwhatdoyouwantacomputer?(你干嘛要一台电脑呢?)▲反意疑问句:反意疑问句表示对陈述句所说的事实提出相反的疑问,要求对方用“yes”或“no”来进行回答。1)构成:由两部分组成:前一部分是陈述句,后一部分是疑问句,它是由be,have,助动词或情态动词+主语构成。如果陈述句是肯定结构,反意疑问句须用否定结构;反之,陈述句如果是否定结构,反意疑问句须用肯定结构。反意疑问句的两部分,必须保持人称和时态的一致;反意疑问句的回答有时会和汉语不同。陈述句部分附加问句部分注意点肯定陈述句否定的简短一般问句当陈述句部分含有“是”动词、(“有”动词)、情态动词和助动词时,简短问句中沿用该词;否则就使用do/does//did.否定陈述句肯定的简短一般问句如:Heisold,isn’the?(他老了不是吗?)/Themanwentaway,didn’the?(那个男人走开了不是吗?)/Heisn’told,ishe?(他不老是吗?)/Heneverwentthere,didhe?(他从没有去过那里是吗?)2)反意问句的回答:无论哪种形式的反意问句,回答时要遵循:“Yes,+肯定式”或者“No,+否定式”3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档如:Themanwentaway,didn’the?(那人走开了,不是吗?)——Yes,hedid.(是的,他走了。)/No,hedidn’t.(不,他没有走。)Themanneverwentthere,didhe?(这人从来不去那里,是吗?)——Yes,hedid.(不是呀,他去的。)/No,hedidn’t.(是呀,他不去。)▲选择疑问句:提出两种或两种以上情况,需要对方作出选择回答的疑问句叫选择疑问句。1)构成:(1)一般疑问句+or+第二选项?(2)特殊疑问句+第一选项(+第二选项)+or+第三选项?2)选择疑问句的结构与特殊疑问句相同,即要具体回答,不可以用yes/no回答。如:Isyourfriendaboyoragirl?–Agirl.(----你的朋友是男孩还是女孩?----是女孩。)/Whichdoyouprefer,coffeeortea?–Tea,please.(---你要哪一样咖啡还是茶?----请来茶吧。)/Whichdoyoulikebest,singing,dancingorskating?--Dancing,ofcourse.(----唱歌、跳舞和溜冰你最喜欢哪样?----当然是跳舞啦!)5、祈使句:祈使句用来表示请求、命令等。它的主语you往往不说出。▲祈使句的肯定式:动词(原形)+其他如:Pleasegivemeahand.(请帮忙)/Shutup!(住嘴!)▲祈使句的否定式:Don’t+动词原形+其他如:Pleasedon’ttalkinlowvoices.(请不要低声讲话。)/Don’tlookback!(不要掉头看。)[注意]以“let’s”引出的祈使句的否定结构,“not”应放在“let’s”后面。如:Let’snottroublehim.(我们不要打扰他。)肯定祈使句前可以用助动词来强调语气。如:Pleasedohelpme!(请千万帮帮我。)6、感叹句:感叹句用来表示喜怒哀乐等强烈感情。句末常用“!”▲对含有形容词的名词短语感叹的结构通常是:What+(a/an)+(形容词)+名词+陈述句结构(主谓语),用来强调句子中的名词,如:Whatagood,kindgirl(sheis)!(她是多么善良的好女孩!)/Whatbadweather(itis)!(天气真糟糕!)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档▲仅对形容词或副词进行感叹的结构通常是:How+形容词/副词+陈述句结构(主谓语),用来强调句子中的形容词、副词或动词。Howcarefullytheoldmanwalks!(这老人走路真小心!)/Howdeliciousthefoodis!(这食品真好吃!)/Howbeautiful!(真美呀!)▲有时,陈述句、祈使句、疑问句、一个词或词组,也带有一定的感情色彩,也可以成为感叹句,此时未必使用感叹句型。Heissittingonatiger’sback!(他坐在老虎的背上!)/Aniceshot!(漂亮一击!)/Goodgoal!(好球!)十一、句子成分:主语、谓语、宾语、表语、定语、宾语补足语和状语1、主语:(1)由名词、代词(人称代词用主格)、动词不定式、动名词等充当,说明动作是“谁”发出的。如:Thepainterpaintedaverynicepicture.(画家画了一幅漂亮的画。)/TheyfoughtagainstSARSbravely.(他们勇敢地与非典搏斗。)/Toseeistobelieve.(耳听为虚眼见为实)./Helpinganimalsistohelppeople.(帮助动物就是帮助人类。)(2)动词不定式或动名词做主语时可用it代替,而不定式或动名词移至表语或宾语之后。如:ItisverycomfortabletohaveaClassAseatduringthelongjourney.(在长途旅行中能有个甲等座位简直太舒服了。)/Eatingtoomuchisbadforyourhealth.(=Itisbadforyourhealtheatingtoomuch.)(吃得太多对你的身体不利。)(3)口语中常见主语或“主--系”省略:(Itis)nothing.((那)没有什么。)/(It)doesn’tmatter.((那)没有关系。)/(I)thankyou.((我)谢谢你。)(4)反意问句的附加问句,主语必须是代词:Themanlooksworried,doesn’the?(这个人看上去很着急不是吗?)/Tigersaredangerousanimals,aren’tthey?(老虎是危险的动物不是吗?)(5)祈使句一般省略主语。加主语时往往用来指定某个人。Keepthekeyboardsclean,children.(孩子们请保持键盘的清洁。)(省略了主语)/Yougothereandfetchmeaglassofwater.(你去给我弄一杯水来。)(6)主语一般在句首,但在问句中会处于第二位和句尾;倒装句及therebe句3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档型主语在动词之后。如:Computersaremadeinthisfactory.(计算机生产于这家工厂。)/Wherearethey?(他们在哪儿?)/Doestheboylikestayinghome?(这个男孩喜欢呆在家里吗?)(7)主语与谓语必须保持单、复数的一致,而谓语与表语或宾语之间没有这一要求。NeitherJimnorRosehaspassedtheeGam.(Jim和Rose都没有通过考试。)/TheChinesepeopleareahardworkingandbravepeople.(中华民族是一个勤劳勇敢的民族。)(8)主语可以由从句充当,详见“主语从句”。2、谓语:(1)由“不及物动词”、“及物动词+宾语”或“系动词+表语”等构成,说明主语所表示的人物“干什么”或“怎么样”。如:Hetravelledinspaceforthefirsttime.(他首次在太空旅行。)/WhoteachesyouEnglishthisyear?(今年谁教你们的英语?)/Thepizzahasgonebad.(那块烤馅饼已经变坏。)/(2)谓语动词必须反映出人称、单复数、时态等信息,谓语动词往往由下列词语依序排列构成:[情态动词]+[时态助动词]+[语态助动词]+[主要动词](不一定全部出现)。(见动词的时态和语态构成表) 记住:谓语部分第一个动词往往是变形动词。如:IamsorryIammakingsomuchnoisebutIhaveto.(对不起我发出了太大的声音但是只能这样。)/Hecan’thavefinishedreadingthe800-page-longnovel.(他不可能读完了那本长达800页的小说。)/Somethingmustbedonetostopthefowlflufromspreadingout.(该采取措施防止禽流感蔓延。)(3)谓语动词切忌用“行为动词1+原形动词”、“be+原形动词”。记住使用下列正确形式:①情态动词+原形动词。如:You’dbettergooverthelesson.(你最好复习这一课。)②shall/will/would+原形动词。如:Theyshouldhavebeenthereonce.(他们应该去过那儿。)③be+现在分词或者过去分词。如:Whatareyoudoingthisevening?3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(今晚你打算做什么?)/Manytreeshavebeencutdownsince1970s.(自从20世纪70年代大批树木被砍伐。)④have+过去分词。如:Manytreeshavebeencutdownsince1970s.(意思同上)⑤一般时问句和否定句中:do/does/did+原形动词。如:Hedoesnotenjoyhimselfverymuch.(他日子过的不好。)/Didanyofyouseedinosaureggs?(你们当中有谁见过恐龙蛋吗?)⑥行为动词1+行为动词2(不定式、动名词、现在分词、过去分词等形式)。如:Hemadeuphismindtobeavet.(他拿定主意要做个兽医。)/Feelinggoodaboutyourselfisessentialtofeelinggoodaboutlife.(自尊自爱是享受生活的根本。)/Theywakeuptheotherfamilymembers,calling,“MerryChristmas!”(他们叫醒家庭的其他成员,呼喊着:圣诞快乐!)/ThekingsofancientEgypthadstrongtombsbuiltforthemselves.(古代的埃及国王让人给他们自己修建坚固的坟墓。)(4)不可用形容词、名词、代词、副词、介词短语等独立作谓语,必须在此之前加连系动词。(5)谓语动词单复数形式:单数形式的动词有:is,was,has,does以及“动词+s”;复数形式的动词有:are,were,have以及动词原形。其他动词不分单、复数。谓语部分第一个动词的形式单数形式复数形式一般现在时be(是)动词;现在某些时态和语态的助动词beam(单一);are(单二);is(单三);are一般过去时be(是)动词;过去某些时态和语态的助动词bewas(单一);were(单二);was;(单三)were一般现在时have(有)动词;现在完成时态的助动词havehave(单一);have(单二);has(单三);have一般现在时行为动词和助动词dodo(单一、单二);does(单三)do原形动词(单一、单二);原形动词3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档实意动词和连系动词的一般现在时动词(否定和疑问句除外)动词+s/es(单三)其他各时态语态的谓语动词单复数形式相同记住:主语、谓语单复数必须保持一致。(参见“4、名词或代词作主语时和谓语之间的单复数的一致问题:”)Airandwaterisnecessarytousall.(空气和水对于我们大家是必不可少的。)(6)一般问句和反意问句的回答不使用行为动词,应该使用“是”动词、情态动词、助动词(be,will,have,do以及变形)。如:TheOlympicGamesisheldeveryotheryear,isn’tit?----Yes,itis.(奥运会每两年举办一次,是吗?----是的。)3、宾语:(1)由名词、代词(人称代词要用宾格)、不定式、动名词、(宾语)从句充当,表示动作的承受者是“谁”或者是“何物”。如:TheangelalsocametoJosephandtoldhimthesamething.(那个天使同样来到约瑟夫面前并且告诉他同样的事情。)(代词和名词充当两个宾语)/Hetoldmethatthecompanycouldnotaffordtopayhimsomuchmoney.(他告诉我说公司付不起他那么多的钱。)(不定式作宾语)/Theyenjoywatchingfootballgamessomuchthattheyoftenforgettheirlessons.(他们如此喜爱看足球以至于常常忘记了他们的功课。)(动名词作宾语)/Ithinktobeachildren’sdoctorisveryrewarding.(我认为当个儿童医生是很值得的。)(从句作宾语)(2)只有及物动词或介词才有宾语,不及物动词没有宾语,如果涉及到事物,则必须在不及物动词后面加合适的介词。Listentotheradio.(listen不是及物动词,故加to。)/CanyouhearanythingeGciting?(你能听到什么令人兴奋的消息吗?)(3)宾语一般放在及物动词或介词的后面,但是在疑问句中,如果宾语是疑问词,则宾语要放在句首。介词的宾语如果是疑问词,则可以放在介词后或句首。如:Whatdidhesee?(他看见了什么?)/Whatdoeshewritealetterwith?(他用什么写的信?)/Withwhatdoeshewritealetter?(他用什么写的信?)(4)“动词+副词+宾语”结构中,如果宾语是代词,则代词必须放在“动”“副”3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档之间。如:Pleaseputtheshoesaway.(请把鞋子收起来。)/Pleaseputawaytheshoes.(请把鞋子收起来。)/Pleaseputthemaway.(请把它们收起来。)(5)动词后面跟双宾语时可以采用两种结构:①动词+间接宾语(人)+直接宾语(物)。如:Heoftengivesmesomehelp.(他常常帮我。)②动词+直接宾语+介词+间接宾语。注意,一般情况介词用to,但动词是make,buy,borrow时,介词用for.如:Pleasemakemeakite.(请给我做个风筝。)或Pleasemakeakiteforme.(6)在“动词+宾语+宾补”结构中,如果宾语是不定式、动名词、宾语从句,则常用it做形式宾语,而将实际的宾语移到补语后面去。如:Ifoundthejobratherdifficult.(我发觉这个工作相当难做。)/Ifounditratherdifficulttodothejob.(7)宾语可以由从句充当,详见“宾语从句”。4、表语:(1)说明主语的身份、性质、状况等含义的成分,通常由形容词、副词、介词短语、名词、代词等充当。如:Hebecameadoctorafterhelefthighschool.(高中毕业他当上了医生。)/Therubberwheelsareoverthere.(橡胶轮子在那边。)/Hedoesnotfeellikeeatinganythingtodaybecausehehascaughtabadcold.(他今天不想吃任何东西因为他得了重感冒。)/Whoisit?(谁呀?)(2)表语只能放在连系动词(如:be,look,become,turnget,grow,feel,seem)之后,对表语进行提问的句子除外。(3)代词做表语一般用主格,口语中常用宾。如:It’sI.(It’sme.)是我。(4)只能作表语的形容词有:sorry,afraid,alone,asleep,awake,ill,well,sure,interested等等。Hewasterriblysorryforhiscarelessness.(他很为他的粗心而歉疚。)/Pleasemakenonoisehere;thebabyisasleep.(请不要发出响动,婴儿正熟睡呢。)/Iamonlyinterestedinsittinginaboatanddoingnothingatall!(我只是对独坐孤舟无所事事感兴趣。)/Iamnotaloneinthinkingso.(并非只有我才这样想的。)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(5)表语也可以由从句充当,详见“表语从句”。5、定语:(1)修饰名词或代词的成分,常由形容词、名词(含所有格)、代词(物主、指示、疑问、不定)、介词短语、不定式(短语)充当,在初三阶段还学习了定语从句做定语的知识。如:Putitinthetopdrawer.(把它放在最上层的抽屉里。)/FranceandSwitzerlandareEuropeancountries.(法国和瑞士是欧洲国家。)/Hismotherandfatherarebothcollegeteachers.(他的父母都是大学教师。)/ThisisthedaythatIcanneverforgetinmylife.(这是我一辈子难忘的日子。)(2)单词做定语时一般放在被修饰的名词前面,而且有一定的次序:冠词/物代年龄/形状/大小/温度色彩来源质地/材料目的/用途被修饰的名词(中心词)athemyhis…old,young,…red,yellow,blue,…Chinese,English,American,…wooden,woolen,glass,silk,paper…meeting,tennis,sports,reading,swimming,…boG,shoes,room,pig…long,short,round,square…big,large,small,little…hot,cold,warm,cool…(3)时间副词(now,then,today,yesterday,...)、地点副词(here,there,back,in,out,home,...作定语时放在被修饰的名词后面。如:Icouldnotfindmywayout,soIstayedthereallalong.(我找不到出去的路,所以就一直呆在那儿。)(4)介词短语修饰名词时只能放在名词的后面:Themonkeyinthecagewascaughtyesterday.(笼子里的猴子是昨天逮着的。)(5)形容词修饰复合不定代词时,往往后置。如:Herememberedeverythingunusual.(他记得所有不寻常的事情。)(6)定语还可以用从句充当,详见定语从句。(7)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档注意:由于定语属于修饰性的成分,因此它常归入主语、宾语、表语之中,不作为句子的主要成分。6、状语:(1)说明动作“何时”、“何地”、“如何”发生,或者说明形容词或副词的程度,一般由副词、介词短语、不定式、状语从句等充当。如:Iwasnotbornyesterday.(我又不是昨天才出世的娃娃。)/Formanyofthesefamiliesacollegeeducationwassomethingnew.(对其中的许多家庭来说,大学教育是件新事物。)/Hewokeuptofindhishouseonfire.(他醒来发现房子着火了。)/Youcannotleaveuntilyourworkisfinished.(在你的工作被完成以前你不能离开)(2)副词作状语位置较为灵活,详见《六·2》“副词在句子中的位置以及作用”;介词短语作状语,位置基本固定,详见《七·4》“介词短语在句子中的位置”;不定式作状语,一般表示目的、结果,详见《八·7》“动词的非谓语形式”;从句作状语,详见《主从复合句》的“状语从句”。(3)多个状语相连时,一般先单词、后短语,先地点、后时间,先小概念、后大概念。如:Hewentoufoftheroomataquarterto23:00lastnightandthendisappearedintothedark.(他昨夜22点3刻从房间里出来,然后消失在黑暗之中。)/(4)状语还可以用从句来充当,有时间状语从句、地点状语从句、原因状语从句、目的状语从句、结果状语从句、比较状语从句、让步状语从句、条件状语从句等。详见“状语从句”。(5)注意:由于状语属于修饰性的成分,常归入谓语,因此不作为句子的主要成分。7、宾语补足语:(1)补充说明宾语的动作、状态的成分为宾语补足语,常由名词、形容词、动词非谓语形式(不定式、现在分词、过去分词等)、介词短语等充当。如:CallhimJim,please.(请叫他Jim。)/Itriedmybesttomakehimhappy.(我竭尽所能让他开心。)/Askhertocometodinnertomorrow.(请他明天来。)/Heletthesmalleranimalsbringfoodtohim.(他让小动物们给他带食物来。)3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(2)部分表示位置、方向的副词也可以作宾语补足语。如:Lethimin,Itellyou!(我跟你说,让他进来!)/Pleaseputitaway.(请把它收起来。)(3)不定式或分词作宾语补足语的情况,详见《八·7》“动词的非谓语形式”相关内容。十二、简单句五种基本句型:句子包含主要句子成分(主语、谓语)和次要句子成分(表语、宾语、宾语补足语),按照动词的性质将英语简单句划分为以下五种基本句型:1、基本句型的词序:2、划分符号(没有统一规定,仅供参考):主语:定语:()谓语:状语:[]宾语:宾补:〈〉表语:主谓句型:S-Vi。主系表句型:S-Vlink-P主谓宾句型:S-Vt.-O主谓双宾句型:S-Vt-O间宾-O直宾主谓宾补句型:S-Vt-O-C3、例句:Jimisworking[veryhard][now].(他现在正非常努力地工作。)Sheisyoung.(她年轻。)Itlookslikerain.(天看上去要下雨。)Theboy[always]kickedthedog[withhisfeet].(这男孩老是用脚踢那只狗。)Hehas[never]boughtmeatoy[sincelastyear].(从去年起他没给我买过一个玩具。)Hefeltsomething(cold).(他感到有个冰冷的东西顺着腿上爬。)4、英语词类与句子成分关系图:句子成分词类或短语主语G谓语宾语G表语G定语G状语G宾语补足语名词√√√×√√√√√√×√代词√√√×√√√√√√√××形容词×××√√√√√√×√√数词√×√√√√√×√时态语态形式×√√√×××××3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档动词动词不定式√√×√√√√√√√√√动名词√√×√√√√√××动词现在分词×××√√√√√√√动词过去分词×××√√√√√√副词×××√√√√√√介词短语×××√√√√√√[注释]1、“√”表示某种词类可以充当某个成分,“√√”表示某种词类经常充当某个成分,“√√√”表示某种词类最经常充当某个成分。“×”表示某种词类不能充当某个成分。2、“G”表示该成分可以由从句充当,如主语从句、宾语从句、状语从句等。十三、并列复合句1、基本概念:并列复合句是由两个或两个以上并列而又独立的简单句构成。两个简单句常由并列连接词连在一起;但有时不用连接词,只在两个简单句之间用一逗号或分号。2、常见的并列句:(1)用来连接两个并列概念的连接词有and,notonly…butalso…,neither…nor…等,and所连接的前后分句往往表示先后关系、递进关系。前后分句的时态往往保持一致关系,若第一个分句是祈使句,那么第二个分句用将来时。(2)表示在两者之间选择一个,常用的连接词有or,otherwise,orelse,either…or…等,前后分句的时态往往保持一致关系,若第一个分句是祈使句,那么第二个分句用将来时。(3)表明两个概念彼此有矛盾、相反或者转折,常用的连接词有but,yet,still,however等,前后分句时态一致。(4)说明原因,用连接词for,前后分句时态一致。(5)表示结果,用连接词so,前后分句时态一致。3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档十四、主从复合句1、概念:主从复合句由一个主句和一个或一个以上的从句构成。主句为句子的主体,从句只用作句子的一个次要成分,不能独立成为一个句子。从句通常由关联词引导,并由关联词将从句和主句联系在一起。如:Whilethegrandparentslovethechildren,theyarestrictwiththem.(爷爷奶奶们很爱孩子,同时对他们也严格要求。)/Itseemedasifthemeetingwouldneverend.(看起来会议没完没了。)/Hurryup,or(else)you"llbelate.(快点,要不然就来不及了。)/HoweverIcookeggs,thechildstillrefusestoeatthem.(不管我用什么方法煮鸡蛋,小孩还是不肯吃。)2、分类:从句按其在复合句中的作用,分为主语从句、表语从句、宾语从句、定语从句和状语从句等。(参见以下各条)3、各从句在句子中的位置以及用法:(1)表语从句:在句子中作连系动词的表语的从句,它位于主句中的系动词之后。例如:Thatiswhyhedidnotcometoschoolyesterday./Itisbecauseyouaresoclever.(2)宾语从句:在句子中作及物动词或介词的宾语。①基本形式:(主句+)连词+从句主语+从句谓语+...②关于宾语从句连词的选择:若从句来源于一个陈述句,那么,连词用that,在口语中that可以省略;若从句来源于一个一般疑问句,连词则用if或whether;若从句来源于一个特殊疑问句,则连词就是疑问词(如what,who,where,when等)例如:Theybelievethatthecomputerwillfinallytaketheplaceofhumanbeings.(他们相信计算机终将代替人类。)(从句本来就是陈述句)/IwonderwhetherIshouldsaysomethingforhimtotheheadmaster.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档(我不知道是不是该为他在校长跟前说点什么。)(从句来源于一般问句ShallIsaysomethingforhimtotheheadmaster?)/Heaskedmewherehecouldgetsuchmedicine.(他问我在哪儿能搞到那样的药。)(从句来源于特殊问句Wherecanhegetsuchmedicine?)③宾语从句的时态问题:如果主句是现在时,从句则用现在某一时态,甚至可以用过去时;如主句是过去时,从句则相应地使用过去某一时态,遇到客观真理时仍然用现在时。如:IthinkIwilldobetterinEnglishthisterm.(我想本学期我的英语会学得好点。)/Theteacheraskedtheboyiftheearthisround.(老师问那个男孩地球是不是圆的。)④下列结构后面的从句一般也作为宾语从句看待:besorry/afraid/sure/glad+that从句,如:I’msorryI’mlate.(对不起,我迟到了。)/I’mafraidheisn’tinatthemoment.(恐怕他此刻不在家。)(3)状语从句:在复合句中作状语,其位置可以在主句前或主句后。状语从句可以分为时间、地点、原因、目的、结果、比较、让步、条件等几种。状语从句由从属连接词引导。时间状语从句通常由when,as,while,after,before,since,assoonas,since,till(until),while,whenever等引导。时间状语从句一般放在句首或句尾,特别注意,时间状语从句不允许使用将来时,而应该用现在时替代。如:Whenyoufinishthework,youmaygoouttoplaywithSam.(你完成工作就可以出去和Jim一起玩了。)/Iwon’tleaveuntilMumcomesback.(妈妈回来了我才会走。)地点状语从句通常由where,wherever等引导。如:Gobackwhereyoucamefrom!(哪里来还滚到哪里去!)/Iwillneverforgettocatchthethiefwhostolemynecklacewhereverhemaybe.(我永远也不会忘记去抓住那个偷我项链的贼,无论他会在哪里。)原因状语从句通常由because,since,as等引导,一般放在句首或句尾。如:Hewentabroadbecausehisfatherhadfoundagooduniversityforhim.(他出国了,因为他父亲给他找了一所好大学。)目的状语从句通常由sothat...,so...hat...,inorderthat...3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档等引导,往往放在句尾,从句中通常含有can/could/may/might等情态动词。如:Hegotupearliersothathecouldcatchthefirsttrain.(他起身更早为的是赶上第一班车。)结果状语从句通常由sothat...,so...that...等引导,放在句尾。结果状语从句一般表示已经发生的事情,故多为过去时态。如:Helostsomanybikesthathedecidednevertobuyanewone.(他丢了那么多辆自行车,他决定再也不买新车了。)比较状语从句通常由as,than,as(so)...as等引导,一般省略从句的谓语部分,只剩下名词或代词(用主格或宾格均可)。如:JaneismuchtallerthanI/me.(Jane比我高多了。)/Idon’thaveasmanybooksasyou(do).(我书没有你多)让步状语从句通常由though(although),as,evenif(eventhough),however,whatever等引导。如:Evenifyoupaythedebt(债务)forme,Iwillnotthankyoubecauseithasnothingtodowithme.(即使你替我还了债我也不会感谢你,因为它与我毫无关系。)/HewearsaT-shirtthoughitisverycold.(他穿了一件T恤衫,尽管天很冷。)条件状语从句通常由if,unless,aslongas等引导,条件状语从句一般放在句首或句尾,特别注意,时间状语从句不允许使用将来时,而应该用现在时替代。YouwillcertainlyfailinthecomingfinaleGamsunlessyouworkmuchharder.(即将来到的期末考试你肯定考不及格,除非你更用功。)/Ifitdoesn’traintomorrow,weshallgohiking.(如果明天不下雨我们就要去徒步旅行。)[注意]1、because与so;(al)though与but;if与so不可以同在一个句子中成对出现。2、时间、条件、原因,让步状语从句放在句首时需要用逗号与主句隔开。(4)定语从句:在复合句中作定语用修饰句子中某一名词或代词的从句叫定语从句。①定语从句的位置:放在名词或代词的后面。如:Themanwhohasanumbrellainhishandismyuncle.(手上抓了一把雨伞的人是我的叔叔。)②语法术语的改变:被修饰的名词或代词称为先行词3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档;引导定语从句的连接词称为关系词,其中that、which、who称为关系代词,where、when、how称为关系副词。③关系代词或关系副词的作用:关系代词who、whom和whose指人,分别在从句中作主语、宾语和定语。which指物that多指物,有时也指人,它们在从句中可以作主语或宾语。定语从句中关系代词作从句宾语时可以省略。Thisisthethief(that/who/whom)wehavebeenlookingforthesedays.(这个就是我们近日一直在找的小偷。)/Pleasefindaroomwhichisbigenoughforallofustolivein.(请找一间足够大能住下我们全体的房间。)关系副词when或where引导定语从句时,它们在从句中分别作时间状语和地点状语。如:Thisistheroomwheretheyhadaquarrelaweekago.(这是一个星期前他们吵架的房间。)/IcanneverforgetthedaywhenIfirstsawyou.(我永远不会忘记第一次见到你的日子。)④限制性定语从句和非限制性定语从句。限制性定语从句在句中不能省略,否则主句意思就不完整。非限制性定语从句和主句之间往往用逗号分开,这种从句是一种附加说明,如果从句子中省去,也不致于影响主句的意思。如:Shespentthewholeeveningtalkingaboutherlatestbook,whichnoneofushadheardof.(她一个晚上都在谈论她最近的书,我们一个人都没有听说过那本书。)[注解]1、关系代词只能用that的情况:当先行词是指事物的不定代词(all,anything等),或先行词部分含有最高级,或含有序数词时,不能用其他的关系代词,只能用that.如:AllthatLilytoldmeseemsuntrue.(Lily告诉我的话似乎不真实。)/Canyougivemeanythingthathasnosugarinside?(能不能给我点里面没有糖的东西?)/Thisisthefirsttwo-storybusthatrunsinourcity.(这是第一辆运行于我市的双层公交车。)2、关系代词在从句中作主语时一般用who(指人)、that(指物),而不用that指人或用which指物。如:Doyouknowthewomanwhoisweepinginthecorner?(你认识那个在角落里哭泣的女人吗?)/Donottellmeanywordsthathavenothingtodowith3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档me.(跟我无关的话,请一个字也不要说。)3、关系代词作从句的宾语时,常用which或whom,较少使用that或who,而且,关系代词常常省略。如:Tom’sfatherwasthefirstparentwhomourteachertalkedto.(Tom的父亲是我们老师第一个谈话的人。)4、当关系代词紧跟在介词后面时,必须用which或whom,而当介词移到句尾时,则又可以使用that或who.如:ThisistheroominwhichMissLioncelived.(=ThisistheroomMissLioncelivedin.)(这是李小姐曾经居住过的房间。)(5)主语从句:在句子中充当句子主语的从句叫主语从句。位于谓语动词之前。通常由that,whether以及疑问连词引导。一般情况下,常用it替代主语从句,而将主语从句移到句尾。如:Whenweshouldstartisstillaquestion.(我们该在什么时候开始还是个问题呢。)十G五、直接引语和间接引语(初中不作特别要求)1、直接引语和间接引语:在陈述句中,直接引用说话人原来的语句,称为直接引语。在书写时,直接引语用引号。用自己的词语来转述表达原来说话人说的内容,称为间接引语。2、直接引语改变为间接引语:1、直接引语如果是陈述句,变为间接引语时应注意以下各点:①不用引号,而用连接词that,但有时可省略。②人称作相应变化;③主句里的动词如果是过去时,间接引语中的时态一般应作相应改变:一般现在时变一般过去时;一般将来时变过去将来时;现在进行时变过去进行时;现在完成时变成过去完成时;一般过去时变成过去完成时;但一般过去时如与一个具体的过去时间连用,则时态不变。如:Hesays,"IamnotfromtheUSA.”→HesaysthatheisnotfromtheUSA.MrSmithsaidtohisgirlfriend,“Ihaven’tseenyouforalongtime.”→MrSmithsaidtohisgirlfriendthathehadnotseenherforalongtime.3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档2、直接引语如果是一般疑问句,变为间接引语时,需用从属连接词whether或if引导,词序要改变。如:LinTaosaidtoMissGreen,"IsitmadeinChina?”→LinTaoaskedMissGreenifitwasmadeinChina.3、直接引语如果是特殊疑问句,变为间接引语时,需用疑问词引导,词序是:连词+主语+谓语。如:Lucysaidtome,“HowcanIhelp?”→Lucyaskedmehowshecouldhelp.4、直接引语如是祈使句,变间接引语时,须将祈使句变为动词不定式,并在动词不定式前用tell,ask,order.如:Hesaidtothelittleboy,“Comehere,youngman!”→Heaskedthelittleboytogothere.5、直接引语变为间接引语时,指示代词以及表示时间和地点的词或词组应作相应变化:在直接引语中在间接引语中thatthosethenbeforethatdaythatweek(month,etc.)theneGtweek(month,etc.)thedaybeforetheneGt(following)daytherethisthesenowagotodaythisweek(month,etc.)neGtweek(month,etc.)yesterdaytomorrowhere十六、倒装句:谓语的一部分或者全部放在主语之前的句子称为倒装句。1、THEREBE句型以及以here、there开头的句子。如:Therearealotofchildrenintheshowroom.(在展览室里有许多的小孩。)/Herecomesthebus.(公交车来了。)/Theregoesthebell.(铃响了。)/ThedooropenedandincameMrLee.(门开了,李先生走了进来。)2、用“So/Nor/Neither+助动词+主语”倒装结构表示第二个人物的情况与上文的人物情况相同。如:Tomwenttothebeachlastweek,and,sodidI.(Tom上个星期去了海滩,我也是。)/LiMei’sboughtnothingfromtheshop.NeitherhasJim.(李梅没有在店里买什么,Jim也没有买。)3、在疑问句中,通常使用在主语之前安放助动词的倒装方法,对主语提问除外。如:Howdidhefindthelostbook?(他是怎么样找到丢失的书的?)/Wherearetheygoingtospendthesummervacation?(他们打算到哪儿过暑假?)4、感叹句中通常将被感叹的部分前移,而将句子的主谓语整体后置。如:What3525A版优质实用文档
5A版优质实用文档abeautifulflower(itis)!(那是多漂亮的花!)5、有引号引用某人的原话时,引号外面的主谓一般采用倒装形式放在句尾,但是,若主语是代词则不倒装。如:“Whatonearthareyoudoingupthere?”saidthefather.(父亲说:“你在上边到底干什么?”)/“Whatonearthareyoudoingupthere?”hesaid.(他说:“你在上边到底干什么?”)十七、附加注释die、dead、death的用法:die是动词,可以独立做谓语,有各种时态变化,也可以变成非谓语形式作句子的其他成分;dead是形容词,作句子的定语、表语或宾语补足语;death是名词,作句子的主语、宾语等。如:I’mgoingtodie!(我要死了!)/Themanhasbeendeadforaboutthreemonths.(那个人死了三个月左右。)/Heisworriedtodeath.(他急得要死。)3525A版优质实用文档